[gdb/doc] Fix "maint info selftests" command index entry
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 @node Sample Session
561 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
562
563 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
564 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
565 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
566
567 @iftex
568 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
569 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
570 @end iftex
571
572 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
573 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
574
575 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
576 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
577 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
578 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
579 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
580 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
581 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
582 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
583 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
584
585 @smallexample
586 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
587 $ @b{./m4}
588 @b{define(foo,0000)}
589
590 @b{foo}
591 0000
592 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
593
594 @b{bar}
595 0000
596 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
597
598 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
599 @b{baz}
600 @b{Ctrl-d}
601 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
606
607 @smallexample
608 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
609 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
610 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
611 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
612 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
613 the conditions.
614 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
615 for details.
616
617 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
618 (@value{GDBP})
619 @end smallexample
620
621 @noindent
622 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
623 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
624 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
625 that examples fit in this manual.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
633 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
634 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
635 @code{break} command.
636
637 @smallexample
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
639 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
644 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
645 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
649 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
650 @b{define(foo,0000)}
651
652 @b{foo}
653 0000
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
658 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
659 context where it stops.
660
661 @smallexample
662 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
663
664 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:879
666 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
671 the next line of the current function.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
676 : nil,
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
681 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
682 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
683 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
688 at input.c:530
689 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
694 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
695 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
696 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
697 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
698 stack frame for each active subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
702 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
703 at input.c:530
704 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
705 at builtin.c:882
706 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
707 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
708 at macro.c:71
709 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
710 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
715 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
716 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
717
718 @smallexample
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
720 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
722 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
723 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup(rq);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 @end smallexample
730
731 @noindent
732 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
733 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
734 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
735 (@code{print}) to see their values.
736
737 @smallexample
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
739 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
741 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @noindent
745 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
746 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
747 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
748
749 @smallexample
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
751 533 xfree(rquote);
752 534
753 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
754 : xstrdup (lq);
755 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
756 : xstrdup (rq);
757 537
758 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
759 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
760 540 @}
761 541
762 542 void
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
767 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
768
769 @smallexample
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
771 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
773 540 @}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
775 $3 = 9
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
777 $4 = 7
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
782 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
783 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
784 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
785 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
786 assignments.
787
788 @smallexample
789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
790 $5 = 7
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
792 $6 = 9
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
797 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
798 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
799 example that caused trouble initially:
800
801 @smallexample
802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
803 Continuing.
804
805 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
806
807 baz
808 0000
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
813 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
814 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
815
816 @smallexample
817 @b{Ctrl-d}
818 Program exited normally.
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
823 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
824 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
825
826 @smallexample
827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 @node Invocation
831 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
832
833 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
834 The essentials are:
835 @itemize @bullet
836 @item
837 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
838 @item
839 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
840 @end itemize
841
842 @menu
843 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
844 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
845 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
846 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
847 @end menu
848
849 @node Invoking GDB
850 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
851
852 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
853 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
854
855 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
856 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
857
858 The command-line options described here are designed
859 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
860 options may effectively be unavailable.
861
862 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
863 specifying an executable program:
864
865 @smallexample
866 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
867 @end smallexample
868
869 @noindent
870 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
871 specified:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
875 @end smallexample
876
877 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
878 to debug a running process:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
886 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
887
888 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
889 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
890 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
891 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
892 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
893
894 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
895 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
896 option processing.
897 @smallexample
898 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
899 @end smallexample
900 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
901 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
902
903 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
904 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
905 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} --silent
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
913 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
914
915 @noindent
916 Type
917
918 @smallexample
919 @value{GDBP} -help
920 @end smallexample
921
922 @noindent
923 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
924 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
925
926 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
927 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
928 @samp{-x} option is used.
929
930
931 @menu
932 * File Options:: Choosing files
933 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
934 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
935 @end menu
936
937 @node File Options
938 @subsection Choosing Files
939
940 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
941 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
942 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
943 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
944 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
945 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
946 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
947 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
948 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
949 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
950 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
951 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
952 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
953
954 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
955 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
956 argument and ignore it.
957
958 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
959 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
960 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
961 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
962 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
963
964 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
965 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
966 @c it.
967
968 @table @code
969 @item -symbols @var{file}
970 @itemx -s @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--symbols}
972 @cindex @code{-s}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
974
975 @item -exec @var{file}
976 @itemx -e @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--exec}
978 @cindex @code{-e}
979 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
980 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
981
982 @item -se @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--se}
984 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
985 file.
986
987 @item -core @var{file}
988 @itemx -c @var{file}
989 @cindex @code{--core}
990 @cindex @code{-c}
991 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
992
993 @item -pid @var{number}
994 @itemx -p @var{number}
995 @cindex @code{--pid}
996 @cindex @code{-p}
997 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
998
999 @item -command @var{file}
1000 @itemx -x @var{file}
1001 @cindex @code{--command}
1002 @cindex @code{-x}
1003 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1004 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1005 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1006
1007 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1008 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1009 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1010 @cindex @code{-ex}
1011 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1012
1013 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1014 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1015
1016 @smallexample
1017 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1018 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1019 @end smallexample
1020
1021 @item -init-command @var{file}
1022 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1023 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1024 @cindex @code{-ix}
1025 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1026 after loading gdbinit files).
1027 @xref{Startup}.
1028
1029 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1030 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1031 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1032 @cindex @code{-iex}
1033 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1034 after loading gdbinit files).
1035 @xref{Startup}.
1036
1037 @item -directory @var{directory}
1038 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1039 @cindex @code{--directory}
1040 @cindex @code{-d}
1041 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1042
1043 @item -r
1044 @itemx -readnow
1045 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1046 @cindex @code{-r}
1047 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1048 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1049 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1050
1051 @item --readnever
1052 @anchor{--readnever}
1053 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1054 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1055 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1056 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1057 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1058 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1059 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1060 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1061 @end table
1062
1063 @node Mode Options
1064 @subsection Choosing Modes
1065
1066 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1067 batch mode or quiet mode.
1068
1069 @table @code
1070 @anchor{-nx}
1071 @item -nx
1072 @itemx -n
1073 @cindex @code{--nx}
1074 @cindex @code{-n}
1075 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1076 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1077
1078 @table @code
1079 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1080 This is the system-wide init file.
1081 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1082 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1083 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1084 have been processed.
1085 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1086 This is the init file in your home directory.
1087 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1088 command options have been processed.
1089 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1090 This is the init file in the current directory.
1091 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1092 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1093 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1094 @end table
1095
1096 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1097 For documentation on how to write command files,
1098 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1099
1100 @anchor{-nh}
1101 @item -nh
1102 @cindex @code{--nh}
1103 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1104 in your home directory.
1105 @xref{Startup}.
1106
1107 @item -quiet
1108 @itemx -silent
1109 @itemx -q
1110 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1111 @cindex @code{--silent}
1112 @cindex @code{-q}
1113 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1114 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1115
1116 @item -batch
1117 @cindex @code{--batch}
1118 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1119 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1120 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1121 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1122 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1123 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1124 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1125
1126 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1127 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1128 make this more useful, the message
1129
1130 @smallexample
1131 Program exited normally.
1132 @end smallexample
1133
1134 @noindent
1135 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1136 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1137 mode.
1138
1139 @item -batch-silent
1140 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1141 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1142 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1143 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1144 for an interactive session.
1145
1146 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1147 messages, for example.
1148
1149 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1150 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1151
1152 @item -return-child-result
1153 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1154 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1155 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1156
1157 @itemize @bullet
1158 @item
1159 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1160 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1161 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1162 @item
1163 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1164 @item
1165 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1166 the exit code will be -1.
1167 @end itemize
1168
1169 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1170 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1171 interface.
1172
1173 @item -nowindows
1174 @itemx -nw
1175 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1176 @cindex @code{-nw}
1177 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1178 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1179 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1180
1181 @item -windows
1182 @itemx -w
1183 @cindex @code{--windows}
1184 @cindex @code{-w}
1185 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1186 used if possible.
1187
1188 @item -cd @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--cd}
1190 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1191 instead of the current directory.
1192
1193 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1194 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1195 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1196 @cindex @code{-D}
1197 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1198 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1199 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1200
1201 @item -fullname
1202 @itemx -f
1203 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1204 @cindex @code{-f}
1205 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1206 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1207 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1208 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1209 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1210 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1211 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1212 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1213 frame.
1214
1215 @item -annotate @var{level}
1216 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1217 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1218 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1219 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1220 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1221 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1222 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1223 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1224 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1225
1226 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1227 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1228
1229 @item --args
1230 @cindex @code{--args}
1231 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1232 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1233 This option stops option processing.
1234
1235 @item -baud @var{bps}
1236 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1237 @cindex @code{--baud}
1238 @cindex @code{-b}
1239 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1240 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1241
1242 @item -l @var{timeout}
1243 @cindex @code{-l}
1244 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1245 for remote debugging.
1246
1247 @item -tty @var{device}
1248 @itemx -t @var{device}
1249 @cindex @code{--tty}
1250 @cindex @code{-t}
1251 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1252 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1253
1254 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1255 @item -tui
1256 @cindex @code{--tui}
1257 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1258 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1259 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1260 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1261 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1262 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1263
1264 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1265 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1266 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1267 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1268 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1269 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1270
1271 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi3}) causes
1272 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} version 3 (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1273 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 9.1. @sc{gdb/mi}
1274 version 2 (@code{mi2}), included in @value{GDBN} 6.0 and version 1 (@code{mi1}),
1275 included in @value{GDBN} 5.3, are also available. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi}
1276 interfaces are no longer supported.
1277
1278 @item -write
1279 @cindex @code{--write}
1280 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1281 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1282 (@pxref{Patching}).
1283
1284 @item -statistics
1285 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1286 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1287 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1288
1289 @item -version
1290 @cindex @code{--version}
1291 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1292 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1293
1294 @item -configuration
1295 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1296 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1297 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1298 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1299
1300 @end table
1301
1302 @node Startup
1303 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1304 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1305
1306 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1307
1308 @enumerate
1309 @item
1310 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1311 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1312
1313 @item
1314 @cindex init file
1315 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1316 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1317 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1318 that file.
1319
1320 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1321 @item
1322 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1323 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1324 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1325 that file.
1326
1327 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1328 @item
1329 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1330 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1331 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1332 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1333 gets loaded.
1334
1335 @item
1336 Processes command line options and operands.
1337
1338 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1339 @item
1340 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1341 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1342 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1343 This is only done if the current directory is
1344 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1345 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1346 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1347 @value{GDBN}.
1348
1349 @item
1350 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1351 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1352 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1353 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1354
1355 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1356 you must do something like the following:
1357
1358 @smallexample
1359 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1360 @end smallexample
1361
1362 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1363 off too late.
1364
1365 @item
1366 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1367 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1368 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1369
1370 @item
1371 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1372 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1373 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1374 @end enumerate
1375
1376 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1377 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1378 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1379 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1380 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1381 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1382
1383 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1384 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1385
1386 @cindex init file name
1387 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1388 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1389 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1390 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1391 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1392 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1393 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1394 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1395
1396
1397 @node Quitting GDB
1398 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1399 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1400 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1401
1402 @table @code
1403 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1404 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1405 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1406 @itemx q
1407 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1408 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1409 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1410 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1411 error code.
1412 @end table
1413
1414 @cindex interrupt
1415 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1416 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1417 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1418 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1419 until a time when it is safe.
1420
1421 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1422 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1423 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1424
1425 @node Shell Commands
1426 @section Shell Commands
1427
1428 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1429 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1430 just use the @code{shell} command.
1431
1432 @table @code
1433 @kindex shell
1434 @kindex !
1435 @cindex shell escape
1436 @item shell @var{command-string}
1437 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1438 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1439 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1440 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1441 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1442 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1443 @end table
1444
1445 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1446 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1447 @value{GDBN}:
1448
1449 @table @code
1450 @kindex make
1451 @cindex calling make
1452 @item make @var{make-args}
1453 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1454 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1455 @end table
1456
1457 @node Logging Output
1458 @section Logging Output
1459 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1460 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1461
1462 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1463 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1464
1465 @table @code
1466 @kindex set logging
1467 @item set logging on
1468 Enable logging.
1469 @item set logging off
1470 Disable logging.
1471 @cindex logging file name
1472 @item set logging file @var{file}
1473 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1474 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1475 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1476 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1477 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1478 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1479 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1480 @kindex show logging
1481 @item show logging
1482 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1483 @end table
1484
1485 @node Commands
1486 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1487
1488 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1489 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1490 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1491 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1492 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1493
1494 @menu
1495 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1496 * Completion:: Command completion
1497 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1498 @end menu
1499
1500 @node Command Syntax
1501 @section Command Syntax
1502
1503 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1504 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1505 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1506 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1507 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1508 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1509
1510 @cindex abbreviation
1511 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1512 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1513 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1514 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1515 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1516 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1517 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1518
1519 @cindex repeating commands
1520 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1521 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1522 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1523 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1524 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1525 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1526 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1527
1528 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1529 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1530 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1531
1532 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1533 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1534 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1535 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1536 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1537
1538 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1539 @cindex comment
1540 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1541 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1542 Files,,Command Files}).
1543
1544 @cindex repeating command sequences
1545 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1546 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1547 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1548 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1549 for editing.
1550
1551 @node Completion
1552 @section Command Completion
1553
1554 @cindex completion
1555 @cindex word completion
1556 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1557 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1558 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1559 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1560
1561 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1562 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1563 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1564 enter it). For example, if you type
1565
1566 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1567 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1568 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1569 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1570 @smallexample
1571 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574 @noindent
1575 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1576 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1577
1578 @smallexample
1579 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1580 @end smallexample
1581
1582 @noindent
1583 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1584 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1585 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1586 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1587 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1588 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1589
1590 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1591 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1592 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1593 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1594 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1595 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1596 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1597 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1598 example:
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1602 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1603 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1604 make_abs_section make_function_type
1605 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1606 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1607 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1608 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1609 @end smallexample
1610
1611 @noindent
1612 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1613 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1614 command.
1615
1616 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1617 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1618 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1619 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1620 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1621
1622 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1623 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1624 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1628 main
1629 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1630 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1631 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1632 @end smallexample
1633
1634 @noindent
1635 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1636
1637 @table @code
1638 @kindex set max-completions
1639 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1640 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1641 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1642 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1643 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1644 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1645 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1646 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1647 completion slow.
1648 @kindex show max-completions
1649 @item show max-completions
1650 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1651 during completion.
1652 @end table
1653
1654 @cindex quotes in commands
1655 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1656 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1657 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1658 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1659 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1660 @value{GDBN} commands.
1661
1662 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1663 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1664 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1665 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1666 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1667 Operators}).
1668
1669 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1670 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1671 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1672 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1673 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1674 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1675 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1676 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1677 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1681 func<int>() func<float>()
1682 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1683 @end smallexample
1684
1685 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1686 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1687 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1688 function:
1689
1690 @smallexample
1691 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1692 func<int>() func<float>()
1693 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1697 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1698 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1699 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1700 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1701 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1702
1703 @smallexample
1704 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1705 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1706 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1707 bubble(double)
1708 @end smallexample
1709
1710 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1711 require quoting.
1712
1713 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1714 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1715 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1716 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1717
1718 @cindex completion of structure field names
1719 @cindex structure field name completion
1720 @cindex completion of union field names
1721 @cindex union field name completion
1722 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1723 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1724 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1725 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1726 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1727 left-hand-side:
1728
1729 @smallexample
1730 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1731 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1732 to_data to_isatty to_write
1733 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1734 to_flush to_read
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent
1738 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1739 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1740 follows:
1741
1742 @smallexample
1743 struct ui_file
1744 @{
1745 int *magic;
1746 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1747 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1748 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1749 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1750 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1751 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1752 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1753 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1754 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1755 void *to_data;
1756 @}
1757 @end smallexample
1758
1759
1760 @node Help
1761 @section Getting Help
1762 @cindex online documentation
1763 @kindex help
1764
1765 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1766 using the command @code{help}.
1767
1768 @table @code
1769 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1770 @item help
1771 @itemx h
1772 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1773 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 (@value{GDBP}) help
1777 List of classes of commands:
1778
1779 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1780 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1781 data -- Examining data
1782 files -- Specifying and examining files
1783 internals -- Maintenance commands
1784 obscure -- Obscure features
1785 running -- Running the program
1786 stack -- Examining the stack
1787 status -- Status inquiries
1788 support -- Support facilities
1789 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1790 stopping the program
1791 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1792
1793 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1794 commands in that class.
1795 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1796 documentation.
1797 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1798 (@value{GDBP})
1799 @end smallexample
1800 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1801
1802 @item help @var{class}
1803 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1804 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1805 help display for the class @code{status}:
1806
1807 @smallexample
1808 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1809 Status inquiries.
1810
1811 List of commands:
1812
1813 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1814 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1815 info -- Generic command for showing things
1816 about the program being debugged
1817 show -- Generic command for showing things
1818 about the debugger
1819
1820 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1821 documentation.
1822 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1823 (@value{GDBP})
1824 @end smallexample
1825
1826 @item help @var{command}
1827 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1828 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1829
1830 @kindex apropos
1831 @item apropos @var{args}
1832 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1833 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1834 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1835
1836 @smallexample
1837 apropos alias
1838 @end smallexample
1839
1840 @noindent
1841 results in:
1842
1843 @smallexample
1844 @c @group
1845 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1846 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1847 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1848 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1849 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1850 @c @end group
1851 @end smallexample
1852
1853 @kindex complete
1854 @item complete @var{args}
1855 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1856 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1857 command you want completed. For example:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 complete i
1861 @end smallexample
1862
1863 @noindent results in:
1864
1865 @smallexample
1866 @group
1867 if
1868 ignore
1869 info
1870 inspect
1871 @end group
1872 @end smallexample
1873
1874 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1878 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1879 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1880 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1881 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1882 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1883 Index}.
1884
1885 @c @group
1886 @table @code
1887 @kindex info
1888 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1889 @item info
1890 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1891 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1892 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1893 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1894 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1895 @w{@code{help info}}.
1896
1897 @kindex set
1898 @item set
1899 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1900 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1901 @code{set prompt $}.
1902
1903 @kindex show
1904 @item show
1905 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1906 @value{GDBN} itself.
1907 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1908 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1909 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1910 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1911
1912 @kindex info set
1913 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1914 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1915 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1916 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1917 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1918 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1919 @end table
1920 @c @end group
1921
1922 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1923 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1924
1925 @table @code
1926 @kindex show version
1927 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1928 @item show version
1929 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1930 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1931 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1932 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1933 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1934 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1935 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1936 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1937 @value{GDBN}.
1938
1939 @kindex show copying
1940 @kindex info copying
1941 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1942 @item show copying
1943 @itemx info copying
1944 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1945
1946 @kindex show warranty
1947 @kindex info warranty
1948 @item show warranty
1949 @itemx info warranty
1950 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1951 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1952
1953 @kindex show configuration
1954 @item show configuration
1955 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1956 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1957 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1958 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1959 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1960 your report.
1961
1962 @end table
1963
1964 @node Running
1965 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1966
1967 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1968 debugging information when you compile it.
1969
1970 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1971 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1972 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1973 kill a child process.
1974
1975 @menu
1976 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1977 * Starting:: Starting your program
1978 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1979 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1980
1981 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1982 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1983 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1984 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1985
1986 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1987 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1988 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1989 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1990 @end menu
1991
1992 @node Compilation
1993 @section Compiling for Debugging
1994
1995 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1996 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1997 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1998 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1999 and addresses in the executable code.
2000
2001 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2002 the compiler.
2003
2004 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2005 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2006 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2007 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2008 executables containing debugging information.
2009
2010 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2011 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2012 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2013 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2014 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2015
2016 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2017 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2018 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2019
2020 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2021 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2022 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2023 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2024 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2025 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2026
2027 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2028 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2029 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2030
2031 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2032 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2033 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2034 format in @value{GDBN}.
2035
2036 @need 2000
2037 @node Starting
2038 @section Starting your Program
2039 @cindex starting
2040 @cindex running
2041
2042 @table @code
2043 @kindex run
2044 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2045 @item run
2046 @itemx r
2047 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2048 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2049 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2050 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2051 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2052
2053 @end table
2054
2055 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2056 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2057 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2058 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2059 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2060 message like this one:
2061
2062 @smallexample
2063 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2064 Try "help target" or "continue".
2065 @end smallexample
2066
2067 @noindent
2068 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2069 first (@pxref{load}).
2070
2071 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2072 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2073 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2074 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2075 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2076 divided into four categories:
2077
2078 @table @asis
2079 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2080 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2081 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2082 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2083 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2084 the arguments.
2085 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2086 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2087 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2088 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2089 below for details).
2090
2091 @item The @emph{environment.}
2092 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2093 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2094 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2095 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2096
2097 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2098 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2099 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2100 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2101 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2102 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2103 Directory}.
2104
2105 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2106 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2107 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2108 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2109 set a different device for your program.
2110 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2111
2112 @cindex pipes
2113 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2114 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2115 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2116 wrong program.
2117 @end table
2118
2119 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2120 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2121 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2122 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2123 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2124
2125 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2126 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2127 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2128 your current breakpoints.
2129
2130 @table @code
2131 @kindex start
2132 @item start
2133 @cindex run to main procedure
2134 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2135 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2136 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2137 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2138 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2139 procedure, depending on the language used.
2140
2141 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2142 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2143 the @samp{run} command.
2144
2145 @cindex elaboration phase
2146 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2147 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2148 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2149 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2150 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2151 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2152 will remain to halt execution.
2153
2154 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2155 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2156 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2157 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2158 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2159
2160 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2161 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2162 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2163 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2164 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2165 use the @code{starti} command.
2166
2167 @kindex starti
2168 @item starti
2169 @cindex run to first instruction
2170 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2171 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2172 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2173 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2174 the start of the elaboration phase.
2175
2176 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2177 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2178 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2179 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2180 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2181 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2182 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2183 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2184 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2185 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2186 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2187 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2188
2189 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2190 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2191 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2192 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2193
2194 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2195 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2196 environment:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2200 (@value{GDBP}) run
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2204 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2205
2206 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2207 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2208 @item set startup-with-shell
2209 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2210 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2211 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2212 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2213 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2214 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2215 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2216 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2217 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2218 startup failures such as:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 (@value{GDBP}) run
2222 Starting program: ./a.out
2223 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 @noindent
2227 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2228 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2229 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2230 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2231 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2232 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2233
2234 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2235 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2236 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2237 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2238 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2239 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2240
2241 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2242 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2243 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2244 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2245 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2246 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2247
2248 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2249 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2250 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2251
2252 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2253 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2254
2255 @smallexample
2256 (@value{GDBP}) run
2257 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2258 @end smallexample
2259
2260 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2261 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2262
2263 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2264 @code{target native} command. For example,
2265
2266 @smallexample
2267 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2268 (@value{GDBP}) run
2269 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2270 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2271 (@value{GDBP}) run
2272 Starting program: ./a.out
2273 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2274 @end smallexample
2275
2276 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2277 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2278 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2279 disconnect.
2280
2281 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2282 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2283 proc}, @code{info os}.
2284
2285 @kindex set disable-randomization
2286 @item set disable-randomization
2287 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2288 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2289 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2290 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2291 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2292
2293 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2294 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2295
2296 @smallexample
2297 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2298 @end smallexample
2299
2300 @item set disable-randomization off
2301 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2302 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2303 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2304 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2305 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2306 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2307
2308 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2309 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2310 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2311 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2312 a code at its expected addresses.
2313
2314 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2315 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2316 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2317 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2318 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2319 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2320 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2321 a randomly chosen address.
2322
2323 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2324 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2325 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2326 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2327 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2328
2329 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2330 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2331
2332 @item show disable-randomization
2333 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2334 the virtual address space of the started program.
2335
2336 @end table
2337
2338 @node Arguments
2339 @section Your Program's Arguments
2340
2341 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2342 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2343 @code{run} command.
2344 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2345 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2346 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2347 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2348 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2349
2350 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2351 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2352 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2353 the program, not by the shell.
2354
2355 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2356 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex set args
2360 @item set args
2361 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2362 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2363 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2364 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2365 it again without arguments.
2366
2367 @kindex show args
2368 @item show args
2369 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2370 @end table
2371
2372 @node Environment
2373 @section Your Program's Environment
2374
2375 @cindex environment (of your program)
2376 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2377 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2378 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2379 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2380 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2381 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2382 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2383
2384 @table @code
2385 @kindex path
2386 @item path @var{directory}
2387 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2388 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2389 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2390 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2391 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2392 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2393 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2394
2395 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2396 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2397 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2398 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2399 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2400 @var{directory} to the search path.
2401 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2402 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2403
2404 @kindex show paths
2405 @item show paths
2406 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2407 environment variable).
2408
2409 @kindex show environment
2410 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2411 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2412 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2413 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2414 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2415
2416 @kindex set environment
2417 @anchor{set environment}
2418 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2419 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2420 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2421 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2422 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2423 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2424 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2425 null value.
2426 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2427 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2428
2429 For example, this command:
2430
2431 @smallexample
2432 set env USER = foo
2433 @end smallexample
2434
2435 @noindent
2436 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2437 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2438 are not actually required.)
2439
2440 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2441 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2442 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2443 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2444 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2445
2446 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2447 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2448 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2449
2450 @kindex unset environment
2451 @anchor{unset environment}
2452 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2453 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2454 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2455 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2456 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2457
2458 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2459 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2460 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2461 @end table
2462
2463 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2464 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2465 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2466 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2467 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2468 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2469 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2470 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2471 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2472 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2473
2474 @node Working Directory
2475 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2476
2477 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2478 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2479 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2480 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2481 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2482 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2483 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2484 debugging.
2485
2486 @table @code
2487 @kindex set cwd
2488 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2489 @anchor{set cwd command}
2490 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2491 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2492 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2493 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2494 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2495 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2496 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2497 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2498 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2499 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2500 fallback.
2501
2502 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2503 the @code{cd} command.
2504 @xref{cd command}.
2505
2506 @kindex show cwd
2507 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2508 @item show cwd
2509 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2510 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2511 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2512
2513 @kindex cd
2514 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2515 @anchor{cd command}
2516 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2517 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2518 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2519
2520 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2521 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2522 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2523 @xref{set cwd command}.
2524
2525 @kindex pwd
2526 @item pwd
2527 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2531 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2532 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2533 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2534 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2535 current working directory of the debuggee.
2536
2537 @node Input/Output
2538 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2539
2540 @cindex redirection
2541 @cindex i/o
2542 @cindex terminal
2543 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2544 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2545 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2546 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2547 running your program.
2548
2549 @table @code
2550 @kindex info terminal
2551 @item info terminal
2552 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2553 program is using.
2554 @end table
2555
2556 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2557 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2558
2559 @smallexample
2560 run > outfile
2561 @end smallexample
2562
2563 @noindent
2564 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2565
2566 @kindex tty
2567 @cindex controlling terminal
2568 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2569 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2570 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2571 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2572 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 tty /dev/ttyb
2576 @end smallexample
2577
2578 @noindent
2579 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2580 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2581 that as their controlling terminal.
2582
2583 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2584 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2585 terminal.
2586
2587 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2588 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2589 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2590 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2591
2592 @cindex inferior tty
2593 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2594 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2595 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2596 program.
2597
2598 @table @code
2599 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2600 @kindex set inferior-tty
2601 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2602 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2603 @value{GDBN}.
2604
2605 @item show inferior-tty
2606 @kindex show inferior-tty
2607 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2608 @end table
2609
2610 @node Attach
2611 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2612 @kindex attach
2613 @cindex attach
2614
2615 @table @code
2616 @item attach @var{process-id}
2617 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2618 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2619 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2620 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2621 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2622
2623 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2624 executing the command.
2625 @end table
2626
2627 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2628 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2629 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2630 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2631
2632 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2633 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2634 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2635 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2636 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2637 Specify Files}.
2638
2639 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2640 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2641 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2642 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2643 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2644 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2645 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2646
2647 @table @code
2648 @kindex detach
2649 @item detach
2650 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2651 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2652 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2653 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2654 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2655 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2656 executing the command.
2657 @end table
2658
2659 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2660 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2661 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2662 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2663 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2664 Messages}).
2665
2666 @node Kill Process
2667 @section Killing the Child Process
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex kill
2671 @item kill
2672 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2673 @end table
2674
2675 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2676 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2677 is running.
2678
2679 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2680 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2681 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2682 outside the debugger.
2683
2684 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2685 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2686 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2687 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2688 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2689 breakpoint settings).
2690
2691 @node Inferiors and Programs
2692 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2693
2694 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2695 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2696 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2697 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2698 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2699 from multiple executables.
2700
2701 @cindex inferior
2702 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2703 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2704 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2705 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2706 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2707 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2708 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2709 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2710 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2711 threads running in it.
2712
2713 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2714 inferiors}}:
2715
2716 @table @code
2717 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2718 @item info inferiors
2719 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2720 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2721 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2722 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2723
2724 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2725
2726 @enumerate
2727 @item
2728 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2729
2730 @item
2731 the target system's inferior identifier
2732
2733 @item
2734 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2735
2736 @end enumerate
2737
2738 @noindent
2739 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2740 indicates the current inferior.
2741
2742 For example,
2743 @end table
2744 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2745
2746 @smallexample
2747 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2748 Num Description Executable
2749 2 process 2307 hello
2750 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2751 @end smallexample
2752
2753 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2754
2755 @table @code
2756 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2757 @item inferior @var{infno}
2758 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2759 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2760 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2764 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2765 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2766 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2767 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2768 information on convenience variables.
2769
2770 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2771 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2772 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2773 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2774 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2775 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2776
2777 @table @code
2778 @kindex add-inferior
2779 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2780 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2781 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2782 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2783 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2784 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2785
2786 @kindex clone-inferior
2787 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2788 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2789 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2790 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2791 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2792
2793 @smallexample
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2797 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2798 Added inferior 2.
2799 1 inferiors added.
2800 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2801 Num Description Executable
2802 2 <null> helloworld
2803 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2804 @end smallexample
2805
2806 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2807
2808 @kindex remove-inferiors
2809 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2810 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2811 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2812 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2813
2814 @end table
2815
2816 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2817 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2818 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2819 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2820
2821 @table @code
2822 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2823 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2825 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2826 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2827 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2828
2829 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2830 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2831 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2832 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2833 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2834 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2835 @end table
2836
2837 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2838 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2839 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2840 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2841
2842
2843 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2844 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2845
2846 @table @code
2847 @kindex set print inferior-events
2848 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2849 @item set print inferior-events
2850 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2851 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2852 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2853 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2854 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2855 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2856
2857 @kindex show print inferior-events
2858 @item show print inferior-events
2859 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2860 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2861 @end table
2862
2863 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2864 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2865 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2866
2867
2868 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2869 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2870 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2871 info program-spaces}} command.
2872
2873 @table @code
2874 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2875 @item maint info program-spaces
2876 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2877 @value{GDBN}.
2878
2879 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2880
2881 @enumerate
2882 @item
2883 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2884
2885 @item
2886 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2887 the @code{file} command.
2888
2889 @end enumerate
2890
2891 @noindent
2892 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2893 indicates the current program space.
2894
2895 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2896 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2897 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2898
2899 @smallexample
2900 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2901 Id Executable
2902 * 1 hello
2903 2 goodbye
2904 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2905 @end smallexample
2906
2907 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2908 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2909 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2910 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2911 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2915 Id Executable
2916 * 1 vfork-test
2917 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2921 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2922 @end table
2923
2924 @node Threads
2925 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2926
2927 @cindex threads of execution
2928 @cindex multiple threads
2929 @cindex switching threads
2930 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2931 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2932 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2933 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2934 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2935 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2936 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2937
2938 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2939 programs:
2940
2941 @itemize @bullet
2942 @item automatic notification of new threads
2943 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2944 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2945 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2946 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2947 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2948 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2949 messages on thread start and exit.
2950 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2951 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2952 isn't compatible with the program.
2953 @end itemize
2954
2955 @cindex focus of debugging
2956 @cindex current thread
2957 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2958 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2959 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2960 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2961 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2962
2963 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2964 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2965 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2966 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2967 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2968 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2969 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2970 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2971 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2972 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2973
2974 @smallexample
2975 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2976 @end smallexample
2977
2978 @noindent
2979 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2980 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2981 further qualifier.
2982
2983 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2984 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2985 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2986 @c program?
2987 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2988 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2989 @c threads ab initio?
2990
2991 @anchor{thread numbers}
2992 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2993 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2994 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2995 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2996 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2997 between threads of different inferiors.
2998
2999 @cindex qualified thread ID
3000 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3001 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3002 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3003 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3004 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3005 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3006 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3007 inferior.
3008
3009 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3010 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3011 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3012 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3013
3014 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3015 @cindex thread ID lists
3016 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3017 argument. A list element can be:
3018
3019 @enumerate
3020 @item
3021 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3022 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3023 @samp{1}.
3024
3025 @item
3026 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3027 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3028 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3029
3030 @item
3031 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3032 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3033 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3034 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3035 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3036
3037 @end enumerate
3038
3039 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3040 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3041 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3042 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3043 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3044 7.1}.
3045
3046
3047 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3048 @cindex global thread number
3049 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3050 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3051 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3052 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3053 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3054 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3055
3056 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3057 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3058 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3059
3060 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3061 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3062 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3063 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3064 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3065 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3066 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3067 general information on convenience variables.
3068
3069 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3070 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3071 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3078
3079 @smallexample
3080 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3081 @end smallexample
3082
3083 @table @code
3084 @kindex info threads
3085 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3086
3087 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3088 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3089 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3090 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3091
3092 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3093
3094 @enumerate
3095 @item
3096 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3097
3098 @item
3099 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3100 option was specified
3101
3102 @item
3103 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3104
3105 @item
3106 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3107 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3108 program itself.
3109
3110 @item
3111 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3112 @end enumerate
3113
3114 @noindent
3115 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3116 indicates the current thread.
3117
3118 For example,
3119 @end table
3120 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3121
3122 @smallexample
3123 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3124 Id Target Id Frame
3125 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3126 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3127 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3128 at threadtest.c:68
3129 @end smallexample
3130
3131 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3132 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3133 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3134
3135 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3136 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3137
3138 @smallexample
3139 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3140 Id GId Target Id Frame
3141 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3142 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3143 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3144 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3145 @end smallexample
3146
3147 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3148 Solaris-specific command:
3149
3150 @table @code
3151 @item maint info sol-threads
3152 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3153 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3154 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3155 @end table
3156
3157 @table @code
3158 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3159 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3160 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3161 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3162 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3163 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3164
3165 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3166 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3167
3168 @smallexample
3169 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3170 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3171 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3172 8 printf ("hello\n");
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 @noindent
3176 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3177 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3178 threads.
3179
3180 @kindex thread apply
3181 @cindex apply command to several threads
3182 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3183 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3184 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3185 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3186 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3187 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3188 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3189 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3190
3191 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3192 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3193 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3194 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3195 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3196
3197 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3198 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3199 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3200 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3201
3202 @table @code
3203 @item -c
3204 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3205 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3206 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3207 @item -s
3208 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3209 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3210 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3211 are not printed.
3212 @item -q
3213 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3214 information.
3215 @end table
3216
3217 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3218
3219 @kindex taas
3220 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item taas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3224
3225 @kindex tfaas
3226 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3227 @item tfaas @var{command}
3228 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3229 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3230 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3231 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3232 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3233 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3234 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3235 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3236
3237 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3238 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3239 is, using:
3240 @smallexample
3241 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3242 @end smallexample
3243
3244
3245 @kindex thread name
3246 @cindex name a thread
3247 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3248 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3249 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3250 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3251
3252 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3253 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3254 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3255 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3256 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3257
3258 @kindex thread find
3259 @cindex search for a thread
3260 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3261 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3262 matches the supplied regular expression.
3263
3264 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3265 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3266 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3267 is the LWP id.
3268
3269 @smallexample
3270 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3271 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3272 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3273 Id Target Id Frame
3274 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3275 @end smallexample
3276
3277 @kindex set print thread-events
3278 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3279 @item set print thread-events
3280 @itemx set print thread-events on
3281 @itemx set print thread-events off
3282 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3283 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3284 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3285 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3286 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3287
3288 @kindex show print thread-events
3289 @item show print thread-events
3290 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3291 have started and exited.
3292 @end table
3293
3294 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3295 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3296 programs with multiple threads.
3297
3298 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3299 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3300
3301 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3302 @table @code
3303 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3304 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3305 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3306 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3307 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3308 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3309 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3310 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3311 macro.
3312
3313 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3314 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3315 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3316 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3317 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3318 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the default system directories that are
3322 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3323 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3324 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3325
3326 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3327 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3328 was loaded in the inferior process.
3329
3330 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3331 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3332 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3333 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3334 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3335 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3336 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3337
3338 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3339 only on some platforms.
3340
3341 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3342 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3343 Display current libthread_db search path.
3344
3345 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3346 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3347 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3348 @item set debug libthread-db
3349 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3350 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3351 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3352 @end table
3353
3354 @node Forks
3355 @section Debugging Forks
3356
3357 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3358 @cindex multiple processes
3359 @cindex processes, multiple
3360 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3361 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3362 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3363 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3364 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3365 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3366 will cause it to terminate.
3367
3368 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3369 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3370 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3371 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3372 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3373 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3374 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3375 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3376 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3377 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3378
3379 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3380 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3381 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3382 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3383
3384 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3385 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3386 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3387
3388 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3389 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3390
3391 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3392 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3393
3394 @table @code
3395 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3396 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3397 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3398 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3399 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3400
3401 @table @code
3402 @item parent
3403 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3404 unimpeded. This is the default.
3405
3406 @item child
3407 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3408 unimpeded.
3409
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3413 @item show follow-fork-mode
3414 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3415 @end table
3416
3417 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3418 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3419 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3423 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3424 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3425 retain debugger control over them both.
3426
3427 @table @code
3428 @item on
3429 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3431 independently. This is the default.
3432
3433 @item off
3434 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3435 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3436 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3437 is held suspended.
3438
3439 @end table
3440
3441 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3442 @item show detach-on-fork
3443 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3444 @end table
3445
3446 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3447 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3448 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3449 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3450 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3451 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3452
3453 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3454 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3455 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3456 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3457 and Programs}.
3458
3459 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3460 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3461 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3462 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3463 the child process's @code{main}.
3464
3465 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3466 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3467
3468 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3469 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3470 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3471 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3472 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3473 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3474 command.
3475
3476 @table @code
3477 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3478 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3479
3480 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3481 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3482
3483 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3484
3485 @table @code
3486 @item new
3487 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3488 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3489 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3490 original inferior.
3491
3492 For example:
3493
3494 @smallexample
3495 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3496 (gdb) info inferior
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 * 1 <null> prog1
3499 (@value{GDBP}) run
3500 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3501 Program exited normally.
3502 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3503 Id Description Executable
3504 1 <null> prog1
3505 * 2 <null> prog2
3506 @end smallexample
3507
3508 @item same
3509 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3510 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3511 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3512 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3513 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3514
3515 For example:
3516
3517 @smallexample
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog1
3521 (@value{GDBP}) run
3522 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3523 Program exited normally.
3524 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3525 Id Description Executable
3526 * 1 <null> prog2
3527 @end smallexample
3528
3529 @end table
3530 @end table
3531
3532 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3533 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3534
3535 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3536 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3537 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3538
3539 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3540 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3541
3542 @cindex checkpoint
3543 @cindex restart
3544 @cindex bookmark
3545 @cindex snapshot of a process
3546 @cindex rewind program state
3547
3548 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3549 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3550 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3551 later.
3552
3553 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3554 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3555 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3556 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3557 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3558
3559 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3560 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3561 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3562 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3563 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3564 start again from there.
3565
3566 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3567 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3568
3569 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3570
3571 @table @code
3572 @kindex checkpoint
3573 @item checkpoint
3574 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3575 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3576 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3577
3578 @kindex info checkpoints
3579 @item info checkpoints
3580 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3581 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3582 listed:
3583
3584 @table @code
3585 @item Checkpoint ID
3586 @item Process ID
3587 @item Code Address
3588 @item Source line, or label
3589 @end table
3590
3591 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3592 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3593 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3594 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3595 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3596 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3597 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3598
3599 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3600 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3601 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3602 the debugger.
3603
3604 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3605 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3606 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3607
3608 @end table
3609
3610 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3611 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3612 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3613 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3614 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3615 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3616 previously read data can be read again.
3617
3618 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3619 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3620 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3621 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3622 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3623 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3624
3625 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3626 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3627 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3628 different execution path this time.
3629
3630 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3631 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3632 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3633 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3634 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3635 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3636 potentially pose a problem.
3637
3638 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3639
3640 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3641 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3642 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3643 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3644 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3645 next.
3646
3647 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3648 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3649 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3650 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3651 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3652
3653 @node Stopping
3654 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3655
3656 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3657 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3658 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3659
3660 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3661 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3662 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3663 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3664 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3665 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3666 explicitly request this information at any time.
3667
3668 @table @code
3669 @kindex info program
3670 @item info program
3671 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3672 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3673 @end table
3674
3675 @menu
3676 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3677 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3678 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3679 Skipping over functions and files
3680 * Signals:: Signals
3681 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3682 @end menu
3683
3684 @node Breakpoints
3685 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3686
3687 @cindex breakpoints
3688 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3689 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3690 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3691 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3692 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3693 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3694 program.
3695
3696 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3697 the executable is run.
3698
3699 @cindex watchpoints
3700 @cindex data breakpoints
3701 @cindex memory tracing
3702 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3703 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3704 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3705 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3706 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3707 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3708 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3709 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3710 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3711 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3712 same commands.
3713
3714 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3715 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3716 Automatic Display}.
3717
3718 @cindex catchpoints
3719 @cindex breakpoint on events
3720 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3721 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3722 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3723 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3724 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3725 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3726 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3727
3728 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3729 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3730 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3731 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3732 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3733 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3734 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3735 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3736 enable it again.
3737
3738 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3739 @cindex breakpoint lists
3740 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3741 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3742 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3743 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3744 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3745 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3746 are operated on.
3747
3748 @menu
3749 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3750 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3751 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3752 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3753 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3754 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3755 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3756 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3757 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3758 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3759 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3760 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3761 @end menu
3762
3763 @node Set Breaks
3764 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3765
3766 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3767 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3768 @c
3769 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3770
3771 @kindex break
3772 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3773 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3774 @cindex latest breakpoint
3775 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3776 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3777 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3778 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3779 convenience variables.
3780
3781 @table @code
3782 @item break @var{location}
3783 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3784 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3785 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3786 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3787 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3788
3789 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3790 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3791 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3792 that situation.
3793
3794 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3795 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3796 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3797
3798 @item break
3799 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3800 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3801 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3802 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3803 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3804 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3805 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3806 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3807 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3808 inside loops.
3809
3810 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3811 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3812 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3813 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3814 existed when your program stopped.
3815
3816 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3817 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3818 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3819 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3820 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3821 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3822 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3823
3824 @kindex tbreak
3825 @item tbreak @var{args}
3826 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3827 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3828 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3829 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3830
3831 @kindex hbreak
3832 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3833 @item hbreak @var{args}
3834 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3835 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3836 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3837 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3838 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3839 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3840 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3841 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3842 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3843 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3844 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3845 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3846 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3847 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3848 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3849 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3850 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3851 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3852
3853 @kindex thbreak
3854 @item thbreak @var{args}
3855 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3856 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3857 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3858 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3859 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3860 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3861 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3862 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3863
3864 @kindex rbreak
3865 @cindex regular expression
3866 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3867 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3868 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3869 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3870 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3871 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3872 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3873 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3874 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3875
3876 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
3877 to print the list of all breakpoints it sets according to the
3878 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
3879 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
3880 language of the breakpoint's function, other values mean to use
3881 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
3882
3883 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3884 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3885 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3886 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3887 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3888 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3889
3890 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3891 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3892 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3893 classes.
3894
3895 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3896 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3897 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3898
3899 @smallexample
3900 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3901 @end smallexample
3902
3903 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3904 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3905 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3906 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3907 every function in a given file:
3908
3909 @smallexample
3910 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3911 @end smallexample
3912
3913 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3914 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3915
3916 @kindex info breakpoints
3917 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3918 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3919 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3920 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3921 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3922 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3923 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3924
3925 @table @emph
3926 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3927 @item Type
3928 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3929 @item Disposition
3930 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3931 @item Enabled or Disabled
3932 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3933 that are not enabled.
3934 @item Address
3935 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3936 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3937 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3938 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3939 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3940 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3941 @item What
3942 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3943 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3944 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3945 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3946 @end table
3947
3948 @noindent
3949 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3950 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3951 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3952 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3953 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3954 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3955
3956 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3957 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3958 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3959 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3960
3961 @noindent
3962 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3963 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3964 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3965 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3966 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3967
3968 @noindent
3969 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3970 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3971 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3972 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3973 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3974 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3975
3976 @noindent
3977 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3978 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3979
3980 @end table
3981
3982 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3983 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3984 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3985 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3986
3987 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3988 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3989 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3990 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3991
3992 @itemize @bullet
3993 @item
3994 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3995
3996 @item
3997 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3998 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3999
4000 @item
4001 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
4002 correspond to any number of instantiations.
4003
4004 @item
4005 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
4006 several places where that function is inlined.
4007 @end itemize
4008
4009 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4010 the relevant locations.
4011
4012 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4013 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4014 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4015 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4016 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4017 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4018 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4019
4020 For example:
4021
4022 @smallexample
4023 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4024 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4025 stop only if i==1
4026 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4027 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4028 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4029 @end smallexample
4030
4031 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4032 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4033 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4034 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4035 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4036 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4037 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4038 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4039 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4040 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4041 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4042
4043 @cindex pending breakpoints
4044 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4045 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4046 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4047 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4048 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4049 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4050 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4051 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4052 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4053 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4054 is not yet resolved.
4055
4056 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4057 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4058 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4059 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4060 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4061 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4062
4063 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4064 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4065 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4066 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4067
4068 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4069 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4070 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4071
4072 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4073 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4074 address specification to an address:
4075
4076 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4077 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4078 @table @code
4079 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4080 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4081 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4082
4083 @item set breakpoint pending on
4084 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4085 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4086
4087 @item set breakpoint pending off
4088 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4089 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4090 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4091
4092 @item show breakpoint pending
4093 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4094 @end table
4095
4096 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4097 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4098 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4099
4100 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4101 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4102 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4103 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4104 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4105 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4106 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4107 breakpoints.
4108
4109 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4110
4111 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4112 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4113 @table @code
4114 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4115 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4116 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4117 breakpoint must be used.
4118
4119 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4120 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4121 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4122 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4123 @end table
4124
4125 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4126 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4127 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4128 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4129 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4130 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4131 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4132 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4133 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4134
4135 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4136 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4137 @table @code
4138 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4139 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4140 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4141 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4142
4143 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4144 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4145 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4146 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4147 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4148 @end table
4149
4150 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4151 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4152 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4153
4154 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4155 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4156
4157 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4158
4159 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4160 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4161 @table @code
4162 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4163 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4164 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4165 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4166 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4167
4168 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4169 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4170 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4171 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4172 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4173 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4174 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4175 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4176 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4177 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4178 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4179 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4180 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4181
4182 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4183 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4184 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4185 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4186 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4187 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4188 @end table
4189
4190
4191 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4192 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4193 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4194 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4195 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4196 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4197 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4198 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4199
4200
4201 @node Set Watchpoints
4202 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4203
4204 @cindex setting watchpoints
4205 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4206 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4207 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4208 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4209 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4210
4211 @itemize @bullet
4212 @item
4213 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4214
4215 @item
4216 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4217 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4218 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4219
4220 @item
4221 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4222 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4223 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4224 @end itemize
4225
4226 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4227 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4228 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4229 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4230 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4231 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4232 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4233 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4234 the expression changes.
4235
4236 @cindex software watchpoints
4237 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4238 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4239 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4240 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4241 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4242 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4243 culprit.)
4244
4245 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4246 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4247 slow down the running of your program.
4248
4249 @table @code
4250 @kindex watch
4251 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4252 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4253 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4254 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4255 to watch the value of a single variable:
4256
4257 @smallexample
4258 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4259 @end smallexample
4260
4261 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4262 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4263 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4264 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4265 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4266 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4267
4268 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4269 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4270 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4271 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4272 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4273 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4274 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4275 error.
4276
4277 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4278 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4279 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4280 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4281 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4282 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4283 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4284 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4285 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4286 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4287 Examples:
4288
4289 @smallexample
4290 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4291 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4292 @end smallexample
4293
4294 @kindex rwatch
4295 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4296 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4297 by the program.
4298
4299 @kindex awatch
4300 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4301 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4302 or written into by the program.
4303
4304 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4305 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4306 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4307 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4308 @end table
4309
4310 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4311 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4312 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4313 a never-changing value:
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4317 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4318 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4319 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4320 @end smallexample
4321
4322 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4323 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4324 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4325 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4326 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4327 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4328
4329 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4330 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4331 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4332 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4333 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4334 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4335 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4336 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4337
4338 @table @code
4339 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4340 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4341 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4342
4343 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4344 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4345 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4346 @end table
4347
4348 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4349 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4350 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4351
4352 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4353
4354 @smallexample
4355 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4356 @end smallexample
4357
4358 @noindent
4359 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4360
4361 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4362 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4363 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4364 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4365 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4366 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4367 will print a message like this:
4368
4369 @smallexample
4370 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4371 @end smallexample
4372
4373 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4374 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4375 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4376 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4377 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4378 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4379 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4380 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4381
4382 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4383 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4384 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4385 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4386 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4387 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4388
4389 @smallexample
4390 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4391 @end smallexample
4392
4393 @noindent
4394 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4395
4396 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4397 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4398 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4399 expression with separately allocated resources.
4400
4401 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4402 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4403 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4404
4405 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4406 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4407 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4408 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4409 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4410 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4411 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4412 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4413 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4414
4415 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4416 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4417 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4418 watched expression from every thread.
4419
4420 @quotation
4421 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4422 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4423 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4424 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4425 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4426 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4427 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4428 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4429 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4430 @end quotation
4431
4432 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4433
4434 @node Set Catchpoints
4435 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4436 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4437 @cindex exception handlers
4438 @cindex event handling
4439
4440 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4441 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4442 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4443
4444 @table @code
4445 @kindex catch
4446 @item catch @var{event}
4447 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4448
4449 @table @code
4450 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4451 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4452 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4453 @kindex catch throw
4454 @kindex catch rethrow
4455 @kindex catch catch
4456 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4457 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4458
4459 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4460 regular expression will be caught.
4461
4462 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4463 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4464 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4465 exception being thrown.
4466
4467 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4468 @value{GDBN}:
4469
4470 @itemize @bullet
4471 @item
4472 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4473 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4474 supported.
4475
4476 @item
4477 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4478 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4479 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4480 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4481 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4482 built.
4483
4484 @item
4485 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4486 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4487
4488 @item
4489 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4490 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4491 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4492 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4493
4494 @item
4495 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4496 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4497 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4498 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4499 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4500 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4501 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4502 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4503 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4504
4505 @item
4506 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4507
4508 @item
4509 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4510 @end itemize
4511
4512 @item exception @r{[}@var{name}@r{]}
4513 @kindex catch exception
4514 @cindex Ada exception catching
4515 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4516 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4517 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4518 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4519 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4520
4521 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4522 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4523 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4524 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4525 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4526 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4527 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4528 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4529
4530 @item exception unhandled
4531 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4532 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4533
4534 @item handlers @r{[}@var{name}@r{]}
4535 @kindex catch handlers
4536 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4537 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4538 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4539 specified at the end of the command
4540 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4541 only when this specific exception is handled.
4542 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4543
4544 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4545 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4546 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4547 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4548 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4549 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4550 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4551 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4552 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4553
4554 @item assert
4555 @kindex catch assert
4556 A failed Ada assertion.
4557
4558 @item exec
4559 @kindex catch exec
4560 @cindex break on fork/exec
4561 A call to @code{exec}.
4562
4563 @anchor{catch syscall}
4564 @item syscall
4565 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4566 @kindex catch syscall
4567 @cindex break on a system call.
4568 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4569 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4570 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4571 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4572 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4573 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4574 will be caught.
4575
4576 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4577 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4578 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4579 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4580
4581 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4582 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4583 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4584 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4585
4586 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4587 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4588 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4589 available choices.
4590
4591 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4592 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4593 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4594 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4595 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4596 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4597 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4598 behind the OS upgrades).
4599
4600 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4601 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4602 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4603 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4604 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4605 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4606 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4607 syscall groups available on your environment.
4608
4609 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4610 arguments to it:
4611
4612 @smallexample
4613 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4614 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4615 (@value{GDBP}) r
4616 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4617
4618 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4619 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4620 (@value{GDBP}) c
4621 Continuing.
4622
4623 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4624 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4625 (@value{GDBP})
4626 @end smallexample
4627
4628 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4629
4630 @smallexample
4631 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4632 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4633 (@value{GDBP}) r
4634 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4635
4636 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4637 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4638 (@value{GDBP}) c
4639 Continuing.
4640
4641 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4642 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4643 (@value{GDBP})
4644 @end smallexample
4645
4646 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4647 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4648 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4649
4650 @smallexample
4651 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4652 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4653 (@value{GDBP}) r
4654 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4655
4656 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4657 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4658 (@value{GDBP}) c
4659 Continuing.
4660
4661 Program exited normally.
4662 (@value{GDBP})
4663 @end smallexample
4664
4665 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4666
4667 @smallexample
4668 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4669 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4670 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4671 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4672 (@value{GDBP}) r
4673 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4674
4675 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4676 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4677
4678 (@value{GDBP}) c
4679 Continuing.
4680 @end smallexample
4681
4682 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4683 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4684 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4685 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4689 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4690 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4691 (@value{GDBP})
4692 @end smallexample
4693
4694 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4695 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4696 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4697 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4698 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4699 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4700
4701 @smallexample
4702 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4703 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4704 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4705 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4706 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4707 (@value{GDBP})
4708 @end smallexample
4709
4710 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4711
4712 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4713 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4714
4715 @smallexample
4716 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4717 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4718 @end smallexample
4719
4720 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4721
4722 @item fork
4723 @kindex catch fork
4724 A call to @code{fork}.
4725
4726 @item vfork
4727 @kindex catch vfork
4728 A call to @code{vfork}.
4729
4730 @item load @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4731 @itemx unload @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4732 @kindex catch load
4733 @kindex catch unload
4734 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4735 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4736 matches one of the affected libraries.
4737
4738 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4739 @kindex catch signal
4740 The delivery of a signal.
4741
4742 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4743 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4744 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4745
4746 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4747 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4748 signal names.
4749
4750 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4751 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4752 will be caught.
4753
4754 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4755 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4756 catchpoint.
4757
4758 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4759 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4760 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4761 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4762 commands.
4763
4764 @end table
4765
4766 @item tcatch @var{event}
4767 @kindex tcatch
4768 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4769 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4770
4771 @end table
4772
4773 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4774
4775
4776 @node Delete Breaks
4777 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4778
4779 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4780 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4781 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4782 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4783 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4784 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4785
4786 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4787 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4788 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4789 their breakpoint numbers.
4790
4791 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4792 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4793 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4794
4795 @table @code
4796 @kindex clear
4797 @item clear
4798 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4799 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4800 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4801 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4802
4803 @item clear @var{location}
4804 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4805 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4806 most useful ones are listed below:
4807
4808 @table @code
4809 @item clear @var{function}
4810 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4811 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4812
4813 @item clear @var{linenum}
4814 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4815 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4816 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4817 @end table
4818
4819 @cindex delete breakpoints
4820 @kindex delete
4821 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4822 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4823 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4824 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4825 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4826 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4827 @end table
4828
4829 @node Disabling
4830 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4831
4832 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4833 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4834 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4835 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4836 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4837
4838 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4839 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4840 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4841 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4842 do not know which numbers to use.
4843
4844 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4845 affects all of its locations.
4846
4847 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4848 different states of enablement:
4849
4850 @itemize @bullet
4851 @item
4852 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4853 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4854 @item
4855 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4856 @item
4857 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4858 disabled.
4859 @item
4860 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4861 N times, then becomes disabled.
4862 @item
4863 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4864 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4865 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4866 @end itemize
4867
4868 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4869 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4870
4871 @table @code
4872 @kindex disable
4873 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4874 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4875 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4876 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4877 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4878 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4879 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4880
4881 @kindex enable
4882 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4883 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4884 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4885
4886 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4887 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4888 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4889
4890 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4891 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4892 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4893 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4894 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4895 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4896 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4897
4898 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4899 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4900 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4901 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4902 @end table
4903
4904 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4905 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4906 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4907 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4908 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4909 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4910 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4911 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4912 Stepping}.)
4913
4914 @node Conditions
4915 @subsection Break Conditions
4916 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4917 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4918
4919 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4920 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4921 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4922 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4923 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4924 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4925 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4926 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4927
4928 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4929 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4930 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4931 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4932 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4933
4934 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4935 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4936 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4937 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4938 one.
4939
4940 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4941 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4942 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4943 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4944 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4945 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4946 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4947 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4948 conditions for the
4949 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4950 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4951
4952 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4953 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4954 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4955 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4956 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4957 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4958
4959 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4960 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4961 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4962 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4963 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4964
4965 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4966 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4967 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4968 with the @code{condition} command.
4969
4970 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4971 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4972 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4973 catchpoint.
4974
4975 @table @code
4976 @kindex condition
4977 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4978 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4979 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4980 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4981 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4982 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4983 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4984 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4985 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4986 prints an error message:
4987
4988 @smallexample
4989 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4990 @end smallexample
4991
4992 @noindent
4993 @value{GDBN} does
4994 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4995 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4996 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4997
4998 @item condition @var{bnum}
4999 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
5000 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
5001 @end table
5002
5003 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
5004 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
5005 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
5006 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
5007 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5008 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5009 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5010 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5011 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5012 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5013 your program reaches it.
5014
5015 @table @code
5016 @kindex ignore
5017 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5018 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5019 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5020 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5021 takes no action.
5022
5023 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5024 a count of zero.
5025
5026 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5027 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5028 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5029 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5030
5031 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5032 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5033 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5034
5035 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5036 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5037 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5038 Variables}.
5039 @end table
5040
5041 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5042
5043
5044 @node Break Commands
5045 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5046
5047 @cindex breakpoint commands
5048 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5049 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5050 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5051 enable other breakpoints.
5052
5053 @table @code
5054 @kindex commands
5055 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5056 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5057 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5058 @itemx end
5059 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5060 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5061 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5062
5063 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5064 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5065
5066 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5067 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5068 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5069 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5070 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5071 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5072 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5073 Expressions}).
5074 @end table
5075
5076 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5077 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5078
5079 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5080 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5081 that resumes execution.
5082
5083 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5084 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5085 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5086 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5087 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5088
5089 @kindex silent
5090 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5091 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5092 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5093 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5094 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5095 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5096
5097 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5098 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5099 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5100
5101 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5102 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5103
5104 @smallexample
5105 break foo if x>0
5106 commands
5107 silent
5108 printf "x is %d\n",x
5109 cont
5110 end
5111 @end smallexample
5112
5113 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5114 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5115 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5116 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5117 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5118 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5119 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5120
5121 @smallexample
5122 break 403
5123 commands
5124 silent
5125 set x = y + 4
5126 cont
5127 end
5128 @end smallexample
5129
5130 @node Dynamic Printf
5131 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5132
5133 @cindex dynamic printf
5134 @cindex dprintf
5135 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5136 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5137 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5138 having to recompile it.
5139
5140 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5141 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5142 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5143 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5144 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5145 redirects to files and so forth.
5146
5147 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5148 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5149 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5150 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5151 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5152 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5153 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5154
5155 @table @code
5156 @kindex dprintf
5157 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5158 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5159 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5160 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5161
5162 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5163 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5164 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5165 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5166 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5167 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5168
5169 @table @code
5170 @item gdb
5171 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5172 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5173
5174 @item call
5175 @kindex dprintf-style call
5176 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5177 @code{printf}).
5178
5179 @item agent
5180 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5181 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5182 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5183 support running commands on the target.
5184 @end table
5185
5186 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5187 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5188 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5189 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5190 command.
5191
5192 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5193 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5194 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5195 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5196 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5197 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5198
5199 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5200 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5201 you could do the following:
5202
5203 @example
5204 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5205 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5206 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5207 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5208 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5209 (gdb) info break
5210 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5211 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5212 continue
5213 (gdb)
5214 @end example
5215
5216 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5217 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5218 the variable settings.
5219
5220 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5221 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5222 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5223 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5224 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5225 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5226
5227 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5228 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5229 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5230
5231 @end table
5232
5233 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5234 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5235 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5236 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5237 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5238 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5239
5240 @node Save Breakpoints
5241 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5242
5243 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5244 breakpoints}} command.
5245
5246 @table @code
5247 @kindex save breakpoints
5248 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5249 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5250 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5251 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5252 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5253 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5254 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5255 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5256 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5257 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5258 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5259 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5260 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5261 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5262 that can no longer be recreated.
5263 @end table
5264
5265 @node Static Probe Points
5266 @subsection Static Probe Points
5267
5268 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5269 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5270 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5271 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5272 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5273
5274 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5275 ELF-compatible systems:
5276
5277 @itemize @bullet
5278
5279 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5280 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5281 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5282 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5283 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5284 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5285 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5286 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5287
5288 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5289 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5290 C@t{++} languages.
5291 @end itemize
5292
5293 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5294 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5295 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5296 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5297 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5298 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5299 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5300 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5301 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5302
5303 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5304 probes}, with optional arguments:
5305
5306 @table @code
5307 @kindex info probes
5308 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5309 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5310 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5311 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5312
5313 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5314 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5315 probes from all providers are listed.
5316
5317 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5318 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5319 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5320
5321 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5322 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5323 given, all object files are considered.
5324
5325 @item info probes all
5326 List the available static probes, from all types.
5327 @end table
5328
5329 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5330 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5331 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5332 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5333 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5334
5335 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5336 commands, with optional arguments:
5337
5338 @table @code
5339 @kindex enable probes
5340 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5341 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5342 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5343 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5344
5345 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5346 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5347 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5348
5349 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5350 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5351 given, all object files are considered.
5352
5353 @kindex disable probes
5354 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5355 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5356 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5357 @end table
5358
5359 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5360 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5361 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5362 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5363 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5364 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5365 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5366 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5367 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5368 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5369 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5370 at the current probe point.
5371
5372 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5373 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5374 an error message.
5375
5376
5377 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5378 @node Error in Breakpoints
5379 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5380
5381 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5382 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5383
5384 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5385 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5386 @smallexample
5387 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5388 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5389 @end smallexample
5390
5391 @noindent
5392 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5393 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5394 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5395
5396 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5397 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5398
5399 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5400 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5401 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5402
5403 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5404 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5405 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5406 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5407
5408 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5409 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5410 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5411 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5412 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5413 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5414 first in the bundle.
5415
5416 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5417 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5418 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5419 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5420 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5421 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5422 is hit.
5423
5424 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5425 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5426
5427 @smallexample
5428 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5429 @end smallexample
5430
5431 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5432 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5433 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5434 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5435 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5436 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5437 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5438 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5439
5440 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5441 adjusted breakpoints:
5442
5443 @smallexample
5444 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5445 to 0x00010410.
5446 @end smallexample
5447
5448 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5449 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5450 frequently than expected.
5451
5452 @node Continuing and Stepping
5453 @section Continuing and Stepping
5454
5455 @cindex stepping
5456 @cindex continuing
5457 @cindex resuming execution
5458 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5459 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5460 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5461 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5462 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5463 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5464 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5465 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5466 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5467 handlers}).)
5468
5469 @table @code
5470 @kindex continue
5471 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5472 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5473 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5474 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5475 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5476 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5477 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5478 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5479 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5480 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5481
5482 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5483 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5484 @code{continue} is ignored.
5485
5486 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5487 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5488 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5489 @code{continue}.
5490 @end table
5491
5492 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5493 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5494 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5495 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5496
5497 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5498 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5499 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5500 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5501 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5502 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5503
5504 @table @code
5505 @kindex step
5506 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5507 @item step
5508 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5509 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5510 abbreviated @code{s}.
5511
5512 @quotation
5513 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5514 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5515 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5516 @c distinction here.
5517 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5518 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5519 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5520 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5521 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5522 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5523 below.
5524 @end quotation
5525
5526 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5527 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5528 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5529 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5530 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5531 called within the line.
5532
5533 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5534 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5535 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5536 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5537 was any debugging information about the routine.
5538
5539 @item step @var{count}
5540 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5541 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5542 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5543
5544 @kindex next
5545 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5546 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5547 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5548 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5549 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5550 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5551 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5552 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5553
5554 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5555
5556
5557 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5558 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5559 @c
5560 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5561 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5562 @c function are executed without stopping.
5563
5564 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5565 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5566 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5567
5568 @kindex set step-mode
5569 @item set step-mode
5570 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5571 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5572 @itemx set step-mode on
5573 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5574 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5575 information rather than stepping over it.
5576
5577 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5578 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5579 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5580
5581 @item set step-mode off
5582 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5583 debug information. This is the default.
5584
5585 @item show step-mode
5586 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5587 source line debug information.
5588
5589 @kindex finish
5590 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5591 @item finish
5592 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5593 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5594 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5595
5596 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5597 ,Returning from a Function}).
5598
5599 @kindex until
5600 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5601 @cindex run until specified location
5602 @item until
5603 @itemx u
5604 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5605 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5606 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5607 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5608 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5609 than the address of the jump.
5610
5611 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5612 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5613 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5614 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5615 through the next iteration.
5616
5617 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5618 stack frame.
5619
5620 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5621 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5622 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5623 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5624 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5625
5626 @smallexample
5627 (@value{GDBP}) f
5628 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5629 206 expand_input();
5630 (@value{GDBP}) until
5631 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5632 @end smallexample
5633
5634 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5635 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5636 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5637 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5638 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5639 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5640 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5641
5642 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5643 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5644 argument.
5645
5646 @item until @var{location}
5647 @itemx u @var{location}
5648 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5649 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5650 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5651 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5652 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5653 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5654 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5655 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5656 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5657 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5658 invocations have returned.
5659
5660 @smallexample
5661 94 int factorial (int value)
5662 95 @{
5663 96 if (value > 1) @{
5664 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5665 98 @}
5666 99 return (value);
5667 100 @}
5668 @end smallexample
5669
5670
5671 @kindex advance @var{location}
5672 @item advance @var{location}
5673 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5674 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5675 @ref{Specify Location}.
5676 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5677 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5678 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5679 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5680
5681
5682 @kindex stepi
5683 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5684 @item stepi
5685 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5686 @itemx si
5687 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5688
5689 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5690 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5691 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5692 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5693
5694 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5695
5696 @need 750
5697 @kindex nexti
5698 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5699 @item nexti
5700 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5701 @itemx ni
5702 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5703 proceed until the function returns.
5704
5705 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5706
5707 @end table
5708
5709 @anchor{range stepping}
5710 @cindex range stepping
5711 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5712 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5713 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5714 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5715 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5716 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5717 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5718 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5719 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5720 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5721 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5722 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5723 if necessary:
5724
5725 @table @code
5726 @kindex set range-stepping
5727 @kindex show range-stepping
5728 @item set range-stepping
5729 @itemx show range-stepping
5730 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5731
5732 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5733 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5734 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5735 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5736 default is @code{on}.
5737
5738 @end table
5739
5740 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5741 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5742 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5743
5744 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5745 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5746 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5747 a particular file when stepping.
5748
5749 For example, consider the following C function:
5750
5751 @smallexample
5752 101 int func()
5753 102 @{
5754 103 foo(boring());
5755 104 bar(boring());
5756 105 @}
5757 @end smallexample
5758
5759 @noindent
5760 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5761 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5762 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5763 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5764
5765 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5766 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5767 is called from many places.
5768
5769 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5770 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5771 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5772 @code{foo}.
5773
5774 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5775 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5776 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5777
5778 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5779 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5780 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5781 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5782 the underlying system.
5783 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5784 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5785
5786 @table @code
5787 @kindex skip
5788 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5789 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5790 that specify what to skip.
5791 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5792
5793 @table @code
5794 @item -file @var{file}
5795 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5796 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5797
5798 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5799 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5800 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5801 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5802 over when stepping.
5803
5804 @smallexample
5805 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5806 @end smallexample
5807
5808 @item -function @var{linespec}
5809 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5810 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5811 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5812 @xref{Specify Location}.
5813
5814 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5815 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5816 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5817 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5818
5819 This form is useful for complex function names.
5820 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5821 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5822 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5823 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5824 regular expression makes this easier.
5825
5826 @smallexample
5827 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5828 @end smallexample
5829
5830 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5831 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5832
5833 @smallexample
5834 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5835 @end smallexample
5836 @end table
5837
5838 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5839 will be skipped.
5840
5841 @kindex skip function
5842 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5843 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5844 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5845 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5846
5847 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5848 will be skipped.
5849
5850 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5851 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5852
5853 @kindex skip file
5854 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5855 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5856 will be skipped over when stepping.
5857
5858 @smallexample
5859 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5860 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5861 @end smallexample
5862
5863 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5864 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5865 @end table
5866
5867 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5868 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5869
5870 @table @code
5871 @kindex info skip
5872 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5873 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5874 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5875 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5876
5877 @table @emph
5878 @item Identifier
5879 A number identifying this skip.
5880 @item Enabled or Disabled
5881 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5882 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5883 @item Glob
5884 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5885 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5886 @item File
5887 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5888 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5889 @item RE
5890 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5891 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5892 @item Function
5893 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5894 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5895 @end table
5896
5897 @kindex skip delete
5898 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5899 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5900 skips.
5901
5902 @kindex skip enable
5903 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5904 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5905 skips.
5906
5907 @kindex skip disable
5908 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5909 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5910 skips.
5911
5912 @kindex set debug skip
5913 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5914 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5915
5916 @kindex show debug skip
5917 @item show debug skip
5918 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5919
5920 @end table
5921
5922 @node Signals
5923 @section Signals
5924 @cindex signals
5925
5926 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5927 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5928 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5929 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5930 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5931 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5932 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5933 requested an alarm).
5934
5935 @cindex fatal signals
5936 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5937 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5938 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5939 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5940 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5941 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5942
5943 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5944 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5945 signal.
5946
5947 @cindex handling signals
5948 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5949 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5950 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5951 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5952 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5953
5954 @table @code
5955 @kindex info signals
5956 @kindex info handle
5957 @item info signals
5958 @itemx info handle
5959 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5960 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5961 the defined types of signals.
5962
5963 @item info signals @var{sig}
5964 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5965
5966 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5967
5968 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5969 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5970 for details about this command.
5971
5972 @kindex handle
5973 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5974 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5975 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5976 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5977 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5978 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5979 say what change to make.
5980 @end table
5981
5982 @c @group
5983 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5984 Their full names are:
5985
5986 @table @code
5987 @item nostop
5988 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5989 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5990
5991 @item stop
5992 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5993 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5994
5995 @item print
5996 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5997
5998 @item noprint
5999 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
6000 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
6001
6002 @item pass
6003 @itemx noignore
6004 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
6005 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
6006 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
6007
6008 @item nopass
6009 @itemx ignore
6010 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6011 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6012 @end table
6013 @c @end group
6014
6015 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6016 program until you
6017 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6018 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6019 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6020 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6021 program sees that signal when you continue.
6022
6023 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6024 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6025 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6026 erroneous signals.
6027
6028 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6029 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6030 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6031 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6032 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6033 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6034 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6035 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6036 Program a Signal}.
6037
6038 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6039 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6040
6041 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6042 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6043 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6044 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6045 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6046 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6047 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6048 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6049 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6050 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6051 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6052 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6053 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6054
6055 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6056
6057 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6058 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6059 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6060 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6061
6062 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6063 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6064 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6065 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6066
6067 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6068 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6069
6070 @smallexample
6071 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6072 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6073 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6074 (@value{GDBP}) c
6075 Continuing.
6076
6077 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6078 main () sigusr1.c:28
6079 28 p = 0;
6080 (@value{GDBP}) si
6081 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6082 9 @{
6083 @end smallexample
6084
6085 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6086 program to receive the signal first:
6087
6088 @smallexample
6089 (@value{GDBP}) n
6090 28 p = 0;
6091 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6092 (@value{GDBP}) si
6093 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6094 9 @{
6095 (@value{GDBP})
6096 @end smallexample
6097
6098 @cindex extra signal information
6099 @anchor{extra signal information}
6100
6101 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6102 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6103 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6104 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6105 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6106 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6107 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6108 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6109 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6110 system header.
6111
6112 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6113 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 @group
6117 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6118 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6119 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6120 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6121 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6122 type = struct @{
6123 int si_signo;
6124 int si_errno;
6125 int si_code;
6126 union @{
6127 int _pad[28];
6128 struct @{...@} _kill;
6129 struct @{...@} _timer;
6130 struct @{...@} _rt;
6131 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6132 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6133 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6134 @} _sifields;
6135 @}
6136 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6137 type = struct @{
6138 void *si_addr;
6139 @}
6140 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6141 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6142 @end group
6143 @end smallexample
6144
6145 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6146
6147 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6148 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6149 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6150 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6151 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6152 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6153 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6154 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6155 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6156 information is displayed.
6157
6158 The usual output of a segfault is:
6159 @smallexample
6160 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6161 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6162 68 value = *(p + len);
6163 @end smallexample
6164
6165 While a bound violation is presented as:
6166 @smallexample
6167 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6168 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6169 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6170 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6171 68 value = *(p + len);
6172 @end smallexample
6173
6174 @node Thread Stops
6175 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6176
6177 @cindex stopped threads
6178 @cindex threads, stopped
6179
6180 @cindex continuing threads
6181 @cindex threads, continuing
6182
6183 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6184 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6185 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6186 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6187 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6188 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6189 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6190 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6191 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6192
6193 @menu
6194 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6195 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6196 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6197 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6198 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6199 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6200 @end menu
6201
6202 @node All-Stop Mode
6203 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6204
6205 @cindex all-stop mode
6206
6207 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6208 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6209 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6210 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6211 underfoot.
6212
6213 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6214 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6215 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6216
6217 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6218 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6219 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6220 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6221 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6222 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6223 stops.
6224
6225 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6226 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6227 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6228 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6229
6230 @cindex automatic thread selection
6231 @cindex switching threads automatically
6232 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6233 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6234 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6235 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6236 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6237 thread.
6238
6239 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6240 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6241
6242 @table @code
6243 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6244 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6245 @cindex lock scheduler
6246 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6247 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6248 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6249 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6250 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6251 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6252 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6253 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6254 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6255 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6256 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6257 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6258 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6259 @code{on} in replay mode.
6260
6261 @item show scheduler-locking
6262 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6263 @end table
6264
6265 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6266 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6267 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6268 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6269 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6270 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6271 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6272 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6273 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6274 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6275 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6276 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6277 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6278 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6279
6280 @table @code
6281 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6282 @item set schedule-multiple
6283 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6284 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6285 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6286 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6287 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6288 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6289
6290 @item show schedule-multiple
6291 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6292 multiple processes.
6293 @end table
6294
6295 @node Non-Stop Mode
6296 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6297
6298 @cindex non-stop mode
6299
6300 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6301 @c with more details.
6302
6303 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6304 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6305 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6306 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6307 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6308 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6309
6310 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6311 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6312 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6313 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6314 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6315 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6316 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6317 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6318 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6319 independently and simultaneously.
6320
6321 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6322 or attach to your program:
6323
6324 @smallexample
6325 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6326 set pagination off
6327
6328 # Finally, turn it on!
6329 set non-stop on
6330 @end smallexample
6331
6332 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6333
6334 @table @code
6335 @kindex set non-stop
6336 @item set non-stop on
6337 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6338 @item set non-stop off
6339 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6340 @kindex show non-stop
6341 @item show non-stop
6342 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6343 @end table
6344
6345 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6346 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6347 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6348 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6349 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6350 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6351 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6352 default.
6353
6354 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6355 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6356 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6357
6358 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6359 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6360 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6361 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6362 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6363
6364 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6365 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6366 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6367 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6368 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6369
6370 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6371
6372 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6373 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6374 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6375 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6376 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6377 previously current thread.
6378
6379 @node Background Execution
6380 @subsection Background Execution
6381
6382 @cindex foreground execution
6383 @cindex background execution
6384 @cindex asynchronous execution
6385 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6386
6387 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6388 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6389 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6390 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6391 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6392 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6393
6394 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6395 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6396
6397 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6398 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6399 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6400 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6401 are:
6402
6403 @table @code
6404 @kindex run&
6405 @item run
6406 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6407
6408 @item attach
6409 @kindex attach&
6410 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6411
6412 @item step
6413 @kindex step&
6414 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6415
6416 @item stepi
6417 @kindex stepi&
6418 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6419
6420 @item next
6421 @kindex next&
6422 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6423
6424 @item nexti
6425 @kindex nexti&
6426 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6427
6428 @item continue
6429 @kindex continue&
6430 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6431
6432 @item finish
6433 @kindex finish&
6434 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6435
6436 @item until
6437 @kindex until&
6438 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6439
6440 @end table
6441
6442 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6443 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6444 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6445 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6446 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6447 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6448
6449 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6450 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6451
6452 @table @code
6453 @kindex interrupt
6454 @item interrupt
6455 @itemx interrupt -a
6456
6457 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6458 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6459 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6460 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6461 @end table
6462
6463 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6464 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6465
6466 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6467 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6468 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6469
6470 @table @code
6471 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6472 @cindex thread breakpoints
6473 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6474 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6475 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6476 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6477 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6478 specify some source line.
6479
6480 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6481 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6482 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6483 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6484 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6485
6486 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6487 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6488 program.
6489
6490 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6491 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6492 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6493
6494 @smallexample
6495 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 @end table
6499
6500 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6501 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6502 thread list. For example:
6503
6504 @smallexample
6505 (@value{GDBP}) c
6506 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6507 @end smallexample
6508
6509 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6510 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6511 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6512 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6513 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6514 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6515 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6516 command.
6517
6518 @node Interrupted System Calls
6519 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6520
6521 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6522 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6523 @cindex premature return from system calls
6524 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6525 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6526 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6527 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6528 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6529 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6530 stop execution.
6531
6532 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6533 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6534 style anyways.
6535
6536 For example, do not write code like this:
6537
6538 @smallexample
6539 sleep (10);
6540 @end smallexample
6541
6542 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6543 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6544
6545 Instead, write this:
6546
6547 @smallexample
6548 int unslept = 10;
6549 while (unslept > 0)
6550 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6551 @end smallexample
6552
6553 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6554 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6555 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6556 @value{GDBN}.
6557
6558 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6559 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6560 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6561 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6562
6563 @node Observer Mode
6564 @subsection Observer Mode
6565
6566 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6567 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6568 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6569 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6570 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6571
6572 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6573 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6574 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6575 mode.
6576
6577 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6578 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6579 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6580 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6581 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6582
6583 @table @code
6584
6585 @kindex observer
6586 @item set observer on
6587 @itemx set observer off
6588 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6589 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6590 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6591 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6592
6593 @item show observer
6594 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6595
6596 @kindex may-write-registers
6597 @item set may-write-registers on
6598 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6599 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6600 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6601 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6602
6603 @item show may-write-registers
6604 Show the current permission to write registers.
6605
6606 @kindex may-write-memory
6607 @item set may-write-memory on
6608 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6609 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6610 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6611 defaults to @code{on}.
6612
6613 @item show may-write-memory
6614 Show the current permission to write memory.
6615
6616 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6617 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6618 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6619 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6620 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6621 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6622
6623 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6624 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6625
6626 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6627 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6628 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6629 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6630 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6631 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6632 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6633
6634 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6635 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6636
6637 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6638 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6639 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6640 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6641 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6642 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6643 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6644
6645 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6646 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6647
6648 @kindex may-interrupt
6649 @item set may-interrupt on
6650 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6651 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6652 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6653 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6654 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6655
6656 @item show may-interrupt
6657 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6658
6659 @end table
6660
6661 @node Reverse Execution
6662 @chapter Running programs backward
6663 @cindex reverse execution
6664 @cindex running programs backward
6665
6666 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6667 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6668 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6669 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6670
6671 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6672 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6673 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6674 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6675 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6676 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6677
6678 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6679 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6680 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6681 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6682 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6683 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6684 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6685 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6686 prior values@footnote{
6687 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6688 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6689 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6690
6691 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6692 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6693 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6694 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6695 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6696 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6697 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6698 }.
6699
6700 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} has built-in support for reverse
6701 execution, activated with the @code{record} or @code{record btrace}
6702 commands. @xref{Process Record and Replay}. Some remote targets,
6703 typically full system emulators, support reverse execution directly
6704 without requiring any special command.
6705
6706 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6707 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6708
6709 @table @code
6710 @kindex reverse-continue
6711 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6712 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6713 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6714 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6715 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6716 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6717 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6718
6719 @kindex reverse-step
6720 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6721 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6722 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6723 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6724
6725 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6726 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6727 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6728 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6729 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6730 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6731
6732 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6733 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6734
6735 @kindex reverse-stepi
6736 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6737 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6738 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6739 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6740 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6741 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6742 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6743
6744 @kindex reverse-next
6745 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6746 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6747 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6748 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6749 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6750 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6751 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6752 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6753 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6754 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6755
6756 @kindex reverse-nexti
6757 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6758 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6759 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6760 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6761 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6762 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6763 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6764 frame) is reached.
6765
6766 @kindex reverse-finish
6767 @item reverse-finish
6768 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6769 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6770 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6771 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6772
6773 @kindex set exec-direction
6774 @item set exec-direction
6775 Set the direction of target execution.
6776 @item set exec-direction reverse
6777 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6778 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6779 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6780 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6781 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6782 @item set exec-direction forward
6783 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6784 This is the default.
6785 @end table
6786
6787
6788 @node Process Record and Replay
6789 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6790 @cindex process record and replay
6791 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6792
6793 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6794 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6795 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6796
6797 @cindex replay mode
6798 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6799 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6800 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6801 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6802 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6803 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6804 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6805 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6806 execution log.
6807
6808 @cindex record mode
6809 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6810 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6811 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6812 for future replay.
6813
6814 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6815 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6816 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6817 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6818 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6819 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6820
6821 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6822 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6823 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6824 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6825
6826 Currently, process record and replay is supported on ARM, Aarch64,
6827 Moxie, PowerPC, PowerPC64, S/390, and x86 (i386/amd64) running
6828 GNU/Linux. Process record and replay can be used both when native
6829 debugging, and when remote debugging via @code{gdbserver}.
6830
6831 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6832 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6833
6834 @table @code
6835 @kindex target record
6836 @kindex target record-full
6837 @kindex target record-btrace
6838 @kindex record
6839 @kindex record full
6840 @kindex record btrace
6841 @kindex record btrace bts
6842 @kindex record btrace pt
6843 @kindex record bts
6844 @kindex record pt
6845 @kindex rec
6846 @kindex rec full
6847 @kindex rec btrace
6848 @kindex rec btrace bts
6849 @kindex rec btrace pt
6850 @kindex rec bts
6851 @kindex rec pt
6852 @item record @var{method}
6853 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6854 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6855 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6856 recording methods are available:
6857
6858 @table @code
6859 @item full
6860 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6861 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6862 execution.
6863
6864 @item btrace @var{format}
6865 Hardware-supported instruction recording, supported on Intel
6866 processors. This method does not record data. Further, the data is
6867 collected in a ring buffer so old data will be overwritten when the
6868 buffer is full. It allows limited reverse execution. Variables and
6869 registers are not available during reverse execution. In remote
6870 debugging, recording continues on disconnect. Recorded data can be
6871 inspected after reconnecting. The recording may be stopped using
6872 @code{record stop}.
6873
6874 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6875 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6876 formats are available:
6877
6878 @table @code
6879 @item bts
6880 @cindex branch trace store
6881 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6882 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6883 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6884
6885 @item pt
6886 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6887 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6888 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6889 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6890
6891 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6892 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6893 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6894
6895 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6896 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6897 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6898 buffer-size with care.
6899 @end table
6900
6901 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6902 @end table
6903
6904 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6905 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6906 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6907 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6908
6909 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6910 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6911 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6912 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6913 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6914
6915 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6916 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6917 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6918 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6919 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6920 does not support these two modes.
6921
6922 @kindex record stop
6923 @kindex rec s
6924 @item record stop
6925 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6926 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6927 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6928
6929 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6930 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6931 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6932 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6933 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6934
6935 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6936 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6937 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6938 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6939 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6940
6941 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6942 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6943
6944 @kindex record goto
6945 @item record goto
6946 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6947 ways to specify the location to go to:
6948
6949 @table @code
6950 @item record goto begin
6951 @itemx record goto start
6952 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6953
6954 @item record goto end
6955 Go to the end of the execution log.
6956
6957 @item record goto @var{n}
6958 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6959 @end table
6960
6961 @kindex record save
6962 @item record save @var{filename}
6963 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6964 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6965 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6966
6967 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6968
6969 @kindex record restore
6970 @item record restore @var{filename}
6971 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6972 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6973
6974 @kindex set record full
6975 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6976 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6977 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6978 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6979
6980 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6981 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6982 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6983 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6984 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6985 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6986 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6987 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6988
6989 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6990 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6991 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6992
6993 @kindex show record full
6994 @item show record full insn-number-max
6995 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6996 recording method.
6997
6998 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6999 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
7000 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
7001 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
7002 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
7003 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
7004 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
7005 oldest one to be deleted.
7006
7007 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
7008 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
7009
7010 @item show record full stop-at-limit
7011 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
7012
7013 @item set record full memory-query
7014 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
7015 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
7016 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
7017 case.
7018
7019 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7020 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7021 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7022 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7023 results.
7024
7025 @item show record full memory-query
7026 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7027
7028 @kindex set record btrace
7029 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7030 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7031 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7032 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7033 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7034 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7035 You can use the following command for that:
7036
7037 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7038 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7039 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7040 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7041 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7042 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7043 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7044 position.
7045
7046 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7047 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7048 errata when decoding the trace.
7049
7050 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7051 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7052 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7053 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7054 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7055 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7056 which the trace was recorded.
7057
7058 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7059 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7060 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7061 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7062 disable the workarounds.
7063
7064 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7065 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7066 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7067 (default).
7068
7069 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7070 identifiers are currently supported:
7071
7072 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7073
7074 @item @code{intel}
7075 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7076
7077 @end multitable
7078
7079 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7080 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7081
7082 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7083 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7084 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7085
7086 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7087 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7088 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7089 supports.
7090
7091 @smallexample
7092 (gdb) info record
7093 Active record target: record-btrace
7094 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7095 Buffer size: 16kB.
7096 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7097 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7098 (gdb) info record
7099 Active record target: record-btrace
7100 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7101 Buffer size: 16kB.
7102 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7103 @end smallexample
7104
7105 @kindex show record btrace
7106 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7107 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7108
7109 @item show record btrace cpu
7110 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7111 workarounds.
7112
7113 @kindex set record btrace bts
7114 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7115 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7116 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7117 format. Default is 64KB.
7118
7119 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7120 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7121 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7122 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7123 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7124 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7125 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7126
7127 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7128 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7129
7130 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7131 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7132
7133 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7134 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7135 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7136
7137 @kindex set record btrace pt
7138 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7139 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7140 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7141 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7142
7143 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7144 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7145 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7146 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7147 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7148 actual buffer size for each thread.
7149
7150 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7151 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7152
7153 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7154 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7155
7156 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7157 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7158 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7159
7160 @kindex info record
7161 @item info record
7162 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7163 method:
7164
7165 @table @code
7166 @item full
7167 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7168 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7169
7170 @itemize @bullet
7171 @item
7172 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7173 @item
7174 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7175 @item
7176 Highest recorded instruction number.
7177 @item
7178 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7179 @item
7180 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7181 @item
7182 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7183 @end itemize
7184
7185 @item btrace
7186 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7187
7188 @itemize @bullet
7189 @item
7190 Recording format.
7191 @item
7192 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7193 @item
7194 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7195 instructions.
7196 @item
7197 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7198 @end itemize
7199
7200 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7201 @itemize @bullet
7202 @item
7203 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7204 @end itemize
7205
7206 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7207 @itemize @bullet
7208 @item
7209 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7210 @end itemize
7211 @end table
7212
7213 @kindex record delete
7214 @kindex rec del
7215 @item record delete
7216 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7217 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7218 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7219 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7220
7221 @kindex record instruction-history
7222 @kindex rec instruction-history
7223 @item record instruction-history
7224 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7225 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7226 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7227 are printed in execution order.
7228
7229 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7230 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7231 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7232
7233 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7234 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7235 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7236 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7237 @code{/p} modifier.
7238
7239 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7240 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7241 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7242
7243 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7244 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7245
7246 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7247 disassemble:
7248
7249 @table @code
7250 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7251 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7252 @var{insn}.
7253
7254 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7255 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7256 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7257 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7258 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7259 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7260
7261 @item record instruction-history
7262 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7263
7264 @item record instruction-history -
7265 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7266
7267 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7268 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7269 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7270 number @var{end} is included.
7271 @end table
7272
7273 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7274
7275 @kindex set record
7276 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7277 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7278 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7279 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7280 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7281
7282 @kindex show record
7283 @item show record instruction-history-size
7284 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7285 instruction-history} command.
7286
7287 @kindex record function-call-history
7288 @kindex rec function-call-history
7289 @item record function-call-history
7290 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7291 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7292 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7293 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7294 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7295 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7296 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7297 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7298 given together.
7299
7300 @smallexample
7301 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7302 1 void foo (void)
7303 2 @{
7304 3 @}
7305 4
7306 5 void bar (void)
7307 6 @{
7308 7 ...
7309 8 foo ();
7310 9 ...
7311 10 @}
7312 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7313 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7314 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7315 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7316 @end smallexample
7317
7318 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7319 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7320 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7321 to print:
7322
7323 @table @code
7324 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7325 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7326
7327 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7328 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7329 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7330 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7331 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7332
7333 @item record function-call-history
7334 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7335
7336 @item record function-call-history -
7337 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7338
7339 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7340 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7341 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7342 @end table
7343
7344 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7345
7346 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7347 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7348 Define how many lines to print in the
7349 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7350 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7351
7352 @item show record function-call-history-size
7353 Show how many lines to print in the
7354 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7355 @end table
7356
7357
7358 @node Stack
7359 @chapter Examining the Stack
7360
7361 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7362 stopped and how it got there.
7363
7364 @cindex call stack
7365 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7366 is generated.
7367 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7368 the arguments of the call,
7369 and the local variables of the function being called.
7370 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7371 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7372 stack}.
7373
7374 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7375 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7376
7377 @cindex selected frame
7378 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7379 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7380 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7381 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7382 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7383 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7384
7385 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7386 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7387 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7388
7389 @menu
7390 * Frames:: Stack frames
7391 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7392 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7393 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7394 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7395 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7396
7397 @end menu
7398
7399 @node Frames
7400 @section Stack Frames
7401
7402 @cindex frame, definition
7403 @cindex stack frame
7404 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7405 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7406 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7407 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7408 which the function is executing.
7409
7410 @cindex initial frame
7411 @cindex outermost frame
7412 @cindex innermost frame
7413 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7414 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7415 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7416 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7417 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7418 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7419 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7420 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7421
7422 @cindex frame pointer
7423 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7424 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7425 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7426 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7427 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7428 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7429
7430 @cindex frame level
7431 @cindex frame number
7432 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7433 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7434 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7435 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7436 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7437 describe this number.
7438
7439 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7440 @c underflow problems.
7441 @cindex frameless execution
7442 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7443 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7444 @smallexample
7445 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7446 @end smallexample
7447 generates functions without a frame.)
7448 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7449 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7450 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7451 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7452 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7453 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7454 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7455
7456 @node Backtrace
7457 @section Backtraces
7458
7459 @cindex traceback
7460 @cindex call stack traces
7461 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7462 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7463 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7464 stack.
7465
7466 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7467 @kindex backtrace
7468 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7469 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7470 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7471 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7472 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7473 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7474
7475 @table @code
7476 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7477 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7478 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7479 be one of the following:
7480
7481 @table @code
7482 @item @var{n}
7483 @itemx @var{n}
7484 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7485 number.
7486
7487 @item -@var{n}
7488 @itemx -@var{n}
7489 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7490 number.
7491
7492 @item full
7493 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7494 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7495
7496 @item no-filters
7497 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7498 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7499 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7500 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7501 support.
7502
7503 @item hide
7504 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7505 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7506 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7507 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7508 @end table
7509 @end table
7510
7511 @kindex where
7512 @kindex info stack
7513 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7514 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7515
7516 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7517 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7518 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7519 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7520 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7521 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7522 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7523 multi-threaded program.
7524
7525 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7526 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7527 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7528 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7529 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7530 line number.
7531
7532 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7533 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7534
7535 @smallexample
7536 @group
7537 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7538 at builtin.c:993
7539 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7540 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7541 at macro.c:71
7542 (More stack frames follow...)
7543 @end group
7544 @end smallexample
7545
7546 @noindent
7547 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7548 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7549 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7550
7551 @noindent
7552 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7553 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7554 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7555 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7556 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7557
7558 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7559 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7560 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7561 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7562 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7563 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7564 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7565 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7566 such a backtrace might look like:
7567
7568 @smallexample
7569 @group
7570 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7571 at builtin.c:993
7572 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7573 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7574 at macro.c:71
7575 (More stack frames follow...)
7576 @end group
7577 @end smallexample
7578
7579 @noindent
7580 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7581 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7582
7583 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7584 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7585 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7586
7587 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7588 @cindex program entry point
7589 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7590 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7591 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7592 @code{main}@footnote{
7593 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7594 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7595 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7596 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7597 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7598 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7599
7600 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7601 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7602
7603 @table @code
7604 @item set backtrace past-main
7605 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7606 @kindex set backtrace
7607 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7608
7609 @item set backtrace past-main off
7610 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7611 default.
7612
7613 @item show backtrace past-main
7614 @kindex show backtrace
7615 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7616
7617 @item set backtrace past-entry
7618 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7619 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7620 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7621 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7622
7623 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7624 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7625 application. This is the default.
7626
7627 @item show backtrace past-entry
7628 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7629
7630 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7631 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7632 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7633 @cindex backtrace limit
7634 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7635 or zero means unlimited levels.
7636
7637 @item show backtrace limit
7638 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7639 @end table
7640
7641 You can control how file names are displayed.
7642
7643 @table @code
7644 @item set filename-display
7645 @itemx set filename-display relative
7646 @cindex filename-display
7647 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7648
7649 @item set filename-display basename
7650 Display only basename of a filename.
7651
7652 @item set filename-display absolute
7653 Display an absolute filename.
7654
7655 @item show filename-display
7656 Show the current way to display filenames.
7657 @end table
7658
7659 @node Selection
7660 @section Selecting a Frame
7661
7662 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7663 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7664 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7665 of the stack frame just selected.
7666
7667 @table @code
7668 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7669 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7670 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7671 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7672 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
7673 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
7674
7675 @table @code
7676 @kindex frame level
7677 @item @var{num}
7678 @item level @var{num}
7679 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7680 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7681 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
7682 for @code{main}.
7683
7684 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
7685 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
7686 commands are equivalent:
7687
7688 @smallexample
7689 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
7690 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
7691 @end smallexample
7692
7693 @kindex frame address
7694 @item address @var{stack-address}
7695 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
7696 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
7697 @command{info frame}, for example:
7698
7699 @smallexample
7700 (gdb) info frame
7701 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7702 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
7703 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
7704 source language c++.
7705 Arglist at unknown address.
7706 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
7707 @end smallexample
7708
7709 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
7710 indicated by the line:
7711
7712 @smallexample
7713 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
7714 @end smallexample
7715
7716 @kindex frame function
7717 @item function @var{function-name}
7718 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
7719 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
7720 most stack frame is selected.
7721
7722 @kindex frame view
7723 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
7724 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
7725 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
7726 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
7727
7728 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
7729 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
7730 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
7731 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
7732
7733 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
7734 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
7735 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
7736 for example @command{frame level 0}.
7737
7738 @end table
7739
7740 @kindex up
7741 @item up @var{n}
7742 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7743 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7744 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7745
7746 @kindex down
7747 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7748 @item down @var{n}
7749 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7750 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7751 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7752 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7753 @end table
7754
7755 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7756 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7757 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7758 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7759
7760 @need 1000
7761 For example:
7762
7763 @smallexample
7764 @group
7765 (@value{GDBP}) up
7766 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7767 at env.c:10
7768 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7769 @end group
7770 @end smallexample
7771
7772 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7773 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7774 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7775 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7776 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7777 for details.
7778
7779 @table @code
7780 @kindex select-frame
7781 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7782 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7783 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7784 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7785 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
7786 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
7787 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7788
7789 @kindex down-silently
7790 @kindex up-silently
7791 @item up-silently @var{n}
7792 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7793 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7794 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7795 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7796 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7797 distracting.
7798 @end table
7799
7800 @node Frame Info
7801 @section Information About a Frame
7802
7803 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7804 stack frame.
7805
7806 @table @code
7807 @item frame
7808 @itemx f
7809 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7810 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7811 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7812 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7813 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7814
7815 @kindex info frame
7816 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7817 @item info frame
7818 @itemx info f
7819 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7820 including:
7821
7822 @itemize @bullet
7823 @item
7824 the address of the frame
7825 @item
7826 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7827 @item
7828 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7829 @item
7830 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7831 @item
7832 the address of the frame's arguments
7833 @item
7834 the address of the frame's local variables
7835 @item
7836 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7837 @item
7838 which registers were saved in the frame
7839 @end itemize
7840
7841 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7842 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7843 the usual conventions.
7844
7845 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7846 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7847 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
7848 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
7849 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
7850 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
7851
7852 @kindex info args
7853 @item info args [-q]
7854 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7855
7856 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7857 printing header information and messages explaining why no argument
7858 have been printed.
7859
7860 @item info args [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7861 Like @kbd{info args}, but only print the arguments selected
7862 with the provided regexp(s).
7863
7864 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose names
7865 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7866
7867 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose
7868 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7869 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7870 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7871 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7872 of special characters or quotes.
7873
7874 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
7875 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7876 @var{type_regexp}.
7877
7878 @item info locals [-q]
7879 @kindex info locals
7880 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7881 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7882 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7883
7884 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
7885 printing header information and messages explaining why no local variables
7886 have been printed.
7887
7888 @item info locals [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
7889 Like @kbd{info locals}, but only print the local variables selected
7890 with the provided regexp(s).
7891
7892 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose names
7893 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
7894
7895 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose
7896 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
7897 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
7898 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
7899 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
7900 of special characters or quotes.
7901
7902 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a local variable
7903 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
7904 @var{type_regexp}.
7905
7906 The command @kbd{info locals -q -t @var{type_regexp}} can usefully be
7907 combined with the commands @kbd{frame apply} and @kbd{thread apply}.
7908 For example, your program might use Resource Acquisition Is
7909 Initialization types (RAII) such as @code{lock_something_t}: each
7910 local variable of type @code{lock_something_t} automatically places a
7911 lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
7912 then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
7913 @smallexample
7914 thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
7915 @end smallexample
7916 @noindent
7917 or the equivalent shorter form
7918 @smallexample
7919 tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
7920 @end smallexample
7921
7922 @end table
7923
7924 @node Frame Apply
7925 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7926 @kindex frame apply
7927 @cindex apply command to several frames
7928 @table @code
7929 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7930 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7931 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7932
7933 @table @code
7934 @item @code{all}
7935 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7936
7937 @item @var{count}
7938 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7939 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7940
7941 @item @var{-count}
7942 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7943 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7944
7945 @item @code{level}
7946 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7947 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7948 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7949 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7950 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7951 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7952
7953 @end table
7954
7955 @end table
7956
7957 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7958 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7959 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7960 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7961
7962 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7963 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7964 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7965 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7966 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7967
7968 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7969 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7970 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7971 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7972
7973 @table @code
7974 @item -c
7975 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7976 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7977 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7978 @item -s
7979 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7980 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7981 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7982 are not printed.
7983 @item -q
7984 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7985 information.
7986 @end table
7987
7988 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7989 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7990 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7991 @code{#1 main} frame.
7992
7993 @smallexample
7994 @group
7995 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7996 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7997 No symbol "j" in current context.
7998 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7999 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8000 No symbol "j" in current context.
8001 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8002 $1 = 5
8003 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
8004 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8005 $2 = 5
8006 (gdb)
8007 @end group
8008 @end smallexample
8009
8010 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
8011 information before the command output:
8012
8013 @smallexample
8014 @group
8015 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
8016 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8017 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8018 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8019 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8020 (gdb)
8021 @end group
8022 @end smallexample
8023
8024 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
8025 @smallexample
8026 @group
8027 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
8028 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8029 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8030 (gdb)
8031 @end group
8032 @end smallexample
8033
8034 @table @code
8035
8036 @kindex faas
8037 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
8038 @item faas @var{command}
8039 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
8040 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
8041
8042 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
8043 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
8044 is, using:
8045 @smallexample
8046 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
8047 @end smallexample
8048
8049 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
8050 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
8051 @end table
8052
8053
8054 @node Frame Filter Management
8055 @section Management of Frame Filters.
8056 @cindex managing frame filters
8057
8058 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
8059 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
8060
8061 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
8062 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
8063
8064 @table @code
8065 @kindex info frame-filter
8066 @item info frame-filter
8067 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
8068 their name, priority and enabled status.
8069
8070 @kindex disable frame-filter
8071 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
8072 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8073 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8074 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8075 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8076 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8077 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
8078 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
8079 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8080 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8081 may be enabled again later.
8082
8083 @kindex enable frame-filter
8084 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8085 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8086 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8087 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8088 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8089 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8090 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8091 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8092 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8093
8094 Example:
8095
8096 @smallexample
8097 (gdb) info frame-filter
8098
8099 global frame-filters:
8100 Priority Enabled Name
8101 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8102 100 Yes Reverse
8103
8104 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8105 Priority Enabled Name
8106 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8107
8108 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8109 Priority Enabled Name
8110 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8111
8112 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8113 (gdb) info frame-filter
8114
8115 global frame-filters:
8116 Priority Enabled Name
8117 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8118 100 Yes Reverse
8119
8120 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8121 Priority Enabled Name
8122 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8123
8124 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8125 Priority Enabled Name
8126 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8127
8128 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8129 (gdb) info frame-filter
8130
8131 global frame-filters:
8132 Priority Enabled Name
8133 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8134 100 Yes Reverse
8135
8136 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8137 Priority Enabled Name
8138 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8139
8140 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8141 Priority Enabled Name
8142 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8143 @end smallexample
8144
8145 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8146 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8147 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8148 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8149 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8150 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8151 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8152
8153 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8154 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8155 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8156 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8157 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8158 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8159 dictionary resides.
8160
8161 Example:
8162
8163 @smallexample
8164 (gdb) info frame-filter
8165
8166 global frame-filters:
8167 Priority Enabled Name
8168 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8169 100 Yes Reverse
8170
8171 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8172 Priority Enabled Name
8173 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8174
8175 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8176 Priority Enabled Name
8177 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8178
8179 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8180 (gdb) info frame-filter
8181
8182 global frame-filters:
8183 Priority Enabled Name
8184 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8185 50 Yes Reverse
8186
8187 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8188 Priority Enabled Name
8189 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8190
8191 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8192 Priority Enabled Name
8193 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8194 @end smallexample
8195 @end table
8196
8197 @node Source
8198 @chapter Examining Source Files
8199
8200 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8201 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8202 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8203 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8204 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8205 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8206 source files by explicit command.
8207
8208 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8209 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8210 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8211
8212 @menu
8213 * List:: Printing source lines
8214 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8215 * Edit:: Editing source files
8216 * Search:: Searching source files
8217 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8218 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8219 @end menu
8220
8221 @node List
8222 @section Printing Source Lines
8223
8224 @kindex list
8225 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8226 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8227 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8228 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8229 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8230
8231 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8232
8233 @table @code
8234 @item list @var{linenum}
8235 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8236 current source file.
8237
8238 @item list @var{function}
8239 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8240 @var{function}.
8241
8242 @item list
8243 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8244 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8245 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8246 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8247 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8248
8249 @item list -
8250 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8251 @end table
8252
8253 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8254 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8255 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8256
8257 @table @code
8258 @kindex set listsize
8259 @item set listsize @var{count}
8260 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8261 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8262 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8263 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8264
8265 @kindex show listsize
8266 @item show listsize
8267 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8268 @end table
8269
8270 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8271 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8272 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8273 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8274 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8275
8276 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8277 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8278 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8279 to specify some source line.
8280
8281 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8282
8283 @table @code
8284 @item list @var{location}
8285 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8286
8287 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8288 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8289 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8290 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8291 the same source file as the first location.
8292
8293 @item list ,@var{last}
8294 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8295
8296 @item list @var{first},
8297 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8298
8299 @item list +
8300 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8301
8302 @item list -
8303 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8304
8305 @item list
8306 As described in the preceding table.
8307 @end table
8308
8309 @node Specify Location
8310 @section Specifying a Location
8311 @cindex specifying location
8312 @cindex location
8313 @cindex source location
8314
8315 @menu
8316 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8317 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8318 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8319 @end menu
8320
8321 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8322 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8323 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8324 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8325 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8326
8327 @node Linespec Locations
8328 @subsection Linespec Locations
8329 @cindex linespec locations
8330
8331 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8332 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8333 specifying a linespec:
8334
8335 @table @code
8336 @item @var{linenum}
8337 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8338
8339 @item -@var{offset}
8340 @itemx +@var{offset}
8341 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8342 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8343 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8344 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8345 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8346 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8347 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8348 linespec.
8349
8350 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8351 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8352 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8353 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8354 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8355 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8356 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8357
8358 @item @var{function}
8359 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8360 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8361
8362 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8363 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8364 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8365 means in all packages.
8366
8367 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8368 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8369 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8370
8371 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8372 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8373 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8374 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8375
8376 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8377
8378 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8379 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8380
8381 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8382 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8383 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8384 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8385 functions in different source files.
8386
8387 @item @var{label}
8388 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8389 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8390 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8391 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8392
8393 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8394 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8395 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8396 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8397 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8398 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8399
8400 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8401 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8402 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8403 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8404 each one of those probes.
8405 @end table
8406
8407 @node Explicit Locations
8408 @subsection Explicit Locations
8409 @cindex explicit locations
8410
8411 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8412 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8413
8414 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8415 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8416 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8417 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8418 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8419
8420 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8421 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8422 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8423 the symbol table to know.
8424
8425 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8426 following table:
8427
8428 @table @code
8429 @item -source @var{filename}
8430 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8431 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8432 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8433 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8434 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8435
8436 @item -function @var{function}
8437 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8438 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8439 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8440 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8441
8442 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8443 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8444 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8445 means in all packages.
8446
8447 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8448 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8449 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8450 breakpoint on both symbols.
8451
8452 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8453
8454 @item -qualified
8455
8456 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8457 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8458
8459 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8460 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8461 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8462
8463 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8464 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8465 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8466
8467 @item -label @var{label}
8468 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8469 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8470 selected stack frame.
8471
8472 @item -line @var{number}
8473 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8474 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8475 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8476 relative to the current line.
8477 @end table
8478
8479 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8480 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8481
8482 @node Address Locations
8483 @subsection Address Locations
8484 @cindex address locations
8485
8486 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8487 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8488
8489 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8490 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8491 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8492 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8493 source files.
8494
8495 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8496 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8497 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8498 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8499 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8500 of @var{address}:
8501
8502 @table @code
8503 @item @var{expression}
8504 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8505
8506 @item @var{funcaddr}
8507 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8508 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8509 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8510 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8511 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8512 (although the Pascal form also works).
8513
8514 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8515 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8516
8517 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8518 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8519 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8520 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8521 functions with identical names in different source files.
8522 @end table
8523
8524 @node Edit
8525 @section Editing Source Files
8526 @cindex editing source files
8527
8528 @kindex edit
8529 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8530 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8531 The editing program of your choice
8532 is invoked with the current line set to
8533 the active line in the program.
8534 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8535 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8536
8537 @table @code
8538 @item edit @var{location}
8539 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8540 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8541 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8542 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8543 command most commonly used:
8544
8545 @table @code
8546 @item edit @var{number}
8547 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8548
8549 @item edit @var{function}
8550 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8551 @end table
8552
8553 @end table
8554
8555 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8556 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8557 @footnote{
8558 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8559 following command-line syntax:
8560 @smallexample
8561 ex +@var{number} file
8562 @end smallexample
8563 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8564 the file where to start editing.}.
8565 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8566 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8567 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8568 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8569 @smallexample
8570 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8571 export EDITOR
8572 gdb @dots{}
8573 @end smallexample
8574 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8575 @smallexample
8576 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8577 gdb @dots{}
8578 @end smallexample
8579
8580 @node Search
8581 @section Searching Source Files
8582 @cindex searching source files
8583
8584 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8585 regular expression.
8586
8587 @table @code
8588 @kindex search
8589 @kindex forward-search
8590 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8591 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8592 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8593 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8594 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8595 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8596 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8597 @code{fo}.
8598
8599 @kindex reverse-search
8600 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8601 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8602 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8603 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8604 this command as @code{rev}.
8605 @end table
8606
8607 @node Source Path
8608 @section Specifying Source Directories
8609
8610 @cindex source path
8611 @cindex directories for source files
8612 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8613 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8614 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8615 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8616 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8617 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8618 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8619
8620 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8621 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8622 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8623 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8624 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8625 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8626 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8627 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8628 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8629 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8630 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8631
8632 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8633 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8634 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8635 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8636 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8637 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8638
8639 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8640 source files.
8641
8642 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8643 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8644 each line is in the file.
8645
8646 @kindex directory
8647 @kindex dir
8648 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8649 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8650 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8651
8652 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8653 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8654
8655 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8656 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8657 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8658 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8659 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8660 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8661 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8662 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8663 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8664 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8665 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8666 name to look up the sources.
8667
8668 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8669 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8670 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8671 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8672 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8673 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8674 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8675 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8676
8677 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8678 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8679 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8680 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8681 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8682 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8683 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8684
8685 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8686 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8687 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8688 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8689 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8690 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8691 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8692 command.
8693
8694 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8695 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8696 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8697 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8698 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8699 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8700 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8701
8702 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8703 @cindex default source path substitution
8704 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8705 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8706 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8707 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8708 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8709 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8710 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8711 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8712 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8713 together.
8714
8715 @table @code
8716 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8717 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8718 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8719 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8720 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8721 part of absolute file names) or
8722 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8723 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8724
8725 @kindex cdir
8726 @kindex cwd
8727 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8728 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8729 @cindex compilation directory
8730 @cindex current directory
8731 @cindex working directory
8732 @cindex directory, current
8733 @cindex directory, compilation
8734 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8735 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8736 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8737 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8738 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8739 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8740
8741 @item directory
8742 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8743
8744 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8745 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8746
8747 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8748 @kindex set directories
8749 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8750 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8751
8752 @item show directories
8753 @kindex show directories
8754 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8755
8756 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8757 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8758 @kindex set substitute-path
8759 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8760 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8761 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8762
8763 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8764 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8765
8766 @smallexample
8767 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8768 @end smallexample
8769
8770 @noindent
8771 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8772 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8773 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8774
8775 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8776 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8777 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8778 the substitution.
8779
8780 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8781
8782 @smallexample
8783 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8784 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8785 @end smallexample
8786
8787 @noindent
8788 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8789 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8790 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8791 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8792
8793
8794 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8795 @kindex unset substitute-path
8796 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8797 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8798 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8799
8800 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8801
8802 @item show substitute-path [path]
8803 @kindex show substitute-path
8804 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8805 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8806
8807 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8808 rules.
8809
8810 @end table
8811
8812 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8813 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8814 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8815
8816 @enumerate
8817 @item
8818 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8819
8820 @item
8821 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8822 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8823 directories in one command.
8824 @end enumerate
8825
8826 @node Machine Code
8827 @section Source and Machine Code
8828 @cindex source line and its code address
8829
8830 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8831 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8832 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8833 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8834 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8835 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8836 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8837 well as hex.
8838
8839 @table @code
8840 @kindex info line
8841 @item info line
8842 @itemx info line @var{location}
8843 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8844 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8845 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8846 information about the current source line is printed.
8847 @end table
8848
8849 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8850 the object code for the first line of function
8851 @code{m4_changequote}:
8852
8853 @smallexample
8854 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8855 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8856 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8857 @end smallexample
8858
8859 @noindent
8860 @cindex code address and its source line
8861 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8862 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8863 @smallexample
8864 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8865 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8866 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8867 @end smallexample
8868
8869 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8870 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8871 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8872 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8873 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8874 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8875 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8876 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8877 Variables}).
8878
8879 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8880 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8881 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8882 line.
8883
8884 @table @code
8885 @kindex disassemble
8886 @cindex assembly instructions
8887 @cindex instructions, assembly
8888 @cindex machine instructions
8889 @cindex listing machine instructions
8890 @item disassemble
8891 @itemx disassemble /m
8892 @itemx disassemble /s
8893 @itemx disassemble /r
8894 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8895 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8896 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8897 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8898 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8899 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8900 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8901 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8902 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8903 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8904
8905 @table @code
8906 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8907 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8908 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8909 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8910 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8911 @end table
8912
8913 @noindent
8914 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8915 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8916
8917 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8918 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8919
8920 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8921 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8922 @end table
8923
8924 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8925 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8926
8927 @smallexample
8928 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8929 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8930 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8931 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8932 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8933 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8934 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8935 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8936 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8937 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8938 End of assembler dump.
8939 @end smallexample
8940
8941 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8942 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8943 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8944
8945 @smallexample
8946 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8947 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8948 5 @{
8949 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8950 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8951 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8952 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8953 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8954
8955 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8956 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8957 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8958
8959 7 return 0;
8960 8 @}
8961 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8962 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8963 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8964
8965 End of assembler dump.
8966 @end smallexample
8967
8968 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8969 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8970 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8971 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8972 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8973 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8974 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8975 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8976 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8977
8978 @file{foo.h}:
8979
8980 @smallexample
8981 int
8982 foo (int a)
8983 @{
8984 if (a < 0)
8985 return a * 2;
8986 if (a == 0)
8987 return 1;
8988 return a + 10;
8989 @}
8990 @end smallexample
8991
8992 @file{foo.c}:
8993
8994 @smallexample
8995 #include "foo.h"
8996 volatile int x, y;
8997 int
8998 main ()
8999 @{
9000 x = foo (y);
9001 return 0;
9002 @}
9003 @end smallexample
9004
9005 @smallexample
9006 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
9007 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9008 5 @{
9009
9010 6 x = foo (y);
9011 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9012 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9013
9014 7 return 0;
9015 8 @}
9016 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9017 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9018 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9019 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9020
9021 End of assembler dump.
9022 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
9023 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9024 foo.c:
9025 5 @{
9026 6 x = foo (y);
9027 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9028
9029 foo.h:
9030 4 if (a < 0)
9031 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
9032 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
9033
9034 6 if (a == 0)
9035 7 return 1;
9036 8 return a + 10;
9037 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
9038 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
9039 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
9040 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
9041
9042 foo.c:
9043 6 x = foo (y);
9044 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9045
9046 7 return 0;
9047 8 @}
9048 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9049 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9050
9051 foo.h:
9052 5 return a * 2;
9053 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9054 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9055 End of assembler dump.
9056 @end smallexample
9057
9058 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
9059
9060 @smallexample
9061 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
9062 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
9063 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
9064 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
9065 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
9066 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
9067 End of assembler dump.
9068 @end smallexample
9069
9070 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
9071 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
9072 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
9073 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
9074
9075 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
9076 mnemonics or other syntax.
9077
9078 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
9079 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9080 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9081 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9082 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9083
9084 @table @code
9085 @kindex set disassembler-options
9086 @cindex disassembler options
9087 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9088 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9089 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9090 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9091 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9092 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9093 The default value is the empty string.
9094
9095 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9096 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9097 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9098 and S/390.
9099
9100 @kindex show disassembler-options
9101 @item show disassembler-options
9102 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9103 @end table
9104
9105 @table @code
9106 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9107 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9108 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9109 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9110 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9111 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9112
9113 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9114 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9115 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9116 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9117
9118 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9119 @item show disassembly-flavor
9120 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9121 @end table
9122
9123 @table @code
9124 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9125 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9126 @item set disassemble-next-line
9127 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9128 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9129 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9130 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9131 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9132 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9133 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9134 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9135 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9136 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9137 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9138 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9139 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9140 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9141 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9142 instruction.
9143 @end table
9144
9145
9146 @node Data
9147 @chapter Examining Data
9148
9149 @cindex printing data
9150 @cindex examining data
9151 @kindex print
9152 @kindex inspect
9153 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9154 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9155 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9156 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9157 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9158 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9159
9160 @table @code
9161 @item print @var{expr}
9162 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9163 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9164 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9165 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9166 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9167 Formats}.
9168
9169 @item print
9170 @itemx print /@var{f}
9171 @cindex reprint the last value
9172 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9173 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9174 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9175 @end table
9176
9177 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9178 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9179 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9180
9181 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9182 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9183 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9184 Table}.
9185
9186 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9187 @kindex explore
9188 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9189 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9190 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9191 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9192 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9193 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9194 embedded in the higher level data types.
9195
9196 @table @code
9197 @item explore @var{arg}
9198 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9199 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9200 @end table
9201
9202 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9203 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9204 C program as
9205
9206 @smallexample
9207 struct SimpleStruct
9208 @{
9209 int i;
9210 double d;
9211 @};
9212
9213 struct ComplexStruct
9214 @{
9215 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9216 int arr[10];
9217 @};
9218 @end smallexample
9219
9220 @noindent
9221 followed by variable declarations as
9222
9223 @smallexample
9224 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9225 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9226 @end smallexample
9227
9228 @noindent
9229 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9230 @code{explore} command as follows.
9231
9232 @smallexample
9233 (gdb) explore cs
9234 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9235 the following fields:
9236
9237 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9238 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9239
9240 Enter the field number of choice:
9241 @end smallexample
9242
9243 @noindent
9244 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9245 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9246 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9247 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9248 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9249 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9250 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9251 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9252
9253 @smallexample
9254 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9255 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9256 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9257 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9258
9259 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9260 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9261
9262 Press enter to return to parent value:
9263 @end smallexample
9264
9265 @noindent
9266 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9267 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9268 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9269 to explore.
9270
9271 @smallexample
9272 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9273 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9274
9275 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9276
9277 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9278
9279 Press enter to return to parent value:
9280 @end smallexample
9281
9282 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9283 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9284 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9285 level data structure).
9286
9287 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9288 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9289 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9290 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9291 same example as above, your can explore the type
9292 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9293 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9294
9295 @smallexample
9296 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9297 @end smallexample
9298
9299 @noindent
9300 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9301 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9302 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9303 example.
9304
9305 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9306 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9307 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9308 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9309 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9310
9311 @table @code
9312 @item explore value @var{expr}
9313 @cindex explore value
9314 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9315 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9316 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9317 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9318 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9319
9320 @item explore type @var{arg}
9321 @cindex explore type
9322 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9323 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9324 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9325 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9326 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9327 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9328 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9329 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9330 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9331 @end table
9332
9333 @menu
9334 * Expressions:: Expressions
9335 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9336 * Variables:: Program variables
9337 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9338 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9339 * Memory:: Examining memory
9340 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9341 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9342 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9343 * Value History:: Value history
9344 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9345 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9346 * Registers:: Registers
9347 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9348 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9349 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9350 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9351 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9352 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9353 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9354 character set than GDB does
9355 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9356 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9357 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9358 @end menu
9359
9360 @node Expressions
9361 @section Expressions
9362
9363 @cindex expressions
9364 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9365 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9366 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9367 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9368 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9369 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9370 @ref{Compilation}.
9371
9372 @cindex arrays in expressions
9373 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9374 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9375 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9376 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9377 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9378 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9379
9380 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9381 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9382 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9383 languages.
9384
9385 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9386 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9387
9388 @cindex casts, in expressions
9389 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9390 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9391 at that address in memory.
9392 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9393
9394 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9395 to programming languages:
9396
9397 @table @code
9398 @item @@
9399 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9400 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9401
9402 @item ::
9403 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9404 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9405
9406 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9407 @cindex type casting memory
9408 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9409 @cindex casts, to view memory
9410 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9411 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9412 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9413 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9414 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9415 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9416 @end table
9417
9418 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9419 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9420 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9421
9422 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9423 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9424 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9425 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9426 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9427 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9428 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9429
9430 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9431 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9432 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9433 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9434 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9435 as well.
9436
9437 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9438 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9439 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9440 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9441 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9442 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9443 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9444 choices.
9445
9446 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9447 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9448 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9449
9450 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9451 @smallexample
9452 @group
9453 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9454 [0] cancel
9455 [1] all
9456 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9457 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9458 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9459 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9460 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9461 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9462 > 2 4 6
9463 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9464 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9465 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9466 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9467 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9468 breakpoints.
9469 (@value{GDBP})
9470 @end group
9471 @end smallexample
9472
9473 @table @code
9474 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9475 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9476 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9477
9478 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9479 is ambiguous.
9480
9481 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9482 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9483 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9484 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9485 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9486 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9487 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9488 in the use of the menu.
9489
9490 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9491 when an ambiguity is detected.
9492
9493 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9494 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9495
9496 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9497 @item show multiple-symbols
9498 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9499 @end table
9500
9501 @node Variables
9502 @section Program Variables
9503
9504 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9505 in your program.
9506
9507 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9508 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9509
9510 @itemize @bullet
9511 @item
9512 global (or file-static)
9513 @end itemize
9514
9515 @noindent or
9516
9517 @itemize @bullet
9518 @item
9519 visible according to the scope rules of the
9520 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9521 @end itemize
9522
9523 @noindent This means that in the function
9524
9525 @smallexample
9526 foo (a)
9527 int a;
9528 @{
9529 bar (a);
9530 @{
9531 int b = test ();
9532 bar (b);
9533 @}
9534 @}
9535 @end smallexample
9536
9537 @noindent
9538 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9539 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9540 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9541 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9542
9543 @cindex variable name conflict
9544 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9545 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9546 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9547 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9548 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9549 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9550 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9551
9552 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9553 @ifnotinfo
9554 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9555 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9556 @end ifnotinfo
9557 @smallexample
9558 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9559 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9560 @end smallexample
9561
9562 @noindent
9563 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9564 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9565 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9566 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9567
9568 @smallexample
9569 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9570 @end smallexample
9571
9572 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9573 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9574 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9575 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9576 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9577
9578 @smallexample
9579 void
9580 foo (int a)
9581 @{
9582 if (a < 10)
9583 bar (a);
9584 else
9585 process (a); /* Stop here */
9586 @}
9587
9588 int
9589 bar (int a)
9590 @{
9591 foo (a + 5);
9592 @}
9593 @end smallexample
9594
9595 @noindent
9596 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9597 here is what you might see
9598 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9599
9600 @smallexample
9601 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9602 $1 = 10
9603 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9604 $2 = 5
9605 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9606 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9607 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9608 $3 = 5
9609 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9610 $4 = 0
9611 @end smallexample
9612
9613 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9614 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9615 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9616 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9617 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9618
9619 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9620 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9621 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9622 @code{some_global}.
9623
9624 @smallexample
9625 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9626 $1 = 23
9627 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9628 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9629 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9630 $2 = 27
9631 @end smallexample
9632
9633 @cindex wrong values
9634 @cindex variable values, wrong
9635 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9636 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9637 @quotation
9638 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9639 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9640 scope, and just before exit.
9641 @end quotation
9642 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9643 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9644 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9645 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9646 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9647 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9648 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9649 variable definitions may be gone.
9650
9651 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9652 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9653 when compiling.
9654
9655 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9656 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9657 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9658 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9659 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9660 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9661 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9662
9663 @smallexample
9664 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9665 @end smallexample
9666
9667 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9668 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9669 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9670 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9671 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9672
9673 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9674 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9675 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9676 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9677
9678 @cindex no debug info variables
9679 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9680 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9681 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9682 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9683 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9684 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9685 example, in a C program:
9686
9687 @smallexample
9688 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9689 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9690 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9691 $1 = 3.14
9692 @end smallexample
9693
9694 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9695 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9696 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9697 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9698 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9699
9700 @smallexample
9701 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9702 29 i++;
9703 (gdb) next
9704 30 e (i);
9705 (gdb) print i
9706 $1 = 31
9707 (gdb) print i@@entry
9708 $2 = 30
9709 @end smallexample
9710
9711 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9712 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9713 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9714 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9715 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9716 For program code
9717
9718 @smallexample
9719 char var0[] = "A";
9720 signed char var1[] = "A";
9721 @end smallexample
9722
9723 You get during debugging
9724 @smallexample
9725 (gdb) print var0
9726 $1 = "A"
9727 (gdb) print var1
9728 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9729 @end smallexample
9730
9731 @node Arrays
9732 @section Artificial Arrays
9733
9734 @cindex artificial array
9735 @cindex arrays
9736 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9737 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9738 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9739 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9740 program.
9741
9742 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9743 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9744 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9745 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9746 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9747 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9748 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9749 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9750 example. If a program says
9751
9752 @smallexample
9753 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9754 @end smallexample
9755
9756 @noindent
9757 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9758
9759 @smallexample
9760 p *array@@len
9761 @end smallexample
9762
9763 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9764 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9765 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9766 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9767 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9768
9769 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9770 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9771 The value need not be in memory:
9772 @smallexample
9773 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9774 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9775 @end smallexample
9776
9777 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9778 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9779 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9780 @smallexample
9781 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9782 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9783 @end smallexample
9784
9785 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9786 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9787 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9788 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9789 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9790 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9791 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9792 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9793 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9794 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9795
9796 @smallexample
9797 set $i = 0
9798 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9799 @key{RET}
9800 @key{RET}
9801 @dots{}
9802 @end smallexample
9803
9804 @node Output Formats
9805 @section Output Formats
9806
9807 @cindex formatted output
9808 @cindex output formats
9809 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9810 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9811 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9812 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9813 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9814
9815 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9816 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9817 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9818 letters supported are:
9819
9820 @table @code
9821 @item x
9822 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9823 hexadecimal.
9824
9825 @item d
9826 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9827
9828 @item u
9829 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9830
9831 @item o
9832 Print as integer in octal.
9833
9834 @item t
9835 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9836 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9837 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9838 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9839
9840 @item a
9841 @cindex unknown address, locating
9842 @cindex locate address
9843 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9844 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9845 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9846
9847 @smallexample
9848 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9849 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9850 @end smallexample
9851
9852 @noindent
9853 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9854 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9855
9856 @item c
9857 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9858 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9859 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9860 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9861
9862 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9863 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9864 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9865 data.
9866
9867 @item f
9868 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9869 using typical floating point syntax.
9870
9871 @item s
9872 @cindex printing strings
9873 @cindex printing byte arrays
9874 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9875 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9876 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9877 natural types.
9878
9879 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9880 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9881 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9882 array.
9883
9884 @item z
9885 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9886 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9887 to the size of the integer type.
9888
9889 @item r
9890 @cindex raw printing
9891 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9892 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9893 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9894 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9895 pretty-printer which might exist.
9896 @end table
9897
9898 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9899
9900 @smallexample
9901 p/x $pc
9902 @end smallexample
9903
9904 @noindent
9905 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9906 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9907
9908 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9909 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9910 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9911
9912 @node Memory
9913 @section Examining Memory
9914
9915 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9916 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9917
9918 @cindex examining memory
9919 @table @code
9920 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9921 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9922 @itemx x @var{addr}
9923 @itemx x
9924 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9925 @end table
9926
9927 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9928 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9929 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9930 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9931 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9932
9933 @table @r
9934 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9935 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9936 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9937 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9938 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9939 @c 4.1.2.
9940
9941 @item @var{f}, the display format
9942 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9943 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9944 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9945 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9946 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9947
9948 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9949 The unit size is any of
9950
9951 @table @code
9952 @item b
9953 Bytes.
9954 @item h
9955 Halfwords (two bytes).
9956 @item w
9957 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9958 @item g
9959 Giant words (eight bytes).
9960 @end table
9961
9962 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9963 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9964 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9965 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9966 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9967 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9968 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9969 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9970 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9971 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9972 be altered.
9973
9974 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9975 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9976 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9977 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9978 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9979 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9980 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9981 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9982 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9983 a value from memory).
9984 @end table
9985
9986 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9987 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9988 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9989 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9990 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9991
9992 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9993 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9994 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9995
9996 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9997 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9998 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9999 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
10000 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
10001
10002 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
10003 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
10004 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
10005 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
10006 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
10007 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
10008 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
10009 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
10010 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
10011
10012 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
10013 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
10014 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
10015 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
10016 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
10017 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
10018
10019 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
10020 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
10021 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
10022 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
10023 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
10024 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
10025 for successive uses of @code{x}.
10026
10027 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
10028 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
10029
10030 @smallexample
10031 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
10032 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
10033 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
10034 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
10035 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
10036 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
10037 @end smallexample
10038
10039 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
10040 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
10041 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
10042 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
10043 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
10044 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
10045 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
10046 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
10047 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
10048
10049 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
10050 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
10051 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
10052
10053 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
10054 @cindex addressable memory unit
10055 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
10056 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
10057 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
10058 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
10059 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
10060 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
10061 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
10062 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
10063 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
10064
10065 @cindex remote memory comparison
10066 @cindex target memory comparison
10067 @cindex verify remote memory image
10068 @cindex verify target memory image
10069 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
10070 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
10071 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
10072 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
10073 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
10074 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
10075
10076 @table @code
10077 @kindex compare-sections
10078 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
10079 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10080 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10081 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10082 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10083 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10084
10085 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10086 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10087 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10088 @end table
10089
10090 @node Auto Display
10091 @section Automatic Display
10092 @cindex automatic display
10093 @cindex display of expressions
10094
10095 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10096 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10097 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10098 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10099 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10100 The automatic display looks like this:
10101
10102 @smallexample
10103 2: foo = 38
10104 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10105 @end smallexample
10106
10107 @noindent
10108 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10109 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10110 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10111 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10112 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10113 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10114
10115 @table @code
10116 @kindex display
10117 @item display @var{expr}
10118 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10119 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10120
10121 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10122
10123 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10124 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10125 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10126 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10127 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10128
10129 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10130 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10131 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10132 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10133 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10134 @end table
10135
10136 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10137 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10138 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10139
10140 @table @code
10141 @kindex delete display
10142 @kindex undisplay
10143 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10144 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10145 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10146 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10147 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10148 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10149 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10150
10151 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10152 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10153
10154 @kindex disable display
10155 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10156 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10157 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10158 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10159 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10160 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10161 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10162 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10163
10164 @kindex enable display
10165 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10166 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10167 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10168 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10169 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10170 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10171 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10172
10173 @item display
10174 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10175 done when your program stops.
10176
10177 @kindex info display
10178 @item info display
10179 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10180 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10181 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10182 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10183 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10184 @end table
10185
10186 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10187 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10188 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10189 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10190 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10191 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10192 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10193 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10194 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10195 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10196 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10197
10198 @node Print Settings
10199 @section Print Settings
10200
10201 @cindex format options
10202 @cindex print settings
10203 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10204 and symbols are printed.
10205
10206 @noindent
10207 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10208
10209 @table @code
10210 @kindex set print
10211 @item set print address
10212 @itemx set print address on
10213 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10214 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10215 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10216 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10217 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10218 @code{set print address on}:
10219
10220 @smallexample
10221 @group
10222 (@value{GDBP}) f
10223 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10224 at input.c:530
10225 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10226 @end group
10227 @end smallexample
10228
10229 @item set print address off
10230 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10231 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10232
10233 @smallexample
10234 @group
10235 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10236 (@value{GDBP}) f
10237 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10238 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10239 @end group
10240 @end smallexample
10241
10242 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10243 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10244 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10245 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10246
10247 @kindex show print
10248 @item show print address
10249 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10250 @end table
10251
10252 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10253 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10254 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10255 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10256 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10257 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10258 it prints a symbolic address:
10259
10260 @table @code
10261 @item set print symbol-filename on
10262 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10263 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10264 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10265 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10266
10267 @item set print symbol-filename off
10268 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10269 default.
10270
10271 @item show print symbol-filename
10272 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10273 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10274 @end table
10275
10276 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10277 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10278 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10279
10280 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10281 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10282
10283 @table @code
10284 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10285 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10286 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10287 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10288 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10289 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10290 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10291 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10292
10293 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10294 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10295 symbolic address.
10296 @end table
10297
10298 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10299 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10300 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10301 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10302 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10303 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10304 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10305 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10306
10307 @smallexample
10308 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10309 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10310 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10311 @end smallexample
10312
10313 @quotation
10314 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10315 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10316 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10317 @end quotation
10318
10319 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10320 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10321
10322 @table @code
10323 @item set print symbol on
10324 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10325 one exists.
10326
10327 @item set print symbol off
10328 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10329 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10330 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10331
10332 @item show print symbol
10333 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10334 address.
10335 @end table
10336
10337 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10338
10339 @table @code
10340 @item set print array
10341 @itemx set print array on
10342 @cindex pretty print arrays
10343 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10344 but uses more space. The default is off.
10345
10346 @item set print array off
10347 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10348
10349 @item show print array
10350 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10351 arrays.
10352
10353 @cindex print array indexes
10354 @item set print array-indexes
10355 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10356 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10357 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10358 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10359
10360 @item set print array-indexes off
10361 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10362
10363 @item show print array-indexes
10364 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10365 arrays.
10366
10367 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10368 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10369 @cindex number of array elements to print
10370 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10371 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10372 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10373 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10374 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10375 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10376 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10377 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10378
10379 @item show print elements
10380 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10381 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10382
10383 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10384 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10385 @cindex printing frame argument values
10386 @cindex print all frame argument values
10387 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10388 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10389 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10390 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10391 values are:
10392
10393 @table @code
10394 @item all
10395 The values of all arguments are printed.
10396
10397 @item scalars
10398 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10399 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10400 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10401 only scalar arguments are shown:
10402
10403 @smallexample
10404 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10405 at frame-args.c:23
10406 @end smallexample
10407
10408 @item none
10409 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10410 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10411
10412 @smallexample
10413 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10414 at frame-args.c:23
10415 @end smallexample
10416 @end table
10417
10418 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10419 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10420 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10421 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10422 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10423 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10424 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10425 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10426 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10427 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10428
10429 @item show print frame-arguments
10430 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10431
10432 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10433 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10434
10435 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10436 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10437 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10438 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10439 This is the default.
10440
10441 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10442 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10443
10444 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10445 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10446 @kindex set print entry-values
10447 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10448 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10449 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10450 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10451 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10452
10453 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10454 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10455 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10456 @code{no} setting.
10457
10458 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10459 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10460 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10461 this information.
10462
10463 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10464
10465 @table @code
10466 @item no
10467 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10468 point.
10469 @smallexample
10470 #0 equal (val=5)
10471 #0 different (val=6)
10472 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10473 #0 born (val=10)
10474 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10475 @end smallexample
10476
10477 @item only
10478 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10479 values are never printed.
10480 @smallexample
10481 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10482 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10483 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10484 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10485 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10486 @end smallexample
10487
10488 @item preferred
10489 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10490 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10491 value for such parameter.
10492 @smallexample
10493 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10494 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10495 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10496 #0 born (val=10)
10497 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10498 @end smallexample
10499
10500 @item if-needed
10501 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10502 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10503 parameter.
10504 @smallexample
10505 #0 equal (val=5)
10506 #0 different (val=6)
10507 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10508 #0 born (val=10)
10509 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10510 @end smallexample
10511
10512 @item both
10513 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10514 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10515 optimizations.
10516 @smallexample
10517 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10518 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10519 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10520 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10521 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10522 @end smallexample
10523
10524 @item compact
10525 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10526 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10527 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10528 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10529 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10530 @smallexample
10531 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10532 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10533 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10534 #0 born (val=10)
10535 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10536 @end smallexample
10537
10538 @item default
10539 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10540 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10541 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10542 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10543 @smallexample
10544 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10545 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10546 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10547 #0 born (val=10)
10548 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10549 @end smallexample
10550 @end table
10551
10552 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10553 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10554
10555 @item show print entry-values
10556 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10557 entry.
10558
10559 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10560 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10561 @cindex repeated array elements
10562 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10563 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10564 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10565 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10566 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10567 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10568 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10569 is 10.
10570
10571 @item show print repeats
10572 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10573 elements.
10574
10575 @item set print max-depth @var{depth}
10576 @item set print max-depth unlimited
10577 @cindex printing nested structures
10578 Set the threshold after which nested structures are replaced with
10579 ellipsis, this can make visualising deeply nested structures easier.
10580
10581 For example, given this C code
10582
10583 @smallexample
10584 typedef struct s1 @{ int a; @} s1;
10585 typedef struct s2 @{ s1 b; @} s2;
10586 typedef struct s3 @{ s2 c; @} s3;
10587 typedef struct s4 @{ s3 d; @} s4;
10588
10589 s4 var = @{ @{ @{ @{ 3 @} @} @} @};
10590 @end smallexample
10591
10592 The following table shows how different values of @var{depth} will
10593 effect how @code{var} is printed by @value{GDBN}:
10594
10595 @multitable @columnfractions .3 .7
10596 @headitem @var{depth} setting @tab Result of @samp{p var}
10597 @item unlimited
10598 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}@}@}}
10599 @item @code{0}
10600 @tab @code{$1 = @{...@}}
10601 @item @code{1}
10602 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{...@}@}}
10603 @item @code{2}
10604 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{...@}@}@}}
10605 @item @code{3}
10606 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{...@}@}@}@}}
10607 @item @code{4}
10608 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}@}@}}
10609 @end multitable
10610
10611 To see the contents of structures that have been hidden the user can
10612 either increase the print max-depth, or they can print the elements of
10613 the structure that are visible, for example
10614
10615 @smallexample
10616 (gdb) set print max-depth 2
10617 (gdb) p var
10618 $1 = @{d = @{c = @{...@}@}@}
10619 (gdb) p var.d
10620 $2 = @{c = @{b = @{...@}@}@}
10621 (gdb) p var.d.c
10622 $3 = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}
10623 @end smallexample
10624
10625 The pattern used to replace nested structures varies based on
10626 language, for most languages @code{@{...@}} is used, but Fortran uses
10627 @code{(...)}.
10628
10629 @item show print max-depth
10630 Display the current threshold after which nested structures are
10631 replaces with ellipsis.
10632
10633 @item set print null-stop
10634 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10635 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10636 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10637 contain only short strings.
10638 The default is off.
10639
10640 @item show print null-stop
10641 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10642 @sc{null} character.
10643
10644 @item set print pretty on
10645 @cindex print structures in indented form
10646 @cindex indentation in structure display
10647 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10648 per line, like this:
10649
10650 @smallexample
10651 @group
10652 $1 = @{
10653 next = 0x0,
10654 flags = @{
10655 sweet = 1,
10656 sour = 1
10657 @},
10658 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10659 @}
10660 @end group
10661 @end smallexample
10662
10663 @item set print pretty off
10664 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10665
10666 @smallexample
10667 @group
10668 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10669 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10670 @end group
10671 @end smallexample
10672
10673 @noindent
10674 This is the default format.
10675
10676 @item show print pretty
10677 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10678
10679 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10680 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10681 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10682 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10683 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10684 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10685 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10686 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10687
10688 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10689 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10690 international character sets, and is the default.
10691
10692 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10693 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10694
10695 @item set print union on
10696 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10697 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10698 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10699
10700 @item set print union off
10701 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10702 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10703 instead.
10704
10705 @item show print union
10706 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10707 structures and other unions.
10708
10709 For example, given the declarations
10710
10711 @smallexample
10712 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10713 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10714 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10715 Bug_forms;
10716
10717 struct thing @{
10718 Species it;
10719 union @{
10720 Tree_forms tree;
10721 Bug_forms bug;
10722 @} form;
10723 @};
10724
10725 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10726 @end smallexample
10727
10728 @noindent
10729 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10730
10731 @smallexample
10732 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10733 @end smallexample
10734
10735 @noindent
10736 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10737
10738 @smallexample
10739 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10740 @end smallexample
10741
10742 @noindent
10743 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10744 and in Pascal.
10745 @end table
10746
10747 @need 1000
10748 @noindent
10749 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10750
10751 @table @code
10752 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10753 @item set print demangle
10754 @itemx set print demangle on
10755 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10756 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10757 linkage. The default is on.
10758
10759 @item show print demangle
10760 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10761
10762 @item set print asm-demangle
10763 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10764 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10765 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10766 The default is off.
10767
10768 @item show print asm-demangle
10769 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10770 or demangled form.
10771
10772 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10773 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10774 @kindex set demangle-style
10775 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10776 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to represent
10777 C@t{++} names. If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible
10778 formats. The default value is @var{auto}, which lets @value{GDBN} choose a
10779 decoding style by inspecting your program.
10780
10781 @item show demangle-style
10782 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10783
10784 @item set print object
10785 @itemx set print object on
10786 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10787 @cindex display derived types
10788 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10789 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10790 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10791 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10792 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10793 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10794 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10795
10796 @item set print object off
10797 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10798 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10799
10800 @item show print object
10801 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10802
10803 @item set print static-members
10804 @itemx set print static-members on
10805 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10806 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10807
10808 @item set print static-members off
10809 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10810
10811 @item show print static-members
10812 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10813
10814 @item set print pascal_static-members
10815 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10816 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10817 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10818 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10819
10820 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10821 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10822
10823 @item show print pascal_static-members
10824 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10825
10826 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10827 @item set print vtbl
10828 @itemx set print vtbl on
10829 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10830 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10831 @cindex VTBL display
10832 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10833 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10834 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10835
10836 @item set print vtbl off
10837 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10838
10839 @item show print vtbl
10840 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10841 @end table
10842
10843 @node Pretty Printing
10844 @section Pretty Printing
10845
10846 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10847 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10848 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10849
10850 @menu
10851 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10852 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10853 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10854 @end menu
10855
10856 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10857 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10858
10859 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10860 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10861 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10862
10863 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10864 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10865 pretty-printers with their names.
10866 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10867 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10868 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10869 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10870
10871 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10872 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10873 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10874 do anything special.
10875
10876 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10877
10878 @itemize @bullet
10879 @item
10880 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10881 all inferiors.
10882
10883 @item
10884 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10885 when debugging that program.
10886 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10887
10888 @item
10889 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10890 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10891 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10892 @end itemize
10893
10894 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10895 pretty-printers are selected,
10896
10897 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10898 for new types.
10899
10900 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10901 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10902
10903 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10904
10905 @smallexample
10906 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10907 $1 = @{
10908 static npos = 4294967295,
10909 _M_dataplus = @{
10910 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10911 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10912 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10913 @},
10914 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10915 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10916 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10917 @}
10918 @}
10919 @end smallexample
10920
10921 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10922
10923 @smallexample
10924 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10925 $2 = "abcd"
10926 @end smallexample
10927
10928 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10929 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10930 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10931
10932 @table @code
10933 @kindex info pretty-printer
10934 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10935 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10936 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10937
10938 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10939 whose pretty-printers to list.
10940 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10941 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10942 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10943 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10944 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10945
10946 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10947 to list.
10948
10949 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10950 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10951 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10952 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10953
10954 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10955 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10956 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10957 @end table
10958
10959 Example:
10960
10961 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10962 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10963 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10964 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10965
10966 @smallexample
10967 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10968 library1.so:
10969 foo
10970 library2.so:
10971 bar
10972 bar1
10973 bar2
10974 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10975 library2.so:
10976 bar
10977 bar1
10978 bar2
10979 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10980 1 printer disabled
10981 2 of 3 printers enabled
10982 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10983 library1.so:
10984 foo [disabled]
10985 library2.so:
10986 bar
10987 bar1
10988 bar2
10989 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10990 1 printer disabled
10991 1 of 3 printers enabled
10992 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10993 library1.so:
10994 foo [disabled]
10995 library2.so:
10996 bar
10997 bar1 [disabled]
10998 bar2
10999 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
11000 1 printer disabled
11001 0 of 3 printers enabled
11002 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11003 library1.so:
11004 foo [disabled]
11005 library2.so:
11006 bar [disabled]
11007 bar1 [disabled]
11008 bar2
11009 @end smallexample
11010
11011 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
11012 as can each individual subprinter.
11013
11014 @node Value History
11015 @section Value History
11016
11017 @cindex value history
11018 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
11019 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
11020 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
11021 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
11022 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
11023 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
11024 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
11025 symbol table.
11026
11027 @cindex @code{$}
11028 @cindex @code{$$}
11029 @cindex history number
11030 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
11031 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
11032 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
11033 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
11034 history number.
11035
11036 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
11037 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
11038 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
11039 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
11040 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
11041 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
11042 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
11043
11044 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
11045 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
11046
11047 @smallexample
11048 p *$
11049 @end smallexample
11050
11051 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
11052 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
11053
11054 @smallexample
11055 p *$.next
11056 @end smallexample
11057
11058 @noindent
11059 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
11060 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
11061
11062 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
11063 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
11064
11065 @smallexample
11066 print x
11067 set x=5
11068 @end smallexample
11069
11070 @noindent
11071 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
11072 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
11073
11074 @table @code
11075 @kindex show values
11076 @item show values
11077 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
11078 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
11079 values} does not change the history.
11080
11081 @item show values @var{n}
11082 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
11083
11084 @item show values +
11085 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
11086 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
11087 @end table
11088
11089 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
11090 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
11091
11092 @node Convenience Vars
11093 @section Convenience Variables
11094
11095 @cindex convenience variables
11096 @cindex user-defined variables
11097 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
11098 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
11099 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
11100 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
11101 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
11102
11103 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
11104 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
11105 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
11106 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
11107 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
11108
11109 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
11110 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
11111 For example:
11112
11113 @smallexample
11114 set $foo = *object_ptr
11115 @end smallexample
11116
11117 @noindent
11118 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11119 @code{object_ptr}.
11120
11121 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11122 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11123 value with another assignment at any time.
11124
11125 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11126 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11127 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11128 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11129
11130 @table @code
11131 @kindex show convenience
11132 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11133 @item show convenience
11134 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11135 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11136 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11137
11138 @kindex init-if-undefined
11139 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11140 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11141 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11142 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11143 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11144 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11145 override default values used in a command script.
11146
11147 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11148 any side-effects do not occur.
11149 @end table
11150
11151 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11152 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11153 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11154
11155 @smallexample
11156 set $i = 0
11157 print bar[$i++]->contents
11158 @end smallexample
11159
11160 @noindent
11161 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11162
11163 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11164 values likely to be useful.
11165
11166 @table @code
11167 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11168 @item $_
11169 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11170 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11171 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11172 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11173 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11174 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11175 to the type of @code{$__}.
11176
11177 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11178 @item $__
11179 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11180 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11181 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11182
11183 @item $_exitcode
11184 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11185 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11186 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11187 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11188
11189 @item $_exitsignal
11190 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11191 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11192 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11193 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11194
11195 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11196 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11197 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11198 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11199 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11200
11201 @smallexample
11202 #include <signal.h>
11203
11204 int
11205 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11206 @{
11207 raise (SIGALRM);
11208 return 0;
11209 @}
11210 @end smallexample
11211
11212 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11213 or signalled would be:
11214
11215 @smallexample
11216 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11217 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11218 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11219 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11220 >echo The program has exited\n
11221 >else
11222 >echo The program has signalled\n
11223 >end
11224 >end
11225 (@value{GDBP}) run
11226 Starting program:
11227
11228 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11229 The program no longer exists.
11230 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11231 The program has signalled
11232 @end smallexample
11233
11234 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11235 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11236 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11237 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11238
11239 @smallexample
11240 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11241 The program has exited
11242 @end smallexample
11243
11244 @item $_exception
11245 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11246 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11247
11248 @item $_probe_argc
11249 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11250 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11251
11252 @item $_sdata
11253 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11254 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11255 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11256 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11257 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11258
11259 @item $_siginfo
11260 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11261 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11262 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11263 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11264 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11265
11266 @item $_tlb
11267 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11268 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11269 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11270 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11271 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11272 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11273
11274 @item $_inferior
11275 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11276 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11277
11278 @item $_thread
11279 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11280
11281 @item $_gthread
11282 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11283
11284 @item $_gdb_major
11285 @itemx $_gdb_minor
11286 @vindex $_gdb_major@r{, convenience variable}
11287 @vindex $_gdb_minor@r{, convenience variable}
11288 The major and minor version numbers of the running @value{GDBN}.
11289 Development snapshots and pretest versions have their minor version
11290 incremented by one; thus, @value{GDBN} pretest 9.11.90 will produce
11291 the value 12 for @code{$_gdb_minor}. These variables allow you to
11292 write scripts that work with different versions of @value{GDBN}
11293 without errors caused by features unavailable in some of those
11294 versions.
11295 @end table
11296
11297 @node Convenience Funs
11298 @section Convenience Functions
11299
11300 @cindex convenience functions
11301 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11302 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11303 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11304 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11305 @value{GDBN}.
11306
11307 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11308 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11309
11310 @table @code
11311
11312 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11313 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11314 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11315 returns zero.
11316
11317 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11318 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11319 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11320 it is @code{void}:
11321
11322 @smallexample
11323 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11324 $1 = void
11325 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11326 $2 = 1
11327 (@value{GDBP}) run
11328 Starting program: ./a.out
11329 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11330 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11331 $3 = 0
11332 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11333 $4 = 0
11334 @end smallexample
11335
11336 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11337 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11338 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11339 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11340 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11341 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11342 anymore.
11343
11344 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11345 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11346
11347 @smallexample
11348 void
11349 foo (void)
11350 @{
11351 @}
11352 @end smallexample
11353
11354 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11355
11356 @smallexample
11357 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11358 $1 = void
11359 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11360 $2 = 1
11361 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11362 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11363 $3 = void
11364 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11365 $4 = 1
11366 @end smallexample
11367
11368 @end table
11369
11370 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11371 @code{Python} support.
11372
11373 @table @code
11374
11375 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11376 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11377 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11378 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11379 Otherwise it returns zero.
11380
11381 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11382 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11383 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11384 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11385 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11386 regular expression support.
11387
11388 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11389 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11390 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11391 Otherwise it returns zero.
11392
11393 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11394 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11395 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11396
11397 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11398 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11399 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11400 Otherwise it returns zero.
11401
11402 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11403 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11404 The default is 1.
11405
11406 Example:
11407
11408 @smallexample
11409 (gdb) backtrace
11410 #0 bottom_func ()
11411 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11412 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11413 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11414 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11415 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11416 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11417 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11418 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11419 $1 = 1
11420 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11421 $1 = 1
11422 @end smallexample
11423
11424 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11425 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11426 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11427 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11428
11429 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11430 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11431 The default is 1.
11432
11433 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11434 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11435 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11436 Otherwise it returns zero.
11437
11438 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11439 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11440 The default is 1.
11441
11442 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11443 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11444 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11445 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11446
11447 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11448 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11449 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11450 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11451
11452 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11453 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11454 The default is 1.
11455
11456 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11457 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11458 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11459 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11460
11461 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11462 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11463 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11464
11465 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11466 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11467 an enumerated type:
11468
11469 @smallexample
11470 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11471 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11472 @end smallexample
11473
11474 @item $_cimag(@var{value})
11475 @itemx $_creal(@var{value})
11476 @findex $_cimag@r{, convenience function}
11477 @findex $_creal@r{, convenience function}
11478 Return the imaginary (@code{$_cimag}) or real (@code{$_creal}) part of
11479 the complex number @var{value}.
11480
11481 The type of the imaginary or real part depends on the type of the
11482 complex number, e.g., using @code{$_cimag} on a @code{float complex}
11483 will return an imaginary part of type @code{float}.
11484
11485 @end table
11486
11487 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11488 convenience functions.
11489
11490 @table @code
11491 @item help function
11492 @kindex help function
11493 @cindex show all convenience functions
11494 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11495 @end table
11496
11497 @node Registers
11498 @section Registers
11499
11500 @cindex registers
11501 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11502 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11503 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11504 your machine.
11505
11506 @table @code
11507 @kindex info registers
11508 @item info registers
11509 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11510 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11511
11512 @kindex info all-registers
11513 @cindex floating point registers
11514 @item info all-registers
11515 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11516 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11517
11518 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11519 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11520 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11521 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11522
11523 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11524 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11525 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11526 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11527 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11528 @end table
11529
11530 @anchor{standard registers}
11531 @cindex stack pointer register
11532 @cindex program counter register
11533 @cindex process status register
11534 @cindex frame pointer register
11535 @cindex standard registers
11536 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11537 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11538 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11539 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11540 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11541 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11542 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11543 you could print the program counter in hex with
11544
11545 @smallexample
11546 p/x $pc
11547 @end smallexample
11548
11549 @noindent
11550 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11551
11552 @smallexample
11553 x/i $pc
11554 @end smallexample
11555
11556 @noindent
11557 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11558 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11559 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11560 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11561 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11562 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11563 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11564
11565 @smallexample
11566 set $sp += 4
11567 @end smallexample
11568
11569 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11570 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11571 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11572 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11573 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11574 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11575 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11576
11577 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11578 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11579 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11580 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11581 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11582 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11583 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11584
11585 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11586 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11587 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11588 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11589 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11590 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11591 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11592 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11593 prints the data in both formats.
11594
11595 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11596 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11597 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11598 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11599 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11600 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11601 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11602
11603 @smallexample
11604 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11605 $1 = @{
11606 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11607 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11608 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11609 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11610 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11611 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11612 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11613 @}
11614 @end smallexample
11615
11616 @noindent
11617 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11618 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11619 value to a @code{struct} member:
11620
11621 @smallexample
11622 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11623 @end smallexample
11624
11625 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11626 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11627 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11628 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11629 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11630 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11631
11632 @cindex caller-saved registers
11633 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11634 @cindex volatile registers
11635 @cindex <not saved> values
11636 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11637 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11638 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11639 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11640 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11641 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11642 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11643 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11644 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11645 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11646 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11647 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11648 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11649 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11650 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11651 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11652 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11653 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11654 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11655 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11656 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11657 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11658 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11659
11660 @node Floating Point Hardware
11661 @section Floating Point Hardware
11662 @cindex floating point
11663
11664 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11665 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11666
11667 @table @code
11668 @kindex info float
11669 @item info float
11670 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11671 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11672 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11673 the ARM and x86 machines.
11674 @end table
11675
11676 @node Vector Unit
11677 @section Vector Unit
11678 @cindex vector unit
11679
11680 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11681 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11682
11683 @table @code
11684 @kindex info vector
11685 @item info vector
11686 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11687 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11688 @end table
11689
11690 @node OS Information
11691 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11692 @cindex OS information
11693
11694 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11695 you debug your program.
11696
11697 @cindex auxiliary vector
11698 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11699 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11700 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11701 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11702 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11703 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11704 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11705 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11706 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11707 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11708 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11709 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11710
11711 @table @code
11712 @kindex info auxv
11713 @item info auxv
11714 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11715 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11716 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11717 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11718 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11719 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11720 an unrecognized tag.
11721 @end table
11722
11723 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11724 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11725 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11726 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11727 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11728 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11729 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11730
11731 @table @code
11732 @kindex info os
11733 @item info os @var{infotype}
11734
11735 Display OS information of the requested type.
11736
11737 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11738
11739 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11740 @table @code
11741 @kindex info os cpus
11742 @item cpus
11743 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11744 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11745 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11746 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11747 kernel initialization.
11748
11749 @kindex info os files
11750 @item files
11751 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11752 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11753 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11754 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11755
11756 @kindex info os modules
11757 @item modules
11758 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11759 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11760 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11761 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11762 in memory.
11763
11764 @kindex info os msg
11765 @item msg
11766 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11767 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11768 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11769 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11770 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11771 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11772 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11773 the message queue was last changed.
11774
11775 @kindex info os processes
11776 @item processes
11777 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11778 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11779 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11780 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11781 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11782 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11783
11784 @kindex info os procgroups
11785 @item procgroups
11786 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11787 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11788 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11789 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11790 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11791 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11792 and the process group leader is listed first.
11793
11794 @kindex info os semaphores
11795 @item semaphores
11796 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11797 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11798 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11799 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11800 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11801
11802 @kindex info os shm
11803 @item shm
11804 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11805 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11806 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11807 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11808 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11809 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11810 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11811
11812 @kindex info os sockets
11813 @item sockets
11814 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11815 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11816 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11817 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11818 connection.
11819
11820 @kindex info os threads
11821 @item threads
11822 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11823 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11824 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11825 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11826 process is not listed.
11827 @end table
11828
11829 @item info os
11830 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11831 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11832 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11833 types, this command will report an error.
11834 @end table
11835
11836 @node Memory Region Attributes
11837 @section Memory Region Attributes
11838 @cindex memory region attributes
11839
11840 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11841 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11842 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11843 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11844 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11845 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11846 user can override the fetched regions.
11847
11848 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11849 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11850 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11851 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11852 all memory.
11853
11854 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11855 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11856
11857 @table @code
11858 @kindex mem
11859 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11860 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11861 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11862 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11863 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11864 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11865
11866 @item mem auto
11867 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11868 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11869
11870 @kindex delete mem
11871 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11872 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11873 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11874
11875 @kindex disable mem
11876 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11877 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11878 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11879 It may be enabled again later.
11880
11881 @kindex enable mem
11882 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11883 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11884
11885 @kindex info mem
11886 @item info mem
11887 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11888 for each region:
11889
11890 @table @emph
11891 @item Memory Region Number
11892 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11893 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11894 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11895
11896 @item Lo Address
11897 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11898
11899 @item Hi Address
11900 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11901
11902 @item Attributes
11903 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11904 @end table
11905 @end table
11906
11907
11908 @subsection Attributes
11909
11910 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11911 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11912 write accesses to a memory region.
11913
11914 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11915 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11916 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11917
11918 @table @code
11919 @item ro
11920 Memory is read only.
11921 @item wo
11922 Memory is write only.
11923 @item rw
11924 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11925 @end table
11926
11927 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11928 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11929 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11930 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11931 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11932
11933 @table @code
11934 @item 8
11935 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11936 @item 16
11937 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11938 @item 32
11939 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11940 @item 64
11941 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11942 @end table
11943
11944 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11945 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11946 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11947 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11948 @c
11949 @c @table @code
11950 @c @item hwbreak
11951 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11952 @c @item swbreak (default)
11953 @c @end table
11954
11955 @subsubsection Data Cache
11956 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11957 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11958 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11959 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11960 registers.
11961
11962 @table @code
11963 @item cache
11964 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11965 @item nocache
11966 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11967 @end table
11968
11969 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11970 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11971 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11972 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11973 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11974
11975 @table @code
11976 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11977 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11978 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11979 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11980 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11981 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11982 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11983 The default value is @code{on}.
11984 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11985 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11986 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11987 @end table
11988
11989
11990 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11991 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11992 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11993 @c
11994 @c @table @code
11995 @c @item verify
11996 @c @item noverify (default)
11997 @c @end table
11998
11999 @node Dump/Restore Files
12000 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
12001 @cindex dump/restore files
12002 @cindex append data to a file
12003 @cindex dump data to a file
12004 @cindex restore data from a file
12005
12006 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
12007 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
12008 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
12009 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
12010 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
12011 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
12012 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
12013
12014 @table @code
12015
12016 @kindex dump
12017 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
12018 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
12019 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
12020 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
12021
12022 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
12023 @table @code
12024 @item binary
12025 Raw binary form.
12026 @item ihex
12027 Intel hex format.
12028 @item srec
12029 Motorola S-record format.
12030 @item tekhex
12031 Tektronix Hex format.
12032 @item verilog
12033 Verilog Hex format.
12034 @end table
12035
12036 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
12037 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
12038 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
12039 form.
12040
12041 @kindex append
12042 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
12043 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
12044 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
12045 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
12046 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
12047
12048 @kindex restore
12049 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
12050 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
12051 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
12052 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
12053 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
12054
12055 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
12056 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
12057 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
12058 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
12059 from that location.
12060
12061 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
12062 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
12063 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
12064 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
12065
12066 @end table
12067
12068 @node Core File Generation
12069 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
12070 @cindex dump core from inferior
12071
12072 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
12073 image of a running process and its process status (register values
12074 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
12075 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
12076 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
12077 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
12078 the post-mortem debugging mode.
12079
12080 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
12081 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
12082 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
12083
12084 @table @code
12085 @kindex gcore
12086 @kindex generate-core-file
12087 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
12088 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
12089 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
12090 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
12091 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
12092 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
12093
12094 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
12095 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
12096
12097 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
12098 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
12099 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
12100 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
12101 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
12102
12103 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
12104 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
12105 @item set use-coredump-filter on
12106 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
12107 Enable or disable the use of the file
12108 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
12109 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
12110 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
12111 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
12112
12113 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
12114 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
12115 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
12116 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
12117 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
12118 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
12119 about the bits that can be set in the
12120 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
12121 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
12122
12123 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
12124 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
12125 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
12126 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
12127 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
12128 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
12129 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
12130 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
12131
12132 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
12133 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
12134 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
12135 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
12136 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
12137 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
12138 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
12139
12140 The default value is @code{off}.
12141 @end table
12142
12143 @node Character Sets
12144 @section Character Sets
12145 @cindex character sets
12146 @cindex charset
12147 @cindex translating between character sets
12148 @cindex host character set
12149 @cindex target character set
12150
12151 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12152 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12153 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12154 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12155 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12156 @dfn{target character set}.
12157
12158 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12159 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12160 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12161 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12162 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12163 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12164 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12165 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12166 character and string literals in expressions.
12167
12168 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12169 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12170 target-charset} command, described below.
12171
12172 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12173 support:
12174
12175 @table @code
12176 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12177 @kindex set target-charset
12178 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12179 list of supported target character sets, type
12180 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12181
12182 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12183 @kindex set host-charset
12184 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12185
12186 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12187 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12188 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12189 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12190 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12191
12192 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12193 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12194 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12195
12196 @item set charset @var{charset}
12197 @kindex set charset
12198 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12199 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12200 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12201 for both host and target.
12202
12203 @item show charset
12204 @kindex show charset
12205 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12206
12207 @item show host-charset
12208 @kindex show host-charset
12209 Show the name of the current host character set.
12210
12211 @item show target-charset
12212 @kindex show target-charset
12213 Show the name of the current target character set.
12214
12215 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12216 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12217 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12218 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12219 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12220 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12221
12222 @item show target-wide-charset
12223 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12224 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12225 @end table
12226
12227 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12228 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12229 @file{charset-test.c}:
12230
12231 @smallexample
12232 #include <stdio.h>
12233
12234 char ascii_hello[]
12235 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12236 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12237 char ibm1047_hello[]
12238 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12239 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12240
12241 main ()
12242 @{
12243 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12244 @}
12245 @end smallexample
12246
12247 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12248 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12249 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12250
12251 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12252
12253 @smallexample
12254 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12255 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12256 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12257 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12258 @dots{}
12259 (@value{GDBP})
12260 @end smallexample
12261
12262 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12263 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12264 strings:
12265
12266 @smallexample
12267 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12268 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12269 (@value{GDBP})
12270 @end smallexample
12271
12272 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12273 initial character set:
12274 @smallexample
12275 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12276 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12277 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12278 (@value{GDBP})
12279 @end smallexample
12280
12281 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12282 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12283 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12284 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12285 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12286
12287 @smallexample
12288 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12289 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12290 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12291 $2 = 72 'H'
12292 (@value{GDBP})
12293 @end smallexample
12294
12295 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12296 literals you use in expressions:
12297
12298 @smallexample
12299 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12300 $3 = 43 '+'
12301 (@value{GDBP})
12302 @end smallexample
12303
12304 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12305 character.
12306
12307 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12308 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12309 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12310
12311 @smallexample
12312 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12313 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12314 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12315 $5 = 200 '\310'
12316 (@value{GDBP})
12317 @end smallexample
12318
12319 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12320 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12321
12322 @smallexample
12323 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12324 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12325 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12326 @end smallexample
12327
12328 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12329 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12330 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12331 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12332 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12333
12334 @smallexample
12335 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12336 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12337 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12338 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12339 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12340 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12341 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12342 $7 = 72 '\110'
12343 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12344 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12345 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12346 $9 = 200 'H'
12347 (@value{GDBP})
12348 @end smallexample
12349
12350 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12351 string literals you use in expressions:
12352
12353 @smallexample
12354 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12355 $10 = 78 '+'
12356 (@value{GDBP})
12357 @end smallexample
12358
12359 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12360 character.
12361
12362 @node Caching Target Data
12363 @section Caching Data of Targets
12364 @cindex caching data of targets
12365
12366 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12367 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12368 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12369 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12370 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12371 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12372 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12373 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12374 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12375 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12376 is executing.
12377 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12378 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12379 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12380 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12381 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12382 in the code segment.
12383 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12384 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12385
12386 @table @code
12387 @kindex set remotecache
12388 @item set remotecache on
12389 @itemx set remotecache off
12390 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12391 with old scripts.
12392
12393 @kindex show remotecache
12394 @item show remotecache
12395 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12396
12397 @kindex set stack-cache
12398 @item set stack-cache on
12399 @itemx set stack-cache off
12400 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12401 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12402
12403 @kindex show stack-cache
12404 @item show stack-cache
12405 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12406
12407 @kindex set code-cache
12408 @item set code-cache on
12409 @itemx set code-cache off
12410 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12411 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12412 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12413
12414 @kindex show code-cache
12415 @item show code-cache
12416 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12417 accesses.
12418
12419 @kindex info dcache
12420 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12421 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12422 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12423 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12424 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12425 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12426
12427 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12428 printed in hex.
12429
12430 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12431 @cindex dcache size
12432 @kindex set dcache size
12433 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12434
12435 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12436 @cindex dcache line-size
12437 @kindex set dcache line-size
12438 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12439 Must be a power of 2.
12440
12441 @item show dcache size
12442 @kindex show dcache size
12443 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12444
12445 @item show dcache line-size
12446 @kindex show dcache line-size
12447 Show default size of dcache lines.
12448
12449 @end table
12450
12451 @node Searching Memory
12452 @section Search Memory
12453 @cindex searching memory
12454
12455 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12456 @code{find} command.
12457
12458 @table @code
12459 @kindex find
12460 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12461 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12462 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12463 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12464 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12465 @end table
12466
12467 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12468 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12469
12470 @table @r
12471 @item @var{s}, search query size
12472 The size of each search query value.
12473
12474 @table @code
12475 @item b
12476 bytes
12477 @item h
12478 halfwords (two bytes)
12479 @item w
12480 words (four bytes)
12481 @item g
12482 giant words (eight bytes)
12483 @end table
12484
12485 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12486 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12487 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12488 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12489 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12490
12491 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12492 value's type in the current language.
12493 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12494 pattern as a mixture of types.
12495 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12496 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12497 which is typically four bytes.
12498
12499 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12500 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12501 @end table
12502
12503 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12504 (@code{"}).
12505 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12506 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12507
12508 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12509 number of matches found.
12510
12511 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12512 @samp{$_}.
12513 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12514
12515 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12516
12517 @smallexample
12518 void
12519 hello ()
12520 @{
12521 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12522 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12523 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12524 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12525 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12526 @}
12527 @end smallexample
12528
12529 @noindent
12530 you get during debugging:
12531
12532 @smallexample
12533 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12534 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12535 1 pattern found
12536 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12537 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12538 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12539 2 patterns found.
12540 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12541 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12542 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12543 2 patterns found.
12544 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12545 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12546 1 pattern found
12547 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12548 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12549 1 pattern found
12550 (gdb) print $numfound
12551 $1 = 1
12552 (gdb) print $_
12553 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12554 @end smallexample
12555
12556 @node Value Sizes
12557 @section Value Sizes
12558
12559 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12560 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12561 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12562 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12563 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12564
12565 @table @code
12566 @kindex set max-value-size
12567 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12568 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12569 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12570 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12571 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12572
12573 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12574 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12575
12576 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12577 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12578 currently 16 bytes.
12579
12580 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12581 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12582 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12583 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12584 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12585 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12586 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12587 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12588
12589 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12590
12591 @kindex show max-value-size
12592 @item show max-value-size
12593 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12594 allocate for the contents of a value.
12595 @end table
12596
12597 @node Optimized Code
12598 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12599 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12600 @cindex debugging optimized code
12601
12602 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12603 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12604 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12605 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12606 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12607 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12608 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12609
12610 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12611 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12612 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12613 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12614
12615 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12616 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12617 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12618 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12619 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12620 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12621
12622 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12623 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12624 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12625 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12626 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12627
12628 @menu
12629 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12630 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12631 @end menu
12632
12633 @node Inline Functions
12634 @section Inline Functions
12635 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12636
12637 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12638 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12639 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12640 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12641 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12642 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12643 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12644 @code{info frame} command.
12645
12646 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12647 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12648 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12649 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12650 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12651 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12652 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12653 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12654 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12655 local variables in the caller.
12656
12657 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12658 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12659 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12660 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12661 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12662 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12663 instructions are executed.
12664
12665 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12666 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12667 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12668 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12669
12670 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12671 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12672
12673 @itemize @bullet
12674 @item
12675 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12676 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12677 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12678 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12679 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12680 or inside the inlined function instead.
12681
12682 @item
12683 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12684 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12685 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12686 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12687
12688 @end itemize
12689
12690 @node Tail Call Frames
12691 @section Tail Call Frames
12692 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12693
12694 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12695 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12696 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12697 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12698 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12699
12700 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12701 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12702 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12703 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12704 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12705 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12706 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12707
12708 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12709 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12710 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12711 this information.
12712
12713 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12714 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12715
12716 @smallexample
12717 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12718 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12719 (gdb) info frame
12720 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12721 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12722 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12723 source language c++.
12724 Arglist at unknown address.
12725 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12726 @end smallexample
12727
12728 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12729 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12730 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12731 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12732 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12733 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12734
12735 @table @code
12736 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12737 @item set debug entry-values
12738 @kindex set debug entry-values
12739 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12740 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12741 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12742 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12743 result.
12744
12745 @item show debug entry-values
12746 @kindex show debug entry-values
12747 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12748 values at function entry and tail calls.
12749 @end table
12750
12751 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12752 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12753 reference by variable @code{x}):
12754
12755 @smallexample
12756 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12757 void (*x) (void) = c;
12758 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12759 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12760 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12761
12762 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12763 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12764 a () at t.c:3
12765 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12766 (gdb) bt
12767 #0 a () at t.c:3
12768 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12769 @end smallexample
12770
12771 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12772
12773 @smallexample
12774 int i;
12775 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12776 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12777 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12778 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12779 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12780 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12781 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12782 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12783
12784 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12785 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12786 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12787 (gdb) bt
12788 #0 f () at t.c:2
12789 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12790 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12791 @end smallexample
12792
12793 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12794 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12795
12796 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12797 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12798 @set ARROW @click{}
12799 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12800 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12801 @end ifset
12802 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12803 @set ARROW ->
12804 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12805 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12806 @end ifclear
12807
12808 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12809 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12810 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12811
12812 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12813 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12814 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12815 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12816 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12817 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12818
12819 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12820 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12821 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12822 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12823 omitted.
12824
12825 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12826 entry may fail:
12827
12828 @smallexample
12829 int v;
12830 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12831 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12832 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12833 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12834 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12835 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12836
12837 (gdb) bt
12838 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12839 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12840 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12841 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12842 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12843 @end smallexample
12844
12845 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12846 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12847 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12848 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12849 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12850
12851 @node Macros
12852 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12853
12854 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12855 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12856 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12857 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12858 where it was defined.
12859
12860 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12861 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12862 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12863 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12864
12865 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12866 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12867 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12868 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12869 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12870 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12871 see @ref{List}.
12872
12873 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12874 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12875 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12876
12877 @table @code
12878
12879 @kindex macro expand
12880 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12881 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12882 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12883 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12884 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12885 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12886 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12887 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12888 it can be any string of tokens.
12889
12890 @kindex macro exp1
12891 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12892 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12893 @cindex expand macro once
12894 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12895 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12896 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12897 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12898 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12899 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12900 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12901 can be any string of tokens.
12902
12903 @kindex info macro
12904 @cindex macro definition, showing
12905 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12906 @cindex macros, from debug info
12907 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12908 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12909 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12910 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12911 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12912 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12913
12914 @kindex info macros
12915 @item info macros @var{location}
12916 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12917 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12918 command-line where those definitions were established.
12919
12920 @kindex macro define
12921 @cindex user-defined macros
12922 @cindex defining macros interactively
12923 @cindex macros, user-defined
12924 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12925 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12926 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12927 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12928 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12929 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12930 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12931 @var{arglist}.
12932
12933 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12934 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12935 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12936 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12937 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12938
12939 @kindex macro undef
12940 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12941 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12942 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12943 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12944 in the program being debugged.
12945
12946 @kindex macro list
12947 @item macro list
12948 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12949 @end table
12950
12951 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12952 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12953 show our source files:
12954
12955 @smallexample
12956 $ cat sample.c
12957 #include <stdio.h>
12958 #include "sample.h"
12959
12960 #define M 42
12961 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12962
12963 main ()
12964 @{
12965 #define N 28
12966 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12967 #undef N
12968 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12969 #define N 1729
12970 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12971 @}
12972 $ cat sample.h
12973 #define Q <
12974 $
12975 @end smallexample
12976
12977 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12978 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12979 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12980 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12981 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12982 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12983 information.
12984
12985 @smallexample
12986 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12987 $
12988 @end smallexample
12989
12990 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12991
12992 @smallexample
12993 $ gdb -nw sample
12994 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12995 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12996 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12997 (@value{GDBP})
12998 @end smallexample
12999
13000 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
13001 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
13002 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
13003
13004 @smallexample
13005 (@value{GDBP}) list main
13006 3
13007 4 #define M 42
13008 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13009 6
13010 7 main ()
13011 8 @{
13012 9 #define N 28
13013 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13014 11 #undef N
13015 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13016 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
13017 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
13018 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13019 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
13020 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
13021 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
13022 #define Q <
13023 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
13024 expands to: (42 + 1)
13025 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
13026 expands to: once (M + 1)
13027 (@value{GDBP})
13028 @end smallexample
13029
13030 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
13031 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
13032 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
13033 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
13034
13035 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
13036 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
13037
13038 @smallexample
13039 (@value{GDBP}) break main
13040 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
13041 (@value{GDBP}) run
13042 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
13043
13044 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
13045 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13046 (@value{GDBP})
13047 @end smallexample
13048
13049 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
13050
13051 @smallexample
13052 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13053 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
13054 #define N 28
13055 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
13056 expands to: 28 < 42
13057 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13058 $1 = 1
13059 (@value{GDBP})
13060 @end smallexample
13061
13062 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
13063 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
13064 thereof) in force at each point:
13065
13066 @smallexample
13067 (@value{GDBP}) next
13068 Hello, world!
13069 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13070 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13071 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
13072 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
13073 (@value{GDBP}) next
13074 We're so creative.
13075 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
13076 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13077 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
13078 #define N 1729
13079 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
13080 expands to: 1729 < 42
13081 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13082 $2 = 0
13083 (@value{GDBP})
13084 @end smallexample
13085
13086 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
13087 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
13088 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
13089 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
13090
13091 @smallexample
13092 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
13093 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
13094 -D__STDC__=1
13095 (@value{GDBP})
13096 @end smallexample
13097
13098
13099 @node Tracepoints
13100 @chapter Tracepoints
13101 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
13102 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
13103
13104 @cindex tracepoints
13105 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
13106 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
13107 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
13108 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
13109 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
13110 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
13111 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
13112
13113 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
13114 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
13115 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
13116 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
13117 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
13118 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
13119 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
13120 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
13121 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
13122 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
13123 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
13124
13125 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
13126 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
13127 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
13128 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
13129 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
13130 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
13131 Packets}.
13132
13133 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
13134 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
13135 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
13136
13137 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
13138
13139 @menu
13140 * Set Tracepoints::
13141 * Analyze Collected Data::
13142 * Tracepoint Variables::
13143 * Trace Files::
13144 @end menu
13145
13146 @node Set Tracepoints
13147 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13148
13149 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13150 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13151 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13152 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13153 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13154 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13155 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13156
13157 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13158 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13159 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13160 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13161 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13162 tracepoint was hit.
13163
13164 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13165 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13166 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13167 either.
13168
13169 @cindex fast tracepoints
13170 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13171 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13172 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13173
13174 @cindex static tracepoints
13175 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13176 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13177 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13178 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13179 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13180 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13181 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13182 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13183 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13184 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13185 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13186 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13187 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13188 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13189 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13190 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13191 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13192 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13193 static tracepoint marker.
13194
13195 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13196 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13197
13198 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13199 conditions and actions.
13200
13201 @menu
13202 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13203 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13204 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13205 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13206 * Trace State Variables::
13207 * Tracepoint Actions::
13208 * Listing Tracepoints::
13209 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13210 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13211 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13212 @end menu
13213
13214 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13215 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13216
13217 @table @code
13218 @cindex set tracepoint
13219 @kindex trace
13220 @item trace @var{location}
13221 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13222 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13223 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13224 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13225 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13226 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13227 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13228 in tracing}).
13229 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13230 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13231 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13232 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13233 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13234 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13235 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13236 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13237 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13238 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13239 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13240 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13241
13242 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13243
13244 @smallexample
13245 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13246
13247 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13248
13249 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13250
13251 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13252
13253 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13254 @end smallexample
13255
13256 @noindent
13257 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13258
13259 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13260 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13261 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13262 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13263 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13264 information on tracepoint conditions.
13265
13266 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13267 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13268 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13269 @kindex ftrace
13270 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13271 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13272 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13273 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13274 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13275 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13276 message.
13277
13278 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13279 @code{trace}.
13280
13281 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13282 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13283 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13284 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13285 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13286 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13287 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13288 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13289
13290 @example
13291 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13292 @end example
13293
13294 @noindent
13295 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13296 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13297
13298 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13299 @cindex set static tracepoint
13300 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13301 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13302 @kindex strace
13303 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13304 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13305 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13306 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13307 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13308
13309 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13310 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13311 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13312 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13313 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13314 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13315 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13316 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13317 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13318 tracing engine:
13319
13320 @smallexample
13321 main ()
13322 @{
13323 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13324 @}
13325 @end smallexample
13326
13327 @noindent
13328 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13329 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13330
13331 @smallexample
13332 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13333 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13334 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13335 Data: "str %s"
13336 [etc...]
13337 @end smallexample
13338
13339 @noindent
13340 so you may probe the marker above with:
13341
13342 @smallexample
13343 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13344 @end smallexample
13345
13346 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13347 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13348 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13349 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13350 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13351 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13352 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13353 the @samp{Data:} field.
13354
13355 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13356 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13357 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13358
13359 @vindex $tpnum
13360 @cindex last tracepoint number
13361 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13362 @cindex tracepoint number
13363 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13364 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13365
13366 @kindex delete tracepoint
13367 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13368 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13369 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13370 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13371 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13372
13373 Examples:
13374
13375 @smallexample
13376 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13377
13378 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13379 @end smallexample
13380
13381 @noindent
13382 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13383 @end table
13384
13385 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13386 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13387
13388 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13389
13390 @table @code
13391 @kindex disable tracepoint
13392 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13393 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13394 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13395 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13396 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13397 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13398 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13399 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13400 next trace experiment.
13401
13402 @kindex enable tracepoint
13403 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13404 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13405 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13406 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13407 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13408 next time a trace experiment is run.
13409 @end table
13410
13411 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13412 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13413
13414 @table @code
13415 @kindex passcount
13416 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13417 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13418 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13419 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13420 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13421 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13422 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13423 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13424 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13425 user.
13426
13427 Examples:
13428
13429 @smallexample
13430 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13431 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13432
13433 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13434 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13435 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13436 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13437 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13438 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13439 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13440 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13441 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13442 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13443 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13444 @end smallexample
13445 @end table
13446
13447 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13448 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13449 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13450 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13451
13452 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13453 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13454 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13455 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13456 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13457 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13458 is true.
13459
13460 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13461 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13462 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13463 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13464 just as with breakpoints.
13465
13466 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13467 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13468 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13469 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13470 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13471 accesses, and so forth.
13472
13473 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13474 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13475 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13476 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13477 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13478 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13479 search through.
13480
13481 @smallexample
13482 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13483 @end smallexample
13484
13485 @node Trace State Variables
13486 @subsection Trace State Variables
13487 @cindex trace state variables
13488
13489 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13490 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13491 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13492 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13493 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13494 integers.
13495
13496 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13497 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13498 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13499 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13500
13501 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13502 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13503 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13504 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13505 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13506 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13507 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13508 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13509 variable with the same name.
13510
13511 @table @code
13512
13513 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13514 @kindex tvariable
13515 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13516 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13517 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13518 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13519 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13520 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13521 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13522 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13523 value. The default initial value is 0.
13524
13525 @item info tvariables
13526 @kindex info tvariables
13527 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13528 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13529 currently running.
13530
13531 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13532 @kindex delete tvariable
13533 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13534 are specified.
13535
13536 @end table
13537
13538 @node Tracepoint Actions
13539 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13540
13541 @table @code
13542 @kindex actions
13543 @cindex tracepoint actions
13544 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13545 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13546 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13547 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13548 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13549 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13550 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13551 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13552 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13553 @code{while-stepping}.
13554
13555 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13556 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13557 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13558
13559 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13560 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13561 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13562
13563 @smallexample
13564 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13565
13566 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13567
13568 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13569 @end smallexample
13570
13571 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13572 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13573 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13574 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13575 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13576 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13577 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13578 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13579
13580 @smallexample
13581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13582 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13583 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13584 > collect bar,baz
13585 > collect $regs
13586 > while-stepping 12
13587 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13588 > end
13589 end
13590 @end smallexample
13591
13592 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13593 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13594 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13595 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13596 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13597 special arguments are supported:
13598
13599 @table @code
13600 @item $regs
13601 Collect all registers.
13602
13603 @item $args
13604 Collect all function arguments.
13605
13606 @item $locals
13607 Collect all local variables.
13608
13609 @item $_ret
13610 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13611 of a backtrace.
13612
13613 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13614 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13615 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13616 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13617 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13618 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13619
13620 @item $_probe_argc
13621 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13622 tracepoint is located.
13623 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13624
13625 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13626 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13627 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13628 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13629
13630 @item $_sdata
13631 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13632 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13633 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13634 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13635 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13636 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13637 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13638 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13639 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13640
13641 @smallexample
13642 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13643 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13644 @end smallexample
13645
13646 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13647 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13648 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13649 @value{GDBN}.
13650 @end table
13651
13652 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13653 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13654 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13655
13656 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13657 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13658 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13659 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13660 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13661 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13662 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13663 @samp{mystr}.
13664
13665 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13666 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13667
13668 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13669 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13670 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13671 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13672 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13673 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13674 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13675 action were used.
13676
13677 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13678 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13679 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13680 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13681 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13682 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13683
13684 @smallexample
13685 > while-stepping 12
13686 > collect $regs, myglobal
13687 > end
13688 >
13689 @end smallexample
13690
13691 @noindent
13692 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13693 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13694 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13695 @code{stepping}.
13696
13697 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13698 @kindex set default-collect
13699 @cindex default collection action
13700 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13701 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13702 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13703 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13704 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13705 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13706
13707 @item show default-collect
13708 @kindex show default-collect
13709 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13710 tracepoint hit.
13711
13712 @end table
13713
13714 @node Listing Tracepoints
13715 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13716
13717 @table @code
13718 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13719 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13720 @cindex information about tracepoints
13721 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13722 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13723 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13724 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13725 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13726 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13727
13728 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13729 tracing:
13730
13731 @itemize @bullet
13732 @item
13733 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13734
13735 @item
13736 the state about installed on target of each location
13737 @end itemize
13738
13739 @smallexample
13740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13741 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13742 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13743 while-stepping 20
13744 collect globfoo, $regs
13745 end
13746 collect globfoo2
13747 end
13748 pass count 1200
13749 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13750 collect $eip
13751 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13752 installed on target
13753 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13754 installed on target
13755 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13756 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13757 not installed on target
13758 (@value{GDBP})
13759 @end smallexample
13760
13761 @noindent
13762 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13763 @end table
13764
13765 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13766 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13767
13768 @table @code
13769 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13770 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13771 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13772 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13773 program.
13774
13775 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13776
13777 @table @emph
13778 @item Count
13779 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13780 stable identifier.
13781 @item ID
13782 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13783 @item Enabled or Disabled
13784 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13785 that are not enabled.
13786 @item Address
13787 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13788 @item What
13789 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13790 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13791 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13792 will be left blank.
13793 @end table
13794
13795 @noindent
13796 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13797
13798 @table @emph
13799 @item Data
13800 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13801 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13802 marker call.
13803 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13804 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13805 @end table
13806
13807 @smallexample
13808 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13809 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13810 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13811 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13812 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13813 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13814 Data: str %s
13815 (@value{GDBP})
13816 @end smallexample
13817 @end table
13818
13819 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13820 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13821
13822 @table @code
13823 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13824 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13825 @cindex collected data discarded
13826 @item tstart
13827 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13828 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13829 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13830 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13831 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13832 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13833 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13834 information, and so forth.
13835
13836 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13837 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13838 @item tstop
13839 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13840 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13841 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13842 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13843 needs to be stopped quickly.
13844
13845 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13846 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13847 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13848
13849 @kindex tstatus
13850 @cindex status of trace data collection
13851 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13852 @item tstatus
13853 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13854 collection.
13855 @end table
13856
13857 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13858
13859 @smallexample
13860 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13861 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13862 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13863 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13864 > while-stepping 11
13865 > collect $regs
13866 > end
13867 > end
13868 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13869 [time passes @dots{}]
13870 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13871 @end smallexample
13872
13873 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13874 @cindex disconnected tracing
13875 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13876 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13877 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13878 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13879 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13880 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13881 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13882 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13883
13884 @table @code
13885 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13886 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13887 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13888 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13889 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13890 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13891 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13892 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13893
13894 @item show disconnected-tracing
13895 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13896 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13897
13898 @end table
13899
13900 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13901 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13902 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13903 it will continue after reconnection.
13904
13905 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13906 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13907 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13908 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13909 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13910 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13911 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13912 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13913 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13914 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13915
13916 @cindex circular trace buffer
13917 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13918 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13919 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13920 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13921 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13922 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13923 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13924 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13925 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13926 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13927 the next run.
13928
13929 @table @code
13930 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13931 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13932 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13933 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13934 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13935 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13936 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13937
13938 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13939 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13940 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13941 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13942 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13943 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13944
13945 @end table
13946
13947 @table @code
13948 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13949 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13950 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13951 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13952 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13953 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13954 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13955 likes. This is also the default.
13956
13957 @item show trace-buffer-size
13958 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13959 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13960 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13961 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13962 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13963 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13964 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13965 @end table
13966
13967 @table @code
13968 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13969 @kindex set trace-user
13970
13971 @item show trace-user
13972 @kindex show trace-user
13973
13974 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13975 @kindex set trace-notes
13976 Set the trace run's notes.
13977
13978 @item show trace-notes
13979 @kindex show trace-notes
13980 Show the trace run's notes.
13981
13982 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13983 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13984 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13985 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13986 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13987
13988 @item show trace-stop-notes
13989 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13990 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13991
13992 @end table
13993
13994 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13995 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13996
13997 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13998 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13999 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
14000 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
14001 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
14002 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
14003 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
14004 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
14005 mentioned here.
14006
14007 @itemize @bullet
14008
14009 @item
14010 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
14011 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
14012 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
14013 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
14014 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
14015 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
14016 cannot be collected either.
14017
14018 @item
14019 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
14020 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
14021 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
14022 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
14023 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
14024 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
14025 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
14026 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
14027 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
14028 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
14029
14030 @item
14031 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
14032 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
14033 in a misleading way.
14034
14035 @item
14036 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
14037 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
14038 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
14039 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
14040 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
14041 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
14042 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
14043 by @code{ptr}.
14044
14045 @item
14046 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
14047 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
14048 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
14049 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
14050 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
14051 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
14052 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
14053 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
14054 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
14055 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
14056 invalid address.
14057
14058 @item
14059 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
14060 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
14061 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
14062 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
14063 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
14064 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
14065 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
14066 it to zero.
14067
14068 @end itemize
14069
14070 @node Analyze Collected Data
14071 @section Using the Collected Data
14072
14073 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
14074 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
14075 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
14076 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
14077 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
14078 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
14079 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
14080 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
14081 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
14082 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
14083 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
14084 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
14085 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
14086 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
14087 the buffer will fail.
14088
14089 @menu
14090 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
14091 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
14092 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
14093 @end menu
14094
14095 @node tfind
14096 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
14097
14098 @kindex tfind
14099 @cindex select trace snapshot
14100 @cindex find trace snapshot
14101 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
14102 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
14103 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
14104 snapshot is selected.
14105
14106 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
14107
14108 @table @code
14109 @item tfind start
14110 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
14111 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
14112
14113 @item tfind none
14114 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
14115
14116 @item tfind end
14117 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
14118
14119 @item tfind
14120 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
14121 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
14122
14123 @item tfind -
14124 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
14125 retracing earlier steps.
14126
14127 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
14128 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
14129 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
14130 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
14131 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
14132
14133 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
14134 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
14135 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
14136 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
14137 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
14138
14139 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14140 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
14141 addresses (exclusive).
14142
14143 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14144 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14145 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14146
14147 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14148 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14149 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14150 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14151 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14152 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14153 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14154 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14155 @end table
14156
14157 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14158 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14159 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14160 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14161 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14162 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14163 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14164 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14165 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14166 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14167 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14168 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14169 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14170 tracepoint as the current one.
14171
14172 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14173 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14174 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14175 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14176 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14177
14178 @smallexample
14179 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14180 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14181 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14182 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14183 > tfind
14184 > end
14185
14186 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14187 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14188 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14189 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14190 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14191 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14192 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14193 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14194 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14195 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14196 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14197 @end smallexample
14198
14199 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14200 the buffer:
14201
14202 @smallexample
14203 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14204 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14205 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14206 > tfind line
14207 > end
14208
14209 Frame 0, X = 1
14210 Frame 7, X = 2
14211 Frame 13, X = 255
14212 @end smallexample
14213
14214 @node tdump
14215 @subsection @code{tdump}
14216 @kindex tdump
14217 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14218 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14219
14220 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14221 the current trace snapshot.
14222
14223 @smallexample
14224 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14225 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14226 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14227 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14228 > end
14229
14230 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14231
14232 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14233 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14234 at gdb_test.c:444
14235 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14236
14237 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14238 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14239 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14240 d1 0x18 24
14241 d2 0x80 128
14242 d3 0x33 51
14243 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14244 d5 0x22 34
14245 d6 0xe0 224
14246 d7 0x380035 3670069
14247 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14248 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14249 a2 0x100 256
14250 a3 0x322000 3284992
14251 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14252 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14253 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14254 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14255 ps 0x0 0
14256 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14257 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14258 fpstatus 0x0 0
14259 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14260 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14261 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14262 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14263 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14264 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14265 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14266 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14267 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14268
14269 (@value{GDBP})
14270 @end smallexample
14271
14272 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14273 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14274 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14275 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14276
14277 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14278 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14279 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14280 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14281 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14282 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14283 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14284 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14285 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14286 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14287
14288 @node save tracepoints
14289 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14290 @kindex save tracepoints
14291 @kindex save-tracepoints
14292 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14293
14294 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14295 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14296 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14297 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14298 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14299 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14300
14301 @node Tracepoint Variables
14302 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14303 @cindex tracepoint variables
14304 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14305
14306 @table @code
14307 @vindex $trace_frame
14308 @item (int) $trace_frame
14309 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14310 snapshot is selected.
14311
14312 @vindex $tracepoint
14313 @item (int) $tracepoint
14314 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14315
14316 @vindex $trace_line
14317 @item (int) $trace_line
14318 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14319
14320 @vindex $trace_file
14321 @item (char []) $trace_file
14322 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14323
14324 @vindex $trace_func
14325 @item (char []) $trace_func
14326 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14327 @end table
14328
14329 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14330 use @code{output} instead.
14331
14332 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14333 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14334 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14335 which are managed by the target.
14336
14337 @smallexample
14338 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14339
14340 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14341 > output $trace_file
14342 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14343 > tfind
14344 > end
14345 @end smallexample
14346
14347 @node Trace Files
14348 @section Using Trace Files
14349 @cindex trace files
14350
14351 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14352 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14353 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14354 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14355 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14356
14357 @table @code
14358
14359 @kindex tsave
14360 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14361 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14362 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14363 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14364 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14365 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14366 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14367 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14368 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14369 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14370 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14371 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14372 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14373 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14374 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14375
14376 @kindex target tfile
14377 @kindex tfile
14378 @kindex target ctf
14379 @kindex ctf
14380 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14381 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14382 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14383 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14384 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14385 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14386 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14387 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14388 the host.
14389
14390 @smallexample
14391 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14392 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14393 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14394 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14395 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14396 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14397 i = 0
14398 a = 0
14399 b = 1 '\001'
14400 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14401 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14402 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14403 $1 = 1
14404 @end smallexample
14405
14406 @end table
14407
14408 @node Overlays
14409 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14410 @cindex overlays
14411
14412 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14413 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14414 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14415 use overlays.
14416
14417 @menu
14418 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14419 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14420 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14421 mapped by asking the inferior.
14422 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14423 @end menu
14424
14425 @node How Overlays Work
14426 @section How Overlays Work
14427 @cindex mapped overlays
14428 @cindex unmapped overlays
14429 @cindex load address, overlay's
14430 @cindex mapped address
14431 @cindex overlay area
14432
14433 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14434 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14435 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14436 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14437 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14438
14439 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14440 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14441 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14442 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14443 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14444 largest overlay as well.
14445
14446 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14447 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14448 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14449 there.
14450
14451 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14452 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14453 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14454
14455 @smallexample
14456 @group
14457 Data Instruction Larger
14458 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14459 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14460 | | | | | |
14461 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14462 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14463 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14464 | and heap | | | | | |
14465 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14466 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14467 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14468 | | | | | |
14469 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14470 address | | | | | |
14471 | overlay | <-' | | |
14472 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14473 | | <---. | | load address
14474 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14475 | | | |
14476 +-----------+ | |
14477 +-----------+
14478 | |
14479 +-----------+
14480
14481 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14482 @end group
14483 @end smallexample
14484
14485 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14486 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14487 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14488 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14489 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14490 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14491 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14492 program and the overlay area.
14493
14494 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14495 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14496 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14497 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14498 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14499 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14500 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14501
14502 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14503 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14504 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14505
14506 @itemize @bullet
14507
14508 @item
14509 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14510 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14511 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14512 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14513
14514 @item
14515 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14516 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14517 your program's performance.
14518
14519 @item
14520 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14521 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14522 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14523 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14524 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14525 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14526 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14527
14528 @item
14529 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14530 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14531 instruction and data spaces.
14532
14533 @end itemize
14534
14535 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14536 improved in many ways:
14537
14538 @itemize @bullet
14539
14540 @item
14541 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14542 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14543 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14544 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14545 area in the usual way.
14546
14547 @item
14548 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14549 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14550
14551 @item
14552 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14553 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14554 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14555 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14556 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14557 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14558 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14559
14560 @end itemize
14561
14562
14563 @node Overlay Commands
14564 @section Overlay Commands
14565
14566 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14567 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14568 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14569 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14570 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14571 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14572
14573 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14574 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14575
14576 @table @code
14577 @item overlay off
14578 @kindex overlay
14579 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14580 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14581 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14582 overlay support is disabled.
14583
14584 @item overlay manual
14585 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14586 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14587 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14588 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14589 commands described below.
14590
14591 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14592 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14593 @cindex map an overlay
14594 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14595 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14596 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14597 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14598 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14599 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14600
14601 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14602 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14603 @cindex unmap an overlay
14604 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14605 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14606 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14607 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14608
14609 @item overlay auto
14610 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14611 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14612 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14613 Overlay Debugging}.
14614
14615 @item overlay load-target
14616 @itemx overlay load
14617 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14618 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14619 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14620 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14621 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14622 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14623
14624 @item overlay list-overlays
14625 @itemx overlay list
14626 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14627 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14628 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14629
14630 @end table
14631
14632 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14633 of the function the address falls in:
14634
14635 @smallexample
14636 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14637 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14638 @end smallexample
14639 @noindent
14640 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14641 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14642 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14643 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14644
14645 @smallexample
14646 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14647 No sections are mapped.
14648 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14649 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14650 @end smallexample
14651 @noindent
14652 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14653 name normally:
14654
14655 @smallexample
14656 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14657 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14658 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14659 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14660 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14661 @end smallexample
14662
14663 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14664 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14665 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14666 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14667 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14668
14669 @itemize @bullet
14670 @item
14671 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14672 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14673 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14674 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14675 @item
14676 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14677 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14678 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14679 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14680 breakpoints properly.
14681 @end itemize
14682
14683
14684 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14685 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14686 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14687
14688 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14689 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14690 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14691 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14692 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14693 current state of the overlays.
14694
14695 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14696 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14697
14698 @table @asis
14699
14700 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14701 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14702
14703 @smallexample
14704 struct
14705 @{
14706 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14707 unsigned long vma;
14708
14709 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14710 unsigned long size;
14711
14712 /* The overlay's load address. */
14713 unsigned long lma;
14714
14715 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14716 zero otherwise. */
14717 unsigned long mapped;
14718 @}
14719 @end smallexample
14720
14721 @item @code{_novlys}:
14722 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14723 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14724
14725 @end table
14726
14727 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14728 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14729 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14730 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14731 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14732 currently mapped.
14733
14734 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14735 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14736 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14737 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14738 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14739 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14740 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14741 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14742 are not being executed.
14743
14744 @node Overlay Sample Program
14745 @section Overlay Sample Program
14746 @cindex overlay example program
14747
14748 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14749 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14750 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14751 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14752 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14753 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14754 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14755
14756 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14757 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14758 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14759 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14760
14761 @table @file
14762 @item overlays.c
14763 The main program file.
14764 @item ovlymgr.c
14765 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14766 @item foo.c
14767 @itemx bar.c
14768 @itemx baz.c
14769 @itemx grbx.c
14770 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14771 @item d10v.ld
14772 @itemx m32r.ld
14773 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14774 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14775 @end table
14776
14777 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14778 cross-compiler like this:
14779
14780 @smallexample
14781 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14782 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14783 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14784 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14785 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14786 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14787 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14788 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14789 @end smallexample
14790
14791 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14792 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14793 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14794
14795
14796 @node Languages
14797 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14798 @cindex languages
14799
14800 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14801 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14802 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14803 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14804 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14805 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14806
14807 @cindex working language
14808 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14809 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14810 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14811 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14812 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14813 language}.
14814
14815 @menu
14816 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14817 * Show:: Displaying the language
14818 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14819 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14820 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14821 @end menu
14822
14823 @node Setting
14824 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14825
14826 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14827 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14828 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14829 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14830 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14831 are printed, etc.
14832
14833 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14834 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14835 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14836 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14837 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14838 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14839 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14840 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14841 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14842 Displaying the Language}.
14843
14844 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14845 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14846 another language. In that case, make the
14847 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14848 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14849 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14850
14851 @menu
14852 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14853 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14854 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14855 @end menu
14856
14857 @node Filenames
14858 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14859
14860 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14861 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14862
14863 @table @file
14864 @item .ada
14865 @itemx .ads
14866 @itemx .adb
14867 @itemx .a
14868 Ada source file.
14869
14870 @item .c
14871 C source file
14872
14873 @item .C
14874 @itemx .cc
14875 @itemx .cp
14876 @itemx .cpp
14877 @itemx .cxx
14878 @itemx .c++
14879 C@t{++} source file
14880
14881 @item .d
14882 D source file
14883
14884 @item .m
14885 Objective-C source file
14886
14887 @item .f
14888 @itemx .F
14889 Fortran source file
14890
14891 @item .mod
14892 Modula-2 source file
14893
14894 @item .s
14895 @itemx .S
14896 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14897 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14898 @end table
14899
14900 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14901 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14902
14903 @node Manually
14904 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14905
14906 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14907 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14908 your program.
14909
14910 @kindex set language
14911 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14912 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14913 a language, such as
14914 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14915 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14916
14917 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14918 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14919 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14920 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14921 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14922 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14923 command such as:
14924
14925 @smallexample
14926 print a = b + c
14927 @end smallexample
14928
14929 @noindent
14930 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14931 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14932 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14933 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14934
14935 @node Automatically
14936 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14937
14938 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14939 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14940 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14941 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14942 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14943 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14944 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14945 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14946 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14947
14948 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14949 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14950 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14951 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14952 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14953
14954 @node Show
14955 @section Displaying the Language
14956
14957 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14958 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14959
14960 @table @code
14961 @item show language
14962 @anchor{show language}
14963 @kindex show language
14964 Display the current working language. This is the
14965 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14966 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14967
14968 @item info frame
14969 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14970 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14971 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14972 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14973 information listed here.
14974
14975 @item info source
14976 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14977 Display the source language of this source file.
14978 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14979 information listed here.
14980 @end table
14981
14982 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14983 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14984 with a language explicitly:
14985
14986 @table @code
14987 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14988 @kindex set extension-language
14989 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14990 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14991
14992 @item info extensions
14993 @kindex info extensions
14994 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14995 @end table
14996
14997 @node Checks
14998 @section Type and Range Checking
14999
15000 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
15001 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
15002 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
15003 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
15004 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
15005 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
15006 errors when your program is running.
15007
15008 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
15009 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
15010 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
15011 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
15012
15013 @menu
15014 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
15015 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
15016 @end menu
15017
15018 @cindex type checking
15019 @cindex checks, type
15020 @node Type Checking
15021 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
15022
15023 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
15024 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
15025 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
15026 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
15027
15028 @smallexample
15029 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
15030
15031 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
15032 $1 = 2
15033 @exdent but
15034 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
15035 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
15036 @end smallexample
15037
15038 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
15039 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
15040
15041 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15042 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
15043 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
15044 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
15045 expressions like the second example above.
15046
15047 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
15048 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
15049 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
15050 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
15051 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
15052 little sense to evaluate anyway.
15053
15054 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
15055
15056 @kindex set check type
15057 @kindex show check type
15058 @table @code
15059 @item set check type on
15060 @itemx set check type off
15061 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
15062 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
15063 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
15064
15065 @item show check type
15066 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
15067 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
15068 @end table
15069
15070 @cindex range checking
15071 @cindex checks, range
15072 @node Range Checking
15073 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
15074
15075 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
15076 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
15077 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
15078 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
15079 not exceed the bounds of the array.
15080
15081 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15082 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
15083 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
15084 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
15085
15086 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
15087 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
15088 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
15089 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
15090 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
15091 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
15092
15093 @smallexample
15094 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
15095 @end smallexample
15096
15097 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
15098 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
15099 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
15100
15101 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
15102
15103 @kindex set check range
15104 @kindex show check range
15105 @table @code
15106 @item set check range auto
15107 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
15108 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
15109 each language.
15110
15111 @item set check range on
15112 @itemx set check range off
15113 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
15114 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
15115 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
15116 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
15117
15118 @item set check range warn
15119 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
15120 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
15121 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
15122 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
15123 systems).
15124
15125 @item show range
15126 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
15127 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
15128 @end table
15129
15130 @node Supported Languages
15131 @section Supported Languages
15132
15133 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
15134 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
15135 @c This is false ...
15136 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
15137 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
15138 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
15139 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
15140 language.
15141
15142 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
15143 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
15144 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15145 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15146 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15147 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15148 language reference or tutorial.
15149
15150 @menu
15151 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15152 * D:: D
15153 * Go:: Go
15154 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15155 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15156 * Fortran:: Fortran
15157 * Pascal:: Pascal
15158 * Rust:: Rust
15159 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15160 * Ada:: Ada
15161 @end menu
15162
15163 @node C
15164 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15165
15166 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15167 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15168
15169 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15170 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15171 together.
15172
15173 @cindex C@t{++}
15174 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15175 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15176 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15177 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15178 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15179 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15180 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15181
15182 @menu
15183 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15184 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15185 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15186 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15187 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15188 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15189 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15190 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15191 @end menu
15192
15193 @node C Operators
15194 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15195
15196 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15197
15198 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15199 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15200 often defined on groups of types.
15201
15202 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15203
15204 @itemize @bullet
15205
15206 @item
15207 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15208 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15209
15210 @item
15211 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15212 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15213
15214 @item
15215 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15216
15217 @item
15218 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15219
15220 @end itemize
15221
15222 @noindent
15223 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15224 in order of increasing precedence:
15225
15226 @table @code
15227 @item ,
15228 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15229 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15230 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15231
15232 @item =
15233 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15234 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15235
15236 @item @var{op}=
15237 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15238 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15239 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15240 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15241 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15242
15243 @item ?:
15244 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15245 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15246 should be of an integral type.
15247
15248 @item ||
15249 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15250
15251 @item &&
15252 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15253
15254 @item |
15255 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15256
15257 @item ^
15258 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15259
15260 @item &
15261 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15262
15263 @item ==@r{, }!=
15264 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15265 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15266
15267 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15268 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15269 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15270 and non-zero for true.
15271
15272 @item <<@r{, }>>
15273 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15274
15275 @item @@
15276 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15277
15278 @item +@r{, }-
15279 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15280 pointer types.
15281
15282 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15283 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15284 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15285 integral types.
15286
15287 @item ++@r{, }--
15288 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15289 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15290 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15291 operation takes place.
15292
15293 @item *
15294 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15295 @code{++}.
15296
15297 @item &
15298 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15299
15300 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15301 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15302 to examine the address
15303 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15304 stored.
15305
15306 @item -
15307 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15308 precedence as @code{++}.
15309
15310 @item !
15311 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15312 @code{++}.
15313
15314 @item ~
15315 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15316 @code{++}.
15317
15318
15319 @item .@r{, }->
15320 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15321 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15322 pointer based on the stored type information.
15323 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15324
15325 @item .*@r{, }->*
15326 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15327
15328 @item []
15329 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15330 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15331
15332 @item ()
15333 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15334
15335 @item ::
15336 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15337 and @code{class} types.
15338
15339 @item ::
15340 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15341 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15342 above.
15343 @end table
15344
15345 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15346 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15347 predefined meaning.
15348
15349 @node C Constants
15350 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15351
15352 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15353
15354 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15355 following ways:
15356
15357 @itemize @bullet
15358 @item
15359 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15360 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15361 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15362 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15363 @code{long} value.
15364
15365 @item
15366 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15367 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15368 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15369 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15370 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15371 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15372 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15373 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15374 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15375 constant.
15376
15377 @item
15378 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15379 integral equivalents.
15380
15381 @item
15382 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15383 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15384 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15385 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15386 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15387 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15388 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15389 @samp{\n} for newline.
15390
15391 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15392 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15393 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15394 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15395
15396 @item
15397 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15398 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15399 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15400 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15401 characters.
15402
15403 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15404 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15405 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15406
15407 @item
15408 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15409 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15410
15411 @item
15412 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15413 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15414 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15415 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15416 @end itemize
15417
15418 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15419 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15420
15421 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15422 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15423
15424 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15425 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15426 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15427 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15428 @quotation
15429 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15430 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15431 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15432 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15433 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15434 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15435 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15436 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15437 @end quotation
15438
15439 @enumerate
15440
15441 @cindex member functions
15442 @item
15443 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15444
15445 @smallexample
15446 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15447 @end smallexample
15448
15449 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15450 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15451 @item
15452 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15453 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15454 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15455 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15456 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15457
15458 @cindex call overloaded functions
15459 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15460 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15461 @item
15462 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15463 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15464 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15465 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15466 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15467 default arguments.
15468
15469 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15470 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15471 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15472 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15473 number of function arguments.
15474
15475 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15476 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15477 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15478
15479 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15480 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15481 @smallexample
15482 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15483 @end smallexample
15484
15485 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15486 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15487
15488 @cindex reference declarations
15489 @item
15490 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15491 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15492 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15493
15494 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15495 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15496 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15497 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15498 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15499
15500 @item
15501 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15502 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15503 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15504 necessary, for example in an expression like
15505 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15506 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15507 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15508
15509 @item
15510 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15511 specification.
15512 @end enumerate
15513
15514 @node C Defaults
15515 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15516
15517 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15518
15519 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15520 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15521 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15522 selects the working language.
15523
15524 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15525 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15526 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15527 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15528 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15529 for further details.
15530
15531 @node C Checks
15532 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15533
15534 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15535
15536 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15537 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15538 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15539 constants to pointers.
15540
15541 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15542 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15543 that is not itself an array.
15544
15545 @node Debugging C
15546 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15547
15548 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15549 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15550 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15551 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15552
15553 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15554 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15555 ,Expressions}.
15556
15557 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15558 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15559
15560 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15561
15562 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15563 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15564
15565 @table @code
15566 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15567 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15568 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15569 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15570 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15571 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15572
15573 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15574 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15575 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15576 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15577 classes.
15578 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15579
15580 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15581 @item catch throw
15582 @itemx catch rethrow
15583 @itemx catch catch
15584 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15585 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15586
15587 @cindex inheritance
15588 @item ptype @var{typename}
15589 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15590 @var{typename}.
15591 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15592
15593 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15594 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15595 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15596 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15597 multiple inheritance is in use.
15598
15599 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15600 @item demangle @var{name}
15601 Demangle @var{name}.
15602 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15603
15604 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15605 @item set print demangle
15606 @itemx show print demangle
15607 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15608 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15609 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15610 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15611 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15612
15613 @item set print object
15614 @itemx show print object
15615 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15616 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15617
15618 @item set print vtbl
15619 @itemx show print vtbl
15620 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15621 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15622 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15623 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15624
15625 @kindex set overload-resolution
15626 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15627 @item set overload-resolution on
15628 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15629 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15630 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15631 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15632 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15633 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15634
15635 @item set overload-resolution off
15636 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15637 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15638 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15639 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15640 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15641 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15642 argument types.
15643
15644 @kindex show overload-resolution
15645 @item show overload-resolution
15646 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15647
15648 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15649 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15650 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15651 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15652 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15653 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15654 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15655
15656 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15657
15658 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15659 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15660 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15661 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15662 for more detail.
15663
15664 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15665 function that returns a std::string:
15666
15667 @smallexample
15668 std::string function(int);
15669 @end smallexample
15670
15671 @noindent
15672 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15673 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15674
15675 @smallexample
15676 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15677 @end smallexample
15678
15679 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15680 tag. For example:
15681
15682 @smallexample
15683 (gdb) b function(int)
15684 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15685 (gdb) info breakpoints
15686 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15687 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15688 at main.cc:10
15689 @end smallexample
15690
15691 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15692 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15693 name, like:
15694
15695 @smallexample
15696 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15697 @end smallexample
15698 @end table
15699
15700 @node Decimal Floating Point
15701 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15702 @cindex decimal floating point format
15703
15704 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15705 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15706 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15707 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15708
15709 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15710 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15711 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15712 configured target.
15713
15714 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15715 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15716 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15717
15718 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15719 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15720 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15721
15722 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15723 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15724 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15725
15726 @node D
15727 @subsection D
15728
15729 @cindex D
15730 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15731 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15732 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15733
15734 @node Go
15735 @subsection Go
15736
15737 @cindex Go (programming language)
15738 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15739 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15740
15741 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15742
15743 @table @code
15744 @cindex current Go package
15745 @item The current Go package
15746 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15747 specifying global variables and functions.
15748
15749 For example, given the program:
15750
15751 @example
15752 package main
15753 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15754 func main () @{
15755 // ...
15756 @}
15757 @end example
15758
15759 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15760
15761 @example
15762 (gdb) p myglob
15763 (gdb) p main.myglob
15764 @end example
15765
15766 @cindex builtin Go types
15767 @item Builtin Go types
15768 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15769 as a string.
15770
15771 @cindex builtin Go functions
15772 @item Builtin Go functions
15773 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15774 function and handles it internally.
15775
15776 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15777 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15778 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15779 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15780 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15781 @end table
15782
15783 @node Objective-C
15784 @subsection Objective-C
15785
15786 @cindex Objective-C
15787 This section provides information about some commands and command
15788 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15789 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15790 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15791
15792 @menu
15793 * Method Names in Commands::
15794 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15795 @end menu
15796
15797 @node Method Names in Commands
15798 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15799
15800 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15801 names as line specifications:
15802
15803 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15804 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15805 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15806 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15807 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15808 @itemize
15809 @item @code{clear}
15810 @item @code{break}
15811 @item @code{info line}
15812 @item @code{jump}
15813 @item @code{list}
15814 @end itemize
15815
15816 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15817
15818 @smallexample
15819 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15820 @end smallexample
15821
15822 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15823 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15824 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15825 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15826 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15827 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15828 debugged, enter:
15829
15830 @smallexample
15831 break -[Fruit create]
15832 @end smallexample
15833
15834 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15835 enter:
15836
15837 @smallexample
15838 list +[NSText initialize]
15839 @end smallexample
15840
15841 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15842 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15843 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15844 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15845
15846 @smallexample
15847 break create
15848 @end smallexample
15849
15850 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15851 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15852 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15853 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15854 none apply.
15855
15856 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15857 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15858
15859 @smallexample
15860 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15861 @end smallexample
15862
15863 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15864 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15865 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15866 @kindex print-object
15867 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15868
15869 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15870
15871 @smallexample
15872 print -[@var{object} hash]
15873 @end smallexample
15874
15875 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15876 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15877 @noindent
15878 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15879 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15880 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15881 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15882 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15883 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15884
15885 @node OpenCL C
15886 @subsection OpenCL C
15887
15888 @cindex OpenCL C
15889 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15890
15891 @menu
15892 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15893 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15894 * OpenCL C Operators::
15895 @end menu
15896
15897 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15898 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15899
15900 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15901 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15902 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15903 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15904 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15905
15906 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15907 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15908
15909 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15910 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15911 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15912 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15913
15914 @node OpenCL C Operators
15915 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15916
15917 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15918 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15919 vector data types.
15920
15921 @node Fortran
15922 @subsection Fortran
15923 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15924
15925 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15926 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15927
15928 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15929 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15930 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15931 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15932 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15933 underscore.
15934
15935 @menu
15936 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15937 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15938 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15939 @end menu
15940
15941 @node Fortran Operators
15942 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15943
15944 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15945
15946 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15947 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15948 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15949
15950 @table @code
15951 @item **
15952 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15953 of the second one.
15954
15955 @item :
15956 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15957 represent a section of array.
15958
15959 @item %
15960 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15961 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15962 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15963 union type.
15964 @end table
15965
15966 @node Fortran Defaults
15967 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15968
15969 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15970
15971 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15972 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15973 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15974 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15975
15976 @node Special Fortran Commands
15977 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15978
15979 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15980
15981 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15982 such as displaying common blocks.
15983
15984 @table @code
15985 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15986 @kindex info common
15987 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15988 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15989 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15990 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15991 printed.
15992 @end table
15993
15994 @node Pascal
15995 @subsection Pascal
15996
15997 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15998 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15999 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
16000 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
16001 syntax.
16002
16003 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
16004 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
16005 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
16006
16007 @node Rust
16008 @subsection Rust
16009
16010 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
16011 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
16012 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
16013 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
16014
16015 @itemize @bullet
16016 @item
16017 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
16018 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
16019 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
16020
16021 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
16022 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
16023 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
16024 @samp{B}.
16025
16026 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
16027 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
16028
16029 @item
16030 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
16031 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
16032 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
16033 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
16034 @samp{K::x::y}.
16035
16036 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
16037 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
16038 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
16039 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
16040 scope.
16041
16042 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
16043 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
16044
16045 @item
16046 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
16047 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
16048
16049 @item
16050 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
16051
16052 @item
16053 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
16054 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
16055 never be destroyed.
16056
16057 @item
16058 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
16059 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
16060 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
16061
16062 @item
16063 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
16064 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
16065 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
16066 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
16067 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
16068 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
16069 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
16070 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
16071
16072 @item
16073 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
16074 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
16075 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
16076 @itemize @bullet
16077
16078 @item
16079 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
16080
16081 @item
16082 Operator overloading is not implemented.
16083
16084 @item
16085 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
16086 type names.
16087
16088 @item
16089 The type @code{Self} is not available.
16090
16091 @item
16092 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
16093 available in the crate.
16094 @end itemize
16095 @end itemize
16096
16097 @node Modula-2
16098 @subsection Modula-2
16099
16100 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
16101
16102 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
16103 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
16104 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
16105 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16106 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
16107 table.
16108
16109 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
16110 @menu
16111 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
16112 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
16113 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
16114 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
16115 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
16116 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
16117 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
16118 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16119 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16120 @end menu
16121
16122 @node M2 Operators
16123 @subsubsection Operators
16124 @cindex Modula-2 operators
16125
16126 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16127 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
16128 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
16129 following definitions hold:
16130
16131 @itemize @bullet
16132
16133 @item
16134 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
16135 their subranges.
16136
16137 @item
16138 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
16139
16140 @item
16141 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
16142
16143 @item
16144 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16145 @var{type}}.
16146
16147 @item
16148 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16149
16150 @item
16151 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16152
16153 @item
16154 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16155 @end itemize
16156
16157 @noindent
16158 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16159 increasing precedence:
16160
16161 @table @code
16162 @item ,
16163 Function argument or array index separator.
16164
16165 @item :=
16166 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16167 @var{value}.
16168
16169 @item <@r{, }>
16170 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16171 types.
16172
16173 @item <=@r{, }>=
16174 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16175 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16176 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16177
16178 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16179 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16180 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16181 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16182 comment character.
16183
16184 @item IN
16185 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16186 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16187
16188 @item OR
16189 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16190
16191 @item AND@r{, }&
16192 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16193
16194 @item @@
16195 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16196
16197 @item +@r{, }-
16198 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16199 and difference on set types.
16200
16201 @item *
16202 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16203 on set types.
16204
16205 @item /
16206 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16207 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16208
16209 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16210 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16211 precedence as @code{*}.
16212
16213 @item -
16214 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16215
16216 @item ^
16217 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16218
16219 @item NOT
16220 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16221 @code{^}.
16222
16223 @item .
16224 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16225 precedence as @code{^}.
16226
16227 @item []
16228 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16229
16230 @item ()
16231 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16232 as @code{^}.
16233
16234 @item ::@r{, }.
16235 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16236 @end table
16237
16238 @quotation
16239 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16240 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16241 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16242 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16243 @end quotation
16244
16245
16246 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16247 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16248 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16249
16250 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16251 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16252
16253 @table @var
16254
16255 @item a
16256 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16257
16258 @item c
16259 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16260
16261 @item i
16262 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16263
16264 @item m
16265 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16266 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16267 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16268
16269 @item n
16270 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16271
16272 @item r
16273 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16274
16275 @item t
16276 represents a type.
16277
16278 @item v
16279 represents a variable.
16280
16281 @item x
16282 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16283 explanation of the function for details.
16284 @end table
16285
16286 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16287
16288 @table @code
16289 @item ABS(@var{n})
16290 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16291
16292 @item CAP(@var{c})
16293 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16294 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16295
16296 @item CHR(@var{i})
16297 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16298
16299 @item DEC(@var{v})
16300 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16301
16302 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16303 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16304 new value.
16305
16306 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16307 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16308 set.
16309
16310 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16311 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16312
16313 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16314 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16315
16316 @item INC(@var{v})
16317 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16318
16319 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16320 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16321 new value.
16322
16323 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16324 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16325 there. Returns the new set.
16326
16327 @item MAX(@var{t})
16328 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16329
16330 @item MIN(@var{t})
16331 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16332
16333 @item ODD(@var{i})
16334 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16335
16336 @item ORD(@var{x})
16337 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16338 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16339 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16340 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16341
16342 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16343 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16344 variable or a type.
16345
16346 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16347 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16348
16349 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16350 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16351 variable or a type.
16352
16353 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16354 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16355 @end table
16356
16357 @quotation
16358 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16359 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16360 an error.
16361 @end quotation
16362
16363 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16364 @node M2 Constants
16365 @subsubsection Constants
16366
16367 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16368 ways:
16369
16370 @itemize @bullet
16371
16372 @item
16373 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16374 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16375 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16376 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16377
16378 @item
16379 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16380 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16381 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16382 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16383 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16384 digits.
16385
16386 @item
16387 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16388 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16389 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16390 followed by a @samp{C}.
16391
16392 @item
16393 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16394 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16395 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16396 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16397 sequences.
16398
16399 @item
16400 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16401
16402 @item
16403 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16404 @code{FALSE}.
16405
16406 @item
16407 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16408
16409 @item
16410 Set constants are not yet supported.
16411 @end itemize
16412
16413 @node M2 Types
16414 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16415 @cindex Modula-2 types
16416
16417 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16418 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16419 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16420 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16421 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16422 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16423
16424 The first example contains the following section of code:
16425
16426 @smallexample
16427 VAR
16428 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16429 r: [20..40] ;
16430 @end smallexample
16431
16432 @noindent
16433 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16434 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16435
16436 @smallexample
16437 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16438 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16439 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16440 SET OF CHAR
16441 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16442 21
16443 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16444 [20..40]
16445 @end smallexample
16446
16447 @noindent
16448 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16449
16450 @smallexample
16451 VAR
16452 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16453 @end smallexample
16454
16455 @noindent
16456 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16457
16458 @smallexample
16459 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16460 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16461 @end smallexample
16462
16463 @noindent
16464 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16465 expressions using the debugger.
16466
16467 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16468 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16469
16470 @smallexample
16471 VAR
16472 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16473 @end smallexample
16474
16475 @smallexample
16476 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16477 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16478 @end smallexample
16479
16480 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16481 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16482 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16483 above.
16484
16485 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16486
16487 @smallexample
16488 TYPE
16489 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16490 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16491 VAR
16492 s: t ;
16493 BEGIN
16494 s := blue ;
16495 @end smallexample
16496
16497 @noindent
16498 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16499 and value of a variable.
16500
16501 @smallexample
16502 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16503 $1 = blue
16504 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16505 type = [blue..yellow]
16506 @end smallexample
16507
16508 @noindent
16509 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16510 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16511 their @code{C} counterparts.
16512
16513 @smallexample
16514 VAR
16515 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16516 BEGIN
16517 s[1] := 1 ;
16518 @end smallexample
16519
16520 @smallexample
16521 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16522 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16523 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16524 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16525 @end smallexample
16526
16527 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16528 pointer types as shown in this example:
16529
16530 @smallexample
16531 VAR
16532 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16533 BEGIN
16534 NEW(s) ;
16535 s^[1] := 1 ;
16536 @end smallexample
16537
16538 @noindent
16539 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16540
16541 @smallexample
16542 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16543 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16544 @end smallexample
16545
16546 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16547 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16548 types:
16549
16550 @smallexample
16551 TYPE
16552 foo = RECORD
16553 f1: CARDINAL ;
16554 f2: CHAR ;
16555 f3: myarray ;
16556 END ;
16557
16558 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16559 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16560 VAR
16561 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16562 @end smallexample
16563
16564 @noindent
16565 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16566 below.
16567
16568 @smallexample
16569 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16570 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16571 f1 : CARDINAL;
16572 f2 : CHAR;
16573 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16574 END
16575 @end smallexample
16576
16577 @node M2 Defaults
16578 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16579 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16580
16581 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16582 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16583 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16584 selected the working language.
16585
16586 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16587 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16588 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16589 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16590
16591 @node Deviations
16592 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16593 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16594
16595 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16596 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16597
16598 @itemize @bullet
16599 @item
16600 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16601 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16602 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16603 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16604 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16605 returned a pointer.)
16606
16607 @item
16608 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16609 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16610 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16611 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16612
16613 @item
16614 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16615 argument.
16616
16617 @item
16618 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16619 @end itemize
16620
16621 @node M2 Checks
16622 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16623 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16624
16625 @quotation
16626 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16627 range checking.
16628 @end quotation
16629 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16630
16631 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16632
16633 @itemize @bullet
16634 @item
16635 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16636 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16637
16638 @item
16639 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16640 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16641 @end itemize
16642
16643 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16644 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16645
16646 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16647 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16648
16649 @node M2 Scope
16650 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16651 @cindex scope
16652 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16653 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16654 @ifinfo
16655 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16656 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16657 @end ifinfo
16658 @ifnotinfo
16659 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16660 @end ifnotinfo
16661
16662 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16663 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16664 similar syntax:
16665
16666 @smallexample
16667
16668 @var{module} . @var{id}
16669 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16670 @end smallexample
16671
16672 @noindent
16673 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16674 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16675 identifier within your program, except another module.
16676
16677 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16678 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16679 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16680 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16681
16682 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16683 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16684 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16685 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16686 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16687 @var{module}.
16688
16689 @node GDB/M2
16690 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16691
16692 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16693 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16694 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16695 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16696 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16697 analogue in Modula-2.
16698
16699 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16700 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16701 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16702 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16703 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16704 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16705
16706 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16707 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16708 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16709
16710 @node Ada
16711 @subsection Ada
16712 @cindex Ada
16713
16714 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16715 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16716 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16717 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16718 to be difficult.
16719
16720
16721 @cindex expressions in Ada
16722 @menu
16723 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16724 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16725 in @value{GDBN}.
16726 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16727 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16728 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16729 subprograms.
16730 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16731 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16732 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16733 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16734 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16735 Profile
16736 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16737 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16738 @end menu
16739
16740 @node Ada Mode Intro
16741 @subsubsection Introduction
16742 @cindex Ada mode, general
16743
16744 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16745 syntax, with some extensions.
16746 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16747
16748 @itemize @bullet
16749 @item
16750 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16751 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16752 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16753 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16754
16755 @item
16756 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16757 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16758
16759 @item
16760 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16761 @end itemize
16762
16763 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16764 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16765 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16766 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16767 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16768
16769 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16770 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16771 was translated from an Ada source file.
16772
16773 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16774 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16775 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16776 middle (to allow based literals).
16777
16778 @node Omissions from Ada
16779 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16780 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16781
16782 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16783
16784 @itemize @bullet
16785 @item
16786 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16787
16788 @itemize @minus
16789 @item
16790 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16791 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16792
16793 @item
16794 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16795
16796 @item
16797 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16798
16799 @item
16800 @t{'Tag}.
16801
16802 @item
16803 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16804 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16805
16806 @item
16807 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16808 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16809
16810 @item
16811 @t{'Address}.
16812 @end itemize
16813
16814 @item
16815 The names in
16816 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16817 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16818 not currently available.
16819
16820 @item
16821 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16822 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16823 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16824 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16825 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16826 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16827 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16828 indeterminate values.
16829
16830 @item
16831 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16832 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16833 are not implemented.
16834
16835 @item
16836 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16837 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16838 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16839 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16840 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16841
16842 @smallexample
16843 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16844 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16845 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16846 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16847 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16848 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16849 @end smallexample
16850
16851 Changing a
16852 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16853 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16854 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16855 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16856 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16857 declared to have a type such as:
16858
16859 @smallexample
16860 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16861 Id : Integer;
16862 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16863 end record;
16864 @end smallexample
16865
16866 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16867 assignments:
16868
16869 @smallexample
16870 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16871 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16872 @end smallexample
16873
16874 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16875 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16876 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16877 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16878 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16879 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16880 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16881 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16882
16883 @item
16884 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16885
16886 @item
16887 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16888 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16889 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16890 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16891 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16892 the proper resolution.
16893
16894 @item
16895 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16896
16897 @item
16898 Entry calls are not implemented.
16899
16900 @item
16901 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16902 formats are not supported.
16903
16904 @item
16905 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16906
16907 @item
16908 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16909 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16910 context.
16911 Should your program
16912 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16913 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16914 @end itemize
16915
16916 @node Additions to Ada
16917 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16918 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16919
16920 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16921 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16922
16923 @itemize @bullet
16924 @item
16925 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16926 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16927 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16928 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16929 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16930 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16931 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16932 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16933
16934 @item
16935 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16936 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16937 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16938
16939 @item
16940 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16941 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16942
16943 @item
16944 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16945 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16946 @end itemize
16947
16948 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16949 additions specific to Ada:
16950
16951 @itemize @bullet
16952 @item
16953 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16954 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16955
16956 @smallexample
16957 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16958 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16959 @end smallexample
16960
16961 @item
16962 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16963 the value of its right-hand operand.
16964 This allows, for example,
16965 complex conditional breaks:
16966
16967 @smallexample
16968 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16969 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16970 @end smallexample
16971
16972 @item
16973 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16974 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16975 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16976 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16977 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16978 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16979 in strings. For example,
16980 @smallexample
16981 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16982 @end smallexample
16983 @noindent
16984 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16985 after each period.
16986
16987 @item
16988 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16989 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16990 to write
16991
16992 @smallexample
16993 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16994 @end smallexample
16995
16996 @item
16997 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16998 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16999 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
17000 of 3 might print as
17001
17002 @smallexample
17003 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
17004 @end smallexample
17005
17006 @noindent
17007 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
17008 clause.
17009
17010 @item
17011 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
17012 multi-character subsequence of
17013 their names (an exact match gets preference).
17014 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
17015 in place of @t{a'length}.
17016
17017 @item
17018 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
17019 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
17020 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
17021 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
17022 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
17023 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
17024 For example,
17025 @smallexample
17026 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
17027 @end smallexample
17028
17029 @item
17030 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
17031 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
17032 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
17033 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
17034 object.
17035
17036 @end itemize
17037
17038 @node Overloading support for Ada
17039 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
17040 @cindex overloading, Ada
17041
17042 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
17043 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
17044 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
17045 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
17046 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
17047 functions to procedures elsewhere.
17048
17049 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
17050 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
17051 use, for instance:
17052
17053 @smallexample
17054 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
17055 Multiple matches for f
17056 [0] cancel
17057 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
17058 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
17059 >
17060 @end smallexample
17061
17062 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
17063 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
17064 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
17065
17066 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
17067 case:
17068
17069 @table @code
17070
17071 @kindex set ada print-signatures
17072 @item set ada print-signatures
17073 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
17074 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
17075 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17076
17077 @kindex show ada print-signatures
17078 @item show ada print-signatures
17079 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
17080 overloads selection menu.
17081 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17082
17083 @end table
17084
17085 @node Stopping Before Main Program
17086 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
17087
17088 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
17089 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
17090 before reaching the main procedure.
17091 As defined in the Ada Reference
17092 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
17093 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
17094 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
17095 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
17096
17097 @node Ada Exceptions
17098 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
17099
17100 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
17101
17102 @table @code
17103 @kindex info exceptions
17104 @item info exceptions
17105 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
17106 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
17107 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
17108 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
17109 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
17110 @end table
17111
17112 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
17113 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
17114 argument.
17115
17116 @smallexample
17117 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
17118 All defined Ada exceptions:
17119 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17120 program_error: 0x613d20
17121 storage_error: 0x613ce0
17122 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
17123 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17124 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
17125 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
17126 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17127 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17128 @end smallexample
17129
17130 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
17131 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
17132
17133 @node Ada Tasks
17134 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
17135 @cindex Ada, tasking
17136
17137 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
17138 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
17139
17140 @table @code
17141 @kindex info tasks
17142 @item info tasks
17143 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
17144
17145
17146 @smallexample
17147 @iftex
17148 @leftskip=0.5cm
17149 @end iftex
17150 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17151 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17152 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17153 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17154 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17155 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17156
17157 @end smallexample
17158
17159 @noindent
17160 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17161 task currently being inspected.
17162
17163 @table @asis
17164 @item ID
17165 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17166
17167 @item TID
17168 The Ada task ID.
17169
17170 @item P-ID
17171 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17172
17173 @item Pri
17174 The base priority of the task.
17175
17176 @item State
17177 Current state of the task.
17178
17179 @table @code
17180 @item Unactivated
17181 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17182 executing.
17183
17184 @item Runnable
17185 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17186 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17187
17188 @item Terminated
17189 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17190 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17191 terminated themselves.
17192
17193 @item Child Activation Wait
17194 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17195
17196 @item Accept Statement
17197 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17198
17199 @item Waiting on entry call
17200 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17201
17202 @item Async Select Wait
17203 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17204 select statement.
17205
17206 @item Delay Sleep
17207 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17208 alternative open.
17209
17210 @item Child Termination Wait
17211 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17212 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17213 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17214
17215 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17216 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17217 finish terminating.
17218
17219 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17220 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17221 @end table
17222
17223 @item Name
17224 Name of the task in the program.
17225
17226 @end table
17227
17228 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17229 @item info task @var{taskno}
17230 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17231 the following example:
17232 @smallexample
17233 @iftex
17234 @leftskip=0.5cm
17235 @end iftex
17236 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17237 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17238 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17239 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17240 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17241 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17242 Name: task_1
17243 Thread: 0
17244 LWP: 0x1fac
17245 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17246 Base Priority: 15
17247 State: Runnable
17248 @end smallexample
17249
17250 @item task
17251 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17252 @cindex current Ada task ID
17253 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17254
17255 @smallexample
17256 @iftex
17257 @leftskip=0.5cm
17258 @end iftex
17259 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17260 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17261 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17262 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17263 (@value{GDBP}) task
17264 [Current task is 2]
17265 @end smallexample
17266
17267 @item task @var{taskno}
17268 @cindex Ada task switching
17269 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17270 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17271 from the current task to the given task.
17272
17273 @smallexample
17274 @iftex
17275 @leftskip=0.5cm
17276 @end iftex
17277 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17278 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17279 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17280 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17281 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17282 [Switching to task 1]
17283 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17284 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17285 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17286 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17287 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17288 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17289 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17290 @end smallexample
17291
17292 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17293 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17294 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17295 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17296 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17297 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17298 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17299 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17300 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17301
17302 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17303 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17304 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17305 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17306 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17307
17308 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17309 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17310 program.
17311
17312 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17313 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17314 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17315
17316 For example,
17317
17318 @smallexample
17319 @iftex
17320 @leftskip=0.5cm
17321 @end iftex
17322 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17323 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17324 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17325 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17326 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17327 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17328 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17329 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17330 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17331 Continuing.
17332 task # 1 running
17333 task # 2 running
17334
17335 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17336 15 flush;
17337 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17338 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17339 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17340 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17341 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17342 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17343 @end smallexample
17344 @end table
17345
17346 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17347 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17348 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17349
17350 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17351 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17352 the platform being used.
17353 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17354 switching is not supported.
17355
17356 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17357 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17358 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17359 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17360 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17361 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17362
17363 @node Ravenscar Profile
17364 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17365 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17366
17367 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17368 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17369 requirements.
17370
17371 @table @code
17372 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17373 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17374 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17375 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17376 Profile. This is the default.
17377
17378 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17379 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17380 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17381 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17382 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17383 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17384 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17385
17386 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17387 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17388 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17389 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17390
17391 @end table
17392
17393 @node Ada Settings
17394 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17395 @cindex Ada settings
17396
17397 @table @code
17398 @kindex set varsize-limit
17399 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17400 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17401 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17402 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17403 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17404 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17405 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17406
17407 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17408 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17409 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17410 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17411 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17412 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17413 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17414 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17415 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17416 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17417 size is less than @var{size}.
17418
17419 @kindex show varsize-limit
17420 @item show varsize-limit
17421 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17422 @end table
17423
17424 @node Ada Glitches
17425 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17426 @cindex Ada, problems
17427
17428 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17429 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17430 @value{GDBN},
17431 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17432 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17433
17434 @itemize @bullet
17435 @item
17436 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17437 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17438
17439 @item
17440 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17441 argument lists are treated as positional).
17442
17443 @item
17444 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17445
17446 @item
17447 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17448 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17449 the host machine.
17450
17451 @item
17452 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17453 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17454 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17455 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17456 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17457 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17458 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17459 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17460 you can usually resolve the confusion
17461 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17462 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17463 @end itemize
17464
17465 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17466 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17467 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17468 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17469 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17470 enabled.
17471
17472 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17473 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17474 @table @code
17475
17476 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17477 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17478 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17479 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17480 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17481 This is the default.
17482
17483 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17484 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17485 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17486 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17487 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17488 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17489 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17490
17491 @end table
17492
17493 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17494 @cindex GNAT encoding
17495 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17496 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17497 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17498 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17499 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17500 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17501
17502 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17503 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17504 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17505 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17506 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17507 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17508 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17509 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17510
17511 @table @code
17512
17513 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17514 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17515 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17516 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17517
17518 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17519 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17520 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17521
17522 @end table
17523
17524 @node Unsupported Languages
17525 @section Unsupported Languages
17526
17527 @cindex unsupported languages
17528 @cindex minimal language
17529 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17530 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17531 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17532 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17533 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17534 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17535
17536 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17537 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17538 language.
17539
17540 @node Symbols
17541 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17542
17543 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17544 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17545 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17546 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17547 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17548 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17549 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17550
17551 @cindex symbol names
17552 @cindex names of symbols
17553 @cindex quoting names
17554 @anchor{quoting names}
17555 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17556 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17557 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17558 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17559 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17560 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17561 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17562 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17563
17564 @smallexample
17565 p 'foo.c'::x
17566 @end smallexample
17567
17568 @noindent
17569 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17570
17571 @table @code
17572 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17573 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17574 @kindex set case-sensitive
17575 @item set case-sensitive on
17576 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17577 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17578 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17579 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17580 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17581 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17582 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17583 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17584 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17585 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17586 case-insensitive matches.
17587
17588 @kindex show case-sensitive
17589 @item show case-sensitive
17590 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17591 lookups.
17592
17593 @kindex set print type methods
17594 @item set print type methods
17595 @itemx set print type methods on
17596 @itemx set print type methods off
17597 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17598 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17599 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17600 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17601 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17602 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17603
17604 @kindex show print type methods
17605 @item show print type methods
17606 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17607 classes.
17608
17609 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17610 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17611 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17612 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17613 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17614 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17615 types defined in classes.
17616
17617 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17618 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17619 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17620 printing classes.
17621
17622 @kindex set print type typedefs
17623 @item set print type typedefs
17624 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17625 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17626
17627 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17628 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17629 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17630 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17631 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17632 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17633 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17634 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17635 types.
17636
17637 @kindex show print type typedefs
17638 @item show print type typedefs
17639 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17640 printing classes.
17641
17642 @kindex info address
17643 @cindex address of a symbol
17644 @item info address @var{symbol}
17645 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17646 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17647 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17648 is always stored.
17649
17650 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17651 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17652 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17653
17654 @kindex info symbol
17655 @cindex symbol from address
17656 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17657 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17658 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17659 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17660 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17661
17662 @smallexample
17663 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17664 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17665 @end smallexample
17666
17667 @noindent
17668 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17669 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17670
17671 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17672 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17673
17674 @smallexample
17675 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17676 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17677 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17678 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17679 @end smallexample
17680
17681 @kindex demangle
17682 @cindex demangle
17683 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17684 Demangle @var{name}.
17685 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17686 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17687
17688 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17689 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17690
17691 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17692 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17693
17694 @kindex whatis
17695 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17696 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17697 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17698 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17699
17700 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17701 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17702 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17703
17704 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17705 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17706 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17707 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17708 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17709 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17710 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17711 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17712 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17713
17714 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17715 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17716 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17717 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17718 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17719 unroll it.
17720
17721 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17722 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17723 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17724
17725 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17726 Available flags are:
17727
17728 @table @code
17729 @item r
17730 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17731 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17732 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17733
17734 @item m
17735 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17736
17737 @item M
17738 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17739 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17740
17741 @item t
17742 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17743 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17744 names are substituted when printing other types.
17745
17746 @item T
17747 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17748 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17749
17750 @item o
17751 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17752 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17753
17754 For example, given the following declarations:
17755
17756 @smallexample
17757 struct tuv
17758 @{
17759 int a1;
17760 char *a2;
17761 int a3;
17762 @};
17763
17764 struct xyz
17765 @{
17766 int f1;
17767 char f2;
17768 void *f3;
17769 struct tuv f4;
17770 @};
17771
17772 union qwe
17773 @{
17774 struct tuv fff1;
17775 struct xyz fff2;
17776 @};
17777
17778 struct tyu
17779 @{
17780 int a1 : 1;
17781 int a2 : 3;
17782 int a3 : 23;
17783 char a4 : 2;
17784 int64_t a5;
17785 int a6 : 5;
17786 int64_t a7 : 3;
17787 @};
17788 @end smallexample
17789
17790 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17791
17792 @smallexample
17793 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17794 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17795 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17796 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17797 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17798 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17799
17800 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17801 @}
17802 @end smallexample
17803
17804 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17805 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17806 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17807 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17808 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17809 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17810 its fields.
17811
17812 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17813
17814 @smallexample
17815 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17816 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17817 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17818 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17819 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17820 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17821 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17822
17823 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17824 @} fff1;
17825 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17826 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17827 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17828 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17829 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17830 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17831 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17832 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17833 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17834 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17835
17836 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17837 @} f4;
17838
17839 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17840 @} fff2;
17841
17842 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17843 @}
17844 @end smallexample
17845
17846 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17847 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17848 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17849 of these structures' fields.
17850
17851 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17852 bitfields:
17853
17854 @smallexample
17855 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17856 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17857 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17858 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17859 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17860 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17861 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17862 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17863 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17864 /* 16: 0 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17865 /* 16: 5 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17866 "/* XXX 7-byte padding */
17867
17868 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17869 @}
17870 @end smallexample
17871
17872 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include the
17873 first bit of the bitfield.
17874 @end table
17875
17876 @kindex ptype
17877 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17878 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17879 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17880 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17881
17882 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17883 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17884 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17885 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17886 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17887 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17888 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17889 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17890
17891 For example, for this variable declaration:
17892
17893 @smallexample
17894 typedef double real_t;
17895 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17896 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17897 complex_t var;
17898 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17899 @end smallexample
17900
17901 @noindent
17902 the two commands give this output:
17903
17904 @smallexample
17905 @group
17906 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17907 type = complex_t
17908 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17909 type = struct complex @{
17910 real_t real;
17911 double imag;
17912 @}
17913 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17914 type = struct complex
17915 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17916 type = struct complex
17917 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17918 type = struct complex @{
17919 real_t real;
17920 double imag;
17921 @}
17922 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17923 type = real_t *
17924 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17925 type = double *
17926 @end group
17927 @end smallexample
17928
17929 @noindent
17930 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17931 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17932
17933 @cindex incomplete type
17934 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17935 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17936 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17937 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17938 given these declarations:
17939
17940 @smallexample
17941 struct foo;
17942 struct foo *fooptr;
17943 @end smallexample
17944
17945 @noindent
17946 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17947
17948 @smallexample
17949 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17950 $1 = <incomplete type>
17951 @end smallexample
17952
17953 @noindent
17954 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17955 completely specified.
17956
17957 @cindex unknown type
17958 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17959 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17960 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17961 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17962 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17963 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17964 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17965 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17966
17967 @smallexample
17968 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17969 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17970 @end smallexample
17971
17972 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17973 of such variables.
17974
17975 @kindex info types
17976 @item info types @var{regexp}
17977 @itemx info types
17978 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17979 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17980 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17981 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17982 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17983 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17984 name is @code{value}.
17985
17986 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
17987 to print the type description according to the
17988 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
17989 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
17990 language of the type, other values mean to use
17991 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
17992
17993 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17994 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17995 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17996
17997 @kindex info type-printers
17998 @item info type-printers
17999 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
18000 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
18001 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
18002 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
18003 type printers.
18004
18005 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
18006
18007 @kindex enable type-printer
18008 @kindex disable type-printer
18009 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
18010 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
18011 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
18012
18013 @kindex info scope
18014 @cindex local variables
18015 @item info scope @var{location}
18016 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
18017 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
18018 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
18019 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
18020 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
18021
18022 @smallexample
18023 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
18024 Scope for command_line_handler:
18025 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
18026 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
18027 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
18028 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
18029 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
18030 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
18031 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
18032 @end smallexample
18033
18034 @noindent
18035 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
18036 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
18037 collect}.
18038
18039 @kindex info source
18040 @item info source
18041 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
18042 the function containing the current point of execution:
18043 @itemize @bullet
18044 @item
18045 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
18046 @item
18047 the directory it was compiled in,
18048 @item
18049 its length, in lines,
18050 @item
18051 which programming language it is written in,
18052 @item
18053 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
18054 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
18055 @item
18056 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
18057 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
18058 @item
18059 whether the debugging information includes information about
18060 preprocessor macros.
18061 @end itemize
18062
18063
18064 @kindex info sources
18065 @item info sources
18066 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
18067 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
18068 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
18069
18070 @kindex info functions
18071 @item info functions [-q]
18072 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
18073 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
18074 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
18075 number.
18076
18077 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18078 to print the function name and type according to the
18079 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18080 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18081 language of the function, other values mean to use
18082 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18083
18084 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18085 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
18086 have been printed.
18087
18088 @item info functions [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18089 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types
18090 of the functions selected with the provided regexp(s).
18091
18092 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose names
18093 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18094 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
18095 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
18096 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
18097 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
18098 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
18099
18100 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose
18101 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18102 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18103 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18104 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18105 of special characters or quotes.
18106 Thus, @samp{info fun -t '^int ('} finds the functions that return
18107 an integer; @samp{info fun -t '(.*int.*'} finds the functions that
18108 have an argument type containing int; @samp{info fun -t '^int (' ^step}
18109 finds the functions whose names start with @code{step} and that return
18110 int.
18111
18112 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a function
18113 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18114 @var{type_regexp}.
18115
18116
18117 @kindex info variables
18118 @item info variables [-q]
18119 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
18120 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
18121 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
18122 their respective source line numbers.
18123
18124 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18125 to print the variable name and type according to the
18126 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18127 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18128 language of the variable, other values mean to use
18129 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18130
18131 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18132 printing header information and messages explaining why no variables
18133 have been printed.
18134
18135 @item info variables [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18136 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the variables selected
18137 with the provided regexp(s).
18138
18139 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose names
18140 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18141
18142 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose
18143 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18144 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18145 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18146 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18147 of special characters or quotes.
18148
18149 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
18150 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18151 @var{type_regexp}.
18152
18153 @kindex info classes
18154 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
18155 @item info classes
18156 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
18157 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
18158 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18159 expression.
18160
18161 @kindex info selectors
18162 @item info selectors
18163 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
18164 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
18165 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18166 expression.
18167
18168 @ignore
18169 This was never implemented.
18170 @kindex info methods
18171 @item info methods
18172 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
18173 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
18174 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
18175 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
18176 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
18177 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
18178 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
18179 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
18180 @end ignore
18181
18182 @cindex opaque data types
18183 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
18184 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
18185 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
18186 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
18187 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
18188 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
18189 another source file. The default is on.
18190
18191 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
18192 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
18193
18194 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
18195 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
18196 is printed as follows:
18197 @smallexample
18198 @{<no data fields>@}
18199 @end smallexample
18200
18201 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
18202 @item show opaque-type-resolution
18203 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
18204
18205 @kindex set print symbol-loading
18206 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
18207 @item set print symbol-loading
18208 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18209 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18210 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18211 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18212 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18213 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18214 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18215 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18216 can be annoying.
18217 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18218 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18219 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18220 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18221
18222 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18223 @item show print symbol-loading
18224 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18225 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18226
18227 @kindex maint print symbols
18228 @cindex symbol dump
18229 @kindex maint print psymbols
18230 @cindex partial symbol dump
18231 @kindex maint print msymbols
18232 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18233 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18234 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18235 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18236 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18237 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18238 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18239 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18240 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18241 that objfile.
18242 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18243 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18244 @code{main}.
18245 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18246 source file.
18247
18248 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18249 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18250 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18251 tables.
18252 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18253 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18254 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18255 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18256 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18257 ``ELF symbols''.
18258
18259 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18260 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18261
18262 @kindex maint info symtabs
18263 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18264 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18265 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18266 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18267 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18268 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18269 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18270
18271 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18272 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18273 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18274 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18275 structure in more detail. For example:
18276
18277 @smallexample
18278 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18279 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18280 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18281 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18282 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18283 readin no
18284 fullname (null)
18285 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18286 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18287 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18288 dependencies (none)
18289 @}
18290 @}
18291 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18292 (@value{GDBP})
18293 @end smallexample
18294 @noindent
18295 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18296 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18297 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18298 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18299 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18300
18301 @smallexample
18302 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18303 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18304 line 1574.
18305 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18306 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18307 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18308 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18309 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18310 dirname (null)
18311 fullname (null)
18312 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18313 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18314 debugformat DWARF 2
18315 @}
18316 @}
18317 (@value{GDBP})
18318 @end smallexample
18319
18320 @kindex maint info line-table
18321 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18322 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18323 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18324
18325 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18326 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18327 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18328
18329 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18330 @cindex symbol cache size
18331 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18332 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18333 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18334 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18335 with different sizes.
18336
18337 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18338 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18339 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18340
18341 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18342 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18343 @item maint print symbol-cache
18344 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18345 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18346
18347 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18348 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18349 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18350 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18351 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18352
18353 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18354 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18355 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18356 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18357 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18358 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18359
18360 @end table
18361
18362 @node Altering
18363 @chapter Altering Execution
18364
18365 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18366 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18367 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18368 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18369 program.
18370
18371 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18372 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18373 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18374
18375 @menu
18376 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18377 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18378 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18379 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18380 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18381 * Patching:: Patching your program
18382 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18383 @end menu
18384
18385 @node Assignment
18386 @section Assignment to Variables
18387
18388 @cindex assignment
18389 @cindex setting variables
18390 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18391 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18392
18393 @smallexample
18394 print x=4
18395 @end smallexample
18396
18397 @noindent
18398 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18399 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18400 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18401 information on operators in supported languages.
18402
18403 @kindex set variable
18404 @cindex variables, setting
18405 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18406 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18407 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18408 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18409 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18410
18411 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18412 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18413 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18414 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18415 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18416 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18417 command @code{set width}:
18418
18419 @smallexample
18420 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18421 type = double
18422 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18423 $4 = 13
18424 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18425 Invalid syntax in expression.
18426 @end smallexample
18427
18428 @noindent
18429 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18430 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18431
18432 @smallexample
18433 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18434 @end smallexample
18435
18436 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18437 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18438 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18439 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18440 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18441 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18442
18443 @smallexample
18444 @group
18445 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18446 type = double
18447 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18448 $1 = 1
18449 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18450 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18451 $2 = 1
18452 (@value{GDBP}) r
18453 The program being debugged has been started already.
18454 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18455 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18456 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18457 Invalid bfd target.
18458 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18459 The current BFD target is "=4".
18460 @end group
18461 @end smallexample
18462
18463 @noindent
18464 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18465 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18466 @code{g}, use
18467
18468 @smallexample
18469 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18470 @end smallexample
18471
18472 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18473 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18474 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18475 same length or shorter.
18476 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18477 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18478
18479 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18480 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18481 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18482 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18483 and representation in memory), and
18484
18485 @smallexample
18486 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18487 @end smallexample
18488
18489 @noindent
18490 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18491
18492 @node Jumping
18493 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18494
18495 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18496 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18497 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18498
18499 @table @code
18500 @kindex jump
18501 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18502 @item jump @var{location}
18503 @itemx j @var{location}
18504 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18505 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18506 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18507 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18508 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18509
18510 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18511 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18512 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18513 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18514 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18515 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18516 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18517 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18518 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18519 @end table
18520
18521 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18522 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18523 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18524 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18525 example,
18526
18527 @smallexample
18528 set $pc = 0x485
18529 @end smallexample
18530
18531 @noindent
18532 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18533 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18534 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18535
18536 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18537 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18538 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18539 detail.
18540
18541 @c @group
18542 @node Signaling
18543 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18544 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18545
18546 @table @code
18547 @kindex signal
18548 @item signal @var{signal}
18549 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18550 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18551 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18552 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18553
18554 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18555 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18556 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18557 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18558 signal.
18559
18560 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18561 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18562 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18563 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18564 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18565 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18566 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18567 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18568
18569 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18570 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18571 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18572 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18573 passes the signal directly to your program.
18574
18575 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18576 after executing the command.
18577
18578 @kindex queue-signal
18579 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18580 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18581 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18582 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18583 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18584 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18585 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18586 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18587 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18588
18589 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18590 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18591 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18592 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18593 @code{continue} command.
18594
18595 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18596 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18597 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18598 (@pxref{Signals}).
18599 @end table
18600 @c @end group
18601
18602 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18603 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18604
18605 @node Returning
18606 @section Returning from a Function
18607
18608 @table @code
18609 @cindex returning from a function
18610 @kindex return
18611 @item return
18612 @itemx return @var{expression}
18613 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18614 command. If you give an
18615 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18616 value.
18617 @end table
18618
18619 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18620 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18621 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18622 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18623
18624 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18625 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18626 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18627 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18628 of functions.
18629
18630 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18631 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18632 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18633 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18634 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18635
18636 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18637 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18638 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18639 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18640 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18641 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18642 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18643 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18644 assignment into the right register(s).
18645
18646 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18647 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18648 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18649 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18650 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18651 into a @code{long long int}:
18652
18653 @smallexample
18654 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18655 29 return 31;
18656 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18657 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18658 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18659 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18660 (@value{GDBP})
18661 @end smallexample
18662
18663 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18664 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18665 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18666 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18667 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18668 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18669 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18670 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18671
18672 @smallexample
18673 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18674 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18675 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18676 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18677 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18678 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18679 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18680 (@value{GDBP})
18681 @end smallexample
18682
18683 @node Calling
18684 @section Calling Program Functions
18685
18686 @table @code
18687 @cindex calling functions
18688 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18689 @item print @var{expr}
18690 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18691 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18692 debugged.
18693
18694 @kindex call
18695 @item call @var{expr}
18696 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18697 returned values.
18698
18699 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18700 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18701 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18702 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18703 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18704 value history.
18705 @end table
18706
18707 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18708 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18709 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18710 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18711
18712 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18713 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18714 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18715 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18716 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18717 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18718 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18719 in that case is controlled by the
18720 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18721
18722 @table @code
18723 @item set unwindonsignal
18724 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18725 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18726 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18727 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18728 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18729 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18730 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18731 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18732 received.
18733
18734 @item show unwindonsignal
18735 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18736 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18737 @value{GDBN}.
18738
18739 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18740 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18741 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18742 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18743 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18744 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18745 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18746 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18747 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18748 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18749
18750 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18751 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18752 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18753 @value{GDBN}.
18754
18755 @item set may-call-functions
18756 @kindex set may-call-functions
18757 @cindex disabling calling functions in the program
18758 @cindex calling functions in the program, disabling
18759 Set permission to call functions in the program.
18760 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to call functions in
18761 the program, such as with expressions in the @code{print} command. It
18762 defaults to @code{on}.
18763
18764 To call a function in the program, @value{GDBN} has to temporarily
18765 modify the state of the inferior. This has potentially undesired side
18766 effects. Also, having @value{GDBN} call nested functions is likely to
18767 be erroneous and may even crash the program being debugged. You can
18768 avoid such hazards by forbidding @value{GDBN} from calling functions
18769 in the program being debugged. If calling functions in the program
18770 is forbidden, GDB will throw an error when a command (such as printing
18771 an expression) starts a function call in the program.
18772
18773 @item show may-call-functions
18774 @kindex show may-call-functions
18775 Show permission to call functions in the program.
18776
18777 @end table
18778
18779 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18780
18781 @cindex no debug info functions
18782 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18783 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18784 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18785 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18786 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18787 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18788
18789 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18790 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18791 declared return type. For example:
18792
18793 @smallexample
18794 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18795 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18796 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18797 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18798 @end smallexample
18799
18800 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18801 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18802 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18803 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18804
18805 @smallexample
18806 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18807 @end smallexample
18808
18809 @noindent
18810 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18811
18812 @smallexample
18813 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18814 @end smallexample
18815
18816 @noindent
18817 these calls are equivalent:
18818
18819 @smallexample
18820 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18821 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18822 @end smallexample
18823
18824 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18825 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18826 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18827 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18828 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18829 float parameters, and no debug info:
18830
18831 @smallexample
18832 float
18833 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18834 float v1, v2;
18835 @{
18836 return v1 * v2;
18837 @}
18838 @end smallexample
18839
18840 @noindent
18841 you call it like this:
18842
18843 @smallexample
18844 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18845 @end smallexample
18846
18847 @node Patching
18848 @section Patching Programs
18849
18850 @cindex patching binaries
18851 @cindex writing into executables
18852 @cindex writing into corefiles
18853
18854 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18855 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18856 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18857 patching your program's binary.
18858
18859 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18860 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18861 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18862 repairs.
18863
18864 @table @code
18865 @kindex set write
18866 @item set write on
18867 @itemx set write off
18868 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18869 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18870 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18871
18872 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18873 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18874 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18875
18876 @item show write
18877 @kindex show write
18878 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18879 as well as reading.
18880 @end table
18881
18882 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18883 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18884 @cindex injecting code
18885 @cindex writing into executables
18886 @cindex compiling code
18887
18888 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18889 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18890 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18891 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18892
18893 @table @code
18894 @kindex compile code
18895 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18896 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18897 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18898 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18899 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18900 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18901 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18902 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18903 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18904 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18905 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18906 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18907
18908 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18909 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18910 E.g.:
18911
18912 @smallexample
18913 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18914 @end smallexample
18915
18916 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18917 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18918 from actual source code. E.g.:
18919
18920 @smallexample
18921 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18922 @end smallexample
18923
18924 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18925 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18926 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18927 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18928 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18929 editor.
18930
18931 @smallexample
18932 compile code
18933 >printf ("hello\n");
18934 >printf ("world\n");
18935 >end
18936 @end smallexample
18937
18938 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18939 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18940 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18941 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18942 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18943 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18944 inferior symbols otherwise.
18945
18946 @kindex compile file
18947 @item compile file @var{filename}
18948 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18949 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18950
18951 @smallexample
18952 compile file /home/user/example.c
18953 @end smallexample
18954 @end table
18955
18956 @table @code
18957 @item compile print @var{expr}
18958 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18959 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18960 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18961 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18962 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18963 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18964 Formats}.
18965
18966 @item compile print
18967 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18968 @cindex reprint the last value
18969 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18970 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18971 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18972 multiple-line editor.
18973 @end table
18974
18975 @noindent
18976 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18977
18978 @table @code
18979 @anchor{set debug compile}
18980 @item set debug compile
18981 @cindex compile command debugging info
18982 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18983 injecting the code. The default is off.
18984
18985 @item show debug compile
18986 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18987 compiling and injecting the code.
18988
18989 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18990 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18991 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18992 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18993 The default is off.
18994
18995 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18996 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18997 C@t{++} type conversion.
18998 @end table
18999
19000 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
19001
19002 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
19003 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
19004 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
19005 injecting process.
19006
19007 @noindent
19008 The options used, in increasing precedence:
19009
19010 @table @asis
19011 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
19012 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
19013 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
19014 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
19015
19016 @item compilation options recorded in the target
19017 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
19018 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
19019 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
19020 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
19021 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
19022 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
19023 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
19024
19025 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
19026 @end table
19027
19028 @noindent
19029 You can override compilation options using the following command:
19030
19031 @table @code
19032 @item set compile-args
19033 @cindex compile command options override
19034 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
19035 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
19036 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
19037 compilation.
19038
19039 @item show compile-args
19040 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
19041 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
19042 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
19043 @end table
19044
19045 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
19046
19047 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
19048 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
19049 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
19050
19051 @table @asis
19052 @item C code examples and caveats
19053 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
19054 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
19055 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
19056 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
19057 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
19058
19059 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
19060 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
19061 much like any other normal debugging session.
19062
19063 @smallexample
19064 void function1 (void)
19065 @{
19066 int i = 42;
19067 printf ("function 1\n");
19068 @}
19069
19070 void function2 (void)
19071 @{
19072 int j = 12;
19073 function1 ();
19074 @}
19075
19076 int main(void)
19077 @{
19078 int k = 6;
19079 int *p;
19080 function2 ();
19081 return 0;
19082 @}
19083 @end smallexample
19084
19085 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
19086 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
19087 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
19088
19089 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
19090 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
19091 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
19092 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
19093 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
19094
19095 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
19096 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
19097 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
19098 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
19099 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
19100 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
19101 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
19102 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
19103 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
19104 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
19105
19106 @smallexample
19107 compile code k = 3;
19108 @end smallexample
19109
19110 @noindent
19111 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
19112 something else in the example program changes it, or another
19113 @code{compile} command changes it.
19114
19115 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
19116 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
19117 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
19118 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
19119 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
19120
19121 @smallexample
19122 compile code j = 3;
19123 @end smallexample
19124
19125 @noindent
19126 will result in a compilation error message.
19127
19128 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
19129 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
19130 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
19131
19132 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
19133 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
19134 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
19135 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
19136
19137 @smallexample
19138 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
19139 @end smallexample
19140
19141 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
19142 command has completed:
19143
19144 @smallexample
19145 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
19146 @end smallexample
19147
19148 @noindent
19149 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
19150 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
19151 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
19152 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
19153 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
19154
19155 @smallexample
19156 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
19157 @end smallexample
19158
19159 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
19160 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
19161 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
19162 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
19163 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
19164 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
19165 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
19166 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
19167
19168 @smallexample
19169 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
19170 @end smallexample
19171
19172 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
19173 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
19174 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
19175 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
19176 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
19177 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
19178 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
19179
19180 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
19181 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
19182 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
19183 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
19184 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
19185 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
19186
19187 @smallexample
19188 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
19189 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19190 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
19191 Compilation failed.
19192 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19193 42
19194 @end smallexample
19195
19196 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
19197 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
19198 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
19199 will print to the console.
19200 @end table
19201
19202 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
19203
19204 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
19205 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
19206 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
19207 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
19208 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
19209 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
19210 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
19211 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
19212
19213
19214 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
19215 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
19216 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
19217 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
19218 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
19219 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
19220 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
19221
19222 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
19223 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
19224 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
19225 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
19226 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
19227 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
19228 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
19229
19230 @table @code
19231 @item set compile-gcc
19232 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19233 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19234 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19235 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19236 default.
19237
19238 @item show compile-gcc
19239 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19240 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19241 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19242 @end table
19243
19244 @node GDB Files
19245 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19246
19247 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19248 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19249 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19250 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19251
19252 @menu
19253 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19254 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19255 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19256 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19257 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19258 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19259 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19260 @end menu
19261
19262 @node Files
19263 @section Commands to Specify Files
19264
19265 @cindex symbol table
19266 @cindex core dump file
19267
19268 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19269 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19270 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19271 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19272
19273 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19274 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19275 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19276 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19277 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19278 new files are useful.
19279
19280 @table @code
19281 @cindex executable file
19282 @kindex file
19283 @item file @var{filename}
19284 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19285 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19286 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19287 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19288 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19289 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19290 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19291 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19292
19293 @cindex unlinked object files
19294 @cindex patching object files
19295 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19296 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19297 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19298 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19299 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19300 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19301 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19302 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19303
19304 @item file
19305 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19306 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19307
19308 @kindex exec-file
19309 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19310 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19311 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19312 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19313 discard information on the executable file.
19314
19315 @kindex symbol-file
19316 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19317 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19318 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19319 table and program to run from the same file.
19320
19321 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19322 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19323 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19324 enabled.
19325
19326 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19327 program's symbol table.
19328
19329 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19330 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19331 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19332 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19333 @value{GDBN}.
19334
19335 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19336 executing it once.
19337
19338 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19339 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19340 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19341 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19342 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19343 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19344 optimized code.
19345
19346 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19347 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19348 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19349 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19350 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19351
19352 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19353 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19354 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19355 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19356 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19357 Warnings and Messages}.)
19358
19359 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19360 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19361 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19362 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19363 in stabs format.
19364
19365 @kindex readnow
19366 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19367 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19368 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19369 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19370 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19371 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19372 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19373 entire symbol table available.
19374
19375 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19376 @cindex never read symbols
19377 @cindex symbols, never read
19378 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19379 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19380 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19381 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19382 @xref{--readnever}.
19383
19384 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19385 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19386 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19387 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19388 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19389 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19390 @c files.
19391
19392 @kindex core-file
19393 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19394 @itemx core
19395 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19396 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19397 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19398 executable file itself for other parts.
19399
19400 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19401 to be used.
19402
19403 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19404 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19405 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19406 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19407 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19408
19409 @kindex add-symbol-file
19410 @cindex dynamic linking
19411 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19412 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19413 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19414 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19415 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19416 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19417 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19418 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19419 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19420 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19421 can be given as an expression.
19422
19423 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19424 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19425 specified explicitly.
19426
19427 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19428 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19429 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19430 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19431
19432 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19433
19434 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19435 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19436 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19437 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19438 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19439 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19440 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19441 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19442 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19443
19444 @itemize @bullet
19445 @item
19446 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19447 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19448 @item
19449 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19450 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19451 @item
19452 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19453 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19454 @end itemize
19455
19456 @noindent
19457 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19458 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19459 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19460 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19461 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19462 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19463 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19464 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19465 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19466 way.
19467
19468 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19469
19470 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19471 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19472 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19473 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19474 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19475 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19476
19477 @smallexample
19478 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19479 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19480 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19481 (y or n) y
19482 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19483 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19484 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19485 (gdb)
19486 @end smallexample
19487
19488
19489 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19490
19491 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19492 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19493 @cindex load symbols from memory
19494 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19495 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19496 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19497 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19498 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19499 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19500 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19501 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19502 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19503
19504 @kindex section
19505 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19506 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19507 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19508 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19509 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19510 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19511 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19512 their addresses.
19513
19514 @kindex info files
19515 @kindex info target
19516 @item info files
19517 @itemx info target
19518 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19519 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19520 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19521 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19522 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19523 current ones.
19524
19525 @kindex maint info sections
19526 @item maint info sections
19527 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19528 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19529 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19530 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19531 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19532 may be arbitrarily combined):
19533
19534 @table @code
19535 @item ALLOBJ
19536 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19537 @item @var{sections}
19538 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19539 @item @var{section-flags}
19540 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19541 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19542 @table @code
19543 @item ALLOC
19544 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19545 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19546 @item LOAD
19547 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19548 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19549 @item RELOC
19550 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19551 @item READONLY
19552 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19553 @item CODE
19554 Section contains executable code only.
19555 @item DATA
19556 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19557 @item ROM
19558 Section will reside in ROM.
19559 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19560 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19561 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19562 Section is not empty.
19563 @item NEVER_LOAD
19564 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19565 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19566 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19567 COFF shared library information.
19568 @item IS_COMMON
19569 Section contains common symbols.
19570 @end table
19571 @end table
19572 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19573 @cindex read-only sections
19574 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19575 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19576 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19577 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19578 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19579 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19580 enhancement to debugging performance.
19581
19582 The default is off.
19583
19584 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19585 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19586 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19587 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19588
19589 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19590 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19591 @end table
19592
19593 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19594 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19595 name and remembers it that way.
19596
19597 @cindex shared libraries
19598 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19599 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19600 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19601 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19602
19603 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19604 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19605
19606 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19607 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19608 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19609 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19610 debugging a core file).
19611
19612 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19613 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19614 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19615
19616 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19617 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19618 particularly large or there are many of them.
19619
19620 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19621 commands:
19622
19623 @table @code
19624 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19625 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19626 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19627 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19628 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19629 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19630 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19631 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19632
19633 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19634 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19635 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19636 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19637 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19638 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19639 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19640 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19641 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19642
19643 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19644 @item show auto-solib-add
19645 Display the current autoloading mode.
19646 @end table
19647
19648 @cindex load shared library
19649 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19650 command:
19651
19652 @table @code
19653 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19654 @kindex info share
19655 @item info share @var{regex}
19656 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19657 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19658 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19659 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19660
19661 @kindex info dll
19662 @item info dll @var{regex}
19663 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19664
19665 @kindex sharedlibrary
19666 @kindex share
19667 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19668 @itemx share @var{regex}
19669 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19670 Unix regular expression.
19671 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19672 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19673 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19674 loaded.
19675
19676 @item nosharedlibrary
19677 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19678 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19679 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19680 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19681 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19682 discarded.
19683 @end table
19684
19685 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19686 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19687 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19688 Catchpoints}).
19689
19690 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19691 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19692 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19693 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19694
19695 @table @code
19696 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19697 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19698 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19699 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19700 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19701 shared library.
19702
19703 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19704 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19705 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19706 library events happen.
19707 @end table
19708
19709 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19710 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19711 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19712 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19713 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19714 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19715 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19716 not.
19717
19718 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19719 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19720 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19721 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19722 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19723
19724 @table @code
19725 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19726 @cindex system root, alternate
19727 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19728 @kindex set sysroot
19729 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19730 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19731 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19732 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19733 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19734 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19735 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19736 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19737 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19738 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19739 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19740 @var{path}.
19741
19742 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19743 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19744 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19745 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19746 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19747 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19748 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19749 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19750 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19751 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19752 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19753 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19754 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19755 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19756
19757 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19758 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19759 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19760 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19761 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19762
19763 @smallexample
19764 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19765 @end smallexample
19766
19767 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19768 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19769 system:
19770
19771 @smallexample
19772 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19773 @end smallexample
19774
19775 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19776 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19777 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19778 colons:
19779
19780 @smallexample
19781 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19782 @end smallexample
19783
19784 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19785 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19786 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19787 @samp{z}):
19788
19789 @smallexample
19790 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19791 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19792 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19793 @end smallexample
19794
19795 @noindent
19796 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19797 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19798 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19799
19800 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19801 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19802
19803 @smallexample
19804 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19805 @end smallexample
19806
19807 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19808 if you don't want or need to.
19809
19810 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19811 sysroot}.
19812
19813 @cindex default system root
19814 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19815 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19816 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19817 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19818 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19819 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19820 location.
19821
19822 @kindex show sysroot
19823 @item show sysroot
19824 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19825
19826 @kindex set solib-search-path
19827 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19828 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19829 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19830 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19831 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19832 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19833 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19834 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19835 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19836 of shared library symbols.
19837
19838 @kindex show solib-search-path
19839 @item show solib-search-path
19840 Display the current shared library search path.
19841
19842 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19843 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19844 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19845 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19846 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19847
19848 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19849 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19850 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19851 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19852 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19853 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19854 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19855 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19856 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19857 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19858 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19859 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19860 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19861 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19862 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19863 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19864 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19865 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19866 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19867 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19868 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19869 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19870
19871 @table @code
19872 @item unix
19873 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19874 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19875 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19876 the forward slash.
19877
19878 @item dos-based
19879 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19880 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19881 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19882 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19883 considered directory separators.
19884
19885 @item auto
19886 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19887 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19888 This is the default.
19889 @end table
19890 @end table
19891
19892 @cindex file name canonicalization
19893 @cindex base name differences
19894 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19895 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19896 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19897 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19898 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19899 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19900 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19901 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19902 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19903 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19904 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19905 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19906 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19907 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19908 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19909
19910 @table @code
19911 @item set basenames-may-differ
19912 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19913 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19914
19915 @item show basenames-may-differ
19916 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19917 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19918 @end table
19919
19920 @node File Caching
19921 @section File Caching
19922 @cindex caching of opened files
19923 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19924
19925 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19926 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19927 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19928 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19929
19930 @table @code
19931 @kindex maint info bfds
19932 @item maint info bfds
19933 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19934 @value{GDBN}.
19935
19936 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19937 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19938 @kindex bfd caching
19939 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19940 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19941 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19942 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19943 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19944 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19945 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19946 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19947 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19948
19949 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19950 @kindex bfd caching
19951 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19952 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19953
19954 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19955 @kindex bfd caching
19956 @item show debug bfd-cache
19957 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19958 @end table
19959
19960 @node Separate Debug Files
19961 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19962 @cindex separate debugging information files
19963 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19964 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19965 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19966 @cindex global debugging information directories
19967 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19968 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19969
19970 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19971 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19972 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19973 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19974 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19975 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19976 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19977
19978 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19979 file:
19980
19981 @itemize @bullet
19982 @item
19983 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19984 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19985 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19986 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19987 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19988 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19989 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19990 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19991
19992 @item
19993 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19994 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19995 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19996 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19997 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19998 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19999 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
20000 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
20001 below.
20002 @end itemize
20003
20004 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
20005 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
20006
20007 @itemize @bullet
20008 @item
20009 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
20010 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
20011 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the
20012 global debug directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to
20013 the leading directories of the executable's absolute file name. (On
20014 MS-Windows/MS-DOS, the drive letter of the executable's leading
20015 directories is converted to a one-letter subdirectory, i.e.@:
20016 @file{d:/usr/bin/} is converted to @file{/d/usr/bin/}, because Windows
20017 filesystems disallow colons in file names.)
20018
20019 @item
20020 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
20021 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
20022 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
20023 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
20024 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
20025 hex characters, not 10.)
20026 @end itemize
20027
20028 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
20029 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
20030 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
20031 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
20032 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
20033 debug information files, in the indicated order:
20034
20035 @itemize @minus
20036 @item
20037 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
20038 @item
20039 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
20040 @item
20041 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
20042 @item
20043 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
20044 @end itemize
20045
20046 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
20047 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
20048 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
20049 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
20050 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
20051
20052 @table @code
20053
20054 @kindex set debug-file-directory
20055 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
20056 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
20057 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
20058 concatenating them by a path separator.
20059
20060 @kindex show debug-file-directory
20061 @item show debug-file-directory
20062 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
20063 information files.
20064
20065 @end table
20066
20067 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
20068 @cindex debug link sections
20069 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
20070 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
20071
20072 @itemize
20073 @item
20074 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
20075 a zero byte,
20076 @item
20077 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
20078 boundary within the section, and
20079 @item
20080 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
20081 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
20082 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
20083 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
20084 @end itemize
20085
20086 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
20087 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
20088 described above.
20089
20090 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
20091 @cindex build ID sections
20092 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
20093 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
20094 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
20095 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
20096 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
20097 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
20098 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
20099 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
20100 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
20101
20102 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
20103 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
20104 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
20105 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
20106 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
20107 in an ordinary executable.
20108
20109 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
20110 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
20111 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
20112 following commands:
20113
20114 @smallexample
20115 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
20116 @kbd{strip -g foo}
20117 @end smallexample
20118
20119 @noindent
20120 These commands remove the debugging
20121 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
20122 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
20123 two files:
20124
20125 @itemize @bullet
20126 @item
20127 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
20128 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
20129
20130 @smallexample
20131 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
20132 @end smallexample
20133
20134 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
20135 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
20136 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
20137 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
20138
20139 @item
20140 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
20141 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
20142 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
20143 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
20144 @end itemize
20145
20146 @noindent
20147
20148 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
20149 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
20150 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
20151
20152 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
20153 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
20154 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
20155 @c different ways!
20156 @ifhtml
20157 @display
20158 @html
20159 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
20160 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
20161 @end html
20162 @end display
20163 @end ifhtml
20164 @ifnothtml
20165 @display
20166 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
20167 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
20168 @end display
20169 @end ifnothtml
20170
20171 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
20172 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
20173 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
20174 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
20175 CRC.
20176
20177 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
20178 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
20179 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
20180 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
20181 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
20182
20183 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
20184 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
20185 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
20186 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
20187 @code{0xffffffff}.
20188
20189 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
20190 @smallexample
20191 unsigned long
20192 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
20193 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
20194 @{
20195 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
20196 @{
20197 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
20198 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
20199 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
20200 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
20201 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
20202 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
20203 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
20204 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
20205 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
20206 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
20207 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
20208 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
20209 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
20210 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
20211 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
20212 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
20213 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
20214 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
20215 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
20216 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
20217 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
20218 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
20219 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
20220 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
20221 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
20222 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
20223 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
20224 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
20225 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
20226 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
20227 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
20228 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
20229 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
20230 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
20231 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
20232 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
20233 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
20234 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20235 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20236 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20237 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20238 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20239 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20240 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20241 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20242 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20243 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20244 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20245 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20246 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20247 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20248 0x2d02ef8d
20249 @};
20250 unsigned char *end;
20251
20252 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20253 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20254 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20255 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20256 @}
20257 @end smallexample
20258
20259 @noindent
20260 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20261
20262 @node MiniDebugInfo
20263 @section Debugging information in a special section
20264 @cindex separate debug sections
20265 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20266
20267 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20268 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20269 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20270 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20271
20272 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20273 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20274 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20275 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20276 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20277 debugging information might be included in the section.
20278
20279 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20280 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20281 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20282
20283 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20284 standard utilities:
20285
20286 @smallexample
20287 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20288 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20289 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20290 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20291
20292 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20293 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20294 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20295 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20296 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20297 | sort > funcsyms
20298
20299 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20300 # table.
20301 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20302
20303 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20304 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20305
20306 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20307 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20308 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20309 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20310
20311 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20312 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20313
20314 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20315 # original binary.
20316 xz mini_debuginfo
20317 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20318 @end smallexample
20319
20320 @node Index Files
20321 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20322 @cindex index files
20323 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20324
20325 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20326 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20327 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20328 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20329 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20330 startup.
20331
20332 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20333 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20334 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20335
20336 @smallexample
20337 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20338 @end smallexample
20339
20340 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20341
20342 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20343 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20344
20345 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20346 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20347 using @command{objcopy}.
20348
20349 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20350
20351 @table @code
20352 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20353 @kindex save gdb-index
20354 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20355 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20356 default creates it produces a single file
20357 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20358 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20359 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20360 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20361 given @var{directory}.
20362 @end table
20363
20364 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20365 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20366
20367 @smallexample
20368 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20369 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20370 @end smallexample
20371
20372 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20373
20374 @smallexample
20375 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20376 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20377 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20378 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20379 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20380 @end smallexample
20381
20382 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20383 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20384 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20385 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20386 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20387 The default is @code{off}.
20388 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20389 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20390
20391 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20392 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20393
20394 @smallexample
20395 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20396 @end smallexample
20397
20398 Instead you must do, for example,
20399
20400 @smallexample
20401 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20402 @end smallexample
20403
20404 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20405 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20406 currently work for programs using Ada.
20407
20408 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20409
20410 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20411 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20412 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20413 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20414
20415 @table @code
20416
20417 @item set index-cache on
20418 @itemx set index-cache off
20419 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20420
20421 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20422 @itemx show index-cache directory
20423 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20424
20425 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20426 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20427 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20428 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20429 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20430 differ according to local convention.
20431
20432 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20433 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20434
20435 @item show index-cache stats
20436 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20437
20438 @end table
20439
20440 @node Symbol Errors
20441 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20442
20443 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20444 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20445 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20446 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20447 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20448 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20449 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20450 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20451 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20452 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20453 Messages}).
20454
20455 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20456
20457 @table @code
20458 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20459
20460 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20461 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20462 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20463 in its outer scope blocks.
20464
20465 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20466 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20467 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20468 function.
20469
20470 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20471
20472 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20473 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20474 do so.
20475
20476 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20477 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20478 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20479 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20480 Messages}.)
20481
20482 @item bad block start address patched
20483
20484 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20485 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20486 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20487
20488 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20489 starting on the previous source line.
20490
20491 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20492
20493 @cindex foo
20494 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20495 larger than the size of the string table.
20496
20497 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20498 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20499 with this name.
20500
20501 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20502
20503 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20504 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20505 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20506
20507 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20508 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20509 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20510 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20511 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20512 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20513
20514 @item stub type has NULL name
20515
20516 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20517
20518 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20519 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20520 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20521 it.
20522
20523 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20524
20525 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20526
20527 @end table
20528
20529 @node Data Files
20530 @section GDB Data Files
20531
20532 @cindex prefix for data files
20533 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20534 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20535
20536 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20537 is currently using.
20538
20539 @table @code
20540 @kindex set data-directory
20541 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20542 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20543 to @var{directory}.
20544
20545 @kindex show data-directory
20546 @item show data-directory
20547 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20548 @end table
20549
20550 @cindex default data directory
20551 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20552 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20553 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20554 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20555 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20556 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20557 location.
20558
20559 The data directory may also be specified with the
20560 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20561 @xref{Mode Options}.
20562
20563 @node Targets
20564 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20565
20566 @cindex debugging target
20567 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20568
20569 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20570 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20571 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20572 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20573 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20574 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20575 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20576 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20577
20578 @cindex target architecture
20579 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20580 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20581 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20582 command.
20583
20584 @table @code
20585 @kindex set architecture
20586 @kindex show architecture
20587 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20588 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20589 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20590 supported architectures.
20591
20592 @item show architecture
20593 Show the current target architecture.
20594
20595 @item set processor
20596 @itemx processor
20597 @kindex set processor
20598 @kindex show processor
20599 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20600 and @code{show architecture}.
20601 @end table
20602
20603 @menu
20604 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20605 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20606 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20607 @end menu
20608
20609 @node Active Targets
20610 @section Active Targets
20611
20612 @cindex stacking targets
20613 @cindex active targets
20614 @cindex multiple targets
20615
20616 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20617 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20618 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20619 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20620 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20621 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20622 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20623 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20624 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20625
20626 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20627 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20628 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20629 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20630
20631 @node Target Commands
20632 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20633
20634 @table @code
20635 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20636 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20637 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20638 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20639 protocol of the target machine.
20640
20641 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20642 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20643 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20644
20645 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20646 after executing the command.
20647
20648 @kindex help target
20649 @item help target
20650 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20651 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20652 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20653
20654 @item help target @var{name}
20655 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20656 select it.
20657
20658 @kindex set gnutarget
20659 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20660 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20661 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20662 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20663 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20664 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20665
20666 @quotation
20667 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20668 you must know the actual BFD name.
20669 @end quotation
20670
20671 @noindent
20672 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20673
20674 @kindex show gnutarget
20675 @item show gnutarget
20676 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20677 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20678 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20679 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20680 @end table
20681
20682 @cindex common targets
20683 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20684 configuration):
20685
20686 @table @code
20687 @kindex target
20688 @item target exec @var{program}
20689 @cindex executable file target
20690 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20691 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20692
20693 @item target core @var{filename}
20694 @cindex core dump file target
20695 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20696 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20697
20698 @item target remote @var{medium}
20699 @cindex remote target
20700 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20701 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20702 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20703
20704 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20705 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20706
20707 @smallexample
20708 target remote /dev/ttya
20709 @end smallexample
20710
20711 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20712 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20713 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20714 clobbered by the download.
20715
20716 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20717 @cindex built-in simulator target
20718 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20719 In general,
20720 @smallexample
20721 target sim
20722 load
20723 run
20724 @end smallexample
20725 @noindent
20726 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20727 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20728 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20729 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20730 Processors}.
20731
20732 @item target native
20733 @cindex native target
20734 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20735 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20736 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20737 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20738
20739 @end table
20740
20741 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20742 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20743
20744 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20745 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20746 various aspects of this process.
20747
20748 @table @code
20749
20750 @item set hash
20751 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20752 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20753 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20754 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20755 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20756 monitor.
20757
20758 @item show hash
20759 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20760 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20761
20762 @item set debug monitor
20763 @kindex set debug monitor
20764 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20765 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20766 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20767
20768 @item show debug monitor
20769 @kindex show debug monitor
20770 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20771 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20772 @end table
20773
20774 @table @code
20775
20776 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20777 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20778 @anchor{load}
20779 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20780 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20781 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20782 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20783 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20784 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20785
20786 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20787 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20788 target is @dots{}}''
20789
20790 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20791 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20792 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20793 specifies a fixed address.
20794 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20795
20796 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20797 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20798 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20799
20800 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20801 load programs into flash memory.
20802
20803 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20804 @end table
20805
20806 @table @code
20807
20808 @kindex flash-erase
20809 @item flash-erase
20810 @anchor{flash-erase}
20811
20812 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20813
20814 @end table
20815
20816 @node Byte Order
20817 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20818
20819 @cindex choosing target byte order
20820 @cindex target byte order
20821
20822 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20823 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20824 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20825 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20826 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20827 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20828
20829 @table @code
20830 @kindex set endian
20831 @item set endian big
20832 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20833
20834 @item set endian little
20835 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20836
20837 @item set endian auto
20838 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20839 executable.
20840
20841 @item show endian
20842 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20843
20844 @end table
20845
20846 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20847 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20848 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20849 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20850 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20851 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20852 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20853 and @code{big} otherwise.
20854
20855 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20856 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20857 target system.
20858
20859
20860 @node Remote Debugging
20861 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20862 @cindex remote debugging
20863
20864 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20865 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20866 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20867 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20868 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20869
20870 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20871 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20872 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20873 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20874 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20875 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20876
20877 Other remote targets may be available in your
20878 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20879
20880 @menu
20881 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20882 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20883 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20884 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20885 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20886 @end menu
20887
20888 @node Connecting
20889 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20890 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20891 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20892 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20893 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20894 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20895 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20896
20897 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20898 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20899 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20900 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20901
20902 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20903
20904 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20905 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20906 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20907 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20908
20909 @table @asis
20910
20911 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20912 @item Result of detach or program exit
20913 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20914 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20915 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20916
20917 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20918 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20919 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20920 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20921
20922 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20923 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20924 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20925 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20926
20927 @item Specifying the program to debug
20928 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20929 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20930 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20931 target.
20932
20933 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20934 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20935 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20936
20937 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20938 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20939 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20940 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20941
20942 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20943 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20944 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20945 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20946 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20947 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20948 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20949 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20950 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20951
20952 @item The @code{run} command
20953 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20954 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20955 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20956 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20957 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20958
20959 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20960 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20961 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20962 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20963 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20964
20965 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20966 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20967 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20968 @code{target remote} mode.
20969
20970 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20971 @item Attaching
20972 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20973 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20974 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20975
20976 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20977 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20978 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20979 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20980 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20981
20982 @end table
20983
20984 @anchor{Host and target files}
20985 @subsection Host and Target Files
20986 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20987 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20988
20989 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20990 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20991 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20992 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20993 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20994
20995 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20996 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20997 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20998 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20999 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
21000
21001 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
21002 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
21003 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
21004 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
21005 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
21006 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
21007 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
21008 target libraries.
21009
21010 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
21011 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
21012 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
21013 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
21014 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
21015 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
21016 programs.
21017
21018 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
21019 @cindex remote connection commands
21020 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
21021 local Unix domain socket, or
21022 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
21023 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
21024 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
21025 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
21026 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
21027 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
21028
21029 @table @code
21030
21031 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
21032 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
21033 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
21034 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
21035 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
21036
21037 @smallexample
21038 target remote /dev/ttyb
21039 @end smallexample
21040
21041 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
21042 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
21043 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
21044 @code{target} command.
21045
21046 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
21047 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
21048 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
21049 @cindex Unix domain socket
21050 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
21051 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
21052
21053 @smallexample
21054 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
21055 @end smallexample
21056
21057 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
21058 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
21059 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
21060 of connection.
21061 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
21062 Unix domain sockets.
21063
21064 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
21065 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21066 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21067 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21068 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21069 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21070 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21071 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
21072 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21073 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21074 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21075 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21076 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21077 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21078 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
21079 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
21080 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
21081 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
21082 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
21083 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
21084 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
21085 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
21086
21087 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
21088 @code{manyfarms}:
21089
21090 @smallexample
21091 target remote manyfarms:2828
21092 @end smallexample
21093
21094 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
21095 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
21096 square bracket syntax:
21097
21098 @smallexample
21099 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
21100 @end smallexample
21101
21102 @noindent
21103 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
21104
21105 @smallexample
21106 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
21107 @end smallexample
21108
21109 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
21110 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
21111 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
21112 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
21113 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
21114 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
21115
21116 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
21117 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
21118 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
21119 port 1234 on your local machine:
21120
21121 @smallexample
21122 target remote :1234
21123 @end smallexample
21124 @noindent
21125
21126 Note that the colon is still required here.
21127
21128 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21129 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21130 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21131 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21132 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21133 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21134 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21135 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21136 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21137 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21138 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
21139 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
21140 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
21141
21142 @smallexample
21143 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
21144 @end smallexample
21145
21146 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
21147 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
21148 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
21149 cause havoc with your debugging session.
21150
21151 @item target remote | @var{command}
21152 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
21153 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
21154 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
21155 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
21156 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
21157 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
21158 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
21159 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
21160 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
21161
21162 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
21163 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
21164 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
21165
21166 @end table
21167
21168 @cindex interrupting remote programs
21169 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
21170 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
21171 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
21172 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
21173 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
21174 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
21175
21176 @smallexample
21177 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
21178 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
21179 @end smallexample
21180
21181 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
21182 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
21183 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
21184 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
21185
21186 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
21187 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
21188
21189 @table @code
21190 @kindex detach (remote)
21191 @item detach
21192 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
21193 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
21194 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
21195 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
21196 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
21197 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
21198 still connected to the target.
21199
21200 @kindex disconnect
21201 @item disconnect
21202 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
21203 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
21204 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
21205 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
21206 another target.
21207
21208 @cindex send command to remote monitor
21209 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
21210 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
21211 @kindex monitor
21212 @item monitor @var{cmd}
21213 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
21214 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
21215 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
21216 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
21217 and implement.
21218 @end table
21219
21220 @node File Transfer
21221 @section Sending files to a remote system
21222 @cindex remote target, file transfer
21223 @cindex file transfer
21224 @cindex sending files to remote systems
21225
21226 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
21227 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
21228 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
21229 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
21230 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
21231 the only way to upload or download files.
21232
21233 Not all remote targets support these commands.
21234
21235 @table @code
21236 @kindex remote put
21237 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21238 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21239 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21240
21241 @kindex remote get
21242 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21243 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21244 on the host system.
21245
21246 @kindex remote delete
21247 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
21248 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21249
21250 @end table
21251
21252 @node Server
21253 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21254
21255 @kindex gdbserver
21256 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21257 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21258 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21259 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21260 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21261
21262 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21263 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21264 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21265 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21266 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21267 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21268 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21269 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21270 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21271 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21272 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21273 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21274 choice for debugging.
21275
21276 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21277 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21278 protocol.
21279
21280 @quotation
21281 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21282 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21283 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21284 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21285 @code{gdbserver}.
21286 @end quotation
21287
21288 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21289 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21290 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21291 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21292
21293 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21294 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21295 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21296 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21297 system does all the symbol handling.
21298
21299 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21300 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21301 syntax is:
21302
21303 @smallexample
21304 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21305 @end smallexample
21306
21307 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
21308 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
21309 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21310 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21311 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21312 @file{/dev/com1}:
21313
21314 @smallexample
21315 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21316 @end smallexample
21317
21318 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21319 with it.
21320
21321 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21322
21323 @smallexample
21324 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21325 @end smallexample
21326
21327 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21328 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21329 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21330 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21331 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21332 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21333 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21334 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21335 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21336 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21337 @code{target remote} command.
21338
21339 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21340 with ssh:
21341
21342 @smallexample
21343 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21344 @end smallexample
21345
21346 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21347 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21348 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21349 You could elide it if you want to.
21350
21351 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21352 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21353 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21354 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21355
21356 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21357 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21358 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21359 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21360
21361 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21362 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21363
21364 @smallexample
21365 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21366 @end smallexample
21367
21368 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21369 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21370
21371 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21372 @value{GDBN} attach command
21373 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21374
21375 @pindex pidof
21376 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21377 @code{pidof} utility:
21378
21379 @smallexample
21380 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21381 @end smallexample
21382
21383 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21384 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21385 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21386
21387 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21388
21389 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21390 port.
21391
21392 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21393 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21394 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21395 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21396 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21397 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21398 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21399 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21400
21401 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21402 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21403 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21404
21405 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21406 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21407 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21408 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21409 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21410 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21411 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21412 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21413 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21414 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21415 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21416 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21417
21418 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21419 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21420
21421 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21422 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21423 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21424 program. For more information,
21425 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21426
21427 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21428 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21429 status information about the debugging process.
21430 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21431 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21432 remote protocol debug output.
21433 @cindex @option{--debug-file}, @code{gdbserver} option
21434 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, send all debug output to a single file
21435 The @option{--debug-file=@var{filename}} option tells @code{gdbserver} to
21436 write any debug output to the given @var{filename}. These options are intended
21437 for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21438
21439 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21440 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21441 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21442 Possible options are:
21443
21444 @table @code
21445 @item none
21446 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21447 @item all
21448 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21449 @item timestamps
21450 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21451 @end table
21452
21453 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21454 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21455
21456 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21457 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21458 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21459 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21460 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21461
21462 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21463 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21464 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21465 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21466
21467 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21468 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21469 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21470 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21471
21472 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21473 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21474 environment:
21475
21476 @smallexample
21477 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21478 @end smallexample
21479
21480 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21481 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21482
21483 @smallexample
21484 $ gdbserver --selftest
21485 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21486 @end smallexample
21487
21488 These tests are disabled in release.
21489 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21490
21491 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21492 @itemize
21493
21494 @item
21495 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21496
21497 @item
21498 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21499 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21500 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21501 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21502 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21503 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21504
21505 @item
21506 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21507 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21508 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21509 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21510 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21511 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21512 program is already on the target.
21513
21514 @end itemize
21515
21516 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21517 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21518 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21519
21520 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21521 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21522 Here are the available commands.
21523
21524 @table @code
21525 @item monitor help
21526 List the available monitor commands.
21527
21528 @item monitor set debug 0
21529 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21530 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21531
21532 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21533 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21534 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21535 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21536
21537 @item monitor set debug-file filename
21538 @itemx monitor set debug-file
21539 Send any debug output to the given file, or to stderr.
21540
21541 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21542 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21543 Possible options are:
21544
21545 @table @code
21546 @item none
21547 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21548 @item all
21549 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21550 @item timestamps
21551 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21552 @end table
21553
21554 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21555 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21556
21557 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21558 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21559 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21560 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21561 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21562 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21563
21564 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21565 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21566
21567 @item monitor exit
21568 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21569 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21570 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21571 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21572 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21573
21574 @end table
21575
21576 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21577 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21578
21579 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21580 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21581
21582 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21583 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21584 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21585 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21586 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21587 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21588 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21589 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21590 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21591 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21592 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21593 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21594
21595 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21596
21597 @table @code
21598 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21599
21600 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21601 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21602 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21603
21604 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21605
21606 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21607 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21608 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21609 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21610 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21611 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21612
21613 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21614
21615 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21616 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21617 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21618 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21619 command for that. For example:
21620
21621 @smallexample
21622 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21623 @end smallexample
21624
21625 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21626 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21627 @end table
21628
21629 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21630 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21631 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21632 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21633 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21634 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21635 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21636 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21637 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21638 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21639
21640 @smallexample
21641 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21642 @end smallexample
21643
21644 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21645
21646 @smallexample
21647 $ gdb myprogram
21648 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21649 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21650 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21651 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21652 @end smallexample
21653
21654 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21655 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21656 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21657 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21658 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21659 tracing.
21660
21661 @node Remote Configuration
21662 @section Remote Configuration
21663
21664 @kindex set remote
21665 @kindex show remote
21666 This section documents the configuration options available when
21667 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21668 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21669 system-call-allowed}.
21670
21671 @table @code
21672 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21673 @cindex address size for remote targets
21674 @cindex bits in remote address
21675 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21676 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21677 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21678 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21679
21680 @item show remoteaddresssize
21681 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21682
21683 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21684 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21685 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21686 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21687 remote targets.
21688
21689 @item show serial baud
21690 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21691
21692 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21693 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21694 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21695
21696 @item show serial parity
21697 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21698
21699 @item set remotebreak
21700 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21701 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21702 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21703 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21704 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21705 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21706 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21707 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21708
21709 @item show remotebreak
21710 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21711 interrupt the remote program.
21712
21713 @item set remoteflow on
21714 @itemx set remoteflow off
21715 @kindex set remoteflow
21716 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21717 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21718
21719 @item show remoteflow
21720 @kindex show remoteflow
21721 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21722
21723 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21724 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21725 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21726 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21727 @code{ascii}.
21728
21729 @item show remotelogbase
21730 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21731 protocol.
21732
21733 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21734 @cindex record serial communications on file
21735 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21736 default is not to record at all.
21737
21738 @item show remotelogfile
21739 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21740 serial communications.
21741
21742 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21743 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21744 @cindex remote timeout
21745 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21746 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21747
21748 @item show remotetimeout
21749 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21750 responses.
21751
21752 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21753 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21754 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21755 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21756 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21757 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21758 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21759 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21760 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21761 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21762
21763 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21764 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21765 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21766 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21767
21768 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21769 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21770 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21771 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21772 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21773 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21774 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21775 length.
21776
21777 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21778 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21779 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21780
21781 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21782 @itemx show remote exec-file
21783 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21784 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21785 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21786 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21787 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21788 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21789
21790 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21791 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21792 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21793 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21794 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21795 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21796 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21797 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21798 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21799 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21800
21801 @item show interrupt-sequence
21802 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21803 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21804 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21805 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21806
21807 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21808 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21809 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21810 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21811 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21812 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21813
21814 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21815 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21816 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21817
21818 @kindex set tcp
21819 @kindex show tcp
21820 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21821 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21822 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21823 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21824 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21825 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21826 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21827 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21828 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21829
21830 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21831 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21832
21833 @item show tcp auto-retry
21834 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21835
21836 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21837 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21838 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21839 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21840 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21841 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21842 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21843 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21844 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21845 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21846 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21847
21848 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21849 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21850 @end table
21851
21852 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21853 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21854 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21855 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21856 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21857 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21858 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21859 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21860 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21861
21862 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21863 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21864 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21865 @value{GDBN} developers.
21866
21867 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21868 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21869 are:
21870
21871 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21872 @item Command Name
21873 @tab Remote Packet
21874 @tab Related Features
21875
21876 @item @code{fetch-register}
21877 @tab @code{p}
21878 @tab @code{info registers}
21879
21880 @item @code{set-register}
21881 @tab @code{P}
21882 @tab @code{set}
21883
21884 @item @code{binary-download}
21885 @tab @code{X}
21886 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21887
21888 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21889 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21890 @tab @code{info auxv}
21891
21892 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21893 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21894 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21895
21896 @item @code{attach}
21897 @tab @code{vAttach}
21898 @tab @code{attach}
21899
21900 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21901 @tab @code{vCont}
21902 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21903
21904 @item @code{run}
21905 @tab @code{vRun}
21906 @tab @code{run}
21907
21908 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21909 @tab @code{Z0}
21910 @tab @code{break}
21911
21912 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21913 @tab @code{Z1}
21914 @tab @code{hbreak}
21915
21916 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21917 @tab @code{Z2}
21918 @tab @code{watch}
21919
21920 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21921 @tab @code{Z3}
21922 @tab @code{rwatch}
21923
21924 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21925 @tab @code{Z4}
21926 @tab @code{awatch}
21927
21928 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21929 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21930 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21931
21932 @item @code{target-features}
21933 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21934 @tab @code{set architecture}
21935
21936 @item @code{library-info}
21937 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21938 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21939
21940 @item @code{memory-map}
21941 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21942 @tab @code{info mem}
21943
21944 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21945 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21946 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21947
21948 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21949 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21950 @tab @code{info spu}
21951
21952 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21953 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21954 @tab @code{info spu}
21955
21956 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21957 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21958 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21959
21960 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21961 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21962 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21963
21964 @item @code{threads}
21965 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21966 @tab @code{info threads}
21967
21968 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21969 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21970 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21971
21972 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21973 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21974 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21975
21976 @item @code{search-memory}
21977 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21978 @tab @code{find}
21979
21980 @item @code{supported-packets}
21981 @tab @code{qSupported}
21982 @tab Remote communications parameters
21983
21984 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21985 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21986 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21987
21988 @item @code{pass-signals}
21989 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21990 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21991
21992 @item @code{program-signals}
21993 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21994 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21995
21996 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21997 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21998 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21999
22000 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
22001 @tab @code{vFile:open}
22002 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22003
22004 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
22005 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
22006 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22007
22008 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
22009 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
22010 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22011
22012 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
22013 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
22014 @tab @code{remote delete}
22015
22016 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
22017 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
22018 @tab Host I/O
22019
22020 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
22021 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
22022 @tab Host I/O
22023
22024 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
22025 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
22026 @tab Host I/O
22027
22028 @item @code{noack-packet}
22029 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
22030 @tab Packet acknowledgment
22031
22032 @item @code{osdata}
22033 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
22034 @tab @code{info os}
22035
22036 @item @code{query-attached}
22037 @tab @code{qAttached}
22038 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
22039
22040 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
22041 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
22042 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
22043
22044 @item @code{trace-status}
22045 @tab @code{qTStatus}
22046 @tab @code{tstatus}
22047
22048 @item @code{traceframe-info}
22049 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
22050 @tab Traceframe info
22051
22052 @item @code{install-in-trace}
22053 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
22054 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
22055
22056 @item @code{disable-randomization}
22057 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
22058 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
22059
22060 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
22061 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
22062 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
22063
22064 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
22065 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
22066 @tab @code{set environment}
22067
22068 @item @code{environment-unset}
22069 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
22070 @tab @code{unset environment}
22071
22072 @item @code{environment-reset}
22073 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
22074 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
22075
22076 @item @code{set-working-dir}
22077 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
22078 @tab @code{set cwd}
22079
22080 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
22081 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
22082 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
22083
22084 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
22085 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
22086 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
22087
22088 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
22089 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
22090 @tab @code{break}
22091
22092 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
22093 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
22094 @tab @code{hbreak}
22095
22096 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
22097 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
22098 @tab @code{fork}
22099
22100 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
22101 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
22102 @tab @code{vfork}
22103
22104 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
22105 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
22106 @tab @code{exec}
22107
22108 @item @code{thread-events}
22109 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
22110 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
22111
22112 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
22113 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
22114 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
22115
22116 @end multitable
22117
22118 @node Remote Stub
22119 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
22120
22121 @cindex debugging stub, example
22122 @cindex remote stub, example
22123 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
22124 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
22125 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
22126 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
22127 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
22128 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
22129 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
22130 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
22131
22132 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
22133 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
22134 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
22135 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
22136 program, you need:
22137
22138 @enumerate
22139 @item
22140 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
22141 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
22142 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
22143
22144 @item
22145 A C subroutine library to support your program's
22146 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
22147
22148 @item
22149 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
22150 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
22151 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
22152 documentation.
22153 @end enumerate
22154
22155 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
22156 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
22157 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
22158
22159 @table @emph
22160 @item On the host,
22161 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
22162 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
22163 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
22164
22165 @item On the target,
22166 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
22167 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
22168 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
22169
22170 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
22171 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
22172 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
22173 @end table
22174
22175 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
22176 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
22177 @sc{sparc} boards.
22178
22179 @cindex remote serial stub list
22180 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
22181
22182 @table @code
22183
22184 @item i386-stub.c
22185 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
22186 @cindex Intel
22187 @cindex i386
22188 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
22189
22190 @item m68k-stub.c
22191 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
22192 @cindex Motorola 680x0
22193 @cindex m680x0
22194 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
22195
22196 @item sh-stub.c
22197 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
22198 @cindex Renesas
22199 @cindex SH
22200 For Renesas SH architectures.
22201
22202 @item sparc-stub.c
22203 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
22204 @cindex Sparc
22205 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
22206
22207 @item sparcl-stub.c
22208 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
22209 @cindex Fujitsu
22210 @cindex SparcLite
22211 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
22212
22213 @end table
22214
22215 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
22216 recently added stubs.
22217
22218 @menu
22219 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
22220 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
22221 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
22222 @end menu
22223
22224 @node Stub Contents
22225 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
22226
22227 @cindex remote serial stub
22228 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
22229 subroutines:
22230
22231 @table @code
22232 @item set_debug_traps
22233 @findex set_debug_traps
22234 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
22235 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
22236 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
22237 program's startup code.
22238
22239 @item handle_exception
22240 @findex handle_exception
22241 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
22242 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
22243 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
22244 run when a trap is triggered.
22245
22246 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
22247 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
22248 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
22249 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
22250 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
22251 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
22252 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
22253 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
22254 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
22255 machine.
22256
22257 @item breakpoint
22258 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
22259 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
22260 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
22261 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22262 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22263 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22264 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22265 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22266 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22267 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22268 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22269
22270 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22271 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22272 start of your debugging session.
22273 @end table
22274
22275 @node Bootstrapping
22276 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22277
22278 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22279 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22280 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22281 debugging target machine.
22282
22283 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22284 serial port.
22285
22286 @table @code
22287 @item int getDebugChar()
22288 @findex getDebugChar
22289 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22290 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22291 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22292
22293 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22294 @findex putDebugChar
22295 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22296 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22297 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22298 @end table
22299
22300 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22301 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22302 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22303 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22304 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22305 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22306 remote system to stop.
22307
22308 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22309 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22310 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22311 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22312
22313 Other routines you need to supply are:
22314
22315 @table @code
22316 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22317 @findex exceptionHandler
22318 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22319 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22320 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22321 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22322 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22323 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22324 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22325 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22326 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22327 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22328 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22329 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22330 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22331
22332 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22333 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22334 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22335 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22336 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22337
22338 @item void flush_i_cache()
22339 @findex flush_i_cache
22340 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22341 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22342 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22343
22344 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22345 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22346 @end table
22347
22348 @noindent
22349 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22350
22351 @table @code
22352 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22353 @findex memset
22354 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22355 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22356 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22357 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22358 @end table
22359
22360 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22361 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22362 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22363 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22364
22365
22366 @node Debug Session
22367 @subsection Putting it All Together
22368
22369 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22370 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22371 steps.
22372
22373 @enumerate
22374 @item
22375 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22376 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22377 @display
22378 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22379 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22380 @end display
22381
22382 @item
22383 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22384 procedure is called:
22385
22386 @smallexample
22387 set_debug_traps();
22388 breakpoint();
22389 @end smallexample
22390
22391 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22392 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22393 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22394 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22395 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22396 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22397 progress.
22398
22399 @item
22400 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22401 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22402
22403 @smallexample
22404 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22405 @end smallexample
22406
22407 @noindent
22408 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22409 function in your program, that function is called when
22410 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22411 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22412 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22413
22414 @item
22415 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22416 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22417
22418 @item
22419 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22420 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22421
22422 @item
22423 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22424 @c document that. FIXME.
22425 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22426 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22427
22428 @item
22429 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22430 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22431
22432 @end enumerate
22433
22434 @node Configurations
22435 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22436
22437 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22438 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22439 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22440
22441 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22442 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22443 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22444 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22445 are quite different from each other.
22446
22447 @menu
22448 * Native::
22449 * Embedded OS::
22450 * Embedded Processors::
22451 * Architectures::
22452 @end menu
22453
22454 @node Native
22455 @section Native
22456
22457 This section describes details specific to particular native
22458 configurations.
22459
22460 @menu
22461 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22462 * Process Information:: Process information
22463 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22464 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22465 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22466 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22467 * FreeBSD:: Features specific to FreeBSD
22468 @end menu
22469
22470 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22471 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22472
22473 @cindex libkvm
22474 @cindex kernel memory image
22475 @cindex kernel crash dump
22476
22477 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22478 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22479 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22480 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22481 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22482 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22483 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22484 @code{kvm} target:
22485
22486 @smallexample
22487 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22488 @end smallexample
22489
22490 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22491 argument:
22492
22493 @smallexample
22494 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22495 @end smallexample
22496
22497 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22498 available:
22499
22500 @table @code
22501 @kindex kvm
22502 @item kvm pcb
22503 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22504
22505 @item kvm proc
22506 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22507 modern FreeBSD systems.
22508 @end table
22509
22510 @node Process Information
22511 @subsection Process Information
22512 @cindex /proc
22513 @cindex examine process image
22514 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22515
22516 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22517 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22518 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22519 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22520 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22521 any process running on your system.
22522
22523 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22524 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22525 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22526 systems.
22527
22528 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22529 information.
22530
22531 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22532 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22533 information available from a live process. Process information is
22534 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22535 systems.
22536
22537 @table @code
22538 @kindex info proc
22539 @cindex process ID
22540 @item info proc
22541 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22542 Summarize available information about a process. If a
22543 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22544 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22545 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22546 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22547 executable file's absolute file name.
22548
22549 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22550 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22551 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22552 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22553 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22554 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22555
22556 @item info proc cmdline
22557 @cindex info proc cmdline
22558 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22559 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22560
22561 @item info proc cwd
22562 @cindex info proc cwd
22563 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22564 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22565
22566 @item info proc exe
22567 @cindex info proc exe
22568 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22569 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22570
22571 @item info proc files
22572 @cindex info proc files
22573 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
22574 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
22575 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
22576 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
22577 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
22578 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
22579 FreeBSD.
22580
22581 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
22582 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
22583
22584 @smallexample
22585 (gdb) info proc files 22136
22586 process 22136
22587 Open files:
22588
22589 FD Type Offset Flags Name
22590 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
22591 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
22592 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
22593 root dir - r-------- /
22594 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22595 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22596 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
22597 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
22598 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
22599 @end smallexample
22600
22601 @item info proc mappings
22602 @cindex memory address space mappings
22603 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
22604 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22605 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22606 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22607 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22608
22609 @item info proc stat
22610 @itemx info proc status
22611 @cindex process detailed status information
22612 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22613 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22614 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22615 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22616 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22617
22618 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22619 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22620
22621 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22622 proc status}.
22623
22624 @item info proc all
22625 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22626 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22627
22628 @ignore
22629 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22630 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22631 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22632 @kindex info proc times
22633 @item info proc times
22634 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22635 its children.
22636
22637 @kindex info proc id
22638 @item info proc id
22639 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22640 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22641 @end ignore
22642
22643 @item set procfs-trace
22644 @kindex set procfs-trace
22645 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22646 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22647
22648 @item show procfs-trace
22649 @kindex show procfs-trace
22650 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22651
22652 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22653 @kindex set procfs-file
22654 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22655 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22656 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22657 standard output.
22658
22659 @item show procfs-file
22660 @kindex show procfs-file
22661 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22662
22663 @item proc-trace-entry
22664 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22665 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22666 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22667 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22668 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22669 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22670 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22671 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22672 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22673
22674 @item info pidlist
22675 @kindex info pidlist
22676 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22677 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22678 processes and all the threads within each process.
22679
22680 @item info meminfo
22681 @kindex info meminfo
22682 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22683 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22684 @end table
22685
22686 @node DJGPP Native
22687 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22688 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22689 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22690 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22691
22692 @cindex DPMI
22693 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22694 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22695 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22696 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22697
22698 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22699 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22700 subsection describes those commands.
22701
22702 @table @code
22703 @kindex info dos
22704 @item info dos
22705 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22706 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22707
22708 @kindex sysinfo
22709 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22710 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22711 @item info dos sysinfo
22712 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22713 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22714 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22715
22716 @cindex GDT
22717 @cindex LDT
22718 @cindex IDT
22719 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22720 @cindex descriptor tables display
22721 @item info dos gdt
22722 @itemx info dos ldt
22723 @itemx info dos idt
22724 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22725 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22726 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22727 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22728 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22729 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22730 rights.
22731
22732 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22733 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22734 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22735 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22736 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22737
22738 @cindex garbled pointers
22739 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22740 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22741 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22742 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22743 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22744 debugged program's data segment:
22745
22746 @smallexample
22747 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22748 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22749 @end smallexample
22750
22751 @noindent
22752 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22753 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22754
22755 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22756 @item info dos pde
22757 @itemx info dos pte
22758 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22759 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22760 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22761 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22762 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22763 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22764 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22765 that is currently in use.
22766
22767 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22768 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22769 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22770 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22771 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22772 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22773 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22774
22775 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22776 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22777 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22778 controller.
22779
22780 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22781
22782 @cindex physical address from linear address
22783 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22784 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22785 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22786 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22787 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22788 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22789 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22790
22791 @smallexample
22792 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22793 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22794 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22795 @end smallexample
22796
22797 @noindent
22798 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22799 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22800 attributes of that page.
22801
22802 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22803 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22804 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22805 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22806 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22807 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22808
22809 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22810 transfer buffer:
22811
22812 @smallexample
22813 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22814 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22815 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22816 @end smallexample
22817
22818 @noindent
22819 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22820 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22821 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22822 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22823 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22824
22825 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22826 @end table
22827
22828 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22829 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22830 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22831 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22832
22833 @table @code
22834 @kindex set com1base
22835 @kindex set com1irq
22836 @kindex set com2base
22837 @kindex set com2irq
22838 @kindex set com3base
22839 @kindex set com3irq
22840 @kindex set com4base
22841 @kindex set com4irq
22842 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22843 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22844 port.
22845
22846 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22847 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22848 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22849
22850 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22851 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22852 other 3 COM ports.
22853
22854 @kindex show com1base
22855 @kindex show com1irq
22856 @kindex show com2base
22857 @kindex show com2irq
22858 @kindex show com3base
22859 @kindex show com3irq
22860 @kindex show com4base
22861 @kindex show com4irq
22862 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22863 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22864 lines used by the COM ports.
22865
22866 @item info serial
22867 @kindex info serial
22868 @cindex DOS serial port status
22869 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22870 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22871 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22872 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22873 @end table
22874
22875
22876 @node Cygwin Native
22877 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22878 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22879 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22880 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22881
22882 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22883 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22884
22885 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22886 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22887 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22888 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22889 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22890 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22891 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22892 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22893
22894 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22895 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22896 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22897
22898 @table @code
22899 @kindex info w32
22900 @item info w32
22901 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22902 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22903
22904 @item info w32 selector
22905 This command displays information returned by
22906 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22907 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22908 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22909 Without argument, this command displays information
22910 about the six segment registers.
22911
22912 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22913 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22914 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22915 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22916
22917 @kindex signal-event
22918 @item signal-event @var{id}
22919 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22920 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22921
22922 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22923 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22924 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22925 (for x86_64 versions):
22926
22927 @itemize @minus
22928 @item
22929 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22930 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22931 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22932
22933 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22934 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22935 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22936 to attach.
22937
22938 @item
22939 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22940 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22941 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22942 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22943 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22944 @end itemize
22945
22946 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22947 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22948 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22949 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22950 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22951 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22952 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22953 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22954 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22955 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22956 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22957
22958 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22959 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22960 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22961 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22962
22963 @kindex set new-console
22964 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22965 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22966 be started in a new console on next start.
22967 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22968 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22969
22970 @kindex show new-console
22971 @item show new-console
22972 Displays whether a new console is used
22973 when the debuggee is started.
22974
22975 @kindex set new-group
22976 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22977 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22978 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22979 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22980 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22981
22982 @kindex show new-group
22983 @item show new-group
22984 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22985
22986 @kindex set debugevents
22987 @item set debugevents
22988 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22989 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22990 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22991 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22992 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22993
22994 @kindex set debugexec
22995 @item set debugexec
22996 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22997 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22998
22999 @kindex set debugexceptions
23000 @item set debugexceptions
23001 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
23002 debuggee seen by the debugger.
23003
23004 @kindex set debugmemory
23005 @item set debugmemory
23006 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
23007 and writes by the debugger.
23008
23009 @kindex set shell
23010 @item set shell
23011 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
23012 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
23013
23014 @kindex show shell
23015 @item show shell
23016 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
23017
23018 @end table
23019
23020 @menu
23021 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
23022 @end menu
23023
23024 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
23025 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
23026 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
23027 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
23028
23029 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
23030 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
23031 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
23032 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
23033 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
23034 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
23035 ``minimal symbols''.
23036
23037 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
23038 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
23039 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
23040 program run once to completion.
23041
23042 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
23043
23044 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
23045 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
23046 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
23047 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
23048 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
23049 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
23050 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
23051 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
23052 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
23053
23054 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
23055 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
23056 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
23057 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
23058 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
23059 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
23060
23061 @smallexample
23062 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
23063 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
23064
23065 Non-debugging symbols:
23066 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
23067 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
23068 @end smallexample
23069
23070 @smallexample
23071 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
23072 All functions matching regular expression "!":
23073
23074 Non-debugging symbols:
23075 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
23076 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
23077 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
23078 [etc...]
23079 @end smallexample
23080
23081 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
23082
23083 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
23084 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
23085 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
23086 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
23087 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
23088 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
23089 a function within a DLL without a running program.
23090
23091 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
23092 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
23093 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
23094 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
23095 problem:
23096
23097 @smallexample
23098 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
23099 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
23100 @end smallexample
23101
23102 @smallexample
23103 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
23104 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
23105 @end smallexample
23106
23107 And two possible solutions:
23108
23109 @smallexample
23110 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
23111 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23112 @end smallexample
23113
23114 @smallexample
23115 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
23116 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
23117 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
23118 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
23119 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
23120 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23121 @end smallexample
23122
23123 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
23124 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
23125 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
23126 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
23127 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
23128
23129 @smallexample
23130 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
23131 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
23132 @end smallexample
23133
23134 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
23135 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
23136 safe.
23137
23138 @node Hurd Native
23139 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
23140 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
23141
23142 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
23143 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
23144
23145 @table @code
23146 @item set signals
23147 @itemx set sigs
23148 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
23149 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23150 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
23151 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
23152 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
23153 @code{signals}.
23154
23155 @item show signals
23156 @itemx show sigs
23157 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
23158 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23159 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
23160
23161 @item set signal-thread
23162 @itemx set sigthread
23163 @kindex set signal-thread
23164 @kindex set sigthread
23165 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
23166 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
23167 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
23168 signal-thread}.
23169
23170 @item show signal-thread
23171 @itemx show sigthread
23172 @kindex show signal-thread
23173 @kindex show sigthread
23174 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
23175 delivered a signal.
23176
23177 @item set stopped
23178 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23179 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
23180 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
23181 continued by delivering a signal to it.
23182
23183 @item show stopped
23184 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23185 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
23186 stopped.
23187
23188 @item set exceptions
23189 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23190 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
23191 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
23192 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
23193 trapping on.
23194
23195 @item show exceptions
23196 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23197 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
23198
23199 @item set task pause
23200 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
23201 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23202 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23203 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
23204 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
23205 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
23206 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
23207 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
23208 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
23209
23210 @item show task pause
23211 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
23212 Show the current state of task suspension.
23213
23214 @item set task detach-suspend-count
23215 @cindex task suspend count
23216 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23217 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
23218 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
23219
23220 @item show task detach-suspend-count
23221 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
23222
23223 @item set task exception-port
23224 @itemx set task excp
23225 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23226 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
23227 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
23228 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
23229
23230 @item set noninvasive
23231 @cindex noninvasive task options
23232 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
23233 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
23234 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
23235 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
23236
23237 @item info send-rights
23238 @itemx info receive-rights
23239 @itemx info port-rights
23240 @itemx info port-sets
23241 @itemx info dead-names
23242 @itemx info ports
23243 @itemx info psets
23244 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23245 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23246 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23247 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23248 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23249 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
23250 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
23251 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
23252 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
23253
23254 @item set thread pause
23255 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
23256 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23257 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23258 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
23259 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
23260 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
23261 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
23262 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23263 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23264 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23265 only the current thread.
23266
23267 @item show thread pause
23268 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23269 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23270
23271 @item set thread run
23272 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23273
23274 @item show thread run
23275 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23276
23277 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23278 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23279 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23280 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23281 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23282 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23283 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23284
23285 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23286 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23287 detaching.
23288
23289 @item set thread exception-port
23290 @itemx set thread excp
23291 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23292 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23293 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23294
23295 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23296 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23297 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23298 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23299
23300 @item set thread default
23301 @itemx show thread default
23302 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23303 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23304 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23305 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23306 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23307 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23308 the non-default commands.
23309 @end table
23310
23311 @node Darwin
23312 @subsection Darwin
23313 @cindex Darwin
23314
23315 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23316
23317 @table @code
23318 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23319 @kindex set debug darwin
23320 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23321 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23322
23323 @item show debug darwin
23324 @kindex show debug darwin
23325 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23326
23327 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23328 @kindex set debug mach-o
23329 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23330 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23331 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23332 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23333 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23334 usage.
23335
23336 @item show debug mach-o
23337 @kindex show debug mach-o
23338 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23339
23340 @item set mach-exceptions on
23341 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23342 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23343 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23344 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23345 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23346 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23347
23348 @item show mach-exceptions
23349 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23350 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23351 @end table
23352
23353 @node FreeBSD
23354 @subsection FreeBSD
23355 @cindex FreeBSD
23356
23357 When the ABI of a system call is changed in the FreeBSD kernel, this
23358 is implemented by leaving a compatibility system call using the old
23359 ABI at the existing number and allocating a new system call number for
23360 the version using the new ABI. As a convenience, when a system call
23361 is caught by name (@pxref{catch syscall}), compatibility system calls
23362 are also caught.
23363
23364 For example, FreeBSD 12 introduced a new variant of the @code{kevent}
23365 system call and catching the @code{kevent} system call by name catches
23366 both variants:
23367
23368 @smallexample
23369 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall kevent
23370 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'freebsd11_kevent' [363] 'kevent' [560])
23371 (@value{GDBP})
23372 @end smallexample
23373
23374
23375 @node Embedded OS
23376 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23377
23378 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23379 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23380 architectures.
23381
23382 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23383 various real-time operating systems.
23384
23385 @node Embedded Processors
23386 @section Embedded Processors
23387
23388 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23389 configurations.
23390
23391 @cindex send command to simulator
23392 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23393 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23394
23395 @table @code
23396 @item sim @var{command}
23397 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23398 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23399 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23400 acceptable commands.
23401 @end table
23402
23403
23404 @menu
23405 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23406 * ARM:: ARM
23407 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23408 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23409 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23410 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23411 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23412 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23413 * CRIS:: CRIS
23414 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23415 @end menu
23416
23417 @node ARC
23418 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23419 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23420 @cindex ARC specific commands
23421 @cindex ARC600
23422 @cindex ARC700
23423 @cindex ARC EM
23424 @cindex ARC HS
23425
23426 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23427
23428 @table @code
23429 @item set debug arc
23430 @kindex set debug arc
23431 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23432 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23433
23434 @item show debug arc
23435 @kindex show debug arc
23436 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23437
23438 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23439 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23440 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23441
23442 @end table
23443
23444 @node ARM
23445 @subsection ARM
23446
23447 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23448
23449 @table @code
23450 @item set arm disassembler
23451 @kindex set arm
23452 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23453 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23454
23455 @item show arm disassembler
23456 @kindex show arm
23457 Show the current disassembly style.
23458
23459 @item set arm apcs32
23460 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23461 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23462
23463 @item show arm apcs32
23464 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23465
23466 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23467 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23468 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23469
23470 @table @code
23471 @item auto
23472 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23473 @item softfpa
23474 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23475 processors.
23476 @item fpa
23477 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23478 @item softvfp
23479 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23480 @item vfp
23481 VFP co-processor.
23482 @end table
23483
23484 @item show arm fpu
23485 Show the current type of the FPU.
23486
23487 @item set arm abi
23488 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23489
23490 @item show arm abi
23491 Show the currently used ABI.
23492
23493 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23494 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23495 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23496 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23497 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23498 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23499 register).
23500
23501 @item show arm fallback-mode
23502 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23503
23504 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23505 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23506 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23507 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23508 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23509
23510 @item show arm force-mode
23511 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23512
23513 @item set debug arm
23514 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23515 target support subsystem.
23516
23517 @item show debug arm
23518 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23519 @end table
23520
23521 @table @code
23522 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23523 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23524
23525 @table @code
23526 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23527 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23528 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23529 The default value is @code{all}.
23530
23531 @table @code
23532 @item none
23533 @item demon
23534 @item angel
23535 @item redboot
23536 @item all
23537 @end table
23538 @end table
23539 @end table
23540
23541 @node M68K
23542 @subsection M68k
23543
23544 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23545
23546 @node MicroBlaze
23547 @subsection MicroBlaze
23548 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23549 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23550
23551 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23552 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23553 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23554 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23555 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23556 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23557 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23558 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23559 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23560 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23561 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23562
23563 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23564
23565 @table @code
23566 @item target remote :1234
23567 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23568 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23569
23570 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23571 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23572 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23573
23574 @item load
23575 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23576
23577 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23578 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23579
23580 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23581 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23582 @end table
23583
23584 @node MIPS Embedded
23585 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23586
23587 @noindent
23588 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23589
23590 @table @code
23591 @item set mipsfpu double
23592 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23593 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23594 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23595 @itemx show mipsfpu
23596 @kindex set mipsfpu
23597 @kindex show mipsfpu
23598 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23599 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23600 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23601 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23602 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23603 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23604 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23605 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23606 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23607 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23608 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23609 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23610 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23611
23612 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23613 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23614 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23615
23616 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23617 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23618 @end table
23619
23620 @node OpenRISC 1000
23621 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23622 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23623
23624 @noindent
23625 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23626 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23627 FPGA's.
23628
23629 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23630 a target:
23631
23632 @table @code
23633
23634 @kindex target sim
23635 @item target sim
23636
23637 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23638 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23639 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23640 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23641
23642 Example: @code{target sim}
23643
23644 @item set debug or1k
23645 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23646 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23647
23648 @item show debug or1k
23649 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23650 @end table
23651
23652 @node PowerPC Embedded
23653 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23654
23655 @cindex DVC register
23656 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23657 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23658
23659 @smallexample
23660 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23661 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23662 @end smallexample
23663
23664 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23665 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23666 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23667 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23668 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23669 or newer.
23670
23671 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23672 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23673 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23674 watching variables of scalar types.
23675
23676 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23677 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23678
23679 @smallexample
23680 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23681 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23682 @end smallexample
23683
23684 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23685 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23686
23687 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23688 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23689 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23690 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23691 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23692 use the @code{break-range} command.
23693
23694 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23695
23696 @table @code
23697 @kindex break-range
23698 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23699 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23700 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23701 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23702 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23703 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23704 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23705 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23706 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23707
23708 @kindex set powerpc
23709 @item set powerpc soft-float
23710 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23711 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23712 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23713 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23714
23715 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23716 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23717 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23718 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23719 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23720 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23721 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23722 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23723
23724 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23725 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23726 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23727 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23728 address of its first byte.
23729
23730 @end table
23731
23732 @node AVR
23733 @subsection Atmel AVR
23734 @cindex AVR
23735
23736 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23737 following AVR-specific commands:
23738
23739 @table @code
23740 @item info io_registers
23741 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23742 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23743 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23744 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23745 @end table
23746
23747 @node CRIS
23748 @subsection CRIS
23749 @cindex CRIS
23750
23751 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23752 following CRIS-specific commands:
23753
23754 @table @code
23755 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23756 @cindex CRIS version
23757 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23758 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23759 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23760
23761 @item show cris-version
23762 Show the current CRIS version.
23763
23764 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23765 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23766 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23767 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23768 @code{R59}.
23769
23770 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23771 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23772
23773 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23774 @cindex CRIS mode
23775 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23776 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23777 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23778
23779 @item show cris-mode
23780 Show the current CRIS mode.
23781 @end table
23782
23783 @node Super-H
23784 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23785 @cindex Super-H
23786
23787 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23788 commands:
23789
23790 @table @code
23791 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23792 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23793 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23794 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23795 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23796 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23797 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23798 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23799 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23800 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23801 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23802 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23803
23804 @item show sh calling-convention
23805 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23806 Show the current calling convention setting.
23807
23808 @end table
23809
23810
23811 @node Architectures
23812 @section Architectures
23813
23814 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23815 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23816
23817 @menu
23818 * AArch64::
23819 * i386::
23820 * Alpha::
23821 * MIPS::
23822 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23823 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23824 * PowerPC::
23825 * Nios II::
23826 * Sparc64::
23827 * S12Z::
23828 @end menu
23829
23830 @node AArch64
23831 @subsection AArch64
23832 @cindex AArch64 support
23833
23834 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23835 following special commands:
23836
23837 @table @code
23838 @item set debug aarch64
23839 @kindex set debug aarch64
23840 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23841 messages are to be displayed.
23842
23843 @item show debug aarch64
23844 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23845
23846 @end table
23847
23848 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23849 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23850
23851 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23852 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23853 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23854 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23855 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23856 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23857
23858 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23859 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23860 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23861 target process.
23862
23863
23864 @node i386
23865 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23866
23867 @table @code
23868 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23869 @kindex set struct-convention
23870 @cindex struct return convention
23871 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23872 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23873 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23874 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23875 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23876 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23877 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23878 be returned in a register.
23879
23880 @item show struct-convention
23881 @kindex show struct-convention
23882 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23883 from functions.
23884 @end table
23885
23886
23887 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23888 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23889
23890 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23891 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23892 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23893 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23894 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23895 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23896 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23897
23898 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23899 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23900 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23901 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23902 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23903 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23904
23905 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23906 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23907 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23908
23909 @smallexample
23910 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23911 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23912 @end smallexample
23913
23914 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23915 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23916 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23917 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23918 the pointer.
23919
23920 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23921 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23922 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23923 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23924 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23925
23926 @table @code
23927 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23928 @kindex show mpx bound
23929 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23930
23931 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23932 @kindex set mpx bound
23933 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23934 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23935 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23936 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23937 @end table
23938
23939 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23940 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23941 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23942 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23943
23944 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23945 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23946 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23947 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23948 function.
23949
23950 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23951 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23952 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23953 continuing the execution. For example:
23954
23955 @smallexample
23956 $ break *upper
23957 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23958 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23959 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23960 $ print $bnd0
23961 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23962 @end smallexample
23963
23964 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23965 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23966 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23967
23968 @node Alpha
23969 @subsection Alpha
23970
23971 See the following section.
23972
23973 @node MIPS
23974 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23975
23976 @cindex stack on Alpha
23977 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23978 @cindex Alpha stack
23979 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23980 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23981 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23982 find the beginning of a function.
23983
23984 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23985 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23986 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23987 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23988 commands:
23989
23990 @table @code
23991 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23992 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23993 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23994 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23995 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23996 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23997 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23998 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23999
24000 @item show heuristic-fence-post
24001 Display the current limit.
24002 @end table
24003
24004 @noindent
24005 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
24006 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
24007
24008 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
24009 programs:
24010
24011 @table @code
24012 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
24013 @kindex set mips abi
24014 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
24015 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
24016 values of @var{arg} are:
24017
24018 @table @samp
24019 @item auto
24020 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
24021 default).
24022 @item o32
24023 @item o64
24024 @item n32
24025 @item n64
24026 @item eabi32
24027 @item eabi64
24028 @end table
24029
24030 @item show mips abi
24031 @kindex show mips abi
24032 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
24033
24034 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
24035 @kindex set mips compression
24036 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
24037 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
24038 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
24039 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
24040 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
24041 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
24042 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
24043 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
24044 provided by the executable.
24045
24046 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
24047 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
24048 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
24049 identified as such.
24050
24051 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
24052 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
24053 implicitly from an executable.
24054
24055 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
24056 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
24057 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
24058 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
24059 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
24060
24061 @item show mips compression
24062 @kindex show mips compression
24063 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
24064 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
24065
24066 @item set mipsfpu
24067 @itemx show mipsfpu
24068 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
24069
24070 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
24071 @kindex set mips mask-address
24072 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
24073 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
24074 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
24075 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
24076 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
24077
24078 @item show mips mask-address
24079 @kindex show mips mask-address
24080 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
24081 not.
24082
24083 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24084 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24085 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
24086 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
24087 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
24088 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
24089
24090 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24091 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24092 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
24093
24094 @item set debug mips
24095 @kindex set debug mips
24096 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
24097 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24098
24099 @item show debug mips
24100 @kindex show debug mips
24101 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
24102 @end table
24103
24104
24105 @node HPPA
24106 @subsection HPPA
24107 @cindex HPPA support
24108
24109 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
24110 following special commands:
24111
24112 @table @code
24113 @item set debug hppa
24114 @kindex set debug hppa
24115 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
24116 messages are to be displayed.
24117
24118 @item show debug hppa
24119 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
24120
24121 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
24122 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
24123 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
24124 given @var{address}.
24125
24126 @end table
24127
24128
24129 @node SPU
24130 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
24131 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
24132 @cindex SPU
24133
24134 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
24135 it provides the following special commands:
24136
24137 @table @code
24138 @item info spu event
24139 @kindex info spu
24140 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
24141 and pending event status.
24142
24143 @item info spu signal
24144 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
24145 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
24146 notification channels.
24147
24148 @item info spu mailbox
24149 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
24150 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
24151 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
24152
24153 @item info spu dma
24154 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24155 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24156 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24157
24158 @item info spu proxydma
24159 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24160 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24161 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24162
24163 @end table
24164
24165 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
24166 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
24167 special commands:
24168
24169 @table @code
24170 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
24171 @kindex set spu
24172 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
24173 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
24174 function. The default is @code{off}.
24175
24176 @item show spu stop-on-load
24177 @kindex show spu
24178 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
24179
24180 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
24181 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
24182 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
24183 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
24184 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
24185 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
24186
24187 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
24188 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
24189
24190 @end table
24191
24192 @node PowerPC
24193 @subsection PowerPC
24194 @cindex PowerPC architecture
24195
24196 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
24197 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
24198 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
24199 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
24200 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
24201
24202 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
24203 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
24204 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
24205
24206 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
24207 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
24208
24209 @node Nios II
24210 @subsection Nios II
24211 @cindex Nios II architecture
24212
24213 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
24214 it provides the following special commands:
24215
24216 @table @code
24217
24218 @item set debug nios2
24219 @kindex set debug nios2
24220 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
24221 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24222
24223 @item show debug nios2
24224 @kindex show debug nios2
24225 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
24226 @end table
24227
24228 @node Sparc64
24229 @subsection Sparc64
24230 @cindex Sparc64 support
24231 @cindex Application Data Integrity
24232 @subsubsection ADI Support
24233
24234 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
24235 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
24236 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
24237 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
24238 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
24239 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
24240 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
24241 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
24242 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
24243 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
24244 signal.
24245
24246 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
24247 ADI-enabled.
24248
24249 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
24250 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
24251
24252
24253 @table @code
24254 @kindex adi examine
24255 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
24256
24257 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
24258 cacheline.
24259
24260 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
24261 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
24262 block size, to display.
24263
24264 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24265 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
24266
24267 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
24268
24269 @smallexample
24270 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24271 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
24272 @end smallexample
24273
24274 @kindex adi assign
24275 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
24276
24277 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
24278 to an address.
24279
24280 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
24281 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
24282 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
24283
24284 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24285 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24286
24287 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24288
24289 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24290 variable "shmaddr":
24291
24292 @smallexample
24293 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24294 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24295 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24296 @end smallexample
24297
24298 @end table
24299
24300 @node S12Z
24301 @subsection S12Z
24302 @cindex S12Z support
24303
24304 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
24305 it provides the following special command:
24306
24307 @table @code
24308 @item maint info bdccsr
24309 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
24310 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
24311 BDCCSR register.
24312 @end table
24313
24314
24315 @node Controlling GDB
24316 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24317
24318 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24319 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24320 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24321 described here.
24322
24323 @menu
24324 * Prompt:: Prompt
24325 * Editing:: Command editing
24326 * Command History:: Command history
24327 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24328 * Output Styling:: Output styling
24329 * Numbers:: Numbers
24330 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24331 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24332 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24333 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24334 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24335 @end menu
24336
24337 @node Prompt
24338 @section Prompt
24339
24340 @cindex prompt
24341
24342 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24343 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24344 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24345 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24346 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24347 which one you are talking to.
24348
24349 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24350 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24351 or a prompt that does not.
24352
24353 @table @code
24354 @kindex set prompt
24355 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24356 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24357
24358 @kindex show prompt
24359 @item show prompt
24360 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24361 @end table
24362
24363 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24364 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24365 are:
24366
24367 @table @code
24368 @kindex set extended-prompt
24369 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24370 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24371 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24372 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24373 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24374 is displayed.
24375
24376 For example:
24377
24378 @smallexample
24379 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24380 @end smallexample
24381
24382 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24383 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24384
24385 @kindex show extended-prompt
24386 @item show extended-prompt
24387 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24388 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24389 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24390 @end table
24391
24392 @node Editing
24393 @section Command Editing
24394 @cindex readline
24395 @cindex command line editing
24396
24397 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24398 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24399 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24400 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24401 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24402 debugging sessions.
24403
24404 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24405 command @code{set}.
24406
24407 @table @code
24408 @kindex set editing
24409 @cindex editing
24410 @item set editing
24411 @itemx set editing on
24412 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24413
24414 @item set editing off
24415 Disable command line editing.
24416
24417 @kindex show editing
24418 @item show editing
24419 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24420 @end table
24421
24422 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24423 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24424 @end ifset
24425 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24426 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24427 @end ifclear
24428 for more details about the Readline
24429 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24430 encouraged to read that chapter.
24431
24432 @node Command History
24433 @section Command History
24434 @cindex command history
24435
24436 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24437 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24438 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24439 history facility.
24440
24441 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24442 package, to provide the history facility.
24443 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24444 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24445 @end ifset
24446 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24447 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24448 @end ifclear
24449 for the detailed description of the History library.
24450
24451 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24452 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24453 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24454 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24455 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24456 pressed on a line by itself.
24457
24458 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24459 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24460 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24461 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24462
24463 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24464 history.
24465
24466 @table @code
24467 @cindex history substitution
24468 @cindex history file
24469 @kindex set history filename
24470 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24471 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24472 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24473 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24474 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24475 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24476 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24477 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24478 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24479 is not set.
24480
24481 @cindex save command history
24482 @kindex set history save
24483 @item set history save
24484 @itemx set history save on
24485 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24486 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24487
24488 @item set history save off
24489 Stop recording command history in a file.
24490
24491 @cindex history size
24492 @kindex set history size
24493 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24494 @item set history size @var{size}
24495 @itemx set history size unlimited
24496 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24497 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24498 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24499 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24500 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24501 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24502
24503 @cindex remove duplicate history
24504 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24505 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24506 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24507 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24508 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24509 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24510 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24511 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24512 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24513
24514 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24515 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24516
24517 @end table
24518
24519 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24520 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24521 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24522 @end ifset
24523 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24524 @xref{Event Designators},
24525 @end ifclear
24526 for more details.
24527
24528 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24529 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24530 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24531 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24532 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24533 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24534 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24535 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24536
24537 The commands to control history expansion are:
24538
24539 @table @code
24540 @item set history expansion on
24541 @itemx set history expansion
24542 @kindex set history expansion
24543 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24544
24545 @item set history expansion off
24546 Disable history expansion.
24547
24548 @c @group
24549 @kindex show history
24550 @item show history
24551 @itemx show history filename
24552 @itemx show history save
24553 @itemx show history size
24554 @itemx show history expansion
24555 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24556 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24557 @c @end group
24558 @end table
24559
24560 @table @code
24561 @kindex show commands
24562 @cindex show last commands
24563 @cindex display command history
24564 @item show commands
24565 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24566
24567 @item show commands @var{n}
24568 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24569
24570 @item show commands +
24571 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24572 @end table
24573
24574 @node Screen Size
24575 @section Screen Size
24576 @cindex size of screen
24577 @cindex screen size
24578 @cindex pagination
24579 @cindex page size
24580 @cindex pauses in output
24581
24582 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24583 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24584 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24585 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24586 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24587 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24588 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24589 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24590 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24591 following line.
24592
24593 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24594 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24595 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24596 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24597 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24598 width} commands:
24599
24600 @table @code
24601 @kindex set height
24602 @kindex set width
24603 @kindex show width
24604 @kindex show height
24605 @item set height @var{lpp}
24606 @itemx set height unlimited
24607 @itemx show height
24608 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24609 @itemx set width unlimited
24610 @itemx show width
24611 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24612 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24613 commands display the current settings.
24614
24615 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24616 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24617 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24618 buffer.
24619
24620 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24621 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24622
24623 @item set pagination on
24624 @itemx set pagination off
24625 @kindex set pagination
24626 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24627 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24628 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24629 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24630
24631 @item show pagination
24632 @kindex show pagination
24633 Show the current pagination mode.
24634 @end table
24635
24636 @node Output Styling
24637 @section Output Styling
24638 @cindex styling
24639 @cindex colors
24640
24641 @kindex set style
24642 @kindex show style
24643 @value{GDBN} can style its output on a capable terminal. This is
24644 enabled by default on most systems, but disabled by default when in
24645 batch mode (@pxref{Mode Options}). Various style settings are available;
24646 and styles can also be disabled entirely.
24647
24648 @table @code
24649 @item set style enabled @samp{on|off}
24650 Enable or disable all styling. The default is host-dependent, with
24651 most hosts defaulting to @samp{on}.
24652
24653 @item show style enabled
24654 Show the current state of styling.
24655
24656 @item set style sources @samp{on|off}
24657 Enable or disable source code styling. This affects whether source
24658 code, such as the output of the @code{list} command, is styled. Note
24659 that source styling only works if styling in general is enabled, and
24660 if @value{GDBN} was linked with the GNU Source Highlight library. The
24661 default is @samp{on}.
24662
24663 @item show style sources
24664 Show the current state of source code styling.
24665 @end table
24666
24667 Subcommands of @code{set style} control specific forms of styling.
24668 These subcommands all follow the same pattern: each style-able object
24669 can be styled with a foreground color, a background color, and an
24670 intensity.
24671
24672 For example, the style of file names can be controlled using the
24673 @code{set style filename} group of commands:
24674
24675 @table @code
24676 @item set style filename background @var{color}
24677 Set the background to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
24678 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
24679 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
24680 and@samp{white}.
24681
24682 @item set style filename foreground @var{color}
24683 Set the foreground to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
24684 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
24685 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
24686 and@samp{white}.
24687
24688 @item set style filename intensity @var{value}
24689 Set the intensity to @var{value}. Valid intensities are @samp{normal}
24690 (the default), @samp{bold}, and @samp{dim}.
24691 @end table
24692
24693 The style-able objects are:
24694 @table @code
24695 @item filename
24696 Control the styling of file names. By default, this style's
24697 foreground color is green.
24698
24699 @item function
24700 Control the styling of function names. These are managed with the
24701 @code{set style function} family of commands. By default, this
24702 style's foreground color is yellow.
24703
24704 @item variable
24705 Control the styling of variable names. These are managed with the
24706 @code{set style variable} family of commands. By default, this style's
24707 foreground color is cyan.
24708
24709 @item address
24710 Control the styling of addresses. These are managed with the
24711 @code{set style address} family of commands. By default, this style's
24712 foreground color is blue.
24713 @end table
24714
24715 @node Numbers
24716 @section Numbers
24717 @cindex number representation
24718 @cindex entering numbers
24719
24720 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24721 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24722 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24723 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24724 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24725 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24726 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24727 both input and output with the commands described below.
24728
24729 @table @code
24730 @kindex set input-radix
24731 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24732 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24733 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24734 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24735 example, any of
24736
24737 @smallexample
24738 set input-radix 012
24739 set input-radix 10.
24740 set input-radix 0xa
24741 @end smallexample
24742
24743 @noindent
24744 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24745 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24746 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24747 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24748 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24749 change the radix.
24750
24751 @kindex set output-radix
24752 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24753 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24754 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24755 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24756
24757 @kindex show input-radix
24758 @item show input-radix
24759 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24760
24761 @kindex show output-radix
24762 @item show output-radix
24763 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24764
24765 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24766 @itemx show radix
24767 @kindex set radix
24768 @kindex show radix
24769 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24770 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24771 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24772 default value of 10.
24773
24774 @end table
24775
24776 @node ABI
24777 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24778
24779 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24780 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24781 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24782 current ABI.
24783
24784 @cindex OS ABI
24785 @kindex set osabi
24786 @kindex show osabi
24787 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24788
24789 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24790 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24791 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24792 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24793 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24794 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24795 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24796 platform provides.
24797
24798 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24799 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24800 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24801 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24802
24803 @table @code
24804 @item show osabi
24805 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24806
24807 @item set osabi
24808 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24809
24810 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24811 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24812 @end table
24813
24814 @cindex float promotion
24815
24816 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24817 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24818 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24819 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24820 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24821 @code{double} and then passed.
24822
24823 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24824 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24825 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24826
24827 @table @code
24828 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24829 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24830 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24831 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24832 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24833
24834 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24835 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24836 functions.
24837
24838 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24839 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24840 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24841 @end table
24842
24843 @kindex set cp-abi
24844 @kindex show cp-abi
24845 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24846 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24847 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24848 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24849 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24850 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24851 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24852 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24853 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24854 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24855 ``auto''.
24856
24857 @table @code
24858 @item show cp-abi
24859 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24860
24861 @item set cp-abi
24862 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24863
24864 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24865 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24866 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24867 @end table
24868
24869 @node Auto-loading
24870 @section Automatically loading associated files
24871 @cindex auto-loading
24872
24873 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24874 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24875 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24876 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24877 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24878 sources).
24879
24880 @menu
24881 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24882 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24883
24884 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24885 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24886 @end menu
24887
24888 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24889 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24890 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24891
24892 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24893 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24894 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24895
24896 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24897 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24898
24899 @table @code
24900 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24901 @kindex set auto-load off
24902 @item set auto-load off
24903 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24904 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24905 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24906 @smallexample
24907 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24908 @end smallexample
24909
24910 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24911 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24912 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24913 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24914 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24915 @code{set auto-load no}.
24916
24917 @anchor{show auto-load}
24918 @kindex show auto-load
24919 @item show auto-load
24920 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24921 or disabled.
24922
24923 @smallexample
24924 (gdb) show auto-load
24925 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24926 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24927 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24928 is on.
24929 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24930 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24931 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24932 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24933 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24934 @end smallexample
24935
24936 @anchor{info auto-load}
24937 @kindex info auto-load
24938 @item info auto-load
24939 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24940 not.
24941
24942 @smallexample
24943 (gdb) info auto-load
24944 gdb-scripts:
24945 Loaded Script
24946 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24947 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24948 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24949 loaded.
24950 python-scripts:
24951 Loaded Script
24952 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24953 @end smallexample
24954 @end table
24955
24956 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24957
24958 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24959 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24960 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24961 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24962 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24963 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24964 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24965 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24966 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24967 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24968 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24969 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24970 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24971 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24972 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24973 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24974 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24975 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24976 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24977 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24978 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24979 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24980 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24981 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24982 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24983 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24984 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24985 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24986 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24987 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24988 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24989 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24990 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24991 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24992 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24993 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24994 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24995 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24996 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24997 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24998 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24999 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
25000 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
25001 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
25002 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
25003 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
25004 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
25005 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
25006 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
25007 @end multitable
25008
25009 @node Init File in the Current Directory
25010 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
25011 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
25012
25013 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
25014 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
25015 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
25016
25017 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
25018 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25019
25020 @table @code
25021 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
25022 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
25023 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
25024 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
25025 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
25026
25027 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
25028 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
25029 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
25030 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
25031 current directory is enabled or disabled.
25032
25033 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
25034 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
25035 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
25036 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
25037 current directory have been auto-loaded.
25038 @end table
25039
25040 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
25041 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
25042 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
25043
25044 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
25045
25046 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
25047 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
25048
25049 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
25050 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
25051 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
25052 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
25053 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
25054 library.
25055
25056 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
25057 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25058
25059 @table @code
25060 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
25061 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
25062 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
25063 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
25064
25065 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
25066 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
25067 @item show auto-load libthread-db
25068 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
25069 enabled or disabled.
25070
25071 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
25072 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
25073 @item info auto-load libthread-db
25074 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
25075 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
25076 @end table
25077
25078 @node Auto-loading safe path
25079 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
25080 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
25081
25082 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
25083 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
25084 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
25085 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
25086 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
25087
25088 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
25089 get loaded:
25090
25091 @smallexample
25092 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
25093 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
25094 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
25095 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
25096 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
25097 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
25098 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
25099 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
25100 @end smallexample
25101
25102 @noindent
25103 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
25104 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
25105
25106 @smallexample
25107 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
25108 @end smallexample
25109
25110 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
25111
25112 @table @code
25113 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
25114 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
25115 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25116 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
25117 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
25118 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
25119 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
25120 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25121 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
25122 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
25123
25124 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25125 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25126 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25127
25128 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
25129 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
25130 @item show auto-load safe-path
25131 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
25132 scripts.
25133
25134 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
25135 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
25136 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
25137 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
25138 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
25139 by the host platform path separator in use.
25140 @end table
25141
25142 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
25143 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
25144 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
25145 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
25146 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
25147
25148 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
25149 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
25150 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
25151 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
25152 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
25153 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
25154 init file in the current directory
25155 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
25156
25157 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
25158 example, you could use one of the following ways:
25159
25160 @table @asis
25161 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
25162 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
25163 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
25164 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
25165
25166 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
25167 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
25168 @value{GDBN} session.
25169
25170 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
25171 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25172 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
25173 from trusted sources.
25174
25175 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
25176 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
25177 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
25178 trusted sources.
25179 @end table
25180
25181 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
25182 also suppresses any such warning messages:
25183
25184 @table @asis
25185 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
25186 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25187
25188 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
25189 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
25190 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
25191 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
25192 @end table
25193
25194 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
25195 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
25196 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
25197 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
25198 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
25199 recommended to be entered.
25200
25201 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
25202 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
25203 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
25204
25205 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
25206 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
25207 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
25208 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
25209 be printed.
25210
25211 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
25212 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
25213 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
25214
25215 @smallexample
25216 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
25217 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
25218 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
25219 for objfile "/tmp/true".
25220 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
25221 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
25222 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
25223 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
25224 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
25225 @end smallexample
25226
25227 @table @code
25228 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
25229 @kindex set debug auto-load
25230 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
25231 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
25232
25233 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
25234 @kindex show debug auto-load
25235 @item show debug auto-load
25236 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
25237 on or off.
25238 @end table
25239
25240 @node Messages/Warnings
25241 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
25242
25243 @cindex verbose operation
25244 @cindex optional warnings
25245 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
25246 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
25247 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
25248 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
25249
25250 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
25251 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
25252 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25253
25254 @table @code
25255 @kindex set verbose
25256 @item set verbose on
25257 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25258
25259 @item set verbose off
25260 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25261
25262 @kindex show verbose
25263 @item show verbose
25264 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
25265 @end table
25266
25267 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
25268 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
25269 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
25270 Symbol Files}).
25271
25272 @table @code
25273
25274 @kindex set complaints
25275 @item set complaints @var{limit}
25276 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
25277 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
25278 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
25279 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
25280
25281 @kindex show complaints
25282 @item show complaints
25283 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
25284
25285 @end table
25286
25287 @anchor{confirmation requests}
25288 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
25289 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
25290 you try to run a program which is already running:
25291
25292 @smallexample
25293 (@value{GDBP}) run
25294 The program being debugged has been started already.
25295 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
25296 @end smallexample
25297
25298 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
25299 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
25300
25301 @table @code
25302
25303 @kindex set confirm
25304 @cindex flinching
25305 @cindex confirmation
25306 @cindex stupid questions
25307 @item set confirm off
25308 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
25309 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
25310 automatically disables confirmation requests.
25311
25312 @item set confirm on
25313 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
25314
25315 @kindex show confirm
25316 @item show confirm
25317 Displays state of confirmation requests.
25318
25319 @end table
25320
25321 @cindex command tracing
25322 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
25323 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
25324 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
25325 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
25326
25327 @table @code
25328 @kindex set trace-commands
25329 @cindex command scripts, debugging
25330 @item set trace-commands on
25331 Enable command tracing.
25332 @item set trace-commands off
25333 Disable command tracing.
25334 @item show trace-commands
25335 Display the current state of command tracing.
25336 @end table
25337
25338 @node Debugging Output
25339 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
25340 @cindex optional debugging messages
25341
25342 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
25343 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
25344 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
25345 section documents those commands.
25346
25347 @table @code
25348 @kindex set exec-done-display
25349 @item set exec-done-display
25350 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
25351 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
25352 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
25353 @kindex show exec-done-display
25354 @item show exec-done-display
25355 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
25356 notification.
25357 @kindex set debug
25358 @cindex ARM AArch64
25359 @item set debug aarch64
25360 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
25361 The default is off.
25362 @kindex show debug
25363 @item show debug aarch64
25364 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25365 ARM AArch64.
25366 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
25367 @cindex architecture debugging info
25368 @item set debug arch
25369 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
25370 @item show debug arch
25371 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
25372 @item set debug aix-solib
25373 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
25374 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
25375 support module. The default is off.
25376 @item show debug aix-thread
25377 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
25378 @item set debug aix-thread
25379 @cindex AIX threads
25380 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
25381 module.
25382 @item show debug aix-thread
25383 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
25384 @item set debug check-physname
25385 @cindex physname
25386 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
25387 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
25388 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
25389 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
25390 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
25391 both ways and display any discrepancies.
25392 @item show debug check-physname
25393 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
25394 @item set debug coff-pe-read
25395 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
25396 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
25397 exported symbols. The default is off.
25398 @item show debug coff-pe-read
25399 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25400 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25401 @item set debug dwarf-die
25402 @cindex DWARF DIEs
25403 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
25404 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
25405 A value of zero turns off the display.
25406 @item show debug dwarf-die
25407 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
25408 @item set debug dwarf-line
25409 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
25410 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25411 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
25412 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25413 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25414 @item show debug dwarf-line
25415 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
25416 @item set debug dwarf-read
25417 @cindex DWARF Reading
25418 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
25419 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
25420 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25421 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25422 @item show debug dwarf-read
25423 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
25424 @item set debug displaced
25425 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
25426 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
25427 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
25428 @item show debug displaced
25429 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
25430 related to displaced stepping.
25431 @item set debug event
25432 @cindex event debugging info
25433 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
25434 default is off.
25435 @item show debug event
25436 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
25437 info.
25438 @item set debug expression
25439 @cindex expression debugging info
25440 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
25441 expression parsing. The default is off.
25442 @item show debug expression
25443 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
25444 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
25445 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
25446 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
25447 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
25448 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
25449 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
25450 @item set debug fbsd-nat
25451 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
25452 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
25453 @item show debug fbsd-nat
25454 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
25455 @item set debug frame
25456 @cindex frame debugging info
25457 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
25458 default is off.
25459 @item show debug frame
25460 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
25461 info.
25462 @item set debug gnu-nat
25463 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
25464 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
25465 @item show debug gnu-nat
25466 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
25467 @item set debug infrun
25468 @cindex inferior debugging info
25469 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
25470 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25471 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25472 @item show debug infrun
25473 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25474 @item set debug jit
25475 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25476 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25477 @item show debug jit
25478 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25479 @item set debug lin-lwp
25480 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25481 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25482 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25483 @item show debug lin-lwp
25484 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25485 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25486 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25487 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25488 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25489 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25490 @item set debug mach-o
25491 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25492 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25493 processing. The default is off.
25494 @item show debug mach-o
25495 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25496 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25497 @item set debug notification
25498 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25499 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25500 The default is off.
25501 @item show debug notification
25502 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25503 @item set debug observer
25504 @cindex observer debugging info
25505 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25506 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25507 @item show debug observer
25508 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25509 @item set debug overload
25510 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25511 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25512 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25513 is off.
25514 @item show debug overload
25515 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25516 debugging info.
25517 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25518 @cindex debug expression parser
25519 @item set debug parser
25520 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25521 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25522 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25523 details. The default is off.
25524 @item show debug parser
25525 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25526 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25527 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25528 @cindex debug remote protocol
25529 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25530 @cindex display remote packets
25531 @item set debug remote
25532 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25533 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25534 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25535 @item show debug remote
25536 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25537
25538 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25539 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25540 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25541 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25542
25543 @item set debug serial
25544 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25545 default is off.
25546 @item show debug serial
25547 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25548 info.
25549 @item set debug solib-frv
25550 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25551 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25552 @item show debug solib-frv
25553 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25554 messages.
25555 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25556 @cindex symbol lookup
25557 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25558 The default is 0 (off).
25559 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25560 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25561 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25562 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25563 @item set debug symfile
25564 @cindex symbol file functions
25565 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25566 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25567 @item show debug symfile
25568 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25569 @item set debug symtab-create
25570 @cindex symbol table creation
25571 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25572 The default is 0 (off).
25573 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25574 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25575 @item show debug symtab-create
25576 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25577 @item set debug target
25578 @cindex target debugging info
25579 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25580 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25581 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25582 value of large memory transfers.
25583 @item show debug target
25584 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25585 info.
25586 @item set debug timestamp
25587 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25588 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25589 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25590 message.
25591 @item show debug timestamp
25592 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25593 debugging info.
25594 @item set debug varobj
25595 @cindex variable object debugging info
25596 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25597 info. The default is off.
25598 @item show debug varobj
25599 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25600 debugging info.
25601 @item set debug xml
25602 @cindex XML parser debugging
25603 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25604 @item show debug xml
25605 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25606 @end table
25607
25608 @node Other Misc Settings
25609 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25610 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25611
25612 @table @code
25613 @kindex set interactive-mode
25614 @item set interactive-mode
25615 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25616 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25617 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25618 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25619 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25620 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25621 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25622 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25623
25624 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25625 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25626 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25627 inside a cygwin window.
25628
25629 @kindex show interactive-mode
25630 @item show interactive-mode
25631 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25632 @end table
25633
25634 @node Extending GDB
25635 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25636 @cindex extending GDB
25637
25638 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25639 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25640 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25641 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25642 being debugged.
25643
25644 @menu
25645 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25646 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25647 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25648 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25649 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25650 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25651 @end menu
25652
25653 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25654 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25655 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25656 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25657 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25658 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25659
25660 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25661 setting:
25662
25663 @table @code
25664 @kindex set script-extension
25665 @kindex show script-extension
25666 @item set script-extension off
25667 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25668
25669 @item set script-extension soft
25670 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25671 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25672 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25673 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25674
25675 @item set script-extension strict
25676 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25677 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25678 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25679
25680 @item show script-extension
25681 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25682
25683 @end table
25684
25685 @node Sequences
25686 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25687
25688 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25689 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25690 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25691 files.
25692
25693 @menu
25694 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25695 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25696 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25697 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25698 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25699 @end menu
25700
25701 @node Define
25702 @subsection User-defined Commands
25703
25704 @cindex user-defined command
25705 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25706 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25707 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25708 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25709 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25710 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25711
25712 @smallexample
25713 define adder
25714 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25715 end
25716 @end smallexample
25717
25718 @noindent
25719 To execute the command use:
25720
25721 @smallexample
25722 adder 1 2 3
25723 @end smallexample
25724
25725 @noindent
25726 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25727 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25728 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25729 functions calls.
25730
25731 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25732 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25733 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25734 been passed.
25735
25736 @smallexample
25737 define adder
25738 if $argc == 2
25739 print $arg0 + $arg1
25740 end
25741 if $argc == 3
25742 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25743 end
25744 end
25745 @end smallexample
25746
25747 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25748 to process a variable number of arguments:
25749
25750 @smallexample
25751 define adder
25752 set $i = 0
25753 set $sum = 0
25754 while $i < $argc
25755 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25756 set $i = $i + 1
25757 end
25758 print $sum
25759 end
25760 @end smallexample
25761
25762 @table @code
25763
25764 @kindex define
25765 @item define @var{commandname}
25766 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25767 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25768 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25769 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25770 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25771 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25772
25773 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25774 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25775 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25776
25777 @kindex document
25778 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25779 @item document @var{commandname}
25780 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25781 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25782 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25783 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25784 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25785 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25786
25787 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25788 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25789 does not change the documentation.
25790
25791 @kindex dont-repeat
25792 @cindex don't repeat command
25793 @item dont-repeat
25794 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25795 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25796 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25797
25798 @kindex help user-defined
25799 @item help user-defined
25800 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25801 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25802 included (if any).
25803
25804 @kindex show user
25805 @item show user
25806 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25807 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25808 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25809 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25810 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25811
25812 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25813 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25814 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25815 @item show max-user-call-depth
25816 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25817 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25818 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25819 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25820 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25821 @end table
25822
25823 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25824 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25825
25826 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25827 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25828 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25829
25830 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25831 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25832 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25833 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25834
25835 @node Hooks
25836 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25837 @cindex command hooks
25838 @cindex hooks, for commands
25839 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25840
25841 @kindex hook
25842 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25843 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25844 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25845 before that command.
25846
25847 @cindex hooks, post-command
25848 @kindex hookpost
25849 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25850 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25851 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25852 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25853 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25854
25855 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25856 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25857
25858 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25859 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25860
25861 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25862 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25863 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25864 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25865 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25866
25867 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25868 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25869 you could define:
25870
25871 @smallexample
25872 define hook-stop
25873 handle SIGALRM nopass
25874 end
25875
25876 define hook-run
25877 handle SIGALRM pass
25878 end
25879
25880 define hook-continue
25881 handle SIGALRM pass
25882 end
25883 @end smallexample
25884
25885 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25886 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25887 you could define:
25888
25889 @smallexample
25890 define hook-echo
25891 echo <<<---
25892 end
25893
25894 define hookpost-echo
25895 echo --->>>\n
25896 end
25897
25898 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25899 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25900 (@value{GDBP})
25901
25902 @end smallexample
25903
25904 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25905 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25906 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25907 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25908 @c or not?
25909 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25910 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25911 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25912
25913 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25914 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25915 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25916
25917 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25918 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25919
25920 @node Command Files
25921 @subsection Command Files
25922
25923 @cindex command files
25924 @cindex scripting commands
25925 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25926 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25927 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25928 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25929 terminal.
25930
25931 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25932 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25933 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25934 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25935 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25936
25937 @table @code
25938 @kindex source
25939 @cindex execute commands from a file
25940 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25941 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25942 @end table
25943
25944 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25945 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25946 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25947 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25948 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25949
25950 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25951 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25952 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25953 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25954 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25955 is not relevant to scripts.
25956
25957 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25958 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25959 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25960 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25961 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25962 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25963 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25964 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25965 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25966 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25967 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25968 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25969 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25970 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25971
25972 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25973 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25974 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25975
25976 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25977 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25978 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25979 when called from command files.
25980
25981 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25982 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25983 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25984 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25985 the next command.
25986
25987 @smallexample
25988 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25989 @end smallexample
25990
25991 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25992 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25993 would be directed to @file{log}.
25994
25995 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25996 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25997 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25998 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25999 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
26000 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
26001 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
26002 conditionally, etc.
26003
26004 @table @code
26005 @kindex if
26006 @kindex else
26007 @item if
26008 @itemx else
26009 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
26010 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
26011 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
26012 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
26013 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
26014 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
26015 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
26016
26017 @kindex while
26018 @item while
26019 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
26020 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
26021 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
26022 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
26023 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
26024 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
26025
26026 @kindex loop_break
26027 @item loop_break
26028 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
26029 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
26030 line.
26031
26032 @kindex loop_continue
26033 @item loop_continue
26034 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
26035 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
26036 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
26037 the controlling expression.
26038
26039 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
26040 @item end
26041 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
26042 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
26043 @end table
26044
26045
26046 @node Output
26047 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
26048
26049 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
26050 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
26051 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
26052 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
26053 want.
26054
26055 @table @code
26056 @kindex echo
26057 @item echo @var{text}
26058 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
26059 @c because it is not in ANSI.
26060 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
26061 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
26062 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
26063 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
26064 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
26065 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
26066 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
26067 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
26068 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
26069
26070 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
26071 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
26072
26073 @smallexample
26074 echo This is some text\n\
26075 which is continued\n\
26076 onto several lines.\n
26077 @end smallexample
26078
26079 produces the same output as
26080
26081 @smallexample
26082 echo This is some text\n
26083 echo which is continued\n
26084 echo onto several lines.\n
26085 @end smallexample
26086
26087 @kindex output
26088 @item output @var{expression}
26089 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
26090 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
26091 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
26092 on expressions.
26093
26094 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
26095 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
26096 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
26097 Formats}, for more information.
26098
26099 @kindex printf
26100 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26101 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26102 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
26103 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
26104 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
26105 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
26106 executing the code below:
26107
26108 @smallexample
26109 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
26110 @end smallexample
26111
26112 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
26113 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
26114 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
26115 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
26116 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
26117 printed.
26118
26119 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
26120
26121 @smallexample
26122 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
26123 @end smallexample
26124
26125 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
26126 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
26127 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
26128
26129 @itemize @bullet
26130 @item
26131 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
26132
26133 @item
26134 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
26135 width.
26136
26137 @item
26138 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
26139 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
26140
26141 @item
26142 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
26143 supported.
26144
26145 @item
26146 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
26147
26148 @item
26149 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
26150 @end itemize
26151
26152 @noindent
26153 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
26154 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
26155 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
26156 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
26157
26158 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
26159 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
26160 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
26161 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
26162 supported.
26163
26164 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
26165 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
26166 together with a floating point specifier.
26167 letters:
26168
26169 @itemize @bullet
26170 @item
26171 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
26172
26173 @item
26174 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
26175
26176 @item
26177 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
26178 @end itemize
26179
26180 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
26181 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
26182 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
26183
26184 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
26185 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
26186
26187 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
26188 @smallexample
26189 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
26190 @end smallexample
26191
26192 @anchor{eval}
26193 @kindex eval
26194 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26195 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26196 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
26197
26198 @end table
26199
26200 @node Auto-loading sequences
26201 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
26202 @cindex native script auto-loading
26203
26204 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26205 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
26206 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
26207 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
26208
26209 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26210 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26211
26212 @table @code
26213 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
26214 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
26215 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
26216 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
26217
26218 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
26219 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
26220 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
26221 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
26222 disabled.
26223
26224 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
26225 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
26226 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
26227 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
26228 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
26229 auto-loaded.
26230 @end table
26231
26232 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
26233 matching names are printed.
26234
26235 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
26236 @include python.texi
26237
26238 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
26239 @include guile.texi
26240
26241 @node Auto-loading extensions
26242 @section Auto-loading extensions
26243 @cindex auto-loading extensions
26244
26245 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
26246 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26247 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
26248 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
26249 section of modern file formats like ELF.
26250
26251 @menu
26252 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26253 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26254 * Which flavor to choose?::
26255 @end menu
26256
26257 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
26258 debugging commands and features.
26259
26260 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26261 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26262 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
26263 for more information.
26264 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
26265 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
26266
26267 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26268 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26269
26270 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
26271 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26272 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26273 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26274 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26275
26276 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
26277 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
26278 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
26279 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
26280
26281 @table @code
26282 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26283 GDB's own command language
26284 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26285 Python
26286 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26287 Guile
26288 @end table
26289
26290 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
26291 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
26292 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
26293 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
26294 script in the specified extension language.
26295
26296 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
26297 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
26298
26299 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
26300 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26301
26302 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
26303 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
26304 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
26305 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
26306 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
26307 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
26308
26309 @table @code
26310 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
26311 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
26312 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
26313 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
26314 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
26315 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
26316
26317 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
26318 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
26319
26320 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
26321 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
26322 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
26323 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
26324
26325 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
26326 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
26327 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
26328 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
26329 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
26330 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
26331 platform.
26332
26333 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26334 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26335 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26336
26337 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
26338 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
26339 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
26340 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26341
26342 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
26343 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
26344 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
26345 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
26346 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
26347 @end table
26348
26349 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
26350 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
26351 @var{objfile} is opened.
26352 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
26353 is evaluated more than once.
26354
26355 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
26356 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26357 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26358
26359 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
26360 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
26361 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26362 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
26363 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
26364 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
26365 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26366
26367 The following entries are supported:
26368
26369 @table @code
26370 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
26371 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
26372 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
26373 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
26374 @end table
26375
26376 @subsubsection Script File Entries
26377
26378 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
26379 in the current directory and then along the source search path
26380 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
26381 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
26382 directory is not relevant to scripts.
26383
26384 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
26385 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
26386
26387 @example
26388 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
26389 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
26390 asm("\
26391 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
26392 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
26393 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
26394 .popsection \n\
26395 ");
26396 @end example
26397
26398 @noindent
26399 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
26400 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
26401
26402 @example
26403 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
26404 @end example
26405
26406 The script name may include directories if desired.
26407
26408 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26409 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26410
26411 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
26412 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
26413 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
26414 will remove duplicates.
26415
26416 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
26417
26418 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
26419 itself instead of loading it from a file.
26420 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
26421 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
26422 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
26423 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
26424 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
26425 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
26426 on its name.
26427
26428 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
26429 testsuite.
26430
26431 @example
26432 #include "symcat.h"
26433 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
26434 asm(
26435 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
26436 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
26437 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
26438 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
26439 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
26440 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
26441 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
26442 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
26443 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
26444 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
26445 ".byte 0\n"
26446 ".popsection\n"
26447 );
26448 @end example
26449
26450 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
26451 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26452 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
26453 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
26454
26455 @node Which flavor to choose?
26456 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
26457
26458 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
26459 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
26460
26461 @noindent
26462 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
26463
26464 @itemize @bullet
26465 @item
26466 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
26467
26468 @item
26469 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
26470
26471 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26472 in the source search path.
26473 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26474 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26475
26476 @item
26477 Doesn't require source code additions.
26478 @end itemize
26479
26480 @noindent
26481 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26482
26483 @itemize @bullet
26484 @item
26485 Works with static linking.
26486
26487 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26488 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26489 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26490 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26491 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26492
26493 @item
26494 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26495
26496 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26497 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26498
26499 @item
26500 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26501
26502 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26503 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26504 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26505 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26506 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26507 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26508 @end itemize
26509
26510 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26511 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26512
26513 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26514 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26515 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26516
26517 @subsection Python comes first
26518
26519 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26520 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26521 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26522 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26523 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26524 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26525 pretty-printed form of a value).
26526 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26527 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26528 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26529
26530 @node Aliases
26531 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26532 @cindex aliases for commands
26533
26534 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26535 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26536 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26537 that involves less typing.
26538
26539 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26540 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26541 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26542
26543 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26544 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26545 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26546
26547 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26548
26549 @table @code
26550
26551 @kindex alias
26552 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26553
26554 @end table
26555
26556 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26557 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26558 underscores.
26559
26560 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26561 that is being aliased.
26562
26563 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26564 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26565 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26566
26567 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26568 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26569
26570 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26571 of a command so that there is less to type.
26572 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26573 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26574 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26575 The following will accomplish this.
26576
26577 @smallexample
26578 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26579 @end smallexample
26580
26581 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26582 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26583 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26584 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26585
26586 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26587 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26588 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26589 of a command.
26590
26591 @smallexample
26592 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26593 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26594 (gdb) set p elms 20
26595 (gdb) show p elms
26596 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26597 @end smallexample
26598
26599 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26600 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26601 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26602
26603 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26604 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26605
26606 @smallexample
26607 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26608 @end smallexample
26609
26610 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26611 alias for a more complex command.
26612 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26613
26614 @smallexample
26615 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26616 (gdb) spe 20
26617 @end smallexample
26618
26619 @node Interpreters
26620 @chapter Command Interpreters
26621 @cindex command interpreters
26622
26623 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26624 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26625 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26626
26627 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26628 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26629 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26630 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26631
26632 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26633 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26634 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26635 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26636
26637 @table @code
26638 @item console
26639 @cindex console interpreter
26640 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26641 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26642 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26643
26644 @item mi
26645 @cindex mi interpreter
26646 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi3}). Used primarily
26647 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26648 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26649 Interface}.
26650
26651 @item mi3
26652 @cindex mi3 interpreter
26653 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 9.1.
26654
26655 @item mi2
26656 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26657 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 6.0.
26658
26659 @item mi1
26660 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26661 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 5.1.
26662
26663 @end table
26664
26665 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26666
26667 @kindex interpreter-exec
26668 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26669 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26670 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26671
26672 @smallexample
26673 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26674 @end smallexample
26675
26676 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26677 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26678
26679 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26680 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26681 permanently.
26682
26683 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26684
26685 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26686 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26687 device (usually a tty).
26688
26689 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26690 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26691 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26692 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26693 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26694 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26695 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26696 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26697 the separate MI interpreter.
26698
26699 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26700 @code{new-ui} command:
26701
26702 @kindex new-ui
26703 @cindex new user interface
26704 @smallexample
26705 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26706 @end smallexample
26707
26708 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26709 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26710 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26711 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26712 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26713 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26714
26715 @smallexample
26716 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26717 @end smallexample
26718
26719 @noindent
26720 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26721
26722 @node TUI
26723 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26724 @cindex TUI
26725 @cindex Text User Interface
26726
26727 @menu
26728 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26729 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26730 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26731 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26732 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26733 @end menu
26734
26735 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26736 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26737 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26738 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26739 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26740 is available.
26741
26742 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26743 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26744 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26745 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26746 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26747 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26748
26749 @node TUI Overview
26750 @section TUI Overview
26751
26752 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26753
26754 @table @emph
26755 @item command
26756 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26757 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26758 managed using readline.
26759
26760 @item source
26761 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26762 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26763
26764 @item assembly
26765 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26766
26767 @item register
26768 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26769 when their values change.
26770 @end table
26771
26772 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26773 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26774 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26775 indicates the breakpoint type:
26776
26777 @table @code
26778 @item B
26779 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26780
26781 @item b
26782 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26783
26784 @item H
26785 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26786
26787 @item h
26788 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26789 @end table
26790
26791 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26792
26793 @table @code
26794 @item +
26795 Breakpoint is enabled.
26796
26797 @item -
26798 Breakpoint is disabled.
26799 @end table
26800
26801 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26802 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26803 changes.
26804
26805 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26806 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26807 layouts:
26808
26809 @itemize @bullet
26810 @item
26811 source only,
26812
26813 @item
26814 assembly only,
26815
26816 @item
26817 source and assembly,
26818
26819 @item
26820 source and registers, or
26821
26822 @item
26823 assembly and registers.
26824 @end itemize
26825
26826 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26827
26828 @table @emph
26829 @item target
26830 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26831 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26832
26833 @item process
26834 Gives the current process or thread number.
26835 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26836
26837 @item function
26838 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26839 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26840 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26841 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26842
26843 @item line
26844 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26845 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26846
26847 @item pc
26848 Indicates the current program counter address.
26849 @end table
26850
26851 @node TUI Keys
26852 @section TUI Key Bindings
26853 @cindex TUI key bindings
26854
26855 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26856 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26857 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26858 @end ifset
26859 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26860 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26861 @end ifclear
26862 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26863 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26864
26865 @table @kbd
26866 @kindex C-x C-a
26867 @item C-x C-a
26868 @kindex C-x a
26869 @itemx C-x a
26870 @kindex C-x A
26871 @itemx C-x A
26872 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26873 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26874 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26875 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26876 The screen is then refreshed.
26877
26878 @kindex C-x 1
26879 @item C-x 1
26880 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26881 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26882 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26883
26884 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26885
26886 @kindex C-x 2
26887 @item C-x 2
26888 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26889 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26890 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26891 previous layout and the new one.
26892
26893 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26894
26895 @kindex C-x o
26896 @item C-x o
26897 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26898 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26899 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26900
26901 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26902
26903 @kindex C-x s
26904 @item C-x s
26905 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26906 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26907 @end table
26908
26909 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26910
26911 @table @asis
26912 @kindex PgUp
26913 @item @key{PgUp}
26914 Scroll the active window one page up.
26915
26916 @kindex PgDn
26917 @item @key{PgDn}
26918 Scroll the active window one page down.
26919
26920 @kindex Up
26921 @item @key{Up}
26922 Scroll the active window one line up.
26923
26924 @kindex Down
26925 @item @key{Down}
26926 Scroll the active window one line down.
26927
26928 @kindex Left
26929 @item @key{Left}
26930 Scroll the active window one column left.
26931
26932 @kindex Right
26933 @item @key{Right}
26934 Scroll the active window one column right.
26935
26936 @kindex C-L
26937 @item @kbd{C-L}
26938 Refresh the screen.
26939 @end table
26940
26941 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26942 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26943 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26944 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26945 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26946
26947 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26948 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26949 @cindex TUI single key mode
26950
26951 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26952 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26953 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26954
26955 @table @kbd
26956 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26957 @item c
26958 continue
26959
26960 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26961 @item d
26962 down
26963
26964 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26965 @item f
26966 finish
26967
26968 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26969 @item n
26970 next
26971
26972 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26973 @item o
26974 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26975
26976 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26977 @item q
26978 exit the SingleKey mode.
26979
26980 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26981 @item r
26982 run
26983
26984 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26985 @item s
26986 step
26987
26988 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26989 @item i
26990 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26991
26992 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26993 @item u
26994 up
26995
26996 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26997 @item v
26998 info locals
26999
27000 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27001 @item w
27002 where
27003 @end table
27004
27005 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
27006 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
27007 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
27008 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
27009 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
27010 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
27011
27012
27013 @node TUI Commands
27014 @section TUI-specific Commands
27015 @cindex TUI commands
27016
27017 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
27018 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
27019 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
27020 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
27021
27022 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
27023 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
27024 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
27025 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
27026 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
27027
27028 @table @code
27029 @item tui enable
27030 @kindex tui enable
27031 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
27032 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
27033 otherwise a default layout is used.
27034
27035 @item tui disable
27036 @kindex tui disable
27037 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
27038
27039 @item info win
27040 @kindex info win
27041 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
27042
27043 @item layout @var{name}
27044 @kindex layout
27045 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
27046 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
27047 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
27048
27049 @table @code
27050 @item next
27051 Display the next layout.
27052
27053 @item prev
27054 Display the previous layout.
27055
27056 @item src
27057 Display the source and command windows.
27058
27059 @item asm
27060 Display the assembly and command windows.
27061
27062 @item split
27063 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
27064
27065 @item regs
27066 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
27067 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
27068 register, assembler, and command windows.
27069 @end table
27070
27071 @item focus @var{name}
27072 @kindex focus
27073 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
27074 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
27075
27076 @table @code
27077 @item next
27078 Make the next window active for scrolling.
27079
27080 @item prev
27081 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
27082
27083 @item src
27084 Make the source window active for scrolling.
27085
27086 @item asm
27087 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
27088
27089 @item regs
27090 Make the register window active for scrolling.
27091
27092 @item cmd
27093 Make the command window active for scrolling.
27094 @end table
27095
27096 @item refresh
27097 @kindex refresh
27098 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
27099
27100 @item tui reg @var{group}
27101 @kindex tui reg
27102 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
27103 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
27104 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
27105 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
27106 following groups are available on most targets:
27107 @table @code
27108 @item next
27109 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
27110 through all of the available register groups.
27111
27112 @item prev
27113 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
27114 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
27115 @var{next}.
27116
27117 @item general
27118 Display the general registers.
27119 @item float
27120 Display the floating point registers.
27121 @item system
27122 Display the system registers.
27123 @item vector
27124 Display the vector registers.
27125 @item all
27126 Display all registers.
27127 @end table
27128
27129 @item update
27130 @kindex update
27131 Update the source window and the current execution point.
27132
27133 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
27134 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
27135 @kindex winheight
27136 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
27137 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
27138 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
27139 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
27140 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
27141 @end table
27142
27143 @node TUI Configuration
27144 @section TUI Configuration Variables
27145 @cindex TUI configuration variables
27146
27147 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
27148
27149 @table @code
27150 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
27151 @kindex set tui border-kind
27152 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
27153 The possible values are the following:
27154 @table @code
27155 @item space
27156 Use a space character to draw the border.
27157
27158 @item ascii
27159 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
27160
27161 @item acs
27162 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
27163 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
27164 @end table
27165
27166 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
27167 @kindex set tui border-mode
27168 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
27169 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
27170 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
27171 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
27172 @table @code
27173 @item normal
27174 Use normal attributes to display the border.
27175
27176 @item standout
27177 Use standout mode.
27178
27179 @item reverse
27180 Use reverse video mode.
27181
27182 @item half
27183 Use half bright mode.
27184
27185 @item half-standout
27186 Use half bright and standout mode.
27187
27188 @item bold
27189 Use extra bright or bold mode.
27190
27191 @item bold-standout
27192 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
27193 @end table
27194
27195 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
27196 @kindex set tui tab-width
27197 @kindex tabset
27198 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
27199 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
27200 assembly windows.
27201 @end table
27202
27203 @node Emacs
27204 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
27205
27206 @cindex Emacs
27207 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
27208 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
27209 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
27210 @value{GDBN}.
27211
27212 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
27213 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
27214 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
27215 created Emacs buffer.
27216 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
27217
27218 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
27219 things:
27220
27221 @itemize @bullet
27222 @item
27223 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
27224 the GUD buffer.
27225
27226 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
27227 and output done by the program you are debugging.
27228
27229 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
27230 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
27231 in this way.
27232
27233 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
27234 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
27235 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
27236 stop.
27237
27238 @item
27239 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
27240
27241 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
27242 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
27243 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
27244 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
27245 and the source.
27246
27247 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
27248 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
27249 @end itemize
27250
27251 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
27252 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
27253 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
27254 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
27255
27256 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
27257 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
27258 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
27259 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
27260 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
27261 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
27262 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
27263 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
27264 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
27265
27266 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
27267 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
27268 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
27269 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
27270
27271 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
27272 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
27273 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
27274 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
27275 one you want.
27276
27277 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
27278 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
27279
27280 @table @kbd
27281 @item C-h m
27282 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
27283
27284 @item C-c C-s
27285 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
27286 update the display window to show the current file and location.
27287
27288 @item C-c C-n
27289 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
27290 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
27291 to show the current file and location.
27292
27293 @item C-c C-i
27294 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
27295 display window accordingly.
27296
27297 @item C-c C-f
27298 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
27299 @code{finish} command.
27300
27301 @item C-c C-r
27302 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
27303 command.
27304
27305 @item C-c <
27306 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
27307 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
27308 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
27309
27310 @item C-c >
27311 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
27312 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
27313 @end table
27314
27315 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
27316 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
27317
27318 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
27319 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
27320 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
27321 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
27322 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
27323 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
27324 speedbar displays watch expressions.
27325
27326 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
27327 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
27328 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
27329 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
27330 frame.
27331
27332 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
27333 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
27334 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
27335 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
27336 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
27337 to correspond properly with the code.
27338
27339 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
27340 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
27341 Emacs Manual}).
27342
27343 @node GDB/MI
27344 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
27345
27346 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
27347
27348 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
27349 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
27350 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
27351 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
27352 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
27353 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
27354
27355 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
27356 in the form of a reference manual.
27357
27358 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
27359 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
27360 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
27361
27362 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
27363
27364 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
27365 This chapter uses the following notation:
27366
27367 @itemize @bullet
27368 @item
27369 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
27370
27371 @item
27372 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
27373 it may or may not be given.
27374
27375 @item
27376 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27377 may repeat zero or more times.
27378
27379 @item
27380 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27381 may repeat one or more times.
27382
27383 @item
27384 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
27385 @end itemize
27386
27387 @ignore
27388 @heading Dependencies
27389 @end ignore
27390
27391 @menu
27392 * GDB/MI General Design::
27393 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
27394 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
27395 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
27396 * GDB/MI Output Records::
27397 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
27398 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
27399 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
27400 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27401 * GDB/MI Program Context::
27402 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
27403 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
27404 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
27405 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
27406 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
27407 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
27408 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
27409 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
27410 * GDB/MI File Commands::
27411 @ignore
27412 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
27413 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
27414 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
27415 @end ignore
27416 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
27417 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
27418 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
27419 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
27420 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
27421 @end menu
27422
27423 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27424 @node GDB/MI General Design
27425 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
27426 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
27427
27428 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
27429 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
27430 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
27431 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
27432 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
27433 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
27434 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
27435 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
27436 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
27437 a command and reported as part of that command response.
27438
27439 The important examples of notifications are:
27440 @itemize @bullet
27441
27442 @item
27443 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
27444 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
27445 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
27446 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
27447 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
27448 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
27449 command itself was successfully executed.
27450
27451 @item
27452 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
27453 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
27454 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
27455 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
27456 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
27457 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
27458
27459 @item
27460 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
27461 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
27462 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
27463 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
27464 orthogonal frontend design.
27465
27466 @end itemize
27467
27468 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
27469 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
27470 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
27471 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27472 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27473 the user interface.
27474
27475
27476 @menu
27477 * Context management::
27478 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27479 * Thread groups::
27480 @end menu
27481
27482 @node Context management
27483 @subsection Context management
27484
27485 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27486
27487 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27488 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27489 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27490 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27491 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27492 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27493 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27494 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27495 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27496
27497 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27498 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27499 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27500 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27501 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27502 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27503 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27504 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27505 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27506 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27507 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27508
27509 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27510 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27511 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27512 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27513 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27514 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27515 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27516 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27517 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27518 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27519
27520 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27521 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27522 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27523 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27524 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27525 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27526 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27527 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27528 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27529 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27530 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27531 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27532 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27533 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27534 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27535 @samp{--frame} options.
27536
27537 @subsubsection Language
27538
27539 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27540 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27541 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27542 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27543 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27544 For instance:
27545
27546 @smallexample
27547 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27548 ^done,value="4"
27549 (gdb)
27550 @end smallexample
27551
27552 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27553 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27554 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27555
27556 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27557 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27558
27559 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27560 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27561 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27562 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27563 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27564 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27565 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27566 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27567 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27568
27569 @table @code
27570 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27571 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27572 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27573
27574 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27575 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27576 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27577
27578 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27579 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27580 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27581 MI commands even while the target is running.
27582
27583 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27584 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27585 @end table
27586
27587 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27588 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27589 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27590 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27591 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27592 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27593
27594 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27595 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27596 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27597 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27598 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27599 are running.
27600
27601 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27602 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27603 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27604 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27605 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27606 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27607 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27608 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27609 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27610 @samp{--thread} option).
27611
27612 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27613 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27614 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27615 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27616
27617 @node Thread groups
27618 @subsection Thread groups
27619 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27620 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27621 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27622 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27623 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27624
27625 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27626 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27627 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27628 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27629 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27630 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27631 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27632 into processes.
27633
27634 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27635 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27636 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27637 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27638 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27639 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27640 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27641 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27642 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27643 the members of specific thread group.
27644
27645 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27646 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27647 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27648 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27649 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27650 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27651 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27652 after attaching to that thread group.
27653
27654 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27655 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27656 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27657 such thread groups.
27658
27659 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27660 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27661 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27662
27663 @menu
27664 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27665 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27666 @end menu
27667
27668 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27669 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27670
27671 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27672 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27673 @table @code
27674 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27675 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27676
27677 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27678 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27679 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27680
27681 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27682 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27683 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27684
27685 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27686 "any sequence of digits"
27687
27688 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27689 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27690
27691 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27692 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27693
27694 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27695 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27696
27697 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27698 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27699 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27700
27701 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27702 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27703
27704 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27705 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27706 @end table
27707
27708 @noindent
27709 Notes:
27710
27711 @itemize @bullet
27712 @item
27713 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27714 output is described below.
27715
27716 @item
27717 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27718 finishes.
27719
27720 @item
27721 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27722 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27723 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27724 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27725 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27726 @end itemize
27727
27728 Pragmatics:
27729
27730 @itemize @bullet
27731 @item
27732 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27733
27734 @item
27735 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27736 @end itemize
27737
27738 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27739 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27740
27741 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27742 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27743 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27744 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27745 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27746 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27747
27748 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27749 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27750 @var{token}.
27751
27752 @table @code
27753 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27754 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27755
27756 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27757 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27758
27759 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27760 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27761
27762 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27763 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27764
27765 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27766 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27767
27768 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27769 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27770
27771 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27772 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27773
27774 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27775 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27776
27777 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27778 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27779
27780 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27781 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27782 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27783
27784 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27785 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27786
27787 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27788 @code{ @var{string} }
27789
27790 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27791 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27792
27793 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27794 @code{@var{c-string}}
27795
27796 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27797 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27798
27799 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27800 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27801 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27802
27803 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27804 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27805
27806 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27807 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27808
27809 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27810 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27811
27812 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27813 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27814
27815 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27816 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27817
27818 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27819 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27820 @end table
27821
27822 @noindent
27823 Notes:
27824
27825 @itemize @bullet
27826 @item
27827 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27828
27829 @item
27830 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27831 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27832 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27833 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27834 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27835 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27836 prior command.
27837
27838 @item
27839 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27840 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27841 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27842 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27843
27844 @item
27845 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27846 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27847 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27848 @samp{*}.
27849
27850 @item
27851 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27852 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27853 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27854 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27855
27856 @item
27857 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27858 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27859 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27860 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27861
27862 @item
27863 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27864 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27865 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27866
27867 @item
27868 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27869 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27870 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27871 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27872
27873 @item
27874 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27875 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27876 @var{values}.
27877
27878
27879 @end itemize
27880
27881 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27882 details about the various output records.
27883
27884 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27885 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27886 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27887
27888 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27889 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27890
27891 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27892 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27893 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27894 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27895 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27896 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27897
27898 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27899 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27900 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27901
27902 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27903 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27904 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27905 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27906
27907 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27908 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27909
27910 Since @sc{gdb/mi} is used by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}, changes
27911 to the MI interface may break existing usage. This section describes how the
27912 protocol changes and how to request previous version of the protocol when it
27913 does.
27914
27915 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27916 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27917 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27918 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27919
27920 @itemize @bullet
27921 @item
27922 New MI commands may be added.
27923
27924 @item
27925 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27926
27927 @item
27928 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27929 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27930
27931 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27932 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27933
27934 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27935 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27936 @end itemize
27937
27938 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27939 will be increased by one. The new versions of the MI protocol are not compatible
27940 with the old versions. Old versions of MI remain available, allowing front ends
27941 to keep using them until they are modified to use the latest MI version.
27942
27943 Since @code{--interpreter=mi} always points to the latest MI version, it is
27944 recommended that front ends request a specific version of MI when launching
27945 @value{GDBN} (e.g. @code{--interpreter=mi2}) to make sure they get an
27946 interpreter with the MI version they expect.
27947
27948 The following table gives a summary of the the released versions of the MI
27949 interface: the version number, the version of GDB in which it first appeared
27950 and the breaking changes compared to the previous version.
27951
27952 @multitable @columnfractions .05 .05 .9
27953 @headitem MI version @tab GDB version @tab Breaking changes
27954
27955 @item
27956 @center 1
27957 @tab
27958 @center 5.1
27959 @tab
27960 None
27961
27962 @item
27963 @center 2
27964 @tab
27965 @center 6.0
27966 @tab
27967
27968 @itemize
27969 @item
27970 The @code{-environment-pwd}, @code{-environment-directory} and
27971 @code{-environment-path} commands now returns values using the MI output
27972 syntax, rather than CLI output syntax.
27973
27974 @item
27975 @code{-var-list-children}'s @code{children} result field is now a list, rather
27976 than a tuple.
27977
27978 @item
27979 @code{-var-update}'s @code{changelist} result field is now a list, rather than
27980 a tuple.
27981 @end itemize
27982
27983 @item
27984 @center 3
27985 @tab
27986 @center 9.1
27987 @tab
27988
27989 @itemize
27990 @item
27991 The output of information about multi-location breakpoints has changed in the
27992 responses to the @code{-break-insert} and @code{-break-info} commands, as well
27993 as in the @code{=breakpoint-created} and @code{=breakpoint-modified} events.
27994 The multiple locations are now placed in a @code{locations} field, whose value
27995 is a list.
27996 @end itemize
27997
27998 @end multitable
27999
28000 If your front end cannot yet migrate to a more recent version of the
28001 MI protocol, you can nevertheless selectively enable specific features
28002 available in those recent MI versions, using the following commands:
28003
28004 @table @code
28005
28006 @item -fix-multi-location-breakpoint-output
28007 Use the output for multi-location breakpoints which was introduced by
28008 MI 3, even when using MI versions 2 or 1. This command has no
28009 effect when using MI version 3 or later.
28010
28011 @end table
28012
28013 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
28014 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
28015 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
28016 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
28017 @cindex mailing lists
28018
28019 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28020 @node GDB/MI Output Records
28021 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
28022
28023 @menu
28024 * GDB/MI Result Records::
28025 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
28026 * GDB/MI Async Records::
28027 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
28028 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
28029 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
28030 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
28031 @end menu
28032
28033 @node GDB/MI Result Records
28034 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
28035
28036 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28037 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
28038 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
28039 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
28040
28041 @table @code
28042 @findex ^done
28043 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
28044 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
28045 values.
28046
28047 @item "^running"
28048 @findex ^running
28049 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
28050 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
28051 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
28052 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
28053 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
28054 which threads are resumed.
28055
28056 @item "^connected"
28057 @findex ^connected
28058 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
28059
28060 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
28061 @findex ^error
28062 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
28063 the corresponding error message.
28064
28065 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
28066 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
28067 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
28068
28069 @table @samp
28070 @item "undefined-command"
28071 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
28072 @end table
28073
28074 @item "^exit"
28075 @findex ^exit
28076 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
28077
28078 @end table
28079
28080 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
28081 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
28082
28083 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
28084 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28085 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
28086 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
28087 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
28088
28089 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
28090 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
28091 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
28092 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
28093 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
28094
28095 @table @code
28096 @item "~" @var{string-output}
28097 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
28098 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
28099
28100 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
28101 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
28102 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
28103 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
28104
28105 @item "&" @var{string-output}
28106 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
28107 internals.
28108 @end table
28109
28110 @node GDB/MI Async Records
28111 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
28112
28113 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28114 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
28115 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
28116 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
28117 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
28118 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
28119
28120 The following is the list of possible async records:
28121
28122 @table @code
28123
28124 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
28125 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
28126 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
28127 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
28128 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
28129 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
28130 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
28131 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
28132 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
28133 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
28134 it run freely.
28135
28136 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
28137 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
28138 following values:
28139
28140 @table @code
28141 @item breakpoint-hit
28142 A breakpoint was reached.
28143 @item watchpoint-trigger
28144 A watchpoint was triggered.
28145 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
28146 A read watchpoint was triggered.
28147 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
28148 An access watchpoint was triggered.
28149 @item function-finished
28150 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28151 @item location-reached
28152 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28153 @item watchpoint-scope
28154 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
28155 @item end-stepping-range
28156 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
28157 similar CLI command was accomplished.
28158 @item exited-signalled
28159 The inferior exited because of a signal.
28160 @item exited
28161 The inferior exited.
28162 @item exited-normally
28163 The inferior exited normally.
28164 @item signal-received
28165 A signal was received by the inferior.
28166 @item solib-event
28167 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
28168 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
28169 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
28170 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
28171 @item fork
28172 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
28173 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28174 @item vfork
28175 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
28176 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28177 @item syscall-entry
28178 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
28179 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28180 @item syscall-return
28181 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
28182 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28183 @item exec
28184 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
28185 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28186 @end table
28187
28188 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
28189 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
28190 Depending on whether all-stop
28191 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
28192 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
28193 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
28194 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
28195 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
28196 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
28197 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
28198 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
28199 if such information is not available.
28200
28201 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
28202 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
28203 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
28204 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
28205 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
28206 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
28207 cannot be used in any way.
28208
28209 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
28210 A thread group became associated with a running program,
28211 either because the program was just started or the thread group
28212 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
28213 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
28214 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
28215
28216 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
28217 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
28218 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
28219 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
28220 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
28221 only when the inferior exited with some code.
28222
28223 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28224 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28225 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
28226 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
28227 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
28228
28229 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
28230 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
28231 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
28232 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
28233 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
28234 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
28235 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
28236 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
28237 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
28238
28239 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
28240 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
28241
28242 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
28243 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
28244 that thread.
28245
28246 @item =library-loaded,...
28247 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
28248 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
28249 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
28250 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
28251 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
28252 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
28253 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
28254 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
28255 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
28256 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
28257 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
28258 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
28259 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
28260 to this library.
28261
28262 @item =library-unloaded,...
28263 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
28264 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
28265 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
28266 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
28267 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
28268 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
28269 thread groups.
28270
28271 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
28272 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
28273 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
28274 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
28275 frame is @var{tpnum}.
28276
28277 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
28278 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
28279 initial value @var{initial}.
28280
28281 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
28282 @itemx =tsv-deleted
28283 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
28284 trace state variables are deleted.
28285
28286 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
28287 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
28288 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
28289 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
28290 value of trace state variable is known.
28291
28292 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
28293 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
28294 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
28295 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
28296 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
28297 user.
28298
28299 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
28300 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
28301 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
28302
28303 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
28304 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
28305
28306 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
28307 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
28308 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
28309 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
28310 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
28311
28312 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
28313 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
28314 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
28315 for existing method and format values.
28316
28317 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
28318 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
28319 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
28320 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
28321 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
28322 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
28323
28324 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
28325 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
28326 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
28327 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
28328 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
28329 executable code.
28330 @end table
28331
28332 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
28333 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
28334
28335 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
28336 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
28337 following fields:
28338
28339 @table @code
28340 @item number
28341 The breakpoint number.
28342
28343 @item type
28344 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
28345 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
28346
28347 @item catch-type
28348 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
28349 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
28350
28351 @item disp
28352 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
28353 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
28354 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
28355
28356 @item enabled
28357 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
28358 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28359 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28360
28361 @item addr
28362 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
28363 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
28364 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
28365 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
28366 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
28367
28368 @item func
28369 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
28370 If not known, this field is not present.
28371
28372 @item filename
28373 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
28374 If not known, this field is not present.
28375
28376 @item fullname
28377 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
28378 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28379
28380 @item line
28381 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
28382 If not known, this field is not present.
28383
28384 @item at
28385 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
28386 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
28387 by a symbol name.
28388
28389 @item pending
28390 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
28391 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
28392
28393 @item evaluated-by
28394 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
28395 @samp{target}.
28396
28397 @item thread
28398 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
28399 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
28400
28401 @item task
28402 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
28403 field will hold the task identifier.
28404
28405 @item cond
28406 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
28407
28408 @item ignore
28409 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
28410
28411 @item enable
28412 The enable count of the breakpoint.
28413
28414 @item traceframe-usage
28415 FIXME.
28416
28417 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
28418 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
28419
28420 @item mask
28421 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
28422
28423 @item pass
28424 A tracepoint's pass count.
28425
28426 @item original-location
28427 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
28428 This field is optional.
28429
28430 @item times
28431 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
28432
28433 @item installed
28434 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
28435 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
28436 is not.
28437
28438 @item what
28439 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
28440
28441 @item locations
28442 This field is present if the breakpoint has multiple locations. It is also
28443 exceptionally present if the breakpoint is enabled and has a single, disabled
28444 location.
28445
28446 The value is a list of locations. The format of a location is decribed below.
28447
28448 @end table
28449
28450 A location in a multi-location breakpoint is represented as a tuple with the
28451 following fields:
28452
28453 @table @code
28454
28455 @item number
28456 The location number as a dotted pair, like @samp{1.2}. The first digit is the
28457 number of the parent breakpoint. The second digit is the number of the
28458 location within that breakpoint.
28459
28460 @item enabled
28461 This indicates whether the location is enabled, in which case the
28462 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28463 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28464
28465 @item addr
28466 The address of this location as an hexidecimal number.
28467
28468 @item func
28469 If known, the function in which the location appears.
28470 If not known, this field is not present.
28471
28472 @item file
28473 The name of the source file which contains this location, if known.
28474 If not known, this field is not present.
28475
28476 @item fullname
28477 The full file name of the source file which contains this location, if
28478 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28479
28480 @item line
28481 The line number at which this location appears, if known.
28482 If not known, this field is not present.
28483
28484 @item thread-groups
28485 The thread groups this location is in.
28486
28487 @end table
28488
28489 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
28490 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
28491
28492 @smallexample
28493 -> -break-insert main
28494 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28495 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28496 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28497 times="0"@}
28498 <- (gdb)
28499 @end smallexample
28500
28501 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
28502 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
28503
28504 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
28505 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
28506 fields:
28507
28508 @table @code
28509 @item level
28510 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
28511 zero. This field is always present.
28512
28513 @item func
28514 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
28515 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
28516
28517 @item addr
28518 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
28519
28520 @item file
28521 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
28522 address. This field may be absent.
28523
28524 @item line
28525 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
28526 may be absent.
28527
28528 @item from
28529 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
28530 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
28531
28532 @end table
28533
28534 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
28535 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
28536
28537 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
28538 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
28539 stated otherwise.
28540
28541 @table @code
28542 @item id
28543 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
28544
28545 @item target-id
28546 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
28547
28548 @item details
28549 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
28550 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
28551 frontend. This field is optional.
28552
28553 @item name
28554 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
28555 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
28556 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
28557 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
28558 field is omitted.
28559
28560 @item state
28561 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
28562 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
28563
28564 @item frame
28565 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
28566 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
28567 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
28568
28569 @item core
28570 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
28571 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
28572 @end table
28573
28574 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
28575 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
28576
28577 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
28578 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
28579 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
28580 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
28581 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
28582 the @code{exception-message} field.
28583
28584 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28585 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28586 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28587 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28588
28589 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28590 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28591 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28592 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28593
28594 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28595 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28596
28597 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28598
28599 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28600 information of the breakpoint.
28601
28602 @smallexample
28603 -> -break-insert main
28604 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28605 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28606 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28607 times="0"@}
28608 <- (gdb)
28609 @end smallexample
28610
28611 @subheading Program Execution
28612
28613 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28614 reason that execution stopped.
28615
28616 @smallexample
28617 -> -exec-run
28618 <- ^running
28619 <- (gdb)
28620 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28621 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28622 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28623 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28624 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28625 <- (gdb)
28626 -> -exec-continue
28627 <- ^running
28628 <- (gdb)
28629 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28630 <- (gdb)
28631 @end smallexample
28632
28633 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28634
28635 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28636
28637 @smallexample
28638 -> (gdb)
28639 <- -gdb-exit
28640 <- ^exit
28641 @end smallexample
28642
28643 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28644 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28645 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28646 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28647 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28648 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28649
28650 @subheading A Bad Command
28651
28652 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28653
28654 @smallexample
28655 -> -rubbish
28656 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28657 <- (gdb)
28658 @end smallexample
28659
28660
28661 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28662 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28663 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28664
28665 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28666 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28667
28668 @subheading Motivation
28669
28670 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28671
28672 @subheading Introduction
28673
28674 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28675
28676 @subheading Commands
28677
28678 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28679
28680 @subsubheading Synopsis
28681
28682 @smallexample
28683 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28684 @end smallexample
28685
28686 @subsubheading Result
28687
28688 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28689
28690 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28691
28692 @subsubheading Example
28693
28694 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28695 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28696
28697
28698 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28699 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28700 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28701
28702 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28703 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28704 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28705 breakpoints.
28706
28707 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28708 @findex -break-after
28709
28710 @subsubheading Synopsis
28711
28712 @smallexample
28713 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28714 @end smallexample
28715
28716 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28717 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28718 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28719 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28720
28721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28722
28723 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28724
28725 @subsubheading Example
28726
28727 @smallexample
28728 (gdb)
28729 -break-insert main
28730 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28731 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28732 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28733 times="0"@}
28734 (gdb)
28735 -break-after 1 3
28736 ~
28737 ^done
28738 (gdb)
28739 -break-list
28740 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28741 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28742 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28743 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28744 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28745 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28746 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28747 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28748 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28749 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28750 (gdb)
28751 @end smallexample
28752
28753 @ignore
28754 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28755 @findex -break-catch
28756 @end ignore
28757
28758 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28759 @findex -break-commands
28760
28761 @subsubheading Synopsis
28762
28763 @smallexample
28764 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28765 @end smallexample
28766
28767 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28768 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28769 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28770 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28771 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28772 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28773
28774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28775
28776 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28777
28778 @subsubheading Example
28779
28780 @smallexample
28781 (gdb)
28782 -break-insert main
28783 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28784 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28785 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28786 times="0"@}
28787 (gdb)
28788 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28789 ^done
28790 (gdb)
28791 @end smallexample
28792
28793 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28794 @findex -break-condition
28795
28796 @subsubheading Synopsis
28797
28798 @smallexample
28799 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28800 @end smallexample
28801
28802 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28803 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28804 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28805 command below).
28806
28807 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28808
28809 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28810
28811 @subsubheading Example
28812
28813 @smallexample
28814 (gdb)
28815 -break-condition 1 1
28816 ^done
28817 (gdb)
28818 -break-list
28819 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28820 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28821 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28822 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28823 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28824 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28825 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28826 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28827 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28828 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28829 (gdb)
28830 @end smallexample
28831
28832 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28833 @findex -break-delete
28834
28835 @subsubheading Synopsis
28836
28837 @smallexample
28838 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28839 @end smallexample
28840
28841 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28842 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28843
28844 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28845
28846 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28847
28848 @subsubheading Example
28849
28850 @smallexample
28851 (gdb)
28852 -break-delete 1
28853 ^done
28854 (gdb)
28855 -break-list
28856 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28857 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28858 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28859 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28860 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28861 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28862 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28863 body=[]@}
28864 (gdb)
28865 @end smallexample
28866
28867 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28868 @findex -break-disable
28869
28870 @subsubheading Synopsis
28871
28872 @smallexample
28873 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28874 @end smallexample
28875
28876 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28877 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28878
28879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28880
28881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28882
28883 @subsubheading Example
28884
28885 @smallexample
28886 (gdb)
28887 -break-disable 2
28888 ^done
28889 (gdb)
28890 -break-list
28891 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28892 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28893 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28894 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28895 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28896 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28897 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28898 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28899 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28900 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28901 (gdb)
28902 @end smallexample
28903
28904 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28905 @findex -break-enable
28906
28907 @subsubheading Synopsis
28908
28909 @smallexample
28910 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28911 @end smallexample
28912
28913 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28914
28915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28916
28917 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28918
28919 @subsubheading Example
28920
28921 @smallexample
28922 (gdb)
28923 -break-enable 2
28924 ^done
28925 (gdb)
28926 -break-list
28927 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28928 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28929 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28930 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28931 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28932 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28933 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28934 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28935 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28936 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28937 (gdb)
28938 @end smallexample
28939
28940 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28941 @findex -break-info
28942
28943 @subsubheading Synopsis
28944
28945 @smallexample
28946 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28947 @end smallexample
28948
28949 @c REDUNDANT???
28950 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28951
28952 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28953 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28954 table.
28955
28956 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28957
28958 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28959
28960 @subsubheading Example
28961 N.A.
28962
28963 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28964 @findex -break-insert
28965 @anchor{-break-insert}
28966
28967 @subsubheading Synopsis
28968
28969 @smallexample
28970 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28971 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28972 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28973 @end smallexample
28974
28975 @noindent
28976 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28977
28978 @table @var
28979 @item linespec location
28980 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28981
28982 @item explicit location
28983 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28984 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28985 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28986
28987 @table @samp
28988 @item --source @var{filename}
28989 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28990 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28991
28992 @item --function @var{function}
28993 The name of a function or method.
28994
28995 @item --label @var{label}
28996 The name of a label.
28997
28998 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28999 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
29000 @end table
29001
29002 @item address location
29003 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
29004 @end table
29005
29006 @noindent
29007 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
29008
29009 @table @samp
29010 @item -t
29011 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
29012 @item -h
29013 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
29014 @item -f
29015 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
29016 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
29017 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
29018 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
29019 cannot be parsed.
29020 @item -d
29021 Create a disabled breakpoint.
29022 @item -a
29023 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
29024 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
29025 @item -c @var{condition}
29026 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29027 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
29028 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
29029 @item -p @var{thread-id}
29030 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
29031 @var{thread-id}.
29032 @end table
29033
29034 @subsubheading Result
29035
29036 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
29037 resulting breakpoint.
29038
29039 Note: this format is open to change.
29040 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
29041
29042 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29043
29044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
29045 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
29046
29047 @subsubheading Example
29048
29049 @smallexample
29050 (gdb)
29051 -break-insert main
29052 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
29053 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
29054 times="0"@}
29055 (gdb)
29056 -break-insert -t foo
29057 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
29058 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29059 times="0"@}
29060 (gdb)
29061 -break-list
29062 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29063 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29064 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29065 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29066 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29067 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29068 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29069 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29070 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
29071 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
29072 times="0"@},
29073 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29074 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
29075 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29076 times="0"@}]@}
29077 (gdb)
29078 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
29079 @c ~int foo(int, int);
29080 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
29081 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29082 @c times="0"@}
29083 @c (gdb)
29084 @end smallexample
29085
29086 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
29087 @findex -dprintf-insert
29088
29089 @subsubheading Synopsis
29090
29091 @smallexample
29092 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
29093 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
29094 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
29095 [ @var{argument} ]
29096 @end smallexample
29097
29098 @noindent
29099 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
29100 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
29101
29102 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
29103
29104 @table @samp
29105 @item -t
29106 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
29107 @item -f
29108 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
29109 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
29110 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
29111 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
29112 cannot be parsed.
29113 @item -d
29114 Create a disabled breakpoint.
29115 @item -c @var{condition}
29116 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29117 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
29118 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
29119 to @var{ignore-count}.
29120 @item -p @var{thread-id}
29121 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
29122 @var{thread-id}.
29123 @end table
29124
29125 @subsubheading Result
29126
29127 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
29128 resulting breakpoint.
29129
29130 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
29131
29132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29133
29134 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
29135
29136 @subsubheading Example
29137
29138 @smallexample
29139 (gdb)
29140 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
29141 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29142 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29143 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
29144 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
29145 original-location="foo"@}
29146 (gdb)
29147 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
29148 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29149 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29150 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
29151 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
29152 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
29153 (gdb)
29154 @end smallexample
29155
29156 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
29157 @findex -break-list
29158
29159 @subsubheading Synopsis
29160
29161 @smallexample
29162 -break-list
29163 @end smallexample
29164
29165 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
29166
29167 @table @samp
29168 @item Number
29169 number of the breakpoint
29170 @item Type
29171 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
29172 @item Disposition
29173 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
29174 or @samp{nokeep}
29175 @item Enabled
29176 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
29177 @item Address
29178 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
29179 @item What
29180 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
29181 name, line number
29182 @item Thread-groups
29183 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
29184 @item Times
29185 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
29186 @end table
29187
29188 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
29189 @code{body} field is an empty list.
29190
29191 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29192
29193 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
29194
29195 @subsubheading Example
29196
29197 @smallexample
29198 (gdb)
29199 -break-list
29200 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29201 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29202 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29203 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29204 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29205 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29206 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29207 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29208 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29209 times="0"@},
29210 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29211 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29212 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29213 (gdb)
29214 @end smallexample
29215
29216 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
29217
29218 @smallexample
29219 (gdb)
29220 -break-list
29221 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
29222 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29223 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29224 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29225 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29226 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29227 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29228 body=[]@}
29229 (gdb)
29230 @end smallexample
29231
29232 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
29233 @findex -break-passcount
29234
29235 @subsubheading Synopsis
29236
29237 @smallexample
29238 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
29239 @end smallexample
29240
29241 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
29242 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
29243 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
29244 command @samp{passcount}.
29245
29246 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
29247 @findex -break-watch
29248
29249 @subsubheading Synopsis
29250
29251 @smallexample
29252 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
29253 @end smallexample
29254
29255 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
29256 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
29257 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
29258 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
29259 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
29260 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
29261 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
29262 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
29263
29264 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
29265 breakpoints inserted.
29266
29267 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29268
29269 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
29270 @samp{rwatch}.
29271
29272 @subsubheading Example
29273
29274 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
29275
29276 @smallexample
29277 (gdb)
29278 -break-watch x
29279 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
29280 (gdb)
29281 -exec-continue
29282 ^running
29283 (gdb)
29284 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
29285 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
29286 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29287 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29288 (gdb)
29289 @end smallexample
29290
29291 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
29292 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
29293 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
29294
29295 @smallexample
29296 (gdb)
29297 -break-watch C
29298 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
29299 (gdb)
29300 -exec-continue
29301 ^running
29302 (gdb)
29303 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
29304 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29305 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29306 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29307 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29308 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29309 (gdb)
29310 -exec-continue
29311 ^running
29312 (gdb)
29313 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
29314 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29315 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29316 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29317 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29318 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29319 (gdb)
29320 @end smallexample
29321
29322 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
29323 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
29324 deleted.
29325
29326 @smallexample
29327 (gdb)
29328 -break-watch C
29329 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
29330 (gdb)
29331 -break-list
29332 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29333 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29334 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29335 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29336 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29337 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29338 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29339 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29340 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29341 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29342 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29343 times="1"@},
29344 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29345 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29346 (gdb)
29347 -exec-continue
29348 ^running
29349 (gdb)
29350 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
29351 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29352 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29353 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29354 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29355 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29356 (gdb)
29357 -break-list
29358 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29359 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29360 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29361 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29362 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29363 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29364 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29365 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29366 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29367 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29368 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29369 times="1"@},
29370 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29371 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
29372 (gdb)
29373 -exec-continue
29374 ^running
29375 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
29376 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29377 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29378 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29379 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29380 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29381 (gdb)
29382 -break-list
29383 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29384 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29385 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29386 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29387 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29388 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29389 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29390 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29391 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29392 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29393 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29394 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
29395 (gdb)
29396 @end smallexample
29397
29398
29399 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29400 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29401 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
29402
29403 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29404 catchpoints.
29405
29406 @menu
29407 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29408 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
29409 @end menu
29410
29411 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29412 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29413
29414 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
29415 @findex -catch-load
29416
29417 @subsubheading Synopsis
29418
29419 @smallexample
29420 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29421 @end smallexample
29422
29423 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
29424 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29425 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
29426 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29427 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
29428
29429
29430 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29431
29432 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
29433
29434 @subsubheading Example
29435
29436 @smallexample
29437 -catch-load -t foo.so
29438 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29439 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
29440 (gdb)
29441 @end smallexample
29442
29443
29444 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
29445 @findex -catch-unload
29446
29447 @subsubheading Synopsis
29448
29449 @smallexample
29450 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
29451 @end smallexample
29452
29453 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
29454 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
29455 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
29456 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
29457 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
29458
29459 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29460
29461 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
29462
29463 @subsubheading Example
29464
29465 @smallexample
29466 -catch-unload -d bar.so
29467 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29468 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
29469 (gdb)
29470 @end smallexample
29471
29472 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
29473 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
29474
29475 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
29476 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
29477
29478 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
29479 @findex -catch-assert
29480
29481 @subsubheading Synopsis
29482
29483 @smallexample
29484 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
29485 @end smallexample
29486
29487 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
29488
29489 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29490
29491 @table @samp
29492 @item -c @var{condition}
29493 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29494 @item -d
29495 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29496 @item -t
29497 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29498 @end table
29499
29500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29501
29502 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
29503
29504 @subsubheading Example
29505
29506 @smallexample
29507 -catch-assert
29508 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29509 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
29510 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
29511 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
29512 (gdb)
29513 @end smallexample
29514
29515 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
29516 @findex -catch-exception
29517
29518 @subsubheading Synopsis
29519
29520 @smallexample
29521 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29522 [ -t ] [ -u ]
29523 @end smallexample
29524
29525 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
29526 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29527 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29528 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29529 catchpoints.
29530
29531 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29532
29533 @table @samp
29534 @item -c @var{condition}
29535 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29536 @item -d
29537 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29538 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29539 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
29540 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
29541 @item -t
29542 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29543 @item -u
29544 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
29545 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
29546 @end table
29547
29548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29549
29550 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
29551 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
29552
29553 @subsubheading Example
29554
29555 @smallexample
29556 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
29557 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29558 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
29559 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
29560 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
29561 (gdb)
29562 @end smallexample
29563
29564 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
29565 @findex -catch-handlers
29566
29567 @subsubheading Synopsis
29568
29569 @smallexample
29570 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
29571 [ -t ]
29572 @end smallexample
29573
29574 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
29575 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
29576 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
29577 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
29578 catchpoints.
29579
29580 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29581
29582 @table @samp
29583 @item -c @var{condition}
29584 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29585 @item -d
29586 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29587 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29588 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29589 @item -t
29590 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29591 @end table
29592
29593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29594
29595 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29596
29597 @subsubheading Example
29598
29599 @smallexample
29600 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29601 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29602 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29603 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29604 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29605 (gdb)
29606 @end smallexample
29607
29608 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29609 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29610 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29611
29612 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29613 @findex -exec-arguments
29614
29615
29616 @subsubheading Synopsis
29617
29618 @smallexample
29619 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29620 @end smallexample
29621
29622 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29623 @samp{-exec-run}.
29624
29625 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29626
29627 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29628
29629 @subsubheading Example
29630
29631 @smallexample
29632 (gdb)
29633 -exec-arguments -v word
29634 ^done
29635 (gdb)
29636 @end smallexample
29637
29638
29639 @ignore
29640 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29641 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29642
29643 @subsubheading Synopsis
29644
29645 @smallexample
29646 -exec-show-arguments
29647 @end smallexample
29648
29649 Print the arguments of the program.
29650
29651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29652
29653 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29654
29655 @subsubheading Example
29656 N.A.
29657 @end ignore
29658
29659
29660 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29661 @findex -environment-cd
29662
29663 @subsubheading Synopsis
29664
29665 @smallexample
29666 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29667 @end smallexample
29668
29669 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29670
29671 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29672
29673 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29674
29675 @subsubheading Example
29676
29677 @smallexample
29678 (gdb)
29679 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29680 ^done
29681 (gdb)
29682 @end smallexample
29683
29684
29685 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29686 @findex -environment-directory
29687
29688 @subsubheading Synopsis
29689
29690 @smallexample
29691 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29692 @end smallexample
29693
29694 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29695 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29696 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29697 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29698 occurs as normal.
29699 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29700 multiple directories in a single command
29701 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29702 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29703 If blanks are needed as
29704 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29705 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29706 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29707 character must not be used
29708 in any directory name.
29709 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29710
29711 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29712
29713 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29714
29715 @subsubheading Example
29716
29717 @smallexample
29718 (gdb)
29719 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29720 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29721 (gdb)
29722 -environment-directory ""
29723 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29724 (gdb)
29725 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29726 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29727 (gdb)
29728 -environment-directory -r
29729 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29730 (gdb)
29731 @end smallexample
29732
29733
29734 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29735 @findex -environment-path
29736
29737 @subsubheading Synopsis
29738
29739 @smallexample
29740 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29741 @end smallexample
29742
29743 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29744 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29745 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29746 supplied in addition to the
29747 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29748 occurs as normal.
29749 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29750 multiple directories in a single command
29751 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29752 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29753 If blanks are needed as
29754 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29755 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29756 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29757 character must not be used
29758 in any directory name.
29759 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29760
29761
29762 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29763
29764 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29765
29766 @subsubheading Example
29767
29768 @smallexample
29769 (gdb)
29770 -environment-path
29771 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29772 (gdb)
29773 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29774 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29775 (gdb)
29776 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29777 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29778 (gdb)
29779 @end smallexample
29780
29781
29782 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29783 @findex -environment-pwd
29784
29785 @subsubheading Synopsis
29786
29787 @smallexample
29788 -environment-pwd
29789 @end smallexample
29790
29791 Show the current working directory.
29792
29793 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29794
29795 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29796
29797 @subsubheading Example
29798
29799 @smallexample
29800 (gdb)
29801 -environment-pwd
29802 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29803 (gdb)
29804 @end smallexample
29805
29806 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29807 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29808 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29809
29810
29811 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29812 @findex -thread-info
29813
29814 @subsubheading Synopsis
29815
29816 @smallexample
29817 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29818 @end smallexample
29819
29820 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29821 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29822 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29823 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29824 current thread.
29825
29826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29827
29828 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29829 about all threads.
29830
29831 @subsubheading Result
29832
29833 The result contains the following attributes:
29834
29835 @table @samp
29836 @item threads
29837 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29838 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29839
29840 @item current-thread-id
29841 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29842 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29843 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29844 the command.
29845
29846 @end table
29847
29848 @subsubheading Example
29849
29850 @smallexample
29851 -thread-info
29852 ^done,threads=[
29853 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29854 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29855 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29856 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29857 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29858 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29859 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29860 state="running"@}],
29861 current-thread-id="1"
29862 (gdb)
29863 @end smallexample
29864
29865 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29866 @findex -thread-list-ids
29867
29868 @subsubheading Synopsis
29869
29870 @smallexample
29871 -thread-list-ids
29872 @end smallexample
29873
29874 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29875 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29876 threads.
29877
29878 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29879 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29880
29881 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29882
29883 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29884
29885 @subsubheading Example
29886
29887 @smallexample
29888 (gdb)
29889 -thread-list-ids
29890 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29891 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29892 (gdb)
29893 @end smallexample
29894
29895
29896 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29897 @findex -thread-select
29898
29899 @subsubheading Synopsis
29900
29901 @smallexample
29902 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29903 @end smallexample
29904
29905 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29906 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29907 topmost frame for that thread.
29908
29909 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29910 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29911
29912 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29913
29914 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29915
29916 @subsubheading Example
29917
29918 @smallexample
29919 (gdb)
29920 -exec-next
29921 ^running
29922 (gdb)
29923 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29924 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29925 (gdb)
29926 -thread-list-ids
29927 ^done,
29928 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29929 number-of-threads="3"
29930 (gdb)
29931 -thread-select 3
29932 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29933 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29934 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29935 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29936 (gdb)
29937 @end smallexample
29938
29939 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29940 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29941 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29942
29943 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29944 @findex -ada-task-info
29945
29946 @subsubheading Synopsis
29947
29948 @smallexample
29949 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29950 @end smallexample
29951
29952 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29953 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29954
29955 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29956
29957 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29958 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29959
29960 @subsubheading Result
29961
29962 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29963 defined for each Ada task:
29964
29965 @table @samp
29966 @item current
29967 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29968
29969 @item id
29970 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29971
29972 @item task-id
29973 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29974
29975 @item thread-id
29976 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29977 task.
29978
29979 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29980 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29981 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29982
29983 @item parent-id
29984 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29985 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29986
29987 @item priority
29988 The base priority of the task.
29989
29990 @item state
29991 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29992 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29993
29994 @item name
29995 The name of the task.
29996
29997 @end table
29998
29999 @subsubheading Example
30000
30001 @smallexample
30002 -ada-task-info
30003 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
30004 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
30005 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
30006 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
30007 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
30008 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
30009 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
30010 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
30011 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
30012 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
30013 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
30014 (gdb)
30015 @end smallexample
30016
30017 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30018 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
30019 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
30020
30021 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
30022 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
30023 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
30024 other cases.
30025
30026 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
30027 @findex -exec-continue
30028
30029 @subsubheading Synopsis
30030
30031 @smallexample
30032 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
30033 @end smallexample
30034
30035 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
30036 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
30037 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
30038 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
30039 @itemize @bullet
30040 @item
30041 breakpoints or watchpoints
30042 @item
30043 signals or exceptions
30044 @item
30045 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
30046 @item
30047 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
30048 @end itemize
30049 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
30050 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
30051 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
30052 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
30053 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
30054 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
30055
30056 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30057
30058 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
30059
30060 @subsubheading Example
30061
30062 @smallexample
30063 -exec-continue
30064 ^running
30065 (gdb)
30066 @@Hello world
30067 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
30068 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
30069 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30070 (gdb)
30071 @end smallexample
30072
30073
30074 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
30075 @findex -exec-finish
30076
30077 @subsubheading Synopsis
30078
30079 @smallexample
30080 -exec-finish [--reverse]
30081 @end smallexample
30082
30083 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
30084 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
30085 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
30086 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
30087 function was called.
30088
30089 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30090
30091 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
30092
30093 @subsubheading Example
30094
30095 Function returning @code{void}.
30096
30097 @smallexample
30098 -exec-finish
30099 ^running
30100 (gdb)
30101 @@hello from foo
30102 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30103 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30104 (gdb)
30105 @end smallexample
30106
30107 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
30108 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
30109 value itself.
30110
30111 @smallexample
30112 -exec-finish
30113 ^running
30114 (gdb)
30115 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
30116 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
30117 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30118 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30119 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
30120 (gdb)
30121 @end smallexample
30122
30123
30124 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
30125 @findex -exec-interrupt
30126
30127 @subsubheading Synopsis
30128
30129 @smallexample
30130 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
30131 @end smallexample
30132
30133 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
30134 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
30135 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
30136 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
30137 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
30138
30139 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
30140 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
30141 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
30142 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
30143
30144 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
30145 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
30146 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
30147 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
30148
30149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30150
30151 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
30152
30153 @subsubheading Example
30154
30155 @smallexample
30156 (gdb)
30157 111-exec-continue
30158 111^running
30159
30160 (gdb)
30161 222-exec-interrupt
30162 222^done
30163 (gdb)
30164 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
30165 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30166 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30167 (gdb)
30168
30169 (gdb)
30170 -exec-interrupt
30171 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
30172 (gdb)
30173 @end smallexample
30174
30175 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
30176 @findex -exec-jump
30177
30178 @subsubheading Synopsis
30179
30180 @smallexample
30181 -exec-jump @var{location}
30182 @end smallexample
30183
30184 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
30185 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
30186 different forms of @var{location}.
30187
30188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30189
30190 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
30191
30192 @subsubheading Example
30193
30194 @smallexample
30195 -exec-jump foo.c:10
30196 *running,thread-id="all"
30197 ^running
30198 @end smallexample
30199
30200
30201 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
30202 @findex -exec-next
30203
30204 @subsubheading Synopsis
30205
30206 @smallexample
30207 -exec-next [--reverse]
30208 @end smallexample
30209
30210 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30211 of the next source line is reached.
30212
30213 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30214 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
30215 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
30216 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
30217 source line where the function was called.
30218
30219
30220 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30221
30222 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
30223
30224 @subsubheading Example
30225
30226 @smallexample
30227 -exec-next
30228 ^running
30229 (gdb)
30230 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
30231 (gdb)
30232 @end smallexample
30233
30234
30235 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
30236 @findex -exec-next-instruction
30237
30238 @subsubheading Synopsis
30239
30240 @smallexample
30241 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
30242 @end smallexample
30243
30244 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
30245 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
30246 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
30247 printed as well.
30248
30249 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30250 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
30251 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
30252 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
30253 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
30254
30255 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30256
30257 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
30258
30259 @subsubheading Example
30260
30261 @smallexample
30262 (gdb)
30263 -exec-next-instruction
30264 ^running
30265
30266 (gdb)
30267 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30268 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
30269 (gdb)
30270 @end smallexample
30271
30272
30273 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
30274 @findex -exec-return
30275
30276 @subsubheading Synopsis
30277
30278 @smallexample
30279 -exec-return
30280 @end smallexample
30281
30282 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
30283 Displays the new current frame.
30284
30285 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30286
30287 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
30288
30289 @subsubheading Example
30290
30291 @smallexample
30292 (gdb)
30293 200-break-insert callee4
30294 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
30295 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
30296 (gdb)
30297 000-exec-run
30298 000^running
30299 (gdb)
30300 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30301 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30302 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30303 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30304 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30305 (gdb)
30306 205-break-delete
30307 205^done
30308 (gdb)
30309 111-exec-return
30310 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
30311 args=[@{name="strarg",
30312 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30313 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30314 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
30315 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30316 (gdb)
30317 @end smallexample
30318
30319
30320 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
30321 @findex -exec-run
30322
30323 @subsubheading Synopsis
30324
30325 @smallexample
30326 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
30327 @end smallexample
30328
30329 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
30330 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
30331 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
30332 the program has exited exceptionally.
30333
30334 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
30335 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
30336 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
30337 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
30338 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
30339
30340 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
30341 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
30342 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
30343 (@pxref{Starting}).
30344
30345 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30346
30347 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
30348
30349 @subsubheading Examples
30350
30351 @smallexample
30352 (gdb)
30353 -break-insert main
30354 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
30355 (gdb)
30356 -exec-run
30357 ^running
30358 (gdb)
30359 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
30360 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
30361 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30362 (gdb)
30363 @end smallexample
30364
30365 @noindent
30366 Program exited normally:
30367
30368 @smallexample
30369 (gdb)
30370 -exec-run
30371 ^running
30372 (gdb)
30373 x = 55
30374 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
30375 (gdb)
30376 @end smallexample
30377
30378 @noindent
30379 Program exited exceptionally:
30380
30381 @smallexample
30382 (gdb)
30383 -exec-run
30384 ^running
30385 (gdb)
30386 x = 55
30387 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
30388 (gdb)
30389 @end smallexample
30390
30391 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
30392 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
30393
30394 @smallexample
30395 (gdb)
30396 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
30397 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
30398 @end smallexample
30399
30400
30401 @c @subheading -exec-signal
30402
30403
30404 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
30405 @findex -exec-step
30406
30407 @subsubheading Synopsis
30408
30409 @smallexample
30410 -exec-step [--reverse]
30411 @end smallexample
30412
30413 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30414 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
30415 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
30416 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
30417 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
30418 previously executed source line.
30419
30420 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30421
30422 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
30423
30424 @subsubheading Example
30425
30426 Stepping into a function:
30427
30428 @smallexample
30429 -exec-step
30430 ^running
30431 (gdb)
30432 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30433 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
30434 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
30435 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30436 (gdb)
30437 @end smallexample
30438
30439 Regular stepping:
30440
30441 @smallexample
30442 -exec-step
30443 ^running
30444 (gdb)
30445 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
30446 (gdb)
30447 @end smallexample
30448
30449
30450 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
30451 @findex -exec-step-instruction
30452
30453 @subsubheading Synopsis
30454
30455 @smallexample
30456 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
30457 @end smallexample
30458
30459 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
30460 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
30461 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
30462 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
30463 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
30464 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
30465 as well.
30466
30467 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30468
30469 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
30470
30471 @subsubheading Example
30472
30473 @smallexample
30474 (gdb)
30475 -exec-step-instruction
30476 ^running
30477
30478 (gdb)
30479 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30480 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30481 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30482 (gdb)
30483 -exec-step-instruction
30484 ^running
30485
30486 (gdb)
30487 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
30488 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30489 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30490 (gdb)
30491 @end smallexample
30492
30493
30494 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
30495 @findex -exec-until
30496
30497 @subsubheading Synopsis
30498
30499 @smallexample
30500 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
30501 @end smallexample
30502
30503 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
30504 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
30505 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
30506 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
30507
30508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30509
30510 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
30511
30512 @subsubheading Example
30513
30514 @smallexample
30515 (gdb)
30516 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
30517 ^running
30518 (gdb)
30519 x = 55
30520 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30521 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
30522 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30523 (gdb)
30524 @end smallexample
30525
30526 @ignore
30527 @subheading -file-clear
30528 Is this going away????
30529 @end ignore
30530
30531 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30532 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
30533 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
30534
30535 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
30536 @findex -enable-frame-filters
30537
30538 @smallexample
30539 -enable-frame-filters
30540 @end smallexample
30541
30542 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
30543 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
30544 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30545 request that this functionality be enabled.
30546
30547 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30548
30549 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30550 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30551
30552 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
30553 @findex -stack-info-frame
30554
30555 @subsubheading Synopsis
30556
30557 @smallexample
30558 -stack-info-frame
30559 @end smallexample
30560
30561 Get info on the selected frame.
30562
30563 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30564
30565 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
30566 (without arguments).
30567
30568 @subsubheading Example
30569
30570 @smallexample
30571 (gdb)
30572 -stack-info-frame
30573 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30574 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30575 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30576 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30577 (gdb)
30578 @end smallexample
30579
30580 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
30581 @findex -stack-info-depth
30582
30583 @subsubheading Synopsis
30584
30585 @smallexample
30586 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30587 @end smallexample
30588
30589 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30590 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30591
30592 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30593
30594 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30595
30596 @subsubheading Example
30597
30598 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30599
30600 @smallexample
30601 (gdb)
30602 -stack-info-depth
30603 ^done,depth="12"
30604 (gdb)
30605 -stack-info-depth 4
30606 ^done,depth="4"
30607 (gdb)
30608 -stack-info-depth 12
30609 ^done,depth="12"
30610 (gdb)
30611 -stack-info-depth 11
30612 ^done,depth="11"
30613 (gdb)
30614 -stack-info-depth 13
30615 ^done,depth="12"
30616 (gdb)
30617 @end smallexample
30618
30619 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30620 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30621 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30622
30623 @subsubheading Synopsis
30624
30625 @smallexample
30626 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30627 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30628 @end smallexample
30629
30630 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30631 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30632 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30633 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30634 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30635 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30636 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30637 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30638
30639 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30640 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30641 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30642 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30643 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30644 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30645
30646 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30647 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30648 are still displayed, however.
30649
30650 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30651 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30652
30653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30654
30655 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30656 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30657 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30658
30659 @subsubheading Example
30660
30661 @smallexample
30662 (gdb)
30663 -stack-list-frames
30664 ^done,
30665 stack=[
30666 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30667 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30668 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30669 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30670 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30671 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30672 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30673 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30674 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30675 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30676 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30677 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30678 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30679 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30680 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30681 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30682 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30683 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30684 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30685 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30686 (gdb)
30687 -stack-list-arguments 0
30688 ^done,
30689 stack-args=[
30690 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30691 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30692 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30693 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30694 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30695 (gdb)
30696 -stack-list-arguments 1
30697 ^done,
30698 stack-args=[
30699 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30700 frame=@{level="1",
30701 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30702 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30703 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30704 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30705 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30706 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30707 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30708 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30709 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30710 (gdb)
30711 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30712 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30713 (gdb)
30714 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30715 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30716 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30717 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30718 (gdb)
30719 @end smallexample
30720
30721 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30722
30723
30724 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30725 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30726 @findex -stack-list-frames
30727
30728 @subsubheading Synopsis
30729
30730 @smallexample
30731 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30732 @end smallexample
30733
30734 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30735 following info:
30736
30737 @table @samp
30738 @item @var{level}
30739 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30740 @item @var{addr}
30741 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30742 @item @var{func}
30743 Function name.
30744 @item @var{file}
30745 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30746 @item @var{fullname}
30747 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30748 @item @var{line}
30749 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30750 @item @var{from}
30751 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30752 if the frame's function is not known.
30753 @item @var{arch}
30754 Frame's architecture.
30755 @end table
30756
30757 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30758 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30759 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30760 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30761 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30762 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30763 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30764 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30765 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30766
30767 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30768
30769 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30770
30771 @subsubheading Example
30772
30773 Full stack backtrace:
30774
30775 @smallexample
30776 (gdb)
30777 -stack-list-frames
30778 ^done,stack=
30779 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30780 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30781 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30782 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30783 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30784 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30785 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30786 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30787 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30788 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30789 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30790 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30791 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30792 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30793 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30794 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30795 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30796 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30797 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30798 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30799 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30800 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30801 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30802 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30803 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30804 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30805 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30806 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30807 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30808 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30809 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30810 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30811 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30812 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30813 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30814 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30815 (gdb)
30816 @end smallexample
30817
30818 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30819
30820 @smallexample
30821 (gdb)
30822 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30823 ^done,stack=
30824 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30825 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30826 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30827 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30828 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30829 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30830 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30831 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30832 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30833 (gdb)
30834 @end smallexample
30835
30836 Show a single frame:
30837
30838 @smallexample
30839 (gdb)
30840 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30841 ^done,stack=
30842 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30843 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30844 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30845 (gdb)
30846 @end smallexample
30847
30848
30849 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30850 @findex -stack-list-locals
30851 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30852
30853 @subsubheading Synopsis
30854
30855 @smallexample
30856 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30857 @end smallexample
30858
30859 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30860 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30861 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30862 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30863 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30864 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30865 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30866 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30867 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30868 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30869
30870 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30871 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30872 variables are still displayed, however.
30873
30874 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30875 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30876
30877 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30878
30879 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30880
30881 @subsubheading Example
30882
30883 @smallexample
30884 (gdb)
30885 -stack-list-locals 0
30886 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30887 (gdb)
30888 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30889 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30890 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30891 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30892 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30893 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30894 (gdb)
30895 @end smallexample
30896
30897 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30898 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30899 @findex -stack-list-variables
30900
30901 @subsubheading Synopsis
30902
30903 @smallexample
30904 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30905 @end smallexample
30906
30907 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30908 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30909 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30910 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30911 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30912 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30913 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30914
30915 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30916 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30917 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30918
30919 @subsubheading Example
30920
30921 @smallexample
30922 (gdb)
30923 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30924 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30925 (gdb)
30926 @end smallexample
30927
30928
30929 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30930 @findex -stack-select-frame
30931
30932 @subsubheading Synopsis
30933
30934 @smallexample
30935 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30936 @end smallexample
30937
30938 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30939 the stack.
30940
30941 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30942 option to every command.
30943
30944 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30945
30946 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30947 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30948
30949 @subsubheading Example
30950
30951 @smallexample
30952 (gdb)
30953 -stack-select-frame 2
30954 ^done
30955 (gdb)
30956 @end smallexample
30957
30958 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30959 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30960 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30961
30962 @ignore
30963
30964 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30965
30966 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30967 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30968 used by @code{Insight}.
30969
30970 The two main reasons for that are:
30971
30972 @enumerate 1
30973 @item
30974 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30975
30976 @item
30977 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30978 now).
30979 @end enumerate
30980
30981 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30982 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30983 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30984 hints about their use.
30985
30986 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30987 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30988 least, the following operations:
30989
30990 @itemize @bullet
30991 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30992 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30993 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30994 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30995 @end itemize
30996
30997 @end ignore
30998
30999 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
31000
31001 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
31002
31003 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
31004 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
31005 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
31006 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
31007 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
31008 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
31009 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
31010 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
31011 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
31012 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
31013 object, or to change display format.
31014
31015 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
31016 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
31017 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
31018 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
31019 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
31020 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
31021 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
31022 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
31023 child will be created.
31024
31025 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
31026 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
31027 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
31028 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
31029 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
31030
31031 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
31032 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
31033 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
31034 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
31035 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
31036 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
31037 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
31038 variables that frontend has created.
31039
31040 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
31041 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
31042 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
31043 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
31044 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
31045 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
31046 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
31047 implicitly updated.
31048
31049 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
31050 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
31051 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
31052 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
31053 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
31054 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
31055 frame. Consider this example:
31056
31057 @smallexample
31058 void do_work(...)
31059 @{
31060 struct work_state state;
31061
31062 if (...)
31063 do_work(...);
31064 @}
31065 @end smallexample
31066
31067 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
31068 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
31069 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
31070 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
31071 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
31072
31073 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
31074 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
31075 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
31076 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
31077 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
31078 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
31079
31080 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
31081 access this functionality:
31082
31083 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
31084 @item @strong{Operation}
31085 @tab @strong{Description}
31086
31087 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
31088 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
31089 @item @code{-var-create}
31090 @tab create a variable object
31091 @item @code{-var-delete}
31092 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
31093 @item @code{-var-set-format}
31094 @tab set the display format of this variable
31095 @item @code{-var-show-format}
31096 @tab show the display format of this variable
31097 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
31098 @tab tells how many children this object has
31099 @item @code{-var-list-children}
31100 @tab return a list of the object's children
31101 @item @code{-var-info-type}
31102 @tab show the type of this variable object
31103 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
31104 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
31105 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
31106 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
31107 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
31108 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
31109 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
31110 @tab get the value of this variable
31111 @item @code{-var-assign}
31112 @tab set the value of this variable
31113 @item @code{-var-update}
31114 @tab update the variable and its children
31115 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
31116 @tab set frozeness attribute
31117 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
31118 @tab set range of children to display on update
31119 @end multitable
31120
31121 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
31122 how it can be used.
31123
31124 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
31125
31126 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
31127 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
31128
31129 @smallexample
31130 -enable-pretty-printing
31131 @end smallexample
31132
31133 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
31134 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
31135 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
31136 request that this functionality be enabled.
31137
31138 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31139
31140 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31141 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31142
31143 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
31144 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
31145
31146 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
31147 @findex -var-create
31148
31149 @subsubheading Synopsis
31150
31151 @smallexample
31152 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
31153 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
31154 @end smallexample
31155
31156 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
31157 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
31158 register.
31159
31160 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
31161 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
31162 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
31163 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
31164 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
31165
31166 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
31167 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
31168 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
31169 object must be created.
31170
31171 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
31172 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
31173
31174 @itemize @bullet
31175 @item
31176 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
31177
31178 @item
31179 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
31180
31181 @item
31182 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
31183 @end itemize
31184
31185 @cindex dynamic varobj
31186 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
31187 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
31188 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
31189 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
31190 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
31191 compatibility for existing clients.
31192
31193 @subsubheading Result
31194
31195 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
31196 are:
31197
31198 @table @samp
31199 @item name
31200 The name of the varobj.
31201
31202 @item numchild
31203 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
31204 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
31205 @samp{has_more} attribute.
31206
31207 @item value
31208 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
31209 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
31210 will not be interesting.
31211
31212 @item type
31213 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
31214 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
31215 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31216 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31217 @emph{declared} one.
31218
31219 @item thread-id
31220 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
31221 thread's global identifier.
31222
31223 @item has_more
31224 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
31225 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
31226
31227 @item dynamic
31228 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31229 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31230 then this attribute will not be present.
31231
31232 @item displayhint
31233 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31234 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31235 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31236 @end table
31237
31238 Typical output will look like this:
31239
31240 @smallexample
31241 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
31242 has_more="@var{has_more}"
31243 @end smallexample
31244
31245
31246 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
31247 @findex -var-delete
31248
31249 @subsubheading Synopsis
31250
31251 @smallexample
31252 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
31253 @end smallexample
31254
31255 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
31256 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
31257
31258 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
31259
31260
31261 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
31262 @findex -var-set-format
31263
31264 @subsubheading Synopsis
31265
31266 @smallexample
31267 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
31268 @end smallexample
31269
31270 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
31271 @var{format-spec}.
31272
31273 @anchor{-var-set-format}
31274 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
31275
31276 @smallexample
31277 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
31278 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
31279 @end smallexample
31280
31281 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
31282 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
31283 for pointers, etc.).
31284
31285 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
31286 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
31287 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
31288 zero-hexadecimal format.
31289
31290 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
31291 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
31292
31293 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
31294 @findex -var-show-format
31295
31296 @subsubheading Synopsis
31297
31298 @smallexample
31299 -var-show-format @var{name}
31300 @end smallexample
31301
31302 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
31303
31304 @smallexample
31305 @var{format} @expansion{}
31306 @var{format-spec}
31307 @end smallexample
31308
31309
31310 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
31311 @findex -var-info-num-children
31312
31313 @subsubheading Synopsis
31314
31315 @smallexample
31316 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
31317 @end smallexample
31318
31319 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
31320
31321 @smallexample
31322 numchild=@var{n}
31323 @end smallexample
31324
31325 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
31326 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
31327 be available.
31328
31329
31330 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
31331 @findex -var-list-children
31332
31333 @subsubheading Synopsis
31334
31335 @smallexample
31336 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
31337 @end smallexample
31338 @anchor{-var-list-children}
31339
31340 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
31341 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
31342 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
31343 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
31344 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
31345 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
31346 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
31347 and unions.
31348
31349 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
31350 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
31351 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
31352 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
31353 reported.
31354
31355 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
31356 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
31357 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
31358 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
31359 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
31360 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
31361 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
31362 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
31363 the visible items.
31364
31365 For each child the following results are returned:
31366
31367 @table @var
31368
31369 @item name
31370 Name of the variable object created for this child.
31371
31372 @item exp
31373 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
31374 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
31375
31376 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
31377 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
31378
31379 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
31380 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
31381 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
31382 type and value are not present.
31383
31384 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
31385 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
31386 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
31387
31388 @item numchild
31389 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
31390 0.
31391
31392 @item type
31393 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
31394 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31395 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31396 @emph{declared} one.
31397
31398 @item value
31399 If values were requested, this is the value.
31400
31401 @item thread-id
31402 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
31403 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
31404
31405 @item frozen
31406 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
31407
31408 @item displayhint
31409 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31410 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31411 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31412
31413 @item dynamic
31414 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31415 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31416 then this attribute will not be present.
31417
31418 @end table
31419
31420 The result may have its own attributes:
31421
31422 @table @samp
31423 @item displayhint
31424 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31425 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31426 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31427
31428 @item has_more
31429 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
31430 remaining after the end of the selected range.
31431 @end table
31432
31433 @subsubheading Example
31434
31435 @smallexample
31436 (gdb)
31437 -var-list-children n
31438 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31439 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31440 (gdb)
31441 -var-list-children --all-values n
31442 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
31443 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
31444 @end smallexample
31445
31446
31447 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
31448 @findex -var-info-type
31449
31450 @subsubheading Synopsis
31451
31452 @smallexample
31453 -var-info-type @var{name}
31454 @end smallexample
31455
31456 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
31457 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
31458 @value{GDBN} CLI:
31459
31460 @smallexample
31461 type=@var{typename}
31462 @end smallexample
31463
31464
31465 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
31466 @findex -var-info-expression
31467
31468 @subsubheading Synopsis
31469
31470 @smallexample
31471 -var-info-expression @var{name}
31472 @end smallexample
31473
31474 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
31475 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
31476 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
31477
31478 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
31479 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
31480
31481 @smallexample
31482 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
31483 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
31484 @end smallexample
31485
31486 @noindent
31487 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
31488 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
31489
31490 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
31491 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
31492 is of limited use.
31493
31494 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
31495 @findex -var-info-path-expression
31496
31497 @subsubheading Synopsis
31498
31499 @smallexample
31500 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
31501 @end smallexample
31502
31503 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
31504 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
31505 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
31506 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
31507 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
31508 watchpoint from a variable object.
31509
31510 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
31511 and will give an error when invoked on one.
31512
31513 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
31514 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
31515 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
31516 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
31517 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
31518 @smallexample
31519 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
31520 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
31521 @end smallexample
31522
31523 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
31524 @findex -var-show-attributes
31525
31526 @subsubheading Synopsis
31527
31528 @smallexample
31529 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
31530 @end smallexample
31531
31532 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
31533
31534 @smallexample
31535 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
31536 @end smallexample
31537
31538 @noindent
31539 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
31540
31541 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
31542 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
31543
31544 @subsubheading Synopsis
31545
31546 @smallexample
31547 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
31548 @end smallexample
31549
31550 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
31551 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
31552 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
31553 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
31554 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
31555 the current display format will be used. The current display format
31556 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
31557
31558 @smallexample
31559 value=@var{value}
31560 @end smallexample
31561
31562 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
31563 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
31564
31565 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
31566 @findex -var-assign
31567
31568 @subsubheading Synopsis
31569
31570 @smallexample
31571 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
31572 @end smallexample
31573
31574 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
31575 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
31576 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
31577 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
31578
31579 @subsubheading Example
31580
31581 @smallexample
31582 (gdb)
31583 -var-assign var1 3
31584 ^done,value="3"
31585 (gdb)
31586 -var-update *
31587 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31588 (gdb)
31589 @end smallexample
31590
31591 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31592 @findex -var-update
31593
31594 @subsubheading Synopsis
31595
31596 @smallexample
31597 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31598 @end smallexample
31599
31600 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31601 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31602 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31603 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31604 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31605 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31606 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31607 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31608 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31609 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31610 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31611 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31612 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31613
31614 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31615 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31616 diagnostic.
31617
31618 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31619 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31620
31621 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31622 @samp{changelist}.
31623
31624 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31625
31626 @table @samp
31627 @item name
31628 The name of the varobj.
31629
31630 @item value
31631 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31632 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31633
31634 @item in_scope
31635 @anchor{-var-update}
31636 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31637
31638 @table @code
31639 @item "true"
31640 The variable object's current value is valid.
31641
31642 @item "false"
31643 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31644 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31645 scope.
31646
31647 @item "invalid"
31648 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31649 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31650 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31651 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31652 objects.
31653 @end table
31654
31655 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31656 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31657
31658 @item type_changed
31659 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31660 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31661 be @samp{false}.
31662
31663 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31664 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31665 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31666 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31667 unset.
31668
31669 @item new_type
31670 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31671 hold the new type.
31672
31673 @item new_num_children
31674 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31675 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31676
31677 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31678 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31679 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31680 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31681 children which may be available.
31682
31683 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31684 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31685 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31686 only happen at the end of the update range).
31687
31688 @item displayhint
31689 The display hint, if any.
31690
31691 @item has_more
31692 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31693 available outside the varobj's update range.
31694
31695 @item dynamic
31696 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31697 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31698 then this attribute will not be present.
31699
31700 @item new_children
31701 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31702 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31703 be listed in this attribute.
31704 @end table
31705
31706 @subsubheading Example
31707
31708 @smallexample
31709 (gdb)
31710 -var-assign var1 3
31711 ^done,value="3"
31712 (gdb)
31713 -var-update --all-values var1
31714 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31715 type_changed="false"@}]
31716 (gdb)
31717 @end smallexample
31718
31719 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31720 @findex -var-set-frozen
31721 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31722
31723 @subsubheading Synopsis
31724
31725 @smallexample
31726 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31727 @end smallexample
31728
31729 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31730 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31731 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31732 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31733 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31734 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31735 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31736 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31737 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31738 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31739 @code{-var-update} does.
31740
31741 @subsubheading Example
31742
31743 @smallexample
31744 (gdb)
31745 -var-set-frozen V 1
31746 ^done
31747 (gdb)
31748 @end smallexample
31749
31750 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31751 @findex -var-set-update-range
31752 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31753
31754 @subsubheading Synopsis
31755
31756 @smallexample
31757 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31758 @end smallexample
31759
31760 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31761 @code{-var-update}.
31762
31763 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31764 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31765 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31766 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31767
31768 @subsubheading Example
31769
31770 @smallexample
31771 (gdb)
31772 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31773 ^done
31774 @end smallexample
31775
31776 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31777 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31778 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31779
31780 @subsubheading Synopsis
31781
31782 @smallexample
31783 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31784 @end smallexample
31785
31786 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31787
31788 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31789 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31790
31791 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31792 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31793 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31794 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31795 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31796 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31797 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31798
31799 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31800 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31801 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31802 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31803
31804 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31805 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31806 can be used to check this.
31807
31808 @subsubheading Example
31809
31810 Resetting the visualizer:
31811
31812 @smallexample
31813 (gdb)
31814 -var-set-visualizer V None
31815 ^done
31816 @end smallexample
31817
31818 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31819
31820 @smallexample
31821 (gdb)
31822 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31823 ^done
31824 @end smallexample
31825
31826 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31827 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31828
31829 @smallexample
31830 (gdb)
31831 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31832 ^done
31833 @end smallexample
31834
31835 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31836 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31837 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31838
31839 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31840 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31841 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31842 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31843
31844 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31845 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31846
31847 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31848 @c @subheading -data-assign
31849 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31850 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31851 @c set variable
31852 @c @subsubheading Example
31853 @c N.A.
31854
31855 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31856 @findex -data-disassemble
31857
31858 @subsubheading Synopsis
31859
31860 @smallexample
31861 -data-disassemble
31862 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31863 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31864 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31865 -- @var{mode}
31866 @end smallexample
31867
31868 @noindent
31869 Where:
31870
31871 @table @samp
31872 @item @var{start-addr}
31873 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31874 @item @var{end-addr}
31875 is the end address
31876 @item @var{addr}
31877 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31878 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31879 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31880 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31881 @item @var{filename}
31882 is the name of the file to disassemble
31883 @item @var{linenum}
31884 is the line number to disassemble around
31885 @item @var{lines}
31886 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31887 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31888 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31889 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31890 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31891 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31892 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31893 are displayed.
31894 @item @var{mode}
31895 is one of:
31896 @itemize @bullet
31897 @item 0 disassembly only
31898 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31899 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31900 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31901 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31902 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31903 @end itemize
31904
31905 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31906 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31907 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31908 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31909 @end table
31910
31911 @subsubheading Result
31912
31913 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31914 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31915 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31916
31917 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31918 following fields:
31919
31920 @table @code
31921 @item address
31922 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31923
31924 @item func-name
31925 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31926
31927 @item offset
31928 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31929
31930 @item inst
31931 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31932
31933 @item opcodes
31934 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31935 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31936
31937 @end table
31938
31939 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31940 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31941
31942 @table @code
31943 @item line
31944 The line number within @samp{file}.
31945
31946 @item file
31947 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31948 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31949 used.
31950
31951 @item fullname
31952 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31953 using the source file search path
31954 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31955 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31956
31957 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31958 present in the debug information.
31959
31960 @item line_asm_insn
31961 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31962 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31963 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31964 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31965 @samp{opcodes}.
31966
31967 @end table
31968
31969 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31970 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31971 adjust its format.
31972
31973 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31974
31975 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31976
31977 @subsubheading Example
31978
31979 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31980
31981 @smallexample
31982 (gdb)
31983 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31984 ^done,
31985 asm_insns=[
31986 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31987 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31988 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31989 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31990 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31991 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31992 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31993 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31994 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31995 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31996 (gdb)
31997 @end smallexample
31998
31999 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
32000 @code{main}.
32001
32002 @smallexample
32003 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
32004 ^done,asm_insns=[
32005 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
32006 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
32007 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32008 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32009 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32010 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32011 [@dots{}]
32012 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
32013 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
32014 (gdb)
32015 @end smallexample
32016
32017 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
32018
32019 @smallexample
32020 (gdb)
32021 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
32022 ^done,asm_insns=[
32023 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
32024 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
32025 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32026 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32027 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32028 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
32029 (gdb)
32030 @end smallexample
32031
32032 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
32033
32034 @smallexample
32035 (gdb)
32036 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
32037 ^done,asm_insns=[
32038 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
32039 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32040 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32041 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
32042 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
32043 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
32044 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32045 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32046 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
32047 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32048 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32049 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
32050 (gdb)
32051 @end smallexample
32052
32053
32054 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
32055 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
32056
32057 @subsubheading Synopsis
32058
32059 @smallexample
32060 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
32061 @end smallexample
32062
32063 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
32064 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
32065 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
32066
32067 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32068
32069 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
32070 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
32071 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
32072
32073 @subsubheading Example
32074
32075 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
32076 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
32077 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
32078 output.
32079
32080 @smallexample
32081 211-data-evaluate-expression A
32082 211^done,value="1"
32083 (gdb)
32084 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
32085 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
32086 (gdb)
32087 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
32088 411^done,value="4"
32089 (gdb)
32090 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
32091 511^done,value="4"
32092 (gdb)
32093 @end smallexample
32094
32095
32096 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
32097 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
32098
32099 @subsubheading Synopsis
32100
32101 @smallexample
32102 -data-list-changed-registers
32103 @end smallexample
32104
32105 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
32106
32107 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32108
32109 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
32110 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
32111
32112 @subsubheading Example
32113
32114 On a PPC MBX board:
32115
32116 @smallexample
32117 (gdb)
32118 -exec-continue
32119 ^running
32120
32121 (gdb)
32122 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
32123 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
32124 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
32125 (gdb)
32126 -data-list-changed-registers
32127 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
32128 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
32129 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
32130 (gdb)
32131 @end smallexample
32132
32133
32134 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
32135 @findex -data-list-register-names
32136
32137 @subsubheading Synopsis
32138
32139 @smallexample
32140 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
32141 @end smallexample
32142
32143 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
32144 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
32145 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
32146 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
32147 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
32148 include empty register names.
32149
32150 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32151
32152 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
32153 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
32154 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
32155
32156 @subsubheading Example
32157
32158 For the PPC MBX board:
32159 @smallexample
32160 (gdb)
32161 -data-list-register-names
32162 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
32163 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
32164 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
32165 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
32166 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
32167 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
32168 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
32169 (gdb)
32170 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
32171 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
32172 (gdb)
32173 @end smallexample
32174
32175 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
32176 @findex -data-list-register-values
32177
32178 @subsubheading Synopsis
32179
32180 @smallexample
32181 -data-list-register-values
32182 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
32183 @end smallexample
32184
32185 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
32186 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
32187 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
32188 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
32189 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
32190 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
32191
32192 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
32193
32194 @table @code
32195 @item x
32196 Hexadecimal
32197 @item o
32198 Octal
32199 @item t
32200 Binary
32201 @item d
32202 Decimal
32203 @item r
32204 Raw
32205 @item N
32206 Natural
32207 @end table
32208
32209 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32210
32211 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
32212 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
32213
32214 @subsubheading Example
32215
32216 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
32217 don't appear in the actual output):
32218
32219 @smallexample
32220 (gdb)
32221 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
32222 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32223 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
32224 (gdb)
32225 -data-list-register-values x
32226 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
32227 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32228 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
32229 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
32230 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
32231 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
32232 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
32233 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
32234 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
32235 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32236 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
32237 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
32238 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
32239 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
32240 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
32241 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
32242 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
32243 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
32244 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
32245 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
32246 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
32247 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
32248 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
32249 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
32250 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
32251 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
32252 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
32253 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
32254 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
32255 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
32256 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
32257 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
32258 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32259 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
32260 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
32261 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
32262 (gdb)
32263 @end smallexample
32264
32265
32266 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
32267 @findex -data-read-memory
32268
32269 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
32270
32271 @subsubheading Synopsis
32272
32273 @smallexample
32274 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
32275 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
32276 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
32277 @end smallexample
32278
32279 @noindent
32280 where:
32281
32282 @table @samp
32283 @item @var{address}
32284 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
32285 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32286 quoted using the C convention.
32287
32288 @item @var{word-format}
32289 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
32290 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
32291 ,Output Formats}).
32292
32293 @item @var{word-size}
32294 The size of each memory word in bytes.
32295
32296 @item @var{nr-rows}
32297 The number of rows in the output table.
32298
32299 @item @var{nr-cols}
32300 The number of columns in the output table.
32301
32302 @item @var{aschar}
32303 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
32304 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
32305 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
32306 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
32307
32308 @item @var{byte-offset}
32309 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
32310 @end table
32311
32312 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
32313 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
32314 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
32315 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
32316 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
32317 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
32318 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
32319 @samp{addr}.
32320
32321 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
32322 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
32323 @samp{prev-page}.
32324
32325 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32326
32327 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
32328 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
32329
32330 @subsubheading Example
32331
32332 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
32333 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
32334 word. Display each word in hex.
32335
32336 @smallexample
32337 (gdb)
32338 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
32339 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
32340 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
32341 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
32342 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
32343 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
32344 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
32345 (gdb)
32346 @end smallexample
32347
32348 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
32349 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
32350
32351 @smallexample
32352 (gdb)
32353 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
32354 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
32355 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
32356 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
32357 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
32358 (gdb)
32359 @end smallexample
32360
32361 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
32362 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
32363 used as the non-printable character.
32364
32365 @smallexample
32366 (gdb)
32367 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
32368 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
32369 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
32370 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
32371 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32372 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32373 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32374 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
32375 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
32376 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
32377 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
32378 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
32379 (gdb)
32380 @end smallexample
32381
32382 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
32383 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
32384
32385 @subsubheading Synopsis
32386
32387 @smallexample
32388 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
32389 @var{address} @var{count}
32390 @end smallexample
32391
32392 @noindent
32393 where:
32394
32395 @table @samp
32396 @item @var{address}
32397 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32398 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
32399 quoted using the C convention.
32400
32401 @item @var{count}
32402 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
32403 literal.
32404
32405 @item @var{offset}
32406 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
32407 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
32408 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
32409 arithmetics itself.
32410
32411 @end table
32412
32413 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
32414 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
32415 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
32416 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
32417 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
32418 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
32419
32420 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
32421 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
32422 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
32423 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
32424 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
32425 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
32426 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
32427 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
32428
32429 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
32430 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
32431 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
32432 and has the following fields:
32433
32434 @table @code
32435 @item begin
32436 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32437
32438 @item end
32439 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
32440
32441 @item offset
32442 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
32443 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
32444
32445 @item contents
32446 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
32447
32448 @end table
32449
32450
32451
32452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32453
32454 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
32455
32456 @subsubheading Example
32457
32458 @smallexample
32459 (gdb)
32460 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
32461 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
32462 end="0xbffff15e",
32463 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
32464 (gdb)
32465 @end smallexample
32466
32467
32468 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
32469 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
32470
32471 @subsubheading Synopsis
32472
32473 @smallexample
32474 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
32475 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
32476 @end smallexample
32477
32478 @noindent
32479 where:
32480
32481 @table @samp
32482 @item @var{address}
32483 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
32484 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
32485 be quoted using the C convention.
32486
32487 @item @var{contents}
32488 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
32489 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
32490
32491 @item @var{count}
32492 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
32493 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
32494 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
32495 @var{count} memory units.
32496
32497 @end table
32498
32499 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32500
32501 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32502
32503 @subsubheading Example
32504
32505 @smallexample
32506 (gdb)
32507 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
32508 ^done
32509 (gdb)
32510 @end smallexample
32511
32512 @smallexample
32513 (gdb)
32514 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
32515 ^done
32516 (gdb)
32517 @end smallexample
32518
32519 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32520 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
32521 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
32522
32523 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
32524 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
32525
32526 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
32527 @findex -trace-find
32528
32529 @subsubheading Synopsis
32530
32531 @smallexample
32532 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
32533 @end smallexample
32534
32535 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
32536 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
32537 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
32538
32539 @table @samp
32540
32541 @item none
32542 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
32543
32544 @item frame-number
32545 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
32546 that index.
32547
32548 @item tracepoint-number
32549 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
32550 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
32551
32552 @item pc
32553 An address is required as parameter. Finds
32554 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
32555 address.
32556
32557 @item pc-inside-range
32558 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
32559 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
32560 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32561
32562 @item pc-outside-range
32563 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
32564 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
32565 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
32566
32567 @item line
32568 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
32569 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
32570 the specified location.
32571
32572 @end table
32573
32574 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
32575 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
32576
32577 @table @samp
32578 @item found
32579 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
32580 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
32581
32582 @item traceframe
32583 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
32584 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32585
32586 @item tracepoint
32587 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32588 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32589
32590 @item frame
32591 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32592 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32593 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32594
32595 @end table
32596
32597 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32598
32599 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32600
32601 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32602 @findex -trace-define-variable
32603
32604 @subsubheading Synopsis
32605
32606 @smallexample
32607 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32608 @end smallexample
32609
32610 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32611 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32612 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32613 with the @samp{$} character.
32614
32615 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32616
32617 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32618
32619 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32620 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32621
32622 @subsubheading Synopsis
32623
32624 @smallexample
32625 -trace-frame-collected
32626 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32627 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32628 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32629 [--memory-contents]
32630 @end smallexample
32631
32632 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32633 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32634 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32635 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32636 See the output description table below for more details.
32637
32638 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32639 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32640 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32641 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32642 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32643
32644 For instance, if the actions were
32645 @smallexample
32646 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32647 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32648 @end smallexample
32649
32650 @noindent
32651 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32652 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32653 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32654 objects would be computed expressions.
32655
32656 An example output would be:
32657
32658 @smallexample
32659 (gdb)
32660 -trace-frame-collected
32661 ^done,
32662 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32663 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32664 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32665 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32666 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32667 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32668 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32669 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32670 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32671 ...
32672 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32673 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32674 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32675 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32676 (gdb)
32677 @end smallexample
32678
32679 Where:
32680
32681 @table @code
32682 @item explicit-variables
32683 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32684 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32685 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32686 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32687 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32688 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32689 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32690 arrays, structures and unions.
32691
32692 @item computed-expressions
32693 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32694 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32695 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32696 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32697
32698 @item registers
32699 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32700 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32701 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32702 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32703 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32704
32705 @item tvars
32706 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32707 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32708 current value are returned.
32709
32710 @item memory
32711 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32712 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32713 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32714
32715 @table @code
32716 @item address
32717 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32718
32719 @item length
32720 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32721
32722 @item contents
32723 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32724 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32725
32726 @end table
32727
32728 @end table
32729
32730 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32731
32732 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32733
32734 @subsubheading Example
32735
32736 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32737 @findex -trace-list-variables
32738
32739 @subsubheading Synopsis
32740
32741 @smallexample
32742 -trace-list-variables
32743 @end smallexample
32744
32745 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32746 table has the following fields:
32747
32748 @table @samp
32749 @item name
32750 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32751
32752 @item initial
32753 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32754 field is always present.
32755
32756 @item current
32757 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32758 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32759 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32760 presently running.
32761
32762 @end table
32763
32764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32765
32766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32767
32768 @subsubheading Example
32769
32770 @smallexample
32771 (gdb)
32772 -trace-list-variables
32773 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32774 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32775 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32776 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32777 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32778 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32779 (gdb)
32780 @end smallexample
32781
32782 @subheading -trace-save
32783 @findex -trace-save
32784
32785 @subsubheading Synopsis
32786
32787 @smallexample
32788 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32789 @end smallexample
32790
32791 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32792 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32793 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32794 to perform the save.
32795
32796 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32797 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32798 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32799
32800 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32801
32802 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32803
32804
32805 @subheading -trace-start
32806 @findex -trace-start
32807
32808 @subsubheading Synopsis
32809
32810 @smallexample
32811 -trace-start
32812 @end smallexample
32813
32814 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32815 have any fields.
32816
32817 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32818
32819 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32820
32821 @subheading -trace-status
32822 @findex -trace-status
32823
32824 @subsubheading Synopsis
32825
32826 @smallexample
32827 -trace-status
32828 @end smallexample
32829
32830 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32831 the following fields:
32832
32833 @table @samp
32834
32835 @item supported
32836 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32837 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32838 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32839 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32840 started. This field is always present.
32841
32842 @item running
32843 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32844 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32845 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32846
32847 @item stop-reason
32848 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32849 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32850 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32851 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32852 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32853 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32854 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32855 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32856 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32857
32858 @item stopping-tracepoint
32859 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32860 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32861 @samp{passcount}.
32862
32863 @item frames
32864 @itemx frames-created
32865 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32866 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32867 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32868 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32869
32870 @item buffer-size
32871 @itemx buffer-free
32872 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32873 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32874
32875 @item circular
32876 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32877 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32878 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32879 and may fill up.
32880
32881 @item disconnected
32882 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32883 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32884 that the trace run will stop.
32885
32886 @item trace-file
32887 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32888 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32889
32890 @end table
32891
32892 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32893
32894 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32895
32896 @subheading -trace-stop
32897 @findex -trace-stop
32898
32899 @subsubheading Synopsis
32900
32901 @smallexample
32902 -trace-stop
32903 @end smallexample
32904
32905 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32906 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32907 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32908
32909 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32910
32911 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32912
32913
32914 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32915 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32916 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32917
32918
32919 @ignore
32920 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32921 @findex -symbol-info-address
32922
32923 @subsubheading Synopsis
32924
32925 @smallexample
32926 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32927 @end smallexample
32928
32929 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32930
32931 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32932
32933 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32934
32935 @subsubheading Example
32936 N.A.
32937
32938
32939 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32940 @findex -symbol-info-file
32941
32942 @subsubheading Synopsis
32943
32944 @smallexample
32945 -symbol-info-file
32946 @end smallexample
32947
32948 Show the file for the symbol.
32949
32950 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32951
32952 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32953 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32954
32955 @subsubheading Example
32956 N.A.
32957
32958
32959 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32960 @findex -symbol-info-function
32961
32962 @subsubheading Synopsis
32963
32964 @smallexample
32965 -symbol-info-function
32966 @end smallexample
32967
32968 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32969
32970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32971
32972 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32973
32974 @subsubheading Example
32975 N.A.
32976
32977
32978 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32979 @findex -symbol-info-line
32980
32981 @subsubheading Synopsis
32982
32983 @smallexample
32984 -symbol-info-line
32985 @end smallexample
32986
32987 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32988
32989 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32990
32991 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32992 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32993
32994 @subsubheading Example
32995 N.A.
32996
32997
32998 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32999 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
33000
33001 @subsubheading Synopsis
33002
33003 @smallexample
33004 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
33005 @end smallexample
33006
33007 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
33008
33009 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33010
33011 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
33012
33013 @subsubheading Example
33014 N.A.
33015
33016
33017 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
33018 @findex -symbol-list-functions
33019
33020 @subsubheading Synopsis
33021
33022 @smallexample
33023 -symbol-list-functions
33024 @end smallexample
33025
33026 List the functions in the executable.
33027
33028 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33029
33030 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
33031 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33032
33033 @subsubheading Example
33034 N.A.
33035 @end ignore
33036
33037
33038 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
33039 @findex -symbol-list-lines
33040
33041 @subsubheading Synopsis
33042
33043 @smallexample
33044 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
33045 @end smallexample
33046
33047 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
33048 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
33049 ascending PC order.
33050
33051 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33052
33053 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33054
33055 @subsubheading Example
33056 @smallexample
33057 (gdb)
33058 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
33059 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
33060 (gdb)
33061 @end smallexample
33062
33063
33064 @ignore
33065 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
33066 @findex -symbol-list-types
33067
33068 @subsubheading Synopsis
33069
33070 @smallexample
33071 -symbol-list-types
33072 @end smallexample
33073
33074 List all the type names.
33075
33076 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33077
33078 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
33079 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33080
33081 @subsubheading Example
33082 N.A.
33083
33084
33085 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
33086 @findex -symbol-list-variables
33087
33088 @subsubheading Synopsis
33089
33090 @smallexample
33091 -symbol-list-variables
33092 @end smallexample
33093
33094 List all the global and static variable names.
33095
33096 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33097
33098 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33099
33100 @subsubheading Example
33101 N.A.
33102
33103
33104 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
33105 @findex -symbol-locate
33106
33107 @subsubheading Synopsis
33108
33109 @smallexample
33110 -symbol-locate
33111 @end smallexample
33112
33113 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33114
33115 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
33116
33117 @subsubheading Example
33118 N.A.
33119
33120
33121 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
33122 @findex -symbol-type
33123
33124 @subsubheading Synopsis
33125
33126 @smallexample
33127 -symbol-type @var{variable}
33128 @end smallexample
33129
33130 Show type of @var{variable}.
33131
33132 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33133
33134 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
33135 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
33136
33137 @subsubheading Example
33138 N.A.
33139 @end ignore
33140
33141
33142 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33143 @node GDB/MI File Commands
33144 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
33145
33146 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
33147 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
33148
33149 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
33150 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
33151
33152 @subsubheading Synopsis
33153
33154 @smallexample
33155 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
33156 @end smallexample
33157
33158 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
33159 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
33160 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
33161 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
33162 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
33163 notification.
33164
33165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33166
33167 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
33168
33169 @subsubheading Example
33170
33171 @smallexample
33172 (gdb)
33173 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33174 ^done
33175 (gdb)
33176 @end smallexample
33177
33178
33179 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
33180 @findex -file-exec-file
33181
33182 @subsubheading Synopsis
33183
33184 @smallexample
33185 -file-exec-file @var{file}
33186 @end smallexample
33187
33188 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
33189 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
33190 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
33191 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
33192 notification.
33193
33194 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33195
33196 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
33197
33198 @subsubheading Example
33199
33200 @smallexample
33201 (gdb)
33202 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33203 ^done
33204 (gdb)
33205 @end smallexample
33206
33207
33208 @ignore
33209 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
33210 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
33211
33212 @subsubheading Synopsis
33213
33214 @smallexample
33215 -file-list-exec-sections
33216 @end smallexample
33217
33218 List the sections of the current executable file.
33219
33220 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33221
33222 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
33223 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
33224 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
33225
33226 @subsubheading Example
33227 N.A.
33228 @end ignore
33229
33230
33231 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
33232 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
33233
33234 @subsubheading Synopsis
33235
33236 @smallexample
33237 -file-list-exec-source-file
33238 @end smallexample
33239
33240 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
33241 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
33242 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
33243 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
33244
33245 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33246
33247 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
33248
33249 @subsubheading Example
33250
33251 @smallexample
33252 (gdb)
33253 123-file-list-exec-source-file
33254 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
33255 (gdb)
33256 @end smallexample
33257
33258
33259 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
33260 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
33261
33262 @subsubheading Synopsis
33263
33264 @smallexample
33265 -file-list-exec-source-files
33266 @end smallexample
33267
33268 List the source files for the current executable.
33269
33270 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
33271 name) of a source file.
33272
33273 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33274
33275 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
33276 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
33277
33278 @subsubheading Example
33279 @smallexample
33280 (gdb)
33281 -file-list-exec-source-files
33282 ^done,files=[
33283 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
33284 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
33285 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
33286 (gdb)
33287 @end smallexample
33288
33289 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
33290 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
33291
33292 @subsubheading Synopsis
33293
33294 @smallexample
33295 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
33296 @end smallexample
33297
33298 List the shared libraries in the program.
33299 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
33300 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33301
33302 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33303
33304 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
33305 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
33306 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
33307 library. Each range has the following fields:
33308
33309 @table @samp
33310 @item from
33311 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
33312 @item to
33313 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
33314 @end table
33315
33316 @subsubheading Example
33317 @smallexample
33318 (gdb)
33319 -file-list-exec-source-files
33320 ^done,shared-libraries=[
33321 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
33322 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
33323 (gdb)
33324 @end smallexample
33325
33326
33327 @ignore
33328 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
33329 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
33330
33331 @subsubheading Synopsis
33332
33333 @smallexample
33334 -file-list-symbol-files
33335 @end smallexample
33336
33337 List symbol files.
33338
33339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33340
33341 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
33342
33343 @subsubheading Example
33344 N.A.
33345 @end ignore
33346
33347
33348 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
33349 @findex -file-symbol-file
33350
33351 @subsubheading Synopsis
33352
33353 @smallexample
33354 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
33355 @end smallexample
33356
33357 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
33358 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
33359 produced, except for a completion notification.
33360
33361 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33362
33363 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
33364
33365 @subsubheading Example
33366
33367 @smallexample
33368 (gdb)
33369 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33370 ^done
33371 (gdb)
33372 @end smallexample
33373
33374 @ignore
33375 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33376 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
33377 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
33378
33379 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
33380
33381 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
33382
33383 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
33384
33385 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
33386
33387 @c @subheading -overlay-map
33388
33389 @c @subheading -overlay-off
33390
33391 @c @subheading -overlay-on
33392
33393 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
33394
33395 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33396 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
33397 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
33398
33399 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
33400
33401 @c @subheading -signal-handle
33402
33403 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
33404
33405 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
33406 @end ignore
33407
33408
33409 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33410 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
33411 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
33412
33413
33414 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
33415 @findex -target-attach
33416
33417 @subsubheading Synopsis
33418
33419 @smallexample
33420 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
33421 @end smallexample
33422
33423 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
33424 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
33425 group, the id previously returned by
33426 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
33427
33428 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33429
33430 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
33431
33432 @subsubheading Example
33433 @smallexample
33434 (gdb)
33435 -target-attach 34
33436 =thread-created,id="1"
33437 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
33438 ^done
33439 (gdb)
33440 @end smallexample
33441
33442 @ignore
33443 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
33444 @findex -target-compare-sections
33445
33446 @subsubheading Synopsis
33447
33448 @smallexample
33449 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
33450 @end smallexample
33451
33452 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
33453 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
33454
33455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33456
33457 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
33458
33459 @subsubheading Example
33460 N.A.
33461 @end ignore
33462
33463
33464 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
33465 @findex -target-detach
33466
33467 @subsubheading Synopsis
33468
33469 @smallexample
33470 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
33471 @end smallexample
33472
33473 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
33474 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
33475 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
33476
33477 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33478
33479 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
33480
33481 @subsubheading Example
33482
33483 @smallexample
33484 (gdb)
33485 -target-detach
33486 ^done
33487 (gdb)
33488 @end smallexample
33489
33490
33491 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
33492 @findex -target-disconnect
33493
33494 @subsubheading Synopsis
33495
33496 @smallexample
33497 -target-disconnect
33498 @end smallexample
33499
33500 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
33501 generally not resumed.
33502
33503 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33504
33505 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
33506
33507 @subsubheading Example
33508
33509 @smallexample
33510 (gdb)
33511 -target-disconnect
33512 ^done
33513 (gdb)
33514 @end smallexample
33515
33516
33517 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
33518 @findex -target-download
33519
33520 @subsubheading Synopsis
33521
33522 @smallexample
33523 -target-download
33524 @end smallexample
33525
33526 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
33527 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
33528
33529 @table @samp
33530 @item section
33531 The name of the section.
33532 @item section-sent
33533 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
33534 @item section-size
33535 The size of the section.
33536 @item total-sent
33537 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
33538 @item total-size
33539 The size of the overall executable to download.
33540 @end table
33541
33542 @noindent
33543 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
33544 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
33545
33546 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
33547 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
33548
33549 @table @samp
33550 @item section
33551 The name of the section.
33552 @item section-size
33553 The size of the section.
33554 @item total-size
33555 The size of the overall executable to download.
33556 @end table
33557
33558 @noindent
33559 At the end, a summary is printed.
33560
33561 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33562
33563 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
33564
33565 @subsubheading Example
33566
33567 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
33568 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
33569
33570 @smallexample
33571 (gdb)
33572 -target-download
33573 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
33574 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
33575 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
33576 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
33577 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
33578 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
33579 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
33580 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33581 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33582 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33583 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33584 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33585 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33586 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33587 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33588 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33589 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33590 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33591 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33592 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33593 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33594 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33595 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33596 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33597 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33598 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33599 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33600 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33601 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33602 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33603 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33604 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33605 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33606 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33607 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33608 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33609 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33610 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33611 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33612 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33613 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33614 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33615 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33616 write-rate="429"
33617 (gdb)
33618 @end smallexample
33619
33620
33621 @ignore
33622 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33623 @findex -target-exec-status
33624
33625 @subsubheading Synopsis
33626
33627 @smallexample
33628 -target-exec-status
33629 @end smallexample
33630
33631 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33632 not, for instance).
33633
33634 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33635
33636 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33637
33638 @subsubheading Example
33639 N.A.
33640
33641
33642 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33643 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33644
33645 @subsubheading Synopsis
33646
33647 @smallexample
33648 -target-list-available-targets
33649 @end smallexample
33650
33651 List the possible targets to connect to.
33652
33653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33654
33655 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33656
33657 @subsubheading Example
33658 N.A.
33659
33660
33661 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33662 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33663
33664 @subsubheading Synopsis
33665
33666 @smallexample
33667 -target-list-current-targets
33668 @end smallexample
33669
33670 Describe the current target.
33671
33672 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33673
33674 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33675 other things).
33676
33677 @subsubheading Example
33678 N.A.
33679
33680
33681 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33682 @findex -target-list-parameters
33683
33684 @subsubheading Synopsis
33685
33686 @smallexample
33687 -target-list-parameters
33688 @end smallexample
33689
33690 @c ????
33691 @end ignore
33692
33693 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33694
33695 No equivalent.
33696
33697 @subsubheading Example
33698 N.A.
33699
33700 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33701 @findex -target-flash-erase
33702
33703 @subsubheading Synopsis
33704
33705 @smallexample
33706 -target-flash-erase
33707 @end smallexample
33708
33709 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33710
33711 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33712
33713 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33714 addresses and memory region sizes.
33715
33716 @smallexample
33717 (gdb)
33718 -target-flash-erase
33719 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33720 (gdb)
33721 @end smallexample
33722
33723 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33724 @findex -target-select
33725
33726 @subsubheading Synopsis
33727
33728 @smallexample
33729 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33730 @end smallexample
33731
33732 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33733
33734 @table @samp
33735 @item @var{type}
33736 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33737 @item @var{parameters}
33738 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33739 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33740 @end table
33741
33742 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33743 which the target program is, in the following form:
33744
33745 @smallexample
33746 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33747 args=[@var{arg list}]
33748 @end smallexample
33749
33750 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33751
33752 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33753
33754 @subsubheading Example
33755
33756 @smallexample
33757 (gdb)
33758 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33759 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33760 (gdb)
33761 @end smallexample
33762
33763 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33764 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33765 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33766
33767
33768 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33769 @findex -target-file-put
33770
33771 @subsubheading Synopsis
33772
33773 @smallexample
33774 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33775 @end smallexample
33776
33777 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33778 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33779
33780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33781
33782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33783
33784 @subsubheading Example
33785
33786 @smallexample
33787 (gdb)
33788 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33789 ^done
33790 (gdb)
33791 @end smallexample
33792
33793
33794 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33795 @findex -target-file-get
33796
33797 @subsubheading Synopsis
33798
33799 @smallexample
33800 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33801 @end smallexample
33802
33803 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33804 on the host system.
33805
33806 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33807
33808 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33809
33810 @subsubheading Example
33811
33812 @smallexample
33813 (gdb)
33814 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33815 ^done
33816 (gdb)
33817 @end smallexample
33818
33819
33820 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33821 @findex -target-file-delete
33822
33823 @subsubheading Synopsis
33824
33825 @smallexample
33826 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33827 @end smallexample
33828
33829 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33830
33831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33832
33833 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33834
33835 @subsubheading Example
33836
33837 @smallexample
33838 (gdb)
33839 -target-file-delete remotefile
33840 ^done
33841 (gdb)
33842 @end smallexample
33843
33844
33845 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33846 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33847 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33848
33849 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33850 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33851
33852 @subsubheading Synopsis
33853
33854 @smallexample
33855 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33856 @end smallexample
33857
33858 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33859 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33860 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33861
33862 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33863
33864 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33865
33866 @subsubheading Result
33867
33868 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33869 defined for each exception:
33870
33871 @table @samp
33872 @item name
33873 The name of the exception.
33874
33875 @item address
33876 The address of the exception.
33877
33878 @end table
33879
33880 @subsubheading Example
33881
33882 @smallexample
33883 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33884 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33885 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33886 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33887 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33888 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33889 @end smallexample
33890
33891 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33892
33893 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33894 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33895 Catchpoint Commands}.
33896
33897
33898 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33899 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33900 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33901
33902 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33903 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33904 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33905 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33906
33907 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33908 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33909 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33910
33911 @subsubheading Synopsis
33912
33913 @smallexample
33914 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33915 @end smallexample
33916
33917 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33918
33919 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33920 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33921 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33922 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33923 dash.
33924
33925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33926
33927 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33928
33929 @subsubheading Result
33930
33931 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33932
33933 @table @samp
33934 @item exists
33935 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33936 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33937
33938 @end table
33939
33940 @subsubheading Example
33941
33942 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33943
33944 @smallexample
33945 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33946 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33947 @end smallexample
33948
33949 @noindent
33950 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33951 to the debugger:
33952
33953 @smallexample
33954 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33955 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33956 @end smallexample
33957
33958 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33959 @findex -list-features
33960 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33961
33962 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33963 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33964 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33965 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33966 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33967 startup.
33968
33969 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33970 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33971 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33972 is given below.
33973
33974 Example output:
33975
33976 @smallexample
33977 (gdb) -list-features
33978 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33979 @end smallexample
33980
33981 The current list of features is:
33982
33983 @ftable @samp
33984 @item frozen-varobjs
33985 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33986 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33987 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33988 @item pending-breakpoints
33989 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33990 command.
33991 @item python
33992 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33993 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33994 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33995 @item thread-info
33996 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33997 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33998 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33999 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
34000 @item breakpoint-notifications
34001 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
34002 CLI will be announced via async records.
34003 @item ada-task-info
34004 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
34005 @item language-option
34006 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
34007 option (@pxref{Context management}).
34008 @item info-gdb-mi-command
34009 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
34010 @item undefined-command-error-code
34011 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
34012 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
34013 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
34014 @item exec-run-start-option
34015 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
34016 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
34017 @item data-disassemble-a-option
34018 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
34019 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
34020 @end ftable
34021
34022 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
34023 @findex -list-target-features
34024
34025 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
34026 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
34027 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
34028 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
34029 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
34030 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
34031 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
34032 Example output:
34033
34034 @smallexample
34035 (gdb) -list-target-features
34036 ^done,result=["async"]
34037 @end smallexample
34038
34039 The current list of features is:
34040
34041 @table @samp
34042 @item async
34043 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
34044 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
34045 while the target is running.
34046
34047 @item reverse
34048 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
34049 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34050
34051 @end table
34052
34053 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34054 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
34055 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
34056
34057 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
34058
34059 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
34060 @findex -gdb-exit
34061
34062 @subsubheading Synopsis
34063
34064 @smallexample
34065 -gdb-exit
34066 @end smallexample
34067
34068 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
34069
34070 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34071
34072 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
34073
34074 @subsubheading Example
34075
34076 @smallexample
34077 (gdb)
34078 -gdb-exit
34079 ^exit
34080 @end smallexample
34081
34082
34083 @ignore
34084 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
34085 @findex -exec-abort
34086
34087 @subsubheading Synopsis
34088
34089 @smallexample
34090 -exec-abort
34091 @end smallexample
34092
34093 Kill the inferior running program.
34094
34095 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34096
34097 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
34098
34099 @subsubheading Example
34100 N.A.
34101 @end ignore
34102
34103
34104 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
34105 @findex -gdb-set
34106
34107 @subsubheading Synopsis
34108
34109 @smallexample
34110 -gdb-set
34111 @end smallexample
34112
34113 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
34114 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
34115
34116 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34117
34118 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
34119
34120 @subsubheading Example
34121
34122 @smallexample
34123 (gdb)
34124 -gdb-set $foo=3
34125 ^done
34126 (gdb)
34127 @end smallexample
34128
34129
34130 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
34131 @findex -gdb-show
34132
34133 @subsubheading Synopsis
34134
34135 @smallexample
34136 -gdb-show
34137 @end smallexample
34138
34139 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
34140
34141 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34142
34143 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
34144
34145 @subsubheading Example
34146
34147 @smallexample
34148 (gdb)
34149 -gdb-show annotate
34150 ^done,value="0"
34151 (gdb)
34152 @end smallexample
34153
34154 @c @subheading -gdb-source
34155
34156
34157 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
34158 @findex -gdb-version
34159
34160 @subsubheading Synopsis
34161
34162 @smallexample
34163 -gdb-version
34164 @end smallexample
34165
34166 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
34167
34168 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34169
34170 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
34171 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
34172
34173 @subsubheading Example
34174
34175 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
34176 @c box in TeX.
34177 @smallexample
34178 (gdb)
34179 -gdb-version
34180 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
34181 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34182 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
34183 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
34184 ~ certain conditions.
34185 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34186 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
34187 ~ details.
34188 ~This GDB was configured as
34189 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
34190 ^done
34191 (gdb)
34192 @end smallexample
34193
34194 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
34195 @findex -list-thread-groups
34196
34197 @subheading Synopsis
34198
34199 @smallexample
34200 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
34201 @end smallexample
34202
34203 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
34204 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
34205 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
34206 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
34207 top-level thread groups.
34208
34209 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
34210 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
34211 available on the target.
34212
34213 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
34214 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
34215 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
34216 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
34217 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
34218 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
34219 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
34220 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
34221
34222 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
34223 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
34224 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
34225 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
34226 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
34227 @samp{threads} field.
34228
34229 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
34230 the following caveats:
34231
34232 @itemize @bullet
34233 @item
34234 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
34235 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
34236 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
34237
34238 @item
34239 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
34240 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
34241 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
34242 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
34243 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
34244 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
34245
34246 @end itemize
34247
34248 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
34249 have the following fields:
34250
34251 @table @code
34252 @item id
34253 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
34254 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
34255 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
34256
34257 @item type
34258 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
34259 valid type.
34260
34261 @item pid
34262 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
34263 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
34264
34265 @item exit-code
34266 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
34267 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
34268 only if the process is not running.
34269
34270 @item num_children
34271 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
34272 absent for an available thread group.
34273
34274 @item threads
34275 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
34276 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
34277 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
34278
34279 @item cores
34280 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
34281 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
34282 such information is not available.
34283
34284 @item executable
34285 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
34286 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
34287 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
34288
34289 @end table
34290
34291 @subheading Example
34292
34293 @smallexample
34294 @value{GDBP}
34295 -list-thread-groups
34296 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
34297 -list-thread-groups 17
34298 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
34299 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
34300 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
34301 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
34302 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
34303 -list-thread-groups --available
34304 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
34305 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
34306 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
34307 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
34308 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
34309 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
34310 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
34311 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
34312 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
34313 @end smallexample
34314
34315 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
34316 @findex -info-os
34317
34318 @subsubheading Synopsis
34319
34320 @smallexample
34321 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
34322 @end smallexample
34323
34324 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
34325 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
34326 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
34327 of data of that type.
34328
34329 The types of information available depend on the target operating
34330 system.
34331
34332 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34333
34334 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
34335
34336 @subsubheading Example
34337
34338 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
34339 like this:
34340
34341 @smallexample
34342 @value{GDBP}
34343 -info-os
34344 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
34345 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
34346 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
34347 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
34348 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
34349 col2="CPUs"@},
34350 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
34351 col2="File descriptors"@},
34352 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
34353 col2="Kernel modules"@},
34354 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
34355 col2="Message queues"@},
34356 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
34357 col2="Processes"@},
34358 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
34359 col2="Process groups"@},
34360 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
34361 col2="Semaphores"@},
34362 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
34363 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
34364 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
34365 col2="Sockets"@},
34366 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
34367 col2="Threads"@}]
34368 @value{GDBP}
34369 -info-os processes
34370 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
34371 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
34372 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
34373 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
34374 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
34375 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
34376 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
34377 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
34378 ...
34379 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
34380 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
34381 (gdb)
34382 @end smallexample
34383
34384 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
34385 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
34386 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
34387 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
34388 @code{info os} omits it.)
34389
34390 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
34391 @findex -add-inferior
34392
34393 @subheading Synopsis
34394
34395 @smallexample
34396 -add-inferior
34397 @end smallexample
34398
34399 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
34400 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
34401 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
34402 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
34403 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
34404 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
34405
34406 @subheading Example
34407
34408 @smallexample
34409 @value{GDBP}
34410 -add-inferior
34411 ^done,inferior="i3"
34412 @end smallexample
34413
34414 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
34415 @findex -interpreter-exec
34416
34417 @subheading Synopsis
34418
34419 @smallexample
34420 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
34421 @end smallexample
34422 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
34423
34424 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
34425
34426 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34427
34428 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
34429
34430 @subheading Example
34431
34432 @smallexample
34433 (gdb)
34434 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
34435 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
34436 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
34437 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
34438 ^done
34439 (gdb)
34440 @end smallexample
34441
34442 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
34443 @findex -inferior-tty-set
34444
34445 @subheading Synopsis
34446
34447 @smallexample
34448 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34449 @end smallexample
34450
34451 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
34452
34453 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34454
34455 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
34456
34457 @subheading Example
34458
34459 @smallexample
34460 (gdb)
34461 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34462 ^done
34463 (gdb)
34464 @end smallexample
34465
34466 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
34467 @findex -inferior-tty-show
34468
34469 @subheading Synopsis
34470
34471 @smallexample
34472 -inferior-tty-show
34473 @end smallexample
34474
34475 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
34476
34477 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34478
34479 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
34480
34481 @subheading Example
34482
34483 @smallexample
34484 (gdb)
34485 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
34486 ^done
34487 (gdb)
34488 -inferior-tty-show
34489 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
34490 (gdb)
34491 @end smallexample
34492
34493 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
34494 @findex -enable-timings
34495
34496 @subheading Synopsis
34497
34498 @smallexample
34499 -enable-timings [yes | no]
34500 @end smallexample
34501
34502 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
34503 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
34504 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
34505 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
34506
34507 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
34508
34509 No equivalent.
34510
34511 @subheading Example
34512
34513 @smallexample
34514 (gdb)
34515 -enable-timings
34516 ^done
34517 (gdb)
34518 -break-insert main
34519 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
34520 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
34521 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
34522 times="0"@},
34523 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
34524 (gdb)
34525 -enable-timings no
34526 ^done
34527 (gdb)
34528 -exec-run
34529 ^running
34530 (gdb)
34531 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
34532 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
34533 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
34534 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
34535 (gdb)
34536 @end smallexample
34537
34538 @node Annotations
34539 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
34540
34541 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
34542 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
34543 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
34544 relatively high level.
34545
34546 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
34547 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
34548
34549 @ignore
34550 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
34551 @end ignore
34552
34553 @menu
34554 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
34555 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
34556 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
34557 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
34558 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
34559 * Annotations for Running::
34560 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
34561 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
34562 @end menu
34563
34564 @node Annotations Overview
34565 @section What is an Annotation?
34566 @cindex annotations
34567
34568 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
34569 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
34570 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
34571 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
34572 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
34573 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
34574 cannot contain newline characters.
34575
34576 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
34577 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
34578 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
34579 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
34580 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34581 means those three characters as output.
34582
34583 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34584 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34585 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34586 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34587 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34588 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34589 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34590 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34591 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34592
34593 @table @code
34594 @kindex set annotate
34595 @item set annotate @var{level}
34596 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34597 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34598
34599 @item show annotate
34600 @kindex show annotate
34601 Show the current annotation level.
34602 @end table
34603
34604 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34605
34606 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34607
34608 @smallexample
34609 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34610 GNU gdb 6.0
34611 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34612 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34613 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34614 under certain conditions.
34615 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34616 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34617 for details.
34618 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34619
34620 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34621 (@value{GDBP})
34622 ^Z^Zprompt
34623 @kbd{quit}
34624
34625 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34626 $
34627 @end smallexample
34628
34629 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34630 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34631 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34632 output from @value{GDBN}.
34633
34634 @node Server Prefix
34635 @section The Server Prefix
34636 @cindex server prefix
34637
34638 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34639 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34640 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34641 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34642 a transparent manner.
34643
34644 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34645 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34646 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34647 @code{print} command.
34648
34649 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34650 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34651
34652 @node Prompting
34653 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34654
34655 @cindex annotations for prompts
34656 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34657 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34658 over, etc.
34659
34660 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34661 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34662 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34663 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34664 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34665 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34666 features the following annotations:
34667
34668 @smallexample
34669 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34670 ^Z^Zprompt
34671 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34672 @end smallexample
34673
34674 The input types are
34675
34676 @table @code
34677 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34678 @findex prompt annotation
34679 @findex post-prompt annotation
34680 @item prompt
34681 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34682
34683 @findex pre-commands annotation
34684 @findex commands annotation
34685 @findex post-commands annotation
34686 @item commands
34687 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34688 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34689
34690 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34691 @findex overload-choice annotation
34692 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34693 @item overload-choice
34694 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34695
34696 @findex pre-query annotation
34697 @findex query annotation
34698 @findex post-query annotation
34699 @item query
34700 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34701
34702 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34703 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34704 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34705 @item prompt-for-continue
34706 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34707 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34708 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34709 presence of annotations.
34710 @end table
34711
34712 @node Errors
34713 @section Errors
34714 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34715
34716 @findex quit annotation
34717 @smallexample
34718 ^Z^Zquit
34719 @end smallexample
34720
34721 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34722
34723 @findex error annotation
34724 @smallexample
34725 ^Z^Zerror
34726 @end smallexample
34727
34728 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34729
34730 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34731 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34732 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34733 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34734 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34735 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34736 to the top level.
34737
34738 @findex error-begin annotation
34739 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34740
34741 @smallexample
34742 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34743 @end smallexample
34744
34745 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34746 message.
34747
34748 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34749 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34750 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34751
34752 @node Invalidation
34753 @section Invalidation Notices
34754
34755 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34756 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34757 changed.
34758
34759 @table @code
34760 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34761 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34762
34763 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34764 have changed.
34765
34766 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34767 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34768
34769 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34770 deleted a breakpoint.
34771 @end table
34772
34773 @node Annotations for Running
34774 @section Running the Program
34775 @cindex annotations for running programs
34776
34777 @findex starting annotation
34778 @findex stopping annotation
34779 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34780 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34781
34782 @smallexample
34783 ^Z^Zstarting
34784 @end smallexample
34785
34786 is output. When the program stops,
34787
34788 @smallexample
34789 ^Z^Zstopped
34790 @end smallexample
34791
34792 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34793 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34794
34795 @table @code
34796 @findex exited annotation
34797 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34798 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34799 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34800
34801 @findex signalled annotation
34802 @findex signal-name annotation
34803 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34804 @findex signal-string annotation
34805 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34806 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34807 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34808 annotation continues:
34809
34810 @smallexample
34811 @var{intro-text}
34812 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34813 @var{name}
34814 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34815 @var{middle-text}
34816 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34817 @var{string}
34818 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34819 @var{end-text}
34820 @end smallexample
34821
34822 @noindent
34823 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34824 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34825 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34826 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34827 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34828
34829 @findex signal annotation
34830 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34831 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34832 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34833 terminated with it.
34834
34835 @findex breakpoint annotation
34836 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34837 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34838
34839 @findex watchpoint annotation
34840 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34841 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34842 @end table
34843
34844 @node Source Annotations
34845 @section Displaying Source
34846 @cindex annotations for source display
34847
34848 @findex source annotation
34849 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34850
34851 @smallexample
34852 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34853 @end smallexample
34854
34855 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34856 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34857 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34858 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34859 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34860 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34861 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34862 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34863 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34864 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34865 depend on the language).
34866
34867 @node JIT Interface
34868 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34869 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34870 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34871
34872 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34873 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34874 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34875 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34876
34877 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34878 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34879 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34880 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34881 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34882 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34883
34884 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34885 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34886 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34887 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34888 LLVM JIT.
34889
34890 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34891 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34892 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34893 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34894 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34895 out about additional code.
34896
34897 @menu
34898 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34899 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34900 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34901 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34902 @end menu
34903
34904 @node Declarations
34905 @section JIT Declarations
34906
34907 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34908 implement the interface:
34909
34910 @smallexample
34911 typedef enum
34912 @{
34913 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34914 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34915 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34916 @} jit_actions_t;
34917
34918 struct jit_code_entry
34919 @{
34920 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34921 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34922 const char *symfile_addr;
34923 uint64_t symfile_size;
34924 @};
34925
34926 struct jit_descriptor
34927 @{
34928 uint32_t version;
34929 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34930 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34931 uint32_t action_flag;
34932 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34933 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34934 @};
34935
34936 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34937 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34938
34939 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34940 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34941 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34942 @end smallexample
34943
34944 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34945 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34946 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34947
34948 @node Registering Code
34949 @section Registering Code
34950
34951 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34952
34953 @itemize @bullet
34954 @item
34955 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34956 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34957
34958 @item
34959 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34960 file.
34961
34962 @item
34963 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34964
34965 @item
34966 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34967
34968 @item
34969 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34970 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34971 @end itemize
34972
34973 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34974 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34975 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34976 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34977
34978 @node Unregistering Code
34979 @section Unregistering Code
34980
34981 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34982
34983 @itemize @bullet
34984 @item
34985 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34986
34987 @item
34988 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34989
34990 @item
34991 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34992 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34993 @end itemize
34994
34995 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34996 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34997
34998 @node Custom Debug Info
34999 @section Custom Debug Info
35000 @cindex custom JIT debug info
35001 @cindex JIT debug info reader
35002
35003 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
35004 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
35005 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
35006 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
35007 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
35008 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
35009 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
35010 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
35011 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
35012
35013 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
35014 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
35015 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
35016 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
35017 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
35018 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
35019 compiler.
35020
35021 @menu
35022 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
35023 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
35024 @end menu
35025
35026 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
35027 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
35028 @kindex jit-reader-load
35029 @kindex jit-reader-unload
35030
35031 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
35032 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
35033
35034 @table @code
35035 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
35036 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
35037 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
35038 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
35039 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
35040 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
35041 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
35042
35043 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
35044 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
35045 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
35046 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
35047 @code{jit-reader-load}.
35048
35049 @item jit-reader-unload
35050 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
35051
35052 @end table
35053
35054 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
35055 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
35056 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
35057
35058 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
35059 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
35060
35061 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
35062 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
35063 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
35064 the system include directory.
35065
35066 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
35067 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
35068 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
35069
35070 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
35071 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
35072
35073 @findex gdb_init_reader
35074 @smallexample
35075 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
35076 @end smallexample
35077
35078 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
35079
35080 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
35081 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
35082 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
35083 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
35084 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
35085 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
35086
35087 @smallexample
35088 struct gdb_reader_funcs
35089 @{
35090 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
35091 int reader_version;
35092
35093 /* For use by the reader. */
35094 void *priv_data;
35095
35096 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
35097 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
35098 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
35099 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
35100 @};
35101 @end smallexample
35102
35103 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
35104 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
35105
35106 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
35107 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
35108 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
35109 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
35110 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
35111 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
35112 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
35113 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
35114 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
35115 target's address space.
35116
35117 @node In-Process Agent
35118 @chapter In-Process Agent
35119 @cindex debugging agent
35120 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
35121 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
35122 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
35123 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
35124 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
35125 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
35126 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
35127 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
35128 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
35129 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
35130 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
35131 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
35132 behavior without interrupting it.
35133
35134 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
35135 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
35136 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
35137 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
35138 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
35139 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
35140 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
35141 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
35142 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
35143
35144 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
35145 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
35146 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
35147 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
35148
35149 @anchor{Control Agent}
35150 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
35151 debugging with the following commands:
35152
35153 @table @code
35154 @kindex set agent on
35155 @item set agent on
35156 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
35157 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
35158 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
35159 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
35160 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
35161 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
35162
35163 @kindex set agent off
35164 @item set agent off
35165 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
35166 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
35167
35168 @kindex show agent
35169 @item show agent
35170 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
35171 the in-process agent.
35172 @end table
35173
35174 @menu
35175 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
35176 @end menu
35177
35178 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
35179 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
35180 @cindex in-process agent protocol
35181
35182 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
35183 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
35184 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
35185 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
35186 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
35187 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
35188 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
35189 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
35190 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
35191
35192 @menu
35193 * IPA Protocol Objects::
35194 * IPA Protocol Commands::
35195 @end menu
35196
35197 @node IPA Protocol Objects
35198 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
35199 @cindex ipa protocol objects
35200
35201 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
35202 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
35203
35204 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
35205 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
35206 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
35207 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
35208
35209 @enumerate
35210 @item
35211 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
35212 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
35213 @item
35214 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
35215 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
35216 the other one.
35217 @end enumerate
35218
35219 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
35220
35221 @enumerate
35222 @item
35223 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
35224 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
35225 @anchor{agent expression object}
35226 @item
35227 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
35228 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
35229 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
35230 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
35231 @item
35232 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
35233 @anchor{tracepoint object}
35234
35235 @end enumerate
35236
35237 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
35238 object:
35239
35240 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
35241 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
35242 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
35243 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
35244 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
35245 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
35246 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35247 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
35248 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
35249 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
35250 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
35251 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
35252 memory address for collecting.
35253 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
35254 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35255 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
35256 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35257 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
35258 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
35259 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
35260 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
35261 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
35262 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
35263 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
35264 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
35265 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
35266 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
35267 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
35268 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
35269 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
35270 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
35271 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
35272 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
35273 @ref{agent expression object}
35274 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
35275 @ref{agent expression object}
35276 @item actions @tab variable
35277 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
35278 @end multitable
35279
35280 @node IPA Protocol Commands
35281 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
35282 @cindex ipa protocol commands
35283
35284 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
35285 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
35286
35287 @table @samp
35288
35289 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
35290 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
35291 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
35292 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
35293 in IPA finally.
35294
35295 Replies:
35296 @table @samp
35297 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
35298 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
35299 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
35300 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
35301 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
35302 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
35303 @item E @var{NN}
35304 for an error
35305
35306 @end table
35307
35308 @item close
35309 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
35310 is about to kill inferiors.
35311
35312 @item qTfSTM
35313 @xref{qTfSTM}.
35314 @item qTsSTM
35315 @xref{qTsSTM}.
35316 @item qTSTMat
35317 @xref{qTSTMat}.
35318 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
35319 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
35320
35321 Replies:
35322 @table @samp
35323 @item E @var{NN}
35324 for an error
35325 @end table
35326 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
35327 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
35328 @end table
35329
35330 @node GDB Bugs
35331 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
35332 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
35333 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
35334
35335 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
35336
35337 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
35338 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
35339 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
35340 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
35341
35342 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
35343 information that enables us to fix the bug.
35344
35345 @menu
35346 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
35347 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
35348 @end menu
35349
35350 @node Bug Criteria
35351 @section Have You Found a Bug?
35352 @cindex bug criteria
35353
35354 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
35355
35356 @itemize @bullet
35357 @cindex fatal signal
35358 @cindex debugger crash
35359 @cindex crash of debugger
35360 @item
35361 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
35362 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
35363
35364 @cindex error on valid input
35365 @item
35366 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
35367 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
35368 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
35369
35370 @cindex invalid input
35371 @item
35372 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
35373 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
35374 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
35375 for traditional practice''.
35376
35377 @item
35378 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
35379 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
35380 @end itemize
35381
35382 @node Bug Reporting
35383 @section How to Report Bugs
35384 @cindex bug reports
35385 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
35386
35387 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
35388 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
35389 contact that organization first.
35390
35391 You can find contact information for many support companies and
35392 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
35393 distribution.
35394 @c should add a web page ref...
35395
35396 @ifset BUGURL
35397 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
35398 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35399 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
35400 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
35401 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
35402 be used.
35403
35404 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
35405 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
35406 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
35407 @samp{bug-gdb}.
35408
35409 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
35410 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
35411 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
35412 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
35413 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
35414 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
35415 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
35416 bug reports to the mailing list.
35417 @end ifset
35418 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
35419 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
35420 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
35421 @end ifclear
35422 @end ifset
35423
35424 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
35425 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
35426 fact or leave it out, state it!
35427
35428 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
35429 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
35430 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
35431 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
35432 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
35433 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
35434 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
35435 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
35436 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
35437
35438 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
35439 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
35440 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
35441 self-contained.
35442
35443 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
35444 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
35445 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
35446 bugs properly.
35447
35448 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
35449
35450 @itemize @bullet
35451 @item
35452 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
35453 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
35454 version}.
35455
35456 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
35457 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
35458
35459 @item
35460 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
35461 version number.
35462
35463 @item
35464 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
35465 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
35466 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
35467 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
35468
35469 @item
35470 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
35471 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
35472
35473 @item
35474 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
35475 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
35476 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
35477 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
35478 those compilers.
35479
35480 @item
35481 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
35482 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
35483 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
35484 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
35485
35486 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
35487 and then we might not encounter the bug.
35488
35489 @item
35490 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
35491 reproduce the bug.
35492
35493 @item
35494 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
35495 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
35496
35497 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
35498 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
35499 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
35500 a chance to make a mistake.
35501
35502 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
35503 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
35504 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
35505 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
35506 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
35507 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
35508 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
35509 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
35510
35511 @pindex script
35512 @cindex recording a session script
35513 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
35514 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
35515 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
35516 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
35517
35518 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
35519 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
35520
35521 @item
35522 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
35523 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
35524 it by context, not by line number.
35525
35526 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
35527 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
35528
35529 @end itemize
35530
35531 Here are some things that are not necessary:
35532
35533 @itemize @bullet
35534 @item
35535 A description of the envelope of the bug.
35536
35537 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
35538 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
35539 changes will not affect it.
35540
35541 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
35542 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
35543 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
35544 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
35545
35546 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
35547 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
35548 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
35549 less time, and so on.
35550
35551 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
35552 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
35553
35554 @item
35555 A patch for the bug.
35556
35557 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
35558 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
35559 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
35560 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
35561
35562 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
35563 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
35564 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
35565 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
35566
35567 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
35568 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
35569 help us to understand.
35570
35571 @item
35572 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
35573
35574 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
35575 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
35576 @end itemize
35577
35578 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
35579 @c and consists of the two following files:
35580 @c rluser.texi
35581 @c hsuser.texi
35582 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35583 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35584 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35585 @include rluser.texi
35586 @include hsuser.texi
35587 @end ifclear
35588
35589 @node In Memoriam
35590 @appendix In Memoriam
35591
35592 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35593 contributors:
35594
35595 @table @code
35596 @item Fred Fish
35597 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35598 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35599 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35600
35601 @item Michael Snyder
35602 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35603 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35604 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35605 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35606 @end table
35607
35608 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35609 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35610
35611 @node Formatting Documentation
35612 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35613
35614 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35615 @cindex reference card
35616 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35617 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35618 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35619 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35620 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35621 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35622
35623 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35624 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35625
35626 @smallexample
35627 make refcard.dvi
35628 @end smallexample
35629
35630 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35631 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35632 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35633 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35634 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35635
35636 @cindex documentation
35637
35638 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35639 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35640 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35641 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35642 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35643 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35644
35645 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35646 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35647 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35648 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35649 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35650 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35651 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35652 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35653
35654 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35655 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35656 @code{makeinfo}.
35657
35658 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35659 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35660 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35661
35662 @smallexample
35663 cd gdb
35664 make gdb.info
35665 @end smallexample
35666
35667 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35668 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35669 Texinfo definitions file.
35670
35671 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35672 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35673 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35674 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35675 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35676 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35677 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35678
35679 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35680 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35681 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35682 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35683 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35684 directory.
35685
35686 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35687 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35688 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35689 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35690
35691 @smallexample
35692 make gdb.dvi
35693 @end smallexample
35694
35695 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35696
35697 @node Installing GDB
35698 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35699 @cindex installation
35700
35701 @menu
35702 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35703 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35704 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35705 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35706 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35707 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35708 @end menu
35709
35710 @node Requirements
35711 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35712 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35713
35714 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35715 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35716
35717 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35718 @table @asis
35719 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
35720 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
35721 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35722
35723 @item GNU make
35724 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
35725 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
35726 @end table
35727
35728 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35729 @table @asis
35730 @item Expat
35731 @anchor{Expat}
35732 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35733 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35734 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35735 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35736 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35737 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35738
35739 Expat is used for:
35740
35741 @itemize @bullet
35742 @item
35743 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35744 @item
35745 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35746 @item
35747 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35748 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35749 @item
35750 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35751 @item
35752 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35753 @item
35754 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35755 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35756 @end itemize
35757
35758 @item Guile
35759 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
35760 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
35761 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35762 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
35763 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
35764 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
35765
35766 @item iconv
35767 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35768 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35769 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35770 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35771
35772 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35773 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
35774 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
35775 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
35776 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
35777
35778 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
35779 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
35780 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
35781 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
35782 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
35783
35784 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35785 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35786 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35787 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35788 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35789 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35790 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
35791 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
35792 code to @samp{libiconv}.
35793
35794 @item lzma
35795 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
35796 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
35797 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
35798 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
35799 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
35800 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
35801 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
35802
35803 @item MPFR
35804 @anchor{MPFR}
35805 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35806 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35807 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35808 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35809 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35810 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35811 option to specify its location.
35812
35813 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35814 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35815 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35816 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35817
35818 @item Python
35819 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
35820 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
35821 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
35822 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
35823 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
35824 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
35825 installation of Python.
35826
35827 @item zlib
35828 @cindex compressed debug sections
35829 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35830 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35831 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35832 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35833 information in such binaries.
35834
35835 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35836 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35837 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35838 @end table
35839
35840 @node Running Configure
35841 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35842 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35843 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35844 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35845 build the @code{gdb} program.
35846 @iftex
35847 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35848 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35849 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35850 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35851 @end iftex
35852
35853 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35854 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35855 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35856
35857 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35858 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35859
35860 @table @code
35861 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35862 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35863
35864 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35865 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35866
35867 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35868 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35869
35870 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35871 @sc{gnu} include files
35872
35873 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35874 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35875
35876 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35877 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35878
35879 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35880 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35881 @end table
35882
35883 There may be other subdirectories as well.
35884
35885 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35886 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35887 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35888
35889 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35890 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35891 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35892 argument.
35893
35894 For example:
35895
35896 @smallexample
35897 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35898 ./configure
35899 make
35900 @end smallexample
35901
35902 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
35903 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
35904 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
35905 directories.
35906
35907 @need 750
35908 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35909 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35910 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35911
35912 @smallexample
35913 sh configure
35914 @end smallexample
35915
35916 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35917 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35918 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35919 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35920 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35921 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35922 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35923 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35924 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35925
35926 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
35927 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
35928 install it with @code{make install}.
35929
35930 @node Separate Objdir
35931 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35932
35933 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35934 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35935 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35936 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35937 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35938 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35939 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35940 program specified there.
35941
35942 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35943 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35944 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35945 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35946 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35947 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35948
35949 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35950 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35951
35952 @smallexample
35953 @group
35954 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35955 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35956 cd ../gdb-sun4
35957 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
35958 make
35959 @end group
35960 @end smallexample
35961
35962 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35963 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35964 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35965 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35966 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35967 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35968
35969 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35970 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35971 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35972 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35973 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35974
35975 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35976 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35977 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35978 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35979 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35980 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35981
35982 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35983 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35984 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35985
35986 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35987 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35988 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35989 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35990 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35991
35992 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35993 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35994 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35995 with each other.
35996
35997 @node Config Names
35998 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35999
36000 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
36001 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
36002 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
36003 of information in the following pattern:
36004
36005 @smallexample
36006 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
36007 @end smallexample
36008
36009 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
36010 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
36011 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
36012
36013 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
36014 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
36015 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
36016 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
36017 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
36018 abbreviations---for example:
36019
36020 @smallexample
36021 % sh config.sub i386-linux
36022 i386-pc-linux-gnu
36023 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
36024 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
36025 % sh config.sub hp9k700
36026 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
36027 % sh config.sub sun4
36028 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
36029 % sh config.sub sun3
36030 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
36031 % sh config.sub i986v
36032 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
36033 @end smallexample
36034
36035 @noindent
36036 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
36037 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
36038
36039 @node Configure Options
36040 @section @file{configure} Options
36041
36042 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
36043 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
36044 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
36045 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
36046 explanation of @file{configure}.
36047
36048 @smallexample
36049 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
36050 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
36051 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
36052 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
36053 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
36054 @end smallexample
36055
36056 @noindent
36057 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
36058 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
36059 @samp{--}.
36060
36061 @table @code
36062 @item --help
36063 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
36064
36065 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
36066 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
36067 @file{@var{dir}}.
36068
36069 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
36070 Configure the source to install programs under directory
36071 @file{@var{dir}}.
36072
36073 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
36074 @need 2000
36075 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
36076 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
36077 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
36078 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
36079 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
36080 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
36081 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
36082 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
36083 @var{dirname}.
36084
36085 @item --target=@var{target}
36086 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
36087 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
36088 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
36089
36090 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
36091 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
36092 @end table
36093
36094 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
36095 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
36096 options not described here.
36097
36098 @table @code
36099 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
36100 @itemx --enable-targets=all
36101 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
36102 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
36103 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
36104
36105 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
36106 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
36107 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
36108 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
36109 @code{--datadir}).
36110
36111 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
36112 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
36113 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
36114 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
36115 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
36116 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
36117 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
36118 after it is built.
36119
36120 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
36121 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
36122
36123 @item --disable-gdbmi
36124 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
36125 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
36126
36127 @item --enable-tui
36128 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
36129 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
36130 supported).
36131
36132 @item --with-curses
36133 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
36134 terminal operations.
36135
36136 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
36137 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
36138 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
36139 details.
36140
36141 @item --with-system-readline
36142 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
36143 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
36144
36145 @item --with-system-zlib
36146 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
36147 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
36148
36149 @item --with-expat
36150 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
36151 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
36152 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
36153 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
36154 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
36155 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
36156 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
36157 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
36158
36159 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
36160
36161 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
36162 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
36163 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
36164 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
36165 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
36166
36167 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
36168 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
36169
36170 @item --with-lzma
36171 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
36172 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
36173 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
36174 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
36175 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
36176 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
36177
36178 @item --with-mpfr
36179 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
36180 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
36181 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
36182 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
36183 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
36184 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
36185 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
36186 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
36187 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
36188
36189 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
36190 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
36191 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
36192 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
36193 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
36194 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
36195 of Python supported by GDB is 2.6. The optional argument @var{python}
36196 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
36197 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
36198 Python is installed.
36199
36200 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
36201 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
36202 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
36203 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
36204 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
36205 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
36206 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
36207 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
36208 compile and link against Guile.
36209
36210 @item --without-included-regex
36211 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
36212 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
36213 the GNU C library.
36214
36215 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
36216 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
36217 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
36218 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
36219 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
36220 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
36221 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
36222 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
36223
36224 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
36225 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
36226 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
36227 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
36228 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
36229 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
36230
36231 @item --enable-build-warnings
36232 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
36233 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
36234 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
36235 compiler you are using.
36236
36237 @item --enable-werror
36238 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
36239 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
36240 outputs any warning messages.
36241
36242 @item --enable-ubsan
36243 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
36244 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
36245 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
36246 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
36247 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
36248 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
36249 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
36250 @end table
36251
36252 @node System-wide configuration
36253 @section System-wide configuration and settings
36254 @cindex system-wide init file
36255
36256 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
36257 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
36258 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
36259
36260 Here is the corresponding configure option:
36261
36262 @table @code
36263 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
36264 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
36265 @var{file}.
36266 @end table
36267
36268 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
36269 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
36270
36271 @itemize @bullet
36272 @item
36273 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
36274 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
36275 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
36276 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
36277 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
36278 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
36279
36280 @item
36281 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
36282 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
36283 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
36284 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
36285 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
36286 @end itemize
36287
36288 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
36289 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
36290 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
36291 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
36292 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
36293 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
36294 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
36295 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
36296 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
36297 reread.
36298
36299 @menu
36300 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
36301 @end menu
36302
36303 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
36304 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
36305 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
36306
36307 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
36308 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
36309 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
36310 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
36311 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
36312 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
36313
36314 The following scripts are currently available:
36315 @itemize @bullet
36316
36317 @item @file{elinos.py}
36318 @pindex elinos.py
36319 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
36320 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
36321 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
36322 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
36323 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
36324 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
36325
36326 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
36327 @pindex wrs-linux.py
36328 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
36329 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
36330 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
36331 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
36332
36333 @end itemize
36334
36335 @node Maintenance Commands
36336 @appendix Maintenance Commands
36337 @cindex maintenance commands
36338 @cindex internal commands
36339
36340 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
36341 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
36342 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
36343 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
36344 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
36345
36346 @table @code
36347 @kindex maint agent
36348 @kindex maint agent-eval
36349 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36350 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
36351 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
36352 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
36353 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
36354 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
36355 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
36356 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
36357 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
36358 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
36359 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
36360 addition and return the sum.
36361 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
36362 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
36363
36364 @kindex maint agent-printf
36365 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
36366 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
36367 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
36368 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
36369 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
36370
36371 @kindex maint info breakpoints
36372 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
36373 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
36374 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
36375 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
36376 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
36377 is shown:
36378
36379 @table @code
36380 @item breakpoint
36381 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
36382
36383 @item watchpoint
36384 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
36385
36386 @item longjmp
36387 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
36388 @code{longjmp} calls.
36389
36390 @item longjmp resume
36391 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
36392
36393 @item until
36394 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
36395
36396 @item finish
36397 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
36398
36399 @item shlib events
36400 Shared library events.
36401
36402 @end table
36403
36404 @kindex maint info btrace
36405 @item maint info btrace
36406 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
36407
36408 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
36409 @item maint btrace packet-history
36410 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
36411 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
36412 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
36413 recording format.
36414
36415 @table @code
36416 @item bts
36417 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
36418 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
36419
36420 @table @asis
36421 @item Block number
36422 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
36423 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
36424 @item Highest @samp{PC}
36425 @end table
36426
36427 @item pt
36428 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
36429 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
36430 information is printed:
36431
36432 @table @asis
36433 @item Packet number
36434 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
36435 @item Trace offset
36436 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
36437 @item Packet opcode and payload
36438 @end table
36439 @end table
36440
36441 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
36442 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
36443 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
36444 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
36445 needed.
36446
36447 @kindex maint btrace clear
36448 @item maint btrace clear
36449 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
36450 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
36451
36452 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
36453 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
36454 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
36455 buffer.
36456
36457 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36458 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
36459 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36460 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
36461 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
36462 packet history.
36463
36464 @kindex set displaced-stepping
36465 @kindex show displaced-stepping
36466 @cindex displaced stepping support
36467 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
36468 @item set displaced-stepping
36469 @itemx show displaced-stepping
36470 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
36471 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
36472 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
36473 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
36474 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
36475
36476 @table @code
36477 @item set displaced-stepping on
36478 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
36479 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
36480
36481 @item set displaced-stepping off
36482 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
36483 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
36484
36485 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
36486 @item set displaced-stepping auto
36487 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
36488 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
36489 architecture supports displaced stepping.
36490 @end table
36491
36492 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
36493 @item maint check-psymtabs
36494 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
36495 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
36496
36497 @kindex maint check-symtabs
36498 @item maint check-symtabs
36499 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
36500
36501 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
36502 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
36503 Expand symbol tables.
36504 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
36505 names matching @var{regexp}.
36506
36507 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
36508 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36509 @cindex demangler crashes
36510 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
36511 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
36512 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
36513 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
36514 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
36515 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
36516 option to terminate the current session.
36517
36518 @kindex maint cplus first_component
36519 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
36520 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
36521
36522 @kindex maint cplus namespace
36523 @item maint cplus namespace
36524 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
36525
36526 @kindex maint deprecate
36527 @kindex maint undeprecate
36528 @cindex deprecated commands
36529 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
36530 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
36531 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
36532 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
36533 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
36534 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
36535 the replacement as part of the warning.
36536
36537 @kindex maint dump-me
36538 @item maint dump-me
36539 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
36540 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
36541 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
36542 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
36543
36544 @kindex maint internal-error
36545 @kindex maint internal-warning
36546 @kindex maint demangler-warning
36547 @cindex demangler crashes
36548 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36549 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36550 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
36551
36552 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
36553 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
36554 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
36555 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
36556 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
36557 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
36558 @value{GDBN} session.
36559
36560 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
36561 used as the text of the error or warning message.
36562
36563 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
36564
36565 @smallexample
36566 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
36567 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
36568 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
36569 debugging may prove unreliable.
36570 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36571 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
36572 (@value{GDBP})
36573 @end smallexample
36574
36575 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
36576 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
36577 @cindex demangler crashes
36578
36579 @kindex maint set internal-error
36580 @kindex maint show internal-error
36581 @kindex maint set internal-warning
36582 @kindex maint show internal-warning
36583 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
36584 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
36585 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36586 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
36587 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36588 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
36589 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
36590 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
36591 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
36592 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
36593 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
36594 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
36595 described in the table below.
36596
36597 @table @samp
36598 @item quit
36599 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36600 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
36601
36602 @item corefile
36603 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
36604 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
36605 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
36606 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
36607 disabled.
36608 @end table
36609
36610 @kindex maint packet
36611 @item maint packet @var{text}
36612 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
36613 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
36614 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
36615 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
36616 checksum.
36617
36618 @kindex maint print architecture
36619 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36620 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
36621 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
36622
36623 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36624 @item maint print c-tdesc
36625 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
36626 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
36627 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
36628 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
36629 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
36630 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
36631 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
36632 modify XML target descriptions.
36633
36634 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
36635 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
36636 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
36637 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
36638
36639 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
36640 @kindex maint check libthread-db
36641 @item maint check libthread-db
36642 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
36643 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
36644 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
36645 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
36646 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
36647 on some platforms when debugging core files.
36648
36649 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
36650 @item maint print dummy-frames
36651 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
36652
36653 @smallexample
36654 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
36655 @dots{}
36656 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
36657 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
36658 58 return (a + b);
36659 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
36660 @dots{}
36661 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
36662 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
36663 (@value{GDBP})
36664 @end smallexample
36665
36666 Takes an optional file parameter.
36667
36668 @kindex maint print registers
36669 @kindex maint print raw-registers
36670 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
36671 @kindex maint print register-groups
36672 @kindex maint print remote-registers
36673 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36674 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36675 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36676 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36677 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36678 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
36679
36680 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
36681 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
36682 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
36683 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
36684 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
36685 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
36686 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
36687 and offsets in the `G' packets.
36688
36689 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
36690 write the information.
36691
36692 @kindex maint print reggroups
36693 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
36694 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
36695 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
36696 information.
36697
36698 The register groups info looks like this:
36699
36700 @smallexample
36701 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
36702 Group Type
36703 general user
36704 float user
36705 all user
36706 vector user
36707 system user
36708 save internal
36709 restore internal
36710 @end smallexample
36711
36712 @kindex flushregs
36713 @item flushregs
36714 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
36715
36716 @kindex maint print objfiles
36717 @cindex info for known object files
36718 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
36719 Print a dump of all known object files.
36720 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
36721 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
36722 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
36723
36724 @kindex maint print user-registers
36725 @cindex user registers
36726 @item maint print user-registers
36727 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
36728 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
36729 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
36730 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
36731 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
36732 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
36733 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
36734
36735 @kindex maint print section-scripts
36736 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
36737 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
36738 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36739 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36740 matching @var{regexp}.
36741 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36742 and the full path if known.
36743 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36744
36745 @kindex maint print statistics
36746 @cindex bcache statistics
36747 @item maint print statistics
36748 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36749 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36750 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36751 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36752 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36753 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36754 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36755 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36756 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36757 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36758 lengths.
36759
36760 @kindex maint print target-stack
36761 @cindex target stack description
36762 @item maint print target-stack
36763 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36764 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36765 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36766 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36767 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36768 address.
36769
36770 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36771 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36772
36773 @kindex maint print type
36774 @cindex type chain of a data type
36775 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36776 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36777 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36778 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36779 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36780 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36781
36782 @kindex maint selftest
36783 @cindex self tests
36784 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36785 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36786 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36787 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36788 name will by ran.
36789
36790 @kindex maint info selftests
36791 @cindex self tests
36792 @item maint info selftests
36793 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36794
36795 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36796 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36797 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36798 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36799 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36800 information.
36801
36802 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36803 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36804 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36805 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36806 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36807 always see the disassembly form.
36808
36809 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36810
36811 @smallexample
36812 (gdb) info addr argc
36813 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36814 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36815 @end smallexample
36816
36817 For more information on these expressions, see
36818 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36819
36820 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36821 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36822 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36823 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36824 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36825
36826 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36827 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36828 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36829 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36830 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36831 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36832 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36833 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36834 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36835
36836 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36837 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36838 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36839 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36840 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36841
36842 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36843 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36844 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36845 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36846 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36847 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36848
36849 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36850 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36851 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36852
36853 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36854 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36855 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36856 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36857
36858 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36859 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36860 @kindex maint set profile
36861 @kindex maint show profile
36862 @cindex profiling GDB
36863 @item maint set profile
36864 @itemx maint show profile
36865 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36866
36867 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36868 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36869 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36870 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36871 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36872 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36873 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36874
36875 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36876 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36877
36878 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36879 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36880 @cindex hardware debug registers
36881 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36882 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36883 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36884 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36885 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36886 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36887 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36888
36889 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36890 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36891 @item maint set show-all-tib
36892 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36893 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36894 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36895 command.
36896
36897 @kindex maint set target-async
36898 @kindex maint show target-async
36899 @item maint set target-async
36900 @itemx maint show target-async
36901 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36902 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36903 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36904 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36905
36906 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36907 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36908 @item maint set target-non-stop
36909 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36910
36911 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36912 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36913 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36914 if supported by the target.
36915
36916 @table @code
36917 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36918 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36919 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36920
36921 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36922 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36923 does not indicate support.
36924
36925 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36926 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36927 target supports it.
36928 @end table
36929
36930 @kindex maint set per-command
36931 @kindex maint show per-command
36932 @item maint set per-command
36933 @itemx maint show per-command
36934 @cindex resources used by commands
36935
36936 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36937 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36938
36939 @table @code
36940 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36941 @itemx maint show per-command space
36942 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36943 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36944 took, following the command's own output.
36945 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36946 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36947
36948 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36949 @itemx maint show per-command time
36950 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36951 for each command.
36952 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36953 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36954 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36955 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36956 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36957 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36958 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36959 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36960 spent by the program been debugged.
36961 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36962 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36963
36964 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36965 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36966 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36967 for each command.
36968 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36969
36970 @enumerate a
36971 @item
36972 number of symbol tables
36973 @item
36974 number of primary symbol tables
36975 @item
36976 number of blocks in the blockvector
36977 @end enumerate
36978 @end table
36979
36980 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36981 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36982 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36983 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36984 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36985 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36986 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36987 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36988 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36989 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36990
36991 @kindex maint space
36992 @cindex memory used by commands
36993 @item maint space @var{value}
36994 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36995 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36996
36997 @kindex maint time
36998 @cindex time of command execution
36999 @item maint time @var{value}
37000 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
37001 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
37002
37003 @kindex maint translate-address
37004 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
37005 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
37006 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
37007 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
37008 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
37009 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
37010 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
37011
37012 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
37013 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
37014 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
37015
37016 @end table
37017
37018 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
37019 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
37020
37021 @table @code
37022 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
37023 @kindex set watchdog
37024 @cindex watchdog timer
37025 @cindex timeout for commands
37026 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
37027 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
37028 reports and error and the command is aborted.
37029
37030 @item show watchdog
37031 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
37032 @end table
37033
37034 @node Remote Protocol
37035 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
37036
37037 @menu
37038 * Overview::
37039 * Packets::
37040 * Stop Reply Packets::
37041 * General Query Packets::
37042 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
37043 * Tracepoint Packets::
37044 * Host I/O Packets::
37045 * Interrupts::
37046 * Notification Packets::
37047 * Remote Non-Stop::
37048 * Packet Acknowledgment::
37049 * Examples::
37050 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
37051 * Library List Format::
37052 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
37053 * Memory Map Format::
37054 * Thread List Format::
37055 * Traceframe Info Format::
37056 * Branch Trace Format::
37057 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
37058 @end menu
37059
37060 @node Overview
37061 @section Overview
37062
37063 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
37064 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
37065 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
37066 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
37067
37068 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
37069 transmitted and received data, respectively.
37070
37071 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
37072 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
37073 @cindex remote serial protocol
37074 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
37075 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
37076 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
37077 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
37078 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
37079
37080 @smallexample
37081 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37082 @end smallexample
37083 @noindent
37084
37085 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
37086 @noindent
37087 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
37088 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
37089 eight bit unsigned checksum).
37090
37091 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
37092 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
37093
37094 @smallexample
37095 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37096 @end smallexample
37097
37098 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
37099 @noindent
37100 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
37101 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
37102 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
37103
37104 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
37105 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37106 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
37107 retransmission):
37108
37109 @smallexample
37110 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37111 <- @code{+}
37112 @end smallexample
37113 @noindent
37114
37115 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
37116 once a connection is established.
37117 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
37118
37119 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
37120 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
37121 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
37122 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
37123 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
37124 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
37125 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
37126
37127 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
37128 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
37129 exceptions).
37130
37131 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
37132 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
37133 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
37134 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
37135
37136 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
37137 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
37138 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
37139
37140 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
37141 @anchor{Binary Data}
37142 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
37143 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
37144 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
37145 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
37146 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
37147 binary data.
37148
37149 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
37150 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
37151 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
37152 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
37153 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
37154 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
37155 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
37156 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
37157 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
37158 (described next).
37159
37160 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
37161 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
37162 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
37163 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
37164 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
37165 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
37166 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
37167 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
37168 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
37169 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
37170 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
37171 3}} more times.
37172
37173 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
37174 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
37175 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
37176 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
37177 @samp{0*"00}.
37178
37179 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
37180 error number. That number is not well defined.
37181
37182 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
37183 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
37184 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
37185 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
37186 on that response.
37187
37188 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
37189 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
37190 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
37191 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
37192 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
37193 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
37194
37195 @node Packets
37196 @section Packets
37197
37198 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
37199 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
37200 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
37201 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
37202
37203 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
37204 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
37205 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
37206 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
37207 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
37208 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
37209 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
37210 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
37211 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
37212 @var{baz}.
37213
37214 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
37215 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
37216 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
37217 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
37218 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
37219 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
37220 pick any thread.
37221
37222 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
37223 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
37224 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
37225 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
37226 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
37227 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
37228 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
37229 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
37230 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
37231 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
37232 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
37233 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
37234 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
37235
37236 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
37237 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
37238 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
37239 more information.
37240
37241 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
37242 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
37243
37244 Here are the packet descriptions.
37245
37246 @table @samp
37247
37248 @item !
37249 @cindex @samp{!} packet
37250 @anchor{extended mode}
37251 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
37252 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
37253 debugged.
37254
37255 Reply:
37256 @table @samp
37257 @item OK
37258 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
37259 @end table
37260
37261 @item ?
37262 @cindex @samp{?} packet
37263 @anchor{? packet}
37264 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
37265 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
37266 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37267
37268 Reply:
37269 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37270
37271 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
37272 @cindex @samp{A} packet
37273 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
37274 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
37275 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
37276
37277 Reply:
37278 @table @samp
37279 @item OK
37280 The arguments were set.
37281 @item E @var{NN}
37282 An error occurred.
37283 @end table
37284
37285 @item b @var{baud}
37286 @cindex @samp{b} packet
37287 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
37288 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
37289
37290 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
37291 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
37292 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
37293
37294 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
37295 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
37296 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
37297 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
37298 of view, nothing actually happened.}
37299
37300 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
37301 @cindex @samp{B} packet
37302 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
37303 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
37304
37305 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
37306 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
37307
37308 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
37309 @anchor{bc}
37310 @item bc
37311 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
37312 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37313
37314 Reply:
37315 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37316
37317 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
37318 @anchor{bs}
37319 @item bs
37320 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
37321 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
37322
37323 Reply:
37324 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37325
37326 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37327 @cindex @samp{c} packet
37328 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
37329 is omitted, resume at current address.
37330
37331 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37332 packet}.
37333
37334 Reply:
37335 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37336
37337 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37338 @cindex @samp{C} packet
37339 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
37340 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
37341
37342 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37343 packet}.
37344
37345 Reply:
37346 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37347
37348 @item d
37349 @cindex @samp{d} packet
37350 Toggle debug flag.
37351
37352 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
37353 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
37354
37355 @item D
37356 @itemx D;@var{pid}
37357 @cindex @samp{D} packet
37358 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
37359 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
37360 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
37361
37362 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
37363 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
37364 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
37365 big-endian hex string.
37366
37367 Reply:
37368 @table @samp
37369 @item OK
37370 for success
37371 @item E @var{NN}
37372 for an error
37373 @end table
37374
37375 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
37376 @cindex @samp{F} packet
37377 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
37378 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
37379 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
37380
37381 @item g
37382 @anchor{read registers packet}
37383 @cindex @samp{g} packet
37384 Read general registers.
37385
37386 Reply:
37387 @table @samp
37388 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37389 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
37390 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
37391 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
37392 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
37393 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
37394
37395 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
37396 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
37397 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
37398 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
37399 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
37400 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
37401 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
37402 have been collected, and both have zero value:
37403
37404 @smallexample
37405 -> @code{g}
37406 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
37407 @end smallexample
37408
37409 @item E @var{NN}
37410 for an error.
37411 @end table
37412
37413 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
37414 @cindex @samp{G} packet
37415 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
37416 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
37417
37418 Reply:
37419 @table @samp
37420 @item OK
37421 for success
37422 @item E @var{NN}
37423 for an error
37424 @end table
37425
37426 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
37427 @cindex @samp{H} packet
37428 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
37429 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
37430 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
37431 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
37432 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
37433 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
37434 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37435
37436 Reply:
37437 @table @samp
37438 @item OK
37439 for success
37440 @item E @var{NN}
37441 for an error
37442 @end table
37443
37444 @c FIXME: JTC:
37445 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
37446 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
37447 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
37448 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
37449 @c described. For example:
37450 @c
37451 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37452 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
37453 @c otherwise returns current registers.
37454 @c
37455 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
37456 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
37457 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
37458
37459 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
37460 @anchor{cycle step packet}
37461 @cindex @samp{i} packet
37462 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
37463 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
37464 step starting at that address.
37465
37466 @item I
37467 @cindex @samp{I} packet
37468 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
37469 step packet}.
37470
37471 @item k
37472 @cindex @samp{k} packet
37473 Kill request.
37474
37475 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
37476
37477 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
37478 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
37479
37480 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
37481
37482 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
37483 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
37484 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
37485
37486 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
37487 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
37488 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
37489
37490 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
37491 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
37492 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
37493 (@pxref{? packet}).
37494
37495 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
37496 @cindex @samp{m} packet
37497 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37498 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
37499 any particular boundary.
37500
37501 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
37502 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
37503 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
37504 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
37505 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
37506 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
37507 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
37508 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
37509
37510 Reply:
37511 @table @samp
37512 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37513 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37514 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
37515 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
37516 @item E @var{NN}
37517 @var{NN} is errno
37518 @end table
37519
37520 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37521 @cindex @samp{M} packet
37522 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
37523 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
37524 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
37525
37526 Reply:
37527 @table @samp
37528 @item OK
37529 for success
37530 @item E @var{NN}
37531 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
37532 written).
37533 @end table
37534
37535 @item p @var{n}
37536 @cindex @samp{p} packet
37537 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
37538 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
37539 register value is encoded.
37540
37541 Reply:
37542 @table @samp
37543 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
37544 the register's value
37545 @item E @var{NN}
37546 for an error
37547 @item @w{}
37548 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
37549 @end table
37550
37551 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
37552 @anchor{write register packet}
37553 @cindex @samp{P} packet
37554 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
37555 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
37556 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
37557
37558 Reply:
37559 @table @samp
37560 @item OK
37561 for success
37562 @item E @var{NN}
37563 for an error
37564 @end table
37565
37566 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37567 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
37568 @cindex @samp{q} packet
37569 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
37570 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
37571 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
37572
37573 @item r
37574 @cindex @samp{r} packet
37575 Reset the entire system.
37576
37577 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
37578
37579 @item R @var{XX}
37580 @cindex @samp{R} packet
37581 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
37582 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37583
37584 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
37585
37586 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
37587 @cindex @samp{s} packet
37588 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
37589 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
37590
37591 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37592 packet}.
37593
37594 Reply:
37595 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37596
37597 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
37598 @anchor{step with signal packet}
37599 @cindex @samp{S} packet
37600 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
37601 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
37602
37603 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
37604 packet}.
37605
37606 Reply:
37607 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37608
37609 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
37610 @cindex @samp{t} packet
37611 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
37612 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
37613 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
37614
37615 @item T @var{thread-id}
37616 @cindex @samp{T} packet
37617 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37618
37619 Reply:
37620 @table @samp
37621 @item OK
37622 thread is still alive
37623 @item E @var{NN}
37624 thread is dead
37625 @end table
37626
37627 @item v
37628 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
37629 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
37630
37631 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
37632 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
37633 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
37634 The process ID is a
37635 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
37636 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
37637 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
37638
37639 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
37640 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
37641 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
37642 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
37643 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
37644 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
37645 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
37646 @c stopping or restarting threads.
37647
37648 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37649
37650 Reply:
37651 @table @samp
37652 @item E @var{nn}
37653 for an error
37654 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37655 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37656 @item OK
37657 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
37658 @end table
37659
37660 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
37661 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
37662 @anchor{vCont packet}
37663 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
37664
37665 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
37666 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
37667 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
37668 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
37669 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
37670 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
37671 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
37672 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
37673 error.
37674
37675 Currently supported actions are:
37676
37677 @table @samp
37678 @item c
37679 Continue.
37680 @item C @var{sig}
37681 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37682 @item s
37683 Step.
37684 @item S @var{sig}
37685 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
37686 @item t
37687 Stop.
37688 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
37689 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
37690 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
37691 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
37692 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
37693 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
37694
37695 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
37696 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
37697 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
37698 jumps to @var{start}).
37699
37700 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
37701 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
37702 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
37703
37704 @end table
37705
37706 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
37707 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
37708 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
37709
37710 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
37711 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
37712 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
37713 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
37714 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
37715 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
37716 as an implementation detail.
37717
37718 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
37719 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
37720 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
37721 stopped.
37722
37723 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
37724 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
37725 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
37726
37727 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
37728 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
37729
37730 Reply:
37731 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
37732
37733 @item vCont?
37734 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
37735 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
37736
37737 Reply:
37738 @table @samp
37739 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37740 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37741 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37742 @item @w{}
37743 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37744 @end table
37745
37746 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37747 @item vCtrlC
37748 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37749 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37750 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37751 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37752 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37753 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37754 variant.
37755
37756 Reply:
37757 @table @samp
37758 @item E @var{nn}
37759 for an error
37760 @item OK
37761 for success
37762 @end table
37763
37764 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37765 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37766 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37767 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37768
37769 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37770 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37771 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37772 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37773 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37774 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37775 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37776 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37777 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37778 packet is received.
37779
37780 Reply:
37781 @table @samp
37782 @item OK
37783 for success
37784 @item E @var{NN}
37785 for an error
37786 @end table
37787
37788 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37789 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37790 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37791 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37792 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37793 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37794 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37795 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37796 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37797 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37798 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37799 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37800
37801
37802 Reply:
37803 @table @samp
37804 @item OK
37805 for success
37806 @item E.memtype
37807 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37808 @item E @var{NN}
37809 for an error
37810 @end table
37811
37812 @item vFlashDone
37813 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37814 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37815 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37816 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37817 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37818 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37819 request is completed.
37820
37821 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37822 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37823 @anchor{vKill packet}
37824 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37825 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37826 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37827 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37828
37829 Reply:
37830 @table @samp
37831 @item E @var{nn}
37832 for an error
37833 @item OK
37834 for success
37835 @end table
37836
37837 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37838 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37839 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37840 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37841 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37842
37843 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37844 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37845 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37846 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37847 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37848 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37849
37850 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37851 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37852 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37853 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37854 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37855 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37856 state.
37857
37858 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37859
37860 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37861
37862 Reply:
37863 @table @samp
37864 @item E @var{nn}
37865 for an error
37866 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37867 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37868 @end table
37869
37870 @item vStopped
37871 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37872 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37873
37874 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37875 @anchor{X packet}
37876 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37877 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37878 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37879 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37880 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37881
37882 Reply:
37883 @table @samp
37884 @item OK
37885 for success
37886 @item E @var{NN}
37887 for an error
37888 @end table
37889
37890 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37891 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37892 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37893 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37894 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37895 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37896 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37897
37898 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37899 separately.
37900
37901 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37902 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37903 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37904 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37905 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37906 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37907
37908 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37909 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37910 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37911 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37912 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37913 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37914
37915 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37916 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37917 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37918 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37919 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37920 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37921 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37922 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37923 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37924 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37925 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37926 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37927 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37928
37929 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37930 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37931
37932 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37933 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37934
37935 @table @samp
37936
37937 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37938 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37939 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37940
37941 @end table
37942
37943 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37944 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37945 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37946 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37947 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37948 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37949 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37950
37951 @table @samp
37952
37953 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37954 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37955 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37956
37957 @end table
37958
37959 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37960 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37961 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37962 target, is not defined.}
37963
37964 Reply:
37965 @table @samp
37966 @item OK
37967 success
37968 @item @w{}
37969 not supported
37970 @item E @var{NN}
37971 for an error
37972 @end table
37973
37974 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37975 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37976 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37977 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37978 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37979 address @var{addr}.
37980
37981 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37982 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37983 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37984 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37985
37986 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37987 movement.}
37988
37989 Reply:
37990 @table @samp
37991 @item OK
37992 success
37993 @item @w{}
37994 not supported
37995 @item E @var{NN}
37996 for an error
37997 @end table
37998
37999 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38000 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38001 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
38002 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
38003 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38004 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
38005
38006 Reply:
38007 @table @samp
38008 @item OK
38009 success
38010 @item @w{}
38011 not supported
38012 @item E @var{NN}
38013 for an error
38014 @end table
38015
38016 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38017 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38018 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
38019 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
38020 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38021 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
38022
38023 Reply:
38024 @table @samp
38025 @item OK
38026 success
38027 @item @w{}
38028 not supported
38029 @item E @var{NN}
38030 for an error
38031 @end table
38032
38033 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38034 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38035 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
38036 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
38037 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38038 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
38039
38040 Reply:
38041 @table @samp
38042 @item OK
38043 success
38044 @item @w{}
38045 not supported
38046 @item E @var{NN}
38047 for an error
38048 @end table
38049
38050 @end table
38051
38052 @node Stop Reply Packets
38053 @section Stop Reply Packets
38054 @cindex stop reply packets
38055
38056 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
38057 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
38058 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
38059 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
38060 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
38061 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
38062 @value{GDBN} source code.
38063
38064 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
38065 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
38066 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
38067
38068 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
38069 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
38070 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
38071 components.
38072
38073 @table @samp
38074
38075 @item S @var{AA}
38076 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
38077 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
38078 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
38079
38080 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
38081 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
38082 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
38083 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
38084 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
38085 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
38086 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
38087 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
38088
38089 @itemize @bullet
38090 @item
38091 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
38092 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
38093 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
38094 two-digit hex number.
38095
38096 @item
38097 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
38098 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38099
38100 @item
38101 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
38102 the core on which the stop event was detected.
38103
38104 @item
38105 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
38106 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
38107 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
38108 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
38109
38110 @item
38111 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
38112 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
38113 future.
38114 @end itemize
38115
38116 The currently defined stop reasons are:
38117
38118 @table @samp
38119 @item watch
38120 @itemx rwatch
38121 @itemx awatch
38122 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
38123 hex.
38124
38125 @item syscall_entry
38126 @itemx syscall_return
38127 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
38128 syscall number, in hex.
38129
38130 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
38131 @item library
38132 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
38133 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
38134 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
38135
38136 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
38137 @item replaylog
38138 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
38139 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
38140 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
38141 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
38142 for more information.
38143
38144 @item swbreak
38145 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
38146 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
38147 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
38148 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
38149 part must be left empty.
38150
38151 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
38152 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
38153 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
38154 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
38155 address.
38156
38157 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38158 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38159 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38160 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38161 indicating support.
38162
38163 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
38164
38165 @item hwbreak
38166 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
38167 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
38168
38169 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
38170 apply.
38171
38172 @cindex fork events, remote reply
38173 @item fork
38174 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
38175 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
38176 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38177 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
38178 fork events.
38179
38180 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38181 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38182 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38183 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38184 indicating support.
38185
38186 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
38187 @item vfork
38188 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
38189 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
38190 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38191 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
38192 vfork events.
38193
38194 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38195 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38196 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38197 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38198 indicating support.
38199
38200 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
38201 @item vforkdone
38202 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
38203 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
38204 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
38205 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
38206 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
38207
38208 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38209 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38210 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38211 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38212 indicating support.
38213
38214 @cindex exec events, remote reply
38215 @item exec
38216 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
38217 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
38218 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
38219
38220 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
38221 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
38222 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
38223 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
38224 indicating support.
38225
38226 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
38227 @anchor{thread create event}
38228 @item create
38229 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
38230 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
38231 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
38232 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
38233 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
38234 @var{r} part is ignored.
38235
38236 @end table
38237
38238 @item W @var{AA}
38239 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
38240 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
38241 applicable to certain targets.
38242
38243 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
38244 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
38245 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
38246 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
38247 hex strings.
38248
38249 @item X @var{AA}
38250 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
38251 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
38252
38253 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
38254 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
38255 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
38256 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
38257 hex strings.
38258
38259 @anchor{thread exit event}
38260 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
38261 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
38262
38263 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
38264 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
38265 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
38266 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
38267
38268 @item N
38269 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
38270 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
38271 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
38272 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
38273 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
38274 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
38275 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
38276 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
38277 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
38278 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
38279 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
38280 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
38281 support.
38282
38283 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
38284 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
38285 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
38286 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
38287 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
38288
38289 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
38290 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
38291 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
38292 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
38293 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
38294 system calls.
38295
38296 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
38297 this very system call.
38298
38299 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
38300 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
38301 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
38302 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38303 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
38304 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
38305
38306 @end table
38307
38308 @node General Query Packets
38309 @section General Query Packets
38310 @cindex remote query requests
38311
38312 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
38313 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
38314 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
38315 sending information to and from the stub.
38316
38317 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
38318 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
38319 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
38320 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
38321 conventions:
38322
38323 @itemize @bullet
38324 @item
38325 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
38326 @item
38327 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
38328 letter.
38329 @item
38330 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
38331 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
38332 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
38333 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
38334 @end itemize
38335
38336 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
38337 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
38338 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
38339 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
38340 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
38341 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
38342 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
38343 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
38344 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
38345 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
38346 packet.}.
38347
38348 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
38349 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
38350 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
38351 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
38352 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
38353
38354 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
38355
38356 @table @samp
38357
38358 @item QAgent:1
38359 @itemx QAgent:0
38360 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
38361 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
38362
38363 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
38364 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
38365 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
38366 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
38367 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
38368 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
38369 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
38370 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
38371 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
38372 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
38373 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
38374
38375 @item qC
38376 @cindex current thread, remote request
38377 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
38378 Return the current thread ID.
38379
38380 Reply:
38381 @table @samp
38382 @item QC @var{thread-id}
38383 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
38384 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38385 @item @r{(anything else)}
38386 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
38387 @end table
38388
38389 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
38390 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
38391 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
38392 @anchor{qCRC packet}
38393 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
38394 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
38395 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
38396 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
38397
38398 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
38399 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
38400 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
38401 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
38402 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
38403 detect trailing zeros.
38404
38405 Reply:
38406 @table @samp
38407 @item E @var{NN}
38408 An error (such as memory fault)
38409 @item C @var{crc32}
38410 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
38411 @end table
38412
38413 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
38414 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
38415 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
38416 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
38417 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
38418 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
38419 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
38420 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
38421 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
38422 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
38423 randomization.
38424
38425 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38426
38427 Reply:
38428 @table @samp
38429 @item OK
38430 The request succeeded.
38431
38432 @item E @var{nn}
38433 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38434
38435 @item @w{}
38436 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
38437 by the stub.
38438 @end table
38439
38440 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38441 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38442 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
38443 address space randomization.
38444
38445 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
38446 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
38447 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
38448 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
38449 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
38450 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
38451 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
38452 inferior using a shell or not.
38453
38454 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
38455 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
38456 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
38457 values are considered an error.
38458
38459 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38460 mode}).
38461
38462 Reply:
38463 @table @samp
38464 @item OK
38465 The request succeeded.
38466
38467 @item E @var{nn}
38468 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38469 @end table
38470
38471 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38472 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38473 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38474 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
38475
38476 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
38477 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
38478
38479 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
38480 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38481 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
38482 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
38483 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
38484 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
38485 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
38486 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
38487 environment}).
38488
38489 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38490 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
38491 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
38492 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
38493 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
38494 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
38495 not be present.
38496
38497 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38498 mode}).
38499
38500 Reply:
38501 @table @samp
38502 @item OK
38503 The request succeeded.
38504 @end table
38505
38506 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38507 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38508 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38509 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38510 inferior.
38511
38512 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
38513 @pxref{set environment}.
38514
38515 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
38516 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
38517 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
38518 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
38519 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
38520 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
38521 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
38522 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
38523
38524 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
38525 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
38526
38527 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38528 mode}).
38529
38530 Reply:
38531 @table @samp
38532 @item OK
38533 The request succeeded.
38534 @end table
38535
38536 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38537 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38538 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38539 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38540 inferior.
38541
38542 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
38543 @pxref{unset environment}.
38544
38545 @item QEnvironmentReset
38546 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
38547 @cindex reset environment, remote request
38548 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
38549 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
38550 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
38551 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
38552 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
38553 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
38554 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
38555 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
38556 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
38557
38558 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38559 mode}).
38560
38561 Reply:
38562 @table @samp
38563 @item OK
38564 The request succeeded.
38565 @end table
38566
38567 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38568 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38569 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
38570 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
38571 inferior.
38572
38573 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
38574 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
38575 @cindex set working directory, remote request
38576 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
38577 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
38578 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
38579
38580 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
38581 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
38582 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
38583 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
38584 directory to its original, empty value.
38585
38586 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
38587 mode}).
38588
38589 Reply:
38590 @table @samp
38591 @item OK
38592 The request succeeded.
38593 @end table
38594
38595 @item qfThreadInfo
38596 @itemx qsThreadInfo
38597 @cindex list active threads, remote request
38598 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
38599 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
38600 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
38601 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
38602 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
38603 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
38604 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
38605 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
38606
38607 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
38608
38609 Reply:
38610 @table @samp
38611 @item m @var{thread-id}
38612 A single thread ID
38613 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
38614 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
38615 @item l
38616 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38617 @end table
38618
38619 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38620 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
38621 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
38622 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
38623 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
38624 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
38625 fields.
38626
38627 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
38628 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
38629 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
38630 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
38631 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
38632
38633 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
38634 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
38635 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
38636 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
38637 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
38638
38639 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
38640 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38641
38642 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
38643 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
38644 information associated with the variable.)
38645
38646 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
38647 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
38648 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
38649 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
38650 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
38651 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
38652
38653 Reply:
38654 @table @samp
38655 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38656 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
38657 local storage requested.
38658
38659 @item E @var{nn}
38660 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38661
38662 @item @w{}
38663 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38664 @end table
38665
38666 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
38667 @cindex get thread information block address
38668 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
38669 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
38670
38671 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
38672
38673 Reply:
38674 @table @samp
38675 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38676 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
38677 thread information block.
38678
38679 @item E @var{nn}
38680 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
38681 address could not be retrieved.
38682
38683 @item @w{}
38684 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
38685 @end table
38686
38687 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
38688 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
38689 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
38690 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
38691 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
38692 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
38693 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
38694
38695 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
38696
38697 Reply:
38698 @table @samp
38699 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
38700 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
38701 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
38702 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
38703 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
38704 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
38705 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
38706 @end table
38707
38708 @item qOffsets
38709 @cindex section offsets, remote request
38710 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
38711 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
38712 image.
38713
38714 Reply:
38715 @table @samp
38716 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
38717 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
38718 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
38719 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
38720 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
38721 segments by the supplied offsets.
38722
38723 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
38724 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
38725 to the @code{Bss} section.}
38726
38727 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
38728 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
38729 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
38730 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
38731 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
38732 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
38733 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
38734 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
38735 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
38736 @end table
38737
38738 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38739 @cindex thread information, remote request
38740 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38741 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38742 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38743 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38744
38745 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38746 (see below).
38747
38748 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38749
38750 @item QNonStop:1
38751 @itemx QNonStop:0
38752 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38753 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38754 @anchor{QNonStop}
38755 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38756 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38757
38758 Reply:
38759 @table @samp
38760 @item OK
38761 The request succeeded.
38762
38763 @item E @var{nn}
38764 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38765
38766 @item @w{}
38767 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38768 the stub.
38769 @end table
38770
38771 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38772 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38773 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38774 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38775
38776 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38777 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38778 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38779 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38780 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38781 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38782 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38783
38784 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38785 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38786 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38787
38788 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38789 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38790 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38791 report the requested syscalls.
38792
38793 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38794 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38795
38796 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38797 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38798 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38799 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38800
38801 Reply:
38802 @table @samp
38803 @item OK
38804 The request succeeded.
38805
38806 @item E @var{nn}
38807 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38808
38809 @item @w{}
38810 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38811 the stub.
38812 @end table
38813
38814 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38815 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38816 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38817 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38818
38819 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38820 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38821 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38822 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38823 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38824 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38825 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38826 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38827 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38828 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38829 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38830 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38831 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38832
38833 Reply:
38834 @table @samp
38835 @item OK
38836 The request succeeded.
38837
38838 @item E @var{nn}
38839 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38840
38841 @item @w{}
38842 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38843 the stub.
38844 @end table
38845
38846 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38847 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38848 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38849 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38850
38851 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38852 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38853 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38854 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38855 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38856 Others should be silently discarded.
38857
38858 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38859 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38860 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38861 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38862 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38863 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38864 signals.
38865
38866 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38867 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38868
38869 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38870 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38871 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38872 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38873 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38874
38875 Reply:
38876 @table @samp
38877 @item OK
38878 The request succeeded.
38879
38880 @item E @var{nn}
38881 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38882
38883 @item @w{}
38884 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38885 by the stub.
38886 @end table
38887
38888 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38889 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38890 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38891 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38892
38893 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38894 @item QThreadEvents:1
38895 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38896 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38897 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38898
38899 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38900 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38901 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38902 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38903 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38904 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38905 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38906 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38907 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38908 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38909
38910 Reply:
38911 @table @samp
38912 @item OK
38913 The request succeeded.
38914
38915 @item E @var{nn}
38916 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38917
38918 @item @w{}
38919 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38920 the stub.
38921 @end table
38922
38923 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38924 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38925
38926 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38927 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38928 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38929 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38930 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38931 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38932 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38933 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38934 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38935
38936 Reply:
38937 @table @samp
38938 @item OK
38939 A command response with no output.
38940 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38941 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38942 @item E @var{NN}
38943 Indicate a badly formed request.
38944 @item @w{}
38945 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38946 @end table
38947
38948 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38949 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38950 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38951 packets.)
38952
38953 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38954 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38955 @ifnotinfo
38956 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38957 @end ifnotinfo
38958 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38959 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38960 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38961 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38962 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38963
38964 Reply:
38965 @table @samp
38966 @item 0
38967 The pattern was not found.
38968 @item 1,address
38969 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38970 @item E @var{NN}
38971 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38972 @item @w{}
38973 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38974 @end table
38975
38976 @item QStartNoAckMode
38977 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38978 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38979 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38980 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38981
38982 Reply:
38983 @table @samp
38984 @item OK
38985 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38986 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38987 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38988 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38989 @item @w{}
38990 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38991 @end table
38992
38993 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38994 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38995 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38996 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38997 @anchor{qSupported}
38998 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38999 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
39000 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
39001 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
39002 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
39003 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
39004 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
39005 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
39006 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
39007 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
39008 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
39009 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
39010 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
39011 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
39012
39013 Reply:
39014 @table @samp
39015 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
39016 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
39017 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
39018 possible forms).
39019 @item @w{}
39020 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
39021 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
39022 @end table
39023
39024 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
39025 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
39026 are:
39027
39028 @table @samp
39029 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
39030 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
39031 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
39032 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
39033 @item @var{name}+
39034 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
39035 need an associated value.
39036 @item @var{name}-
39037 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
39038 @item @var{name}?
39039 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
39040 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
39041 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
39042 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
39043 @end table
39044
39045 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
39046 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
39047 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
39048 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
39049 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
39050
39051 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
39052 are defined:
39053
39054 @table @samp
39055 @item multiprocess
39056 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
39057 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39058 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39059 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39060 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
39061
39062 @item xmlRegisters
39063 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
39064 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
39065 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
39066 description.
39067
39068 @item qRelocInsn
39069 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
39070 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39071 instruction reply packet}).
39072
39073 @item swbreak
39074 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
39075 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
39076
39077 @item hwbreak
39078 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
39079 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
39080
39081 @item fork-events
39082 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
39083 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39084 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39085 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39086
39087 @item vfork-events
39088 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
39089 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39090 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39091 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39092
39093 @item exec-events
39094 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
39095 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39096 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39097 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39098
39099 @item vContSupported
39100 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
39101 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
39102 @end table
39103
39104 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
39105 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
39106 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
39107 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
39108 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
39109 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
39110 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
39111 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
39112 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
39113 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
39114 all the features it supports.
39115
39116 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
39117 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
39118
39119 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
39120 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
39121 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
39122 form response.
39123
39124 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
39125 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
39126 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
39127 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
39128
39129 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
39130 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
39131 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
39132 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
39133 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
39134
39135 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
39136
39137 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
39138 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
39139 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
39140 @item Feature Name
39141 @tab Value Required
39142 @tab Default
39143 @tab Probe Allowed
39144
39145 @item @samp{PacketSize}
39146 @tab Yes
39147 @tab @samp{-}
39148 @tab No
39149
39150 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
39151 @tab No
39152 @tab @samp{-}
39153 @tab Yes
39154
39155 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39156 @tab No
39157 @tab @samp{-}
39158 @tab Yes
39159
39160 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39161 @tab No
39162 @tab @samp{-}
39163 @tab Yes
39164
39165 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
39166 @tab No
39167 @tab @samp{-}
39168 @tab Yes
39169
39170 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
39171 @tab No
39172 @tab @samp{-}
39173 @tab Yes
39174
39175 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39176 @tab No
39177 @tab @samp{-}
39178 @tab Yes
39179
39180 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
39181 @tab No
39182 @tab @samp{-}
39183 @tab Yes
39184
39185 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
39186 @tab No
39187 @tab @samp{-}
39188 @tab No
39189
39190 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39191 @tab No
39192 @tab @samp{-}
39193 @tab Yes
39194
39195 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
39196 @tab No
39197 @tab @samp{-}
39198 @tab Yes
39199
39200 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
39201 @tab No
39202 @tab @samp{-}
39203 @tab Yes
39204
39205 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
39206 @tab No
39207 @tab @samp{-}
39208 @tab Yes
39209
39210 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
39211 @tab No
39212 @tab @samp{-}
39213 @tab Yes
39214
39215 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
39216 @tab No
39217 @tab @samp{-}
39218 @tab Yes
39219
39220 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
39221 @tab No
39222 @tab @samp{-}
39223 @tab Yes
39224
39225 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39226 @tab No
39227 @tab @samp{-}
39228 @tab Yes
39229
39230 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39231 @tab No
39232 @tab @samp{-}
39233 @tab Yes
39234
39235 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39236 @tab No
39237 @tab @samp{-}
39238 @tab Yes
39239
39240 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
39241 @tab Yes
39242 @tab @samp{-}
39243 @tab Yes
39244
39245 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
39246 @tab Yes
39247 @tab @samp{-}
39248 @tab Yes
39249
39250 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
39251 @tab Yes
39252 @tab @samp{-}
39253 @tab Yes
39254
39255 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
39256 @tab Yes
39257 @tab @samp{-}
39258 @tab Yes
39259
39260 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
39261 @tab Yes
39262 @tab @samp{-}
39263 @tab Yes
39264
39265 @item @samp{QNonStop}
39266 @tab No
39267 @tab @samp{-}
39268 @tab Yes
39269
39270 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
39271 @tab No
39272 @tab @samp{-}
39273 @tab Yes
39274
39275 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
39276 @tab No
39277 @tab @samp{-}
39278 @tab Yes
39279
39280 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
39281 @tab No
39282 @tab @samp{-}
39283 @tab Yes
39284
39285 @item @samp{multiprocess}
39286 @tab No
39287 @tab @samp{-}
39288 @tab No
39289
39290 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
39291 @tab No
39292 @tab @samp{-}
39293 @tab No
39294
39295 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
39296 @tab No
39297 @tab @samp{-}
39298 @tab No
39299
39300 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
39301 @tab No
39302 @tab @samp{-}
39303 @tab No
39304
39305 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
39306 @tab No
39307 @tab @samp{-}
39308 @tab No
39309
39310 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
39311 @tab No
39312 @tab @samp{-}
39313 @tab No
39314
39315 @item @samp{QAgent}
39316 @tab No
39317 @tab @samp{-}
39318 @tab No
39319
39320 @item @samp{QAllow}
39321 @tab No
39322 @tab @samp{-}
39323 @tab No
39324
39325 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
39326 @tab No
39327 @tab @samp{-}
39328 @tab No
39329
39330 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
39331 @tab No
39332 @tab @samp{-}
39333 @tab No
39334
39335 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
39336 @tab No
39337 @tab @samp{-}
39338 @tab No
39339
39340 @item @samp{tracenz}
39341 @tab No
39342 @tab @samp{-}
39343 @tab No
39344
39345 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
39346 @tab No
39347 @tab @samp{-}
39348 @tab No
39349
39350 @item @samp{swbreak}
39351 @tab No
39352 @tab @samp{-}
39353 @tab No
39354
39355 @item @samp{hwbreak}
39356 @tab No
39357 @tab @samp{-}
39358 @tab No
39359
39360 @item @samp{fork-events}
39361 @tab No
39362 @tab @samp{-}
39363 @tab No
39364
39365 @item @samp{vfork-events}
39366 @tab No
39367 @tab @samp{-}
39368 @tab No
39369
39370 @item @samp{exec-events}
39371 @tab No
39372 @tab @samp{-}
39373 @tab No
39374
39375 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
39376 @tab No
39377 @tab @samp{-}
39378 @tab No
39379
39380 @item @samp{no-resumed}
39381 @tab No
39382 @tab @samp{-}
39383 @tab No
39384
39385 @end multitable
39386
39387 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
39388
39389 @table @samp
39390 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
39391 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
39392 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
39393 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
39394 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
39395 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
39396 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
39397 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
39398 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
39399 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
39400
39401 @item qXfer:auxv:read
39402 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
39403 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
39404
39405 @item qXfer:btrace:read
39406 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39407 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
39408
39409 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
39410 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39411 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
39412
39413 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
39414 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
39415 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
39416
39417 @item qXfer:features:read
39418 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
39419 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
39420
39421 @item qXfer:libraries:read
39422 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
39423 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
39424
39425 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
39426 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39427 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39428
39429 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
39430 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
39431 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
39432 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
39433
39434 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
39435 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
39436 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
39437
39438 @item qXfer:sdata:read
39439 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
39440 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
39441
39442 @item qXfer:spu:read
39443 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
39444 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
39445
39446 @item qXfer:spu:write
39447 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
39448 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
39449
39450 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
39451 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
39452 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
39453
39454 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
39455 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
39456 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
39457
39458 @item qXfer:threads:read
39459 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39460 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
39461
39462 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
39463 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39464 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
39465
39466 @item qXfer:uib:read
39467 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
39468 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
39469
39470 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
39471 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
39472 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
39473
39474 @item QNonStop
39475 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
39476 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
39477
39478 @item QCatchSyscalls
39479 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
39480 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
39481
39482 @item QPassSignals
39483 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39484 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
39485
39486 @item QStartNoAckMode
39487 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
39488 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
39489
39490 @item multiprocess
39491 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
39492 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
39493 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
39494 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
39495 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
39496 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
39497 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
39498 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
39499 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
39500 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
39501 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
39502
39503 @item qXfer:osdata:read
39504 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
39505 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
39506
39507 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
39508 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
39509 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
39510 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
39511
39512 @item ConditionalTracepoints
39513 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
39514 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
39515
39516 @item ReverseContinue
39517 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
39518 (@pxref{bc}).
39519
39520 @item ReverseStep
39521 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
39522 (@pxref{bs}).
39523
39524 @item TracepointSource
39525 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
39526 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
39527
39528 @item QAgent
39529 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
39530
39531 @item QAllow
39532 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
39533
39534 @item QDisableRandomization
39535 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
39536
39537 @item StaticTracepoint
39538 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
39539 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
39540
39541 @item InstallInTrace
39542 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
39543 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
39544
39545 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
39546 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
39547 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
39548 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
39549
39550 @item QTBuffer:size
39551 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
39552 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
39553
39554 @item tracenz
39555 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
39556 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
39557 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
39558
39559 @item BreakpointCommands
39560 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
39561 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
39562 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
39563
39564 @item Qbtrace:off
39565 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
39566
39567 @item Qbtrace:bts
39568 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
39569
39570 @item Qbtrace:pt
39571 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
39572
39573 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
39574 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
39575
39576 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
39577 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
39578
39579 @item swbreak
39580 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
39581 breakpoints.
39582
39583 @item hwbreak
39584 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
39585 breakpoints.
39586
39587 @item fork-events
39588 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
39589
39590 @item vfork-events
39591 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
39592 and vforkdone events.
39593
39594 @item exec-events
39595 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
39596
39597 @item vContSupported
39598 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
39599 @samp{vCont?} packet.
39600
39601 @item QThreadEvents
39602 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
39603
39604 @item no-resumed
39605 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
39606
39607 @end table
39608
39609 @item qSymbol::
39610 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
39611 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
39612 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
39613 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
39614
39615 Reply:
39616 @table @samp
39617 @item OK
39618 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39619 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39620 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
39621 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
39622 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
39623 below.
39624 @end table
39625
39626 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
39627 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
39628
39629 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
39630 target has previously requested.
39631
39632 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
39633 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
39634 will be empty.
39635
39636 Reply:
39637 @table @samp
39638 @item OK
39639 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
39640 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
39641 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
39642 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
39643 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
39644 @end table
39645
39646 @item qTBuffer
39647 @itemx QTBuffer
39648 @itemx QTDisconnected
39649 @itemx QTDP
39650 @itemx QTDPsrc
39651 @itemx QTDV
39652 @itemx qTfP
39653 @itemx qTfV
39654 @itemx QTFrame
39655 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
39656
39657 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39658
39659 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
39660 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
39661 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
39662 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
39663 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
39664 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
39665 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
39666 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
39667 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
39668 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
39669 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
39670
39671 Reply:
39672 @table @samp
39673 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39674 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
39675 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
39676 the thread's attributes.
39677 @end table
39678
39679 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
39680 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39681 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39682 packets.)
39683
39684 @item QTNotes
39685 @itemx qTP
39686 @itemx QTSave
39687 @itemx qTsP
39688 @itemx qTsV
39689 @itemx QTStart
39690 @itemx QTStop
39691 @itemx QTEnable
39692 @itemx QTDisable
39693 @itemx QTinit
39694 @itemx QTro
39695 @itemx qTStatus
39696 @itemx qTV
39697 @itemx qTfSTM
39698 @itemx qTsSTM
39699 @itemx qTSTMat
39700 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
39701
39702 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39703 @cindex read special object, remote request
39704 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
39705 @anchor{qXfer read}
39706 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
39707 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
39708 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
39709 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
39710 additional details about what data to access.
39711
39712 Reply:
39713 @table @samp
39714 @item m @var{data}
39715 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
39716 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
39717 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
39718 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
39719 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
39720 request.
39721
39722 @item l @var{data}
39723 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
39724 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
39725 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
39726
39727 @item l
39728 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
39729 There is no more data to be read.
39730
39731 @item E00
39732 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39733
39734 @item E @var{nn}
39735 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
39736 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39737
39738 @item @w{}
39739 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39740 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39741 @end table
39742
39743 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39744 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39745 formats, listed above.
39746
39747 @table @samp
39748 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39749 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39750 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39751 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39752
39753 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39754 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39755
39756 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39757 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39758
39759 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39760 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39761 packet may have one of the following values:
39762
39763 @table @code
39764 @item all
39765 Returns all available branch trace.
39766
39767 @item new
39768 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39769 the last read request.
39770
39771 @item delta
39772 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39773 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39774 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39775 used to stitch traces together.
39776
39777 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39778 @end table
39779
39780 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39781 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39782
39783 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39784 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39785
39786 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39787 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39788
39789 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39790 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39791
39792 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39793 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39794 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39795 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39796 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39797 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39798 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39799
39800 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39801 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39802
39803 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39804 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39805 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39806 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39807 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39808
39809 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39810 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39811
39812 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39813 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39814 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39815 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39816 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39817
39818 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39819 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39820 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39821
39822 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39823 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39824
39825 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39826 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39827 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39828 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39829 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39830 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39831 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39832 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39833
39834 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39835 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39836
39837 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39838 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39839
39840 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39841 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39842 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39843 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39844
39845 @table @code
39846 @item start=@var{address}
39847 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39848 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39849 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39850 chosen as the starting point.
39851
39852 @item prev=@var{address}
39853 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39854 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39855 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39856 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39857 exists prior to the starting point.
39858
39859 @end table
39860
39861 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39862 ignored.
39863
39864 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39865 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39866 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39867 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39868 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39869
39870 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39871 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39872
39873 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39874 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39875
39876 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39877 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39878 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39879 Action Lists}.
39880
39881 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39882 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39883 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39884
39885 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39886 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39887 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39888 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39889 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39890
39891 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39892 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39893 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39894
39895 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39896 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39897 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39898 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39899 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39900 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39901 in that context to be accessed.
39902
39903 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39904 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39905 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39906
39907 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39908 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39909 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39910 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39911 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39912
39913 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39914 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39915
39916 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39917 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39918
39919 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39920 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39921 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39922
39923 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39924 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39925
39926 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39927 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39928
39929 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39930 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39931
39932 This packet is not probed by default.
39933
39934 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39935 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39936 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39937 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39938 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39939
39940 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39941 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39942
39943 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39944 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39945 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39946 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39947
39948 @end table
39949
39950 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39951 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39952 @anchor{qXfer write}
39953 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39954 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39955 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39956 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39957 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39958 to access.
39959
39960 Reply:
39961 @table @samp
39962 @item @var{nn}
39963 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39964 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39965
39966 @item E00
39967 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39968
39969 @item E @var{nn}
39970 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39971 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39972
39973 @item @w{}
39974 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39975 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39976 @end table
39977
39978 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39979 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39980 formats, listed above.
39981
39982 @table @samp
39983 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39984 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39985 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39986 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39987 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39988
39989 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39990 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39991 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39992
39993 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39994 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39995 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39996 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39997 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39998 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39999 in that context to be accessed.
40000
40001 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40002 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40003 @end table
40004
40005 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
40006 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
40007 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
40008 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
40009 must respond with an empty packet.
40010
40011 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
40012 @cindex query attached, remote request
40013 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
40014 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
40015 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
40016 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
40017 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
40018 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
40019 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
40020
40021 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
40022 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
40023 the @code{quit} command.
40024
40025 Reply:
40026 @table @samp
40027 @item 1
40028 The remote server attached to an existing process.
40029 @item 0
40030 The remote server created a new process.
40031 @item E @var{NN}
40032 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40033 @end table
40034
40035 @item Qbtrace:bts
40036 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
40037
40038 Reply:
40039 @table @samp
40040 @item OK
40041 Branch tracing has been enabled.
40042 @item E.errtext
40043 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40044 @end table
40045
40046 @item Qbtrace:pt
40047 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
40048
40049 Reply:
40050 @table @samp
40051 @item OK
40052 Branch tracing has been enabled.
40053 @item E.errtext
40054 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40055 @end table
40056
40057 @item Qbtrace:off
40058 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
40059
40060 Reply:
40061 @table @samp
40062 @item OK
40063 Branch tracing has been disabled.
40064 @item E.errtext
40065 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40066 @end table
40067
40068 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
40069 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
40070 btrace recording method in bts format.
40071
40072 Reply:
40073 @table @samp
40074 @item OK
40075 The ring buffer size has been set.
40076 @item E.errtext
40077 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40078 @end table
40079
40080 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
40081 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
40082 btrace recording method in pt format.
40083
40084 Reply:
40085 @table @samp
40086 @item OK
40087 The ring buffer size has been set.
40088 @item E.errtext
40089 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40090 @end table
40091
40092 @end table
40093
40094 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
40095 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
40096
40097 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
40098 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
40099 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
40100
40101 @menu
40102 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
40103 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
40104 @end menu
40105
40106 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
40107 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
40108
40109 @menu
40110 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
40111 @end menu
40112
40113 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
40114 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
40115 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
40116
40117 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40118
40119 @table @r
40120
40121 @item 2
40122 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
40123
40124 @item 3
40125 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
40126
40127 @item 4
40128 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
40129
40130 @end table
40131
40132 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
40133 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
40134
40135 @menu
40136 * MIPS Register packet Format::
40137 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
40138 @end menu
40139
40140 @node MIPS Register packet Format
40141 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
40142 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
40143
40144 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
40145 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
40146 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
40147 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
40148 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
40149 most-significant -- least-significant.
40150
40151 @table @r
40152
40153 @item MIPS32
40154 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
40155 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
40156 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
40157
40158 @item MIPS64
40159 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
40160 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
40161 as @code{MIPS32}.
40162
40163 @end table
40164
40165 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
40166 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
40167 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
40168
40169 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40170
40171 @table @r
40172
40173 @item 2
40174 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
40175
40176 @item 3
40177 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
40178
40179 @item 4
40180 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
40181
40182 @item 5
40183 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
40184
40185 @end table
40186
40187 @node Tracepoint Packets
40188 @section Tracepoint Packets
40189 @cindex tracepoint packets
40190 @cindex packets, tracepoint
40191
40192 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
40193 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
40194
40195 @table @samp
40196
40197 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
40198 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
40199 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
40200 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
40201 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
40202 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
40203 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
40204 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
40205 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
40206 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
40207 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
40208 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
40209 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
40210 actions.
40211
40212 Replies:
40213 @table @samp
40214 @item OK
40215 The packet was understood and carried out.
40216 @item qRelocInsn
40217 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
40218 @item @w{}
40219 The packet was not recognized.
40220 @end table
40221
40222 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
40223 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
40224 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
40225 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
40226 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
40227 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
40228 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
40229
40230 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
40231 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
40232 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
40233 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
40234 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
40235 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
40236 tracepoint actions.
40237
40238 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
40239 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
40240 following forms:
40241
40242 @table @samp
40243
40244 @item R @var{mask}
40245 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
40246 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
40247 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
40248 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
40249 not fit in a 32-bit word.
40250
40251 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
40252 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
40253 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
40254 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
40255 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
40256 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
40257 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
40258
40259 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
40260 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
40261 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
40262 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
40263 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
40264 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
40265 packet).
40266
40267 @end table
40268
40269 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
40270 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
40271 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
40272 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
40273 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
40274 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
40275 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
40276 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
40277
40278 Replies:
40279 @table @samp
40280 @item OK
40281 The packet was understood and carried out.
40282 @item qRelocInsn
40283 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
40284 @item @w{}
40285 The packet was not recognized.
40286 @end table
40287
40288 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
40289 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
40290 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
40291 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
40292 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
40293 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
40294 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
40295 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
40296
40297 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
40298 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
40299 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
40300 fit in a single packet.
40301 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
40302 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
40303
40304 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
40305 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
40306 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
40307 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
40308
40309 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
40310 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
40311 query packets.
40312
40313 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
40314 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
40315 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
40316 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
40317 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
40318 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
40319 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
40320 be found.
40321
40322 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
40323 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
40324 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
40325 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
40326 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
40327 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
40328 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
40329 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
40330 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
40331 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
40332 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
40333 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
40334 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
40335 variable.
40336
40337 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
40338 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
40339 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
40340 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
40341 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
40342
40343 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
40344 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
40345 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
40346 one of the following forms:
40347
40348 @table @samp
40349 @item F @var{f}
40350 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
40351 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
40352 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
40353
40354 @item T @var{t}
40355 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
40356 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
40357
40358 @end table
40359
40360 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
40361 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40362 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
40363 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
40364
40365 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
40366 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40367 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
40368 is a hexadecimal number.
40369
40370 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
40371 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
40372 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
40373 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
40374 numbers.
40375
40376 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
40377 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
40378 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
40379
40380 @item qTMinFTPILen
40381 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
40382 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
40383 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
40384 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
40385 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
40386 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
40387 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
40388 arrange for that.
40389
40390 Replies:
40391
40392 @table @samp
40393 @item 0
40394 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
40395 @item @var{length}
40396 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
40397 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
40398 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
40399 regardless of size.
40400 @item E
40401 An error has occurred.
40402 @item @w{}
40403 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
40404 @end table
40405
40406 @item QTStart
40407 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
40408 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
40409 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
40410 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
40411 instruction reply packet}).
40412
40413 @item QTStop
40414 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
40415 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
40416
40417 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40418 @anchor{QTEnable}
40419 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
40420 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40421 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
40422 of data from it will resume.
40423
40424 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
40425 @anchor{QTDisable}
40426 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
40427 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
40428 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
40429 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
40430
40431 @item QTinit
40432 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
40433 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
40434
40435 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
40436 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
40437 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
40438 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
40439 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
40440
40441 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
40442 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
40443 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
40444 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
40445
40446 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
40447 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
40448 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
40449 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
40450 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
40451 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
40452
40453 @item qTStatus
40454 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
40455 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
40456
40457 The reply has the form:
40458
40459 @table @samp
40460
40461 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
40462 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
40463 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
40464 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
40465
40466 @end table
40467
40468 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
40469 explanations as one of the optional fields:
40470
40471 @table @samp
40472
40473 @item tnotrun:0
40474 No trace has been run yet.
40475
40476 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
40477 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
40478 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
40479 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
40480 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
40481
40482 @item tfull:0
40483 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
40484
40485 @item tdisconnected:0
40486 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
40487
40488 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
40489 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
40490
40491 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
40492 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
40493 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
40494 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
40495 is hex encoded.
40496
40497 @item tunknown:0
40498 The trace stopped for some other reason.
40499
40500 @end table
40501
40502 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
40503 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
40504 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
40505 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
40506 trace.
40507
40508 @table @samp
40509
40510 @item tframes:@var{n}
40511 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
40512
40513 @item tcreated:@var{n}
40514 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
40515 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
40516
40517 @item tsize:@var{n}
40518 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
40519
40520 @item tfree:@var{n}
40521 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
40522
40523 @item circular:@var{n}
40524 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
40525 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
40526 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
40527 and may fill up.
40528
40529 @item disconn:@var{n}
40530 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
40531 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
40532 that the trace run will stop.
40533
40534 @end table
40535
40536 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
40537 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
40538 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
40539 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
40540 address @var{addr}.
40541
40542 Replies:
40543 @table @samp
40544 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
40545 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
40546 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
40547 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
40548 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
40549
40550 @end table
40551
40552 @item qTV:@var{var}
40553 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
40554 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
40555 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
40556
40557 Replies:
40558 @table @samp
40559 @item V@var{value}
40560 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
40561 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
40562 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
40563 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
40564 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
40565 program is running.
40566
40567 @item U
40568 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
40569 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
40570 was not collected.
40571 @end table
40572
40573 @item qTfP
40574 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
40575 @itemx qTsP
40576 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
40577 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
40578 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
40579 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
40580 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
40581 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
40582
40583 @item qTfV
40584 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
40585 @itemx qTsV
40586 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
40587 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
40588 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
40589 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
40590 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
40591 trace state variables.
40592
40593 @item qTfSTM
40594 @itemx qTsSTM
40595 @anchor{qTfSTM}
40596 @anchor{qTsSTM}
40597 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
40598 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
40599 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
40600 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
40601 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
40602 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
40603
40604 Reply:
40605 @table @samp
40606 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
40607 A single marker
40608 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
40609 a comma-separated list of markers
40610 @item l
40611 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
40612 @item E @var{nn}
40613 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
40614 @item @w{}
40615 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
40616 stub.
40617 @end table
40618
40619 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
40620 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
40621
40622 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
40623 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
40624 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
40625 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
40626 @dfn{last}).
40627
40628 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
40629 @anchor{qTSTMat}
40630 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
40631 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
40632 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
40633 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
40634 tracepoint markers.
40635
40636 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
40637 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
40638 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
40639 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
40640 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
40641 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
40642
40643 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
40644 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
40645 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
40646 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
40647 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
40648 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
40649 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
40650 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
40651 available.
40652
40653 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
40654 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
40655 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
40656
40657 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
40658 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
40659 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
40660 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
40661 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
40662 use whatever size it prefers.
40663
40664 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
40665 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
40666 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
40667 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
40668 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
40669
40670 @end table
40671
40672 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
40673 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
40674 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
40675 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
40676 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
40677 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
40678 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
40679 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
40680 it had executed in the original location.
40681
40682 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
40683 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
40684 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
40685 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
40686 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
40687 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
40688 format of the request is:
40689
40690 @table @samp
40691 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
40692
40693 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
40694 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
40695 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
40696 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
40697 memory starting at @var{to}.
40698 @end table
40699
40700 Replies:
40701 @table @samp
40702 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
40703 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
40704 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
40705 @item E @var{NN}
40706 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
40707 relocating the instruction.
40708 @end table
40709
40710 @node Host I/O Packets
40711 @section Host I/O Packets
40712 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
40713 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
40714
40715 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
40716 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
40717 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
40718 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
40719 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
40720 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
40721 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
40722 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
40723 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
40724 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
40725
40726 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
40727 its arguments. They have this format:
40728
40729 @table @samp
40730
40731 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
40732 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
40733 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
40734 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
40735 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
40736 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
40737 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
40738 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40739 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40740
40741 @end table
40742
40743 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40744
40745 @table @samp
40746
40747 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40748 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40749 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40750 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40751 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40752 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40753 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40754 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40755 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40756 @var{attachment}.
40757
40758 @item @w{}
40759 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40760
40761 @end table
40762
40763 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40764
40765 @table @samp
40766 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40767 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40768 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40769 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40770 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40771 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40772 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40773
40774 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40775 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40776 -1 if an error occurs.
40777
40778 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40779 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40780 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40781 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40782 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40783 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40784 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40785 @var{count} was zero.
40786
40787 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40788 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40789 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40790 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40791 some characters were escaped.
40792
40793 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40794 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40795 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40796 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40797 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40798 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40799 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40800 error occurred.
40801
40802 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40803 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40804 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40805 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40806 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40807 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40808
40809 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40810 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40811 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40812
40813 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40814 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40815 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40816
40817 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40818 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40819 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40820 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40821 some characters were escaped.
40822
40823 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40824 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40825 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40826 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40827 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40828 inferior(s).
40829
40830 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40831 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40832 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40833 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40834 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40835 operation.
40836
40837 @end table
40838
40839 @node Interrupts
40840 @section Interrupts
40841 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40842 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40843
40844 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40845 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40846 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40847 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40848
40849 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40850 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40851 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40852 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40853 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40854
40855 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40856 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40857 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40858 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40859 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40860 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40861 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40862 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40863
40864 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40865 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40866 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40867
40868 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40869 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40870 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40871 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40872 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40873 @code{0x03}.
40874
40875 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40876 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40877 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40878 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40879 currently-executing threads and processes.
40880 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40881 running program, it should send one of the stop
40882 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40883 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40884 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40885 Interrupts received while the
40886 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40887 it is resumed next time.
40888
40889 @node Notification Packets
40890 @section Notification Packets
40891 @cindex notification packets
40892 @cindex packets, notification
40893
40894 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40895 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40896 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40897 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40898 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40899 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40900 is not a problem.
40901
40902 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40903 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40904 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40905 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40906 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40907 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40908 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40909
40910 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40911 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40912
40913 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40914 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40915 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40916 not they understand it.
40917
40918 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40919 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40920 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40921 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40922 recipients.
40923
40924 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40925 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40926 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40927 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40928 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40929
40930 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40931 @table @samp
40932 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40933 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40934 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40935 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40936 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40937 @item @var{ack}
40938 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40939 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40940 @end table
40941
40942 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40943 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40944
40945 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40946 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40947 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40948 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40949 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40950 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40951 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40952 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40953 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40954 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40955
40956 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40957 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40958 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40959 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40960 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40961 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40962
40963 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40964 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40965 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40966 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40967 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40968
40969 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40970 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40971 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40972 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40973 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40974 normally.
40975
40976 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40977 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40978 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40979 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40980 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40981 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40982 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40983 the process shall be repeated.
40984
40985 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40986 following example:
40987 @smallexample
40988 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40989 @code{...}
40990 -> @code{vStopped}
40991 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40992 -> @code{vStopped}
40993 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40994 -> @code{vStopped}
40995 <- @code{OK}
40996 @end smallexample
40997
40998 The following notifications are defined:
40999 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
41000
41001 @item Notification
41002 @tab Ack
41003 @tab Event
41004 @tab Description
41005
41006 @item Stop
41007 @tab vStopped
41008 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
41009 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
41010 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
41011 @value{GDBN}.
41012 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
41013
41014 @end multitable
41015
41016 @node Remote Non-Stop
41017 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
41018
41019 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
41020 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
41021 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
41022 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
41023
41024 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
41025 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
41026 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
41027 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
41028 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
41029 probe the target state after a mode change.
41030
41031 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
41032 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
41033 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
41034 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
41035 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
41036 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
41037 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
41038 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
41039 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
41040 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
41041 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
41042
41043 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
41044 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
41045 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
41046 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
41047 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
41048 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
41049 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
41050 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
41051 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
41052 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
41053 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
41054 @samp{OK}.
41055
41056 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
41057 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
41058 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
41059 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
41060 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
41061 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
41062 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
41063 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
41064 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
41065 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
41066 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
41067 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
41068 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
41069
41070 @node Packet Acknowledgment
41071 @section Packet Acknowledgment
41072
41073 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
41074 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
41075 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
41076 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
41077 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
41078 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
41079 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
41080
41081 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
41082 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
41083 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
41084 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
41085 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
41086
41087 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
41088 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
41089 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
41090 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
41091
41092 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
41093 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
41094 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
41095 @pxref{qSupported}.
41096 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
41097 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
41098 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
41099 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
41100 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
41101 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
41102 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
41103
41104 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
41105 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
41106 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
41107 connection.
41108 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
41109 new connection is established,
41110 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
41111 for the current connection, once disabled.
41112
41113 @node Examples
41114 @section Examples
41115
41116 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
41117 does not get any direct output:
41118
41119 @smallexample
41120 -> @code{R00}
41121 <- @code{+}
41122 @emph{target restarts}
41123 -> @code{?}
41124 <- @code{+}
41125 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41126 -> @code{+}
41127 @end smallexample
41128
41129 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
41130
41131 @smallexample
41132 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
41133 <- @code{+}
41134 -> @code{s}
41135 <- @code{+}
41136 @emph{time passes}
41137 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41138 -> @code{+}
41139 -> @code{g}
41140 <- @code{+}
41141 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
41142 -> @code{+}
41143 @end smallexample
41144
41145 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41146 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41147 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
41148
41149 @menu
41150 * File-I/O Overview::
41151 * Protocol Basics::
41152 * The F Request Packet::
41153 * The F Reply Packet::
41154 * The Ctrl-C Message::
41155 * Console I/O::
41156 * List of Supported Calls::
41157 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
41158 * Constants::
41159 * File-I/O Examples::
41160 @end menu
41161
41162 @node File-I/O Overview
41163 @subsection File-I/O Overview
41164 @cindex file-i/o overview
41165
41166 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
41167 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
41168 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
41169 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
41170 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
41171 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
41172
41173 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
41174 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
41175 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
41176 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
41177 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
41178
41179 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
41180 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
41181 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
41182 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
41183 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
41184 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
41185 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
41186
41187 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
41188 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
41189 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
41190 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
41191 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
41192
41193 @smallexample
41194 (@value{GDBP}) continue
41195 <- target requests 'system call X'
41196 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
41197 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
41198 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
41199 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
41200 @end smallexample
41201
41202 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
41203 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
41204 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
41205 system are not supported by this protocol.
41206
41207 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
41208
41209 @node Protocol Basics
41210 @subsection Protocol Basics
41211 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
41212
41213 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
41214 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
41215 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
41216 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
41217 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
41218 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
41219 to call the appropriate host system call:
41220
41221 @itemize @bullet
41222 @item
41223 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
41224
41225 @item
41226 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
41227 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
41228 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
41229 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
41230
41231 @end itemize
41232
41233 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
41234
41235 @itemize @bullet
41236 @item
41237 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
41238 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
41239 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
41240 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
41241 packet.
41242
41243 @item
41244 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
41245 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
41246
41247 @item
41248 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
41249
41250 @item
41251 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
41252
41253 @item
41254 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
41255 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
41256 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
41257 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
41258 packet.
41259
41260 @end itemize
41261
41262 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
41263 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
41264
41265 @itemize @bullet
41266 @item
41267 Return value.
41268
41269 @item
41270 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
41271
41272 @item
41273 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
41274
41275 @end itemize
41276
41277 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
41278 the latest continue or step action.
41279
41280 @node The F Request Packet
41281 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
41282 @cindex file-i/o request packet
41283 @cindex @code{F} request packet
41284
41285 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
41286
41287 @table @samp
41288 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
41289
41290 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
41291 This is just the name of the function.
41292
41293 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
41294 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
41295 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
41296 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
41297 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
41298 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
41299 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
41300
41301 @end table
41302
41303
41304
41305 @node The F Reply Packet
41306 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
41307 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
41308 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
41309
41310 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
41311
41312 @table @samp
41313
41314 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
41315
41316 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
41317
41318 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
41319 representation.
41320 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
41321
41322 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
41323 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
41324 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
41325
41326 @smallexample
41327 F0,0,C
41328 @end smallexample
41329
41330 @noindent
41331 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
41332
41333 @smallexample
41334 F-1,4,C
41335 @end smallexample
41336
41337 @noindent
41338 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
41339
41340 @end table
41341
41342
41343 @node The Ctrl-C Message
41344 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
41345 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
41346
41347 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
41348 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
41349 the target should behave as if it had
41350 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
41351 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
41352 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
41353 packet.
41354
41355 It's important for the target to know in which
41356 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
41357
41358 @itemize @bullet
41359 @item
41360 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
41361
41362 @item
41363 The system call on the host has been finished.
41364
41365 @end itemize
41366
41367 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
41368 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
41369 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
41370 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
41371 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
41372 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
41373
41374 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
41375 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
41376 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
41377 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
41378 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
41379 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
41380 or the full action has been completed.
41381
41382 @node Console I/O
41383 @subsection Console I/O
41384 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
41385
41386 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
41387 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
41388 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
41389 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
41390 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
41391 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
41392 conditions is met:
41393
41394 @itemize @bullet
41395 @item
41396 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
41397 @code{read}
41398 system call is treated as finished.
41399
41400 @item
41401 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
41402 newline.
41403
41404 @item
41405 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
41406 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
41407
41408 @end itemize
41409
41410 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
41411 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
41412 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
41413 is stopped at the user's request.
41414
41415
41416 @node List of Supported Calls
41417 @subsection List of Supported Calls
41418 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
41419
41420 @menu
41421 * open::
41422 * close::
41423 * read::
41424 * write::
41425 * lseek::
41426 * rename::
41427 * unlink::
41428 * stat/fstat::
41429 * gettimeofday::
41430 * isatty::
41431 * system::
41432 @end menu
41433
41434 @node open
41435 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
41436 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
41437
41438 @table @asis
41439 @item Synopsis:
41440 @smallexample
41441 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
41442 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
41443 @end smallexample
41444
41445 @item Request:
41446 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
41447
41448 @noindent
41449 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41450
41451 @table @code
41452 @item O_CREAT
41453 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
41454 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
41455 are concerned.
41456
41457 @item O_EXCL
41458 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
41459 an error and open() fails.
41460
41461 @item O_TRUNC
41462 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
41463 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
41464 truncated to zero length.
41465
41466 @item O_APPEND
41467 The file is opened in append mode.
41468
41469 @item O_RDONLY
41470 The file is opened for reading only.
41471
41472 @item O_WRONLY
41473 The file is opened for writing only.
41474
41475 @item O_RDWR
41476 The file is opened for reading and writing.
41477 @end table
41478
41479 @noindent
41480 Other bits are silently ignored.
41481
41482
41483 @noindent
41484 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
41485
41486 @table @code
41487 @item S_IRUSR
41488 User has read permission.
41489
41490 @item S_IWUSR
41491 User has write permission.
41492
41493 @item S_IRGRP
41494 Group has read permission.
41495
41496 @item S_IWGRP
41497 Group has write permission.
41498
41499 @item S_IROTH
41500 Others have read permission.
41501
41502 @item S_IWOTH
41503 Others have write permission.
41504 @end table
41505
41506 @noindent
41507 Other bits are silently ignored.
41508
41509
41510 @item Return value:
41511 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
41512 occurred.
41513
41514 @item Errors:
41515
41516 @table @code
41517 @item EEXIST
41518 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
41519
41520 @item EISDIR
41521 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
41522
41523 @item EACCES
41524 The requested access is not allowed.
41525
41526 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41527 @var{pathname} was too long.
41528
41529 @item ENOENT
41530 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41531
41532 @item ENODEV
41533 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
41534
41535 @item EROFS
41536 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
41537 write access was requested.
41538
41539 @item EFAULT
41540 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
41541
41542 @item ENOSPC
41543 No space on device to create the file.
41544
41545 @item EMFILE
41546 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
41547
41548 @item ENFILE
41549 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
41550 has been reached.
41551
41552 @item EINTR
41553 The call was interrupted by the user.
41554 @end table
41555
41556 @end table
41557
41558 @node close
41559 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
41560 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
41561
41562 @table @asis
41563 @item Synopsis:
41564 @smallexample
41565 int close(int fd);
41566 @end smallexample
41567
41568 @item Request:
41569 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
41570
41571 @item Return value:
41572 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
41573
41574 @item Errors:
41575
41576 @table @code
41577 @item EBADF
41578 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
41579
41580 @item EINTR
41581 The call was interrupted by the user.
41582 @end table
41583
41584 @end table
41585
41586 @node read
41587 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
41588 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
41589
41590 @table @asis
41591 @item Synopsis:
41592 @smallexample
41593 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
41594 @end smallexample
41595
41596 @item Request:
41597 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41598
41599 @item Return value:
41600 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
41601 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
41602 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
41603
41604 @item Errors:
41605
41606 @table @code
41607 @item EBADF
41608 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41609 reading.
41610
41611 @item EFAULT
41612 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41613
41614 @item EINTR
41615 The call was interrupted by the user.
41616 @end table
41617
41618 @end table
41619
41620 @node write
41621 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
41622 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
41623
41624 @table @asis
41625 @item Synopsis:
41626 @smallexample
41627 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
41628 @end smallexample
41629
41630 @item Request:
41631 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
41632
41633 @item Return value:
41634 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
41635 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
41636 is returned.
41637
41638 @item Errors:
41639
41640 @table @code
41641 @item EBADF
41642 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
41643 writing.
41644
41645 @item EFAULT
41646 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41647
41648 @item EFBIG
41649 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
41650 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
41651
41652 @item ENOSPC
41653 No space on device to write the data.
41654
41655 @item EINTR
41656 The call was interrupted by the user.
41657 @end table
41658
41659 @end table
41660
41661 @node lseek
41662 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
41663 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
41664
41665 @table @asis
41666 @item Synopsis:
41667 @smallexample
41668 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
41669 @end smallexample
41670
41671 @item Request:
41672 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
41673
41674 @var{flag} is one of:
41675
41676 @table @code
41677 @item SEEK_SET
41678 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
41679
41680 @item SEEK_CUR
41681 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
41682 bytes.
41683
41684 @item SEEK_END
41685 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
41686 bytes.
41687 @end table
41688
41689 @item Return value:
41690 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
41691 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
41692 value of -1 is returned.
41693
41694 @item Errors:
41695
41696 @table @code
41697 @item EBADF
41698 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
41699
41700 @item ESPIPE
41701 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
41702
41703 @item EINVAL
41704 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
41705
41706 @item EINTR
41707 The call was interrupted by the user.
41708 @end table
41709
41710 @end table
41711
41712 @node rename
41713 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
41714 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
41715
41716 @table @asis
41717 @item Synopsis:
41718 @smallexample
41719 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
41720 @end smallexample
41721
41722 @item Request:
41723 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
41724
41725 @item Return value:
41726 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41727
41728 @item Errors:
41729
41730 @table @code
41731 @item EISDIR
41732 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
41733 directory.
41734
41735 @item EEXIST
41736 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
41737
41738 @item EBUSY
41739 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41740 process.
41741
41742 @item EINVAL
41743 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41744 of itself.
41745
41746 @item ENOTDIR
41747 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41748 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41749 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41750
41751 @item EFAULT
41752 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41753
41754 @item EACCES
41755 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41756
41757 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41758
41759 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41760
41761 @item ENOENT
41762 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41763
41764 @item EROFS
41765 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41766
41767 @item ENOSPC
41768 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41769 directory entry.
41770
41771 @item EINTR
41772 The call was interrupted by the user.
41773 @end table
41774
41775 @end table
41776
41777 @node unlink
41778 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41779 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41780
41781 @table @asis
41782 @item Synopsis:
41783 @smallexample
41784 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41785 @end smallexample
41786
41787 @item Request:
41788 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41789
41790 @item Return value:
41791 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41792
41793 @item Errors:
41794
41795 @table @code
41796 @item EACCES
41797 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41798
41799 @item EPERM
41800 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41801
41802 @item EBUSY
41803 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41804 being used by another process.
41805
41806 @item EFAULT
41807 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41808
41809 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41810 @var{pathname} was too long.
41811
41812 @item ENOENT
41813 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41814
41815 @item ENOTDIR
41816 A component of the path is not a directory.
41817
41818 @item EROFS
41819 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41820
41821 @item EINTR
41822 The call was interrupted by the user.
41823 @end table
41824
41825 @end table
41826
41827 @node stat/fstat
41828 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41829 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41830 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41831
41832 @table @asis
41833 @item Synopsis:
41834 @smallexample
41835 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41836 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41837 @end smallexample
41838
41839 @item Request:
41840 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41841 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41842
41843 @item Return value:
41844 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41845
41846 @item Errors:
41847
41848 @table @code
41849 @item EBADF
41850 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41851
41852 @item ENOENT
41853 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41854 path is an empty string.
41855
41856 @item ENOTDIR
41857 A component of the path is not a directory.
41858
41859 @item EFAULT
41860 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41861
41862 @item EACCES
41863 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41864
41865 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41866 @var{pathname} was too long.
41867
41868 @item EINTR
41869 The call was interrupted by the user.
41870 @end table
41871
41872 @end table
41873
41874 @node gettimeofday
41875 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41876 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41877
41878 @table @asis
41879 @item Synopsis:
41880 @smallexample
41881 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41882 @end smallexample
41883
41884 @item Request:
41885 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41886
41887 @item Return value:
41888 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41889
41890 @item Errors:
41891
41892 @table @code
41893 @item EINVAL
41894 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41895
41896 @item EFAULT
41897 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41898 @end table
41899
41900 @end table
41901
41902 @node isatty
41903 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41904 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41905
41906 @table @asis
41907 @item Synopsis:
41908 @smallexample
41909 int isatty(int fd);
41910 @end smallexample
41911
41912 @item Request:
41913 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41914
41915 @item Return value:
41916 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41917
41918 @item Errors:
41919
41920 @table @code
41921 @item EINTR
41922 The call was interrupted by the user.
41923 @end table
41924
41925 @end table
41926
41927 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41928 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41929 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41930 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41931 needed.
41932
41933
41934 @node system
41935 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41936 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41937
41938 @table @asis
41939 @item Synopsis:
41940 @smallexample
41941 int system(const char *command);
41942 @end smallexample
41943
41944 @item Request:
41945 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41946
41947 @item Return value:
41948 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41949 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41950 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41951 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41952 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41953 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41954 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41955
41956 @item Errors:
41957
41958 @table @code
41959 @item EINTR
41960 The call was interrupted by the user.
41961 @end table
41962
41963 @end table
41964
41965 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41966 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41967 the host is simplified before it's returned
41968 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41969 is discarded, and the return value consists
41970 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41971
41972 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41973 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41974 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41975
41976 @table @code
41977 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41978 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41979 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41980 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41981
41982 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41983 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41984 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41985 protocol.
41986 @end table
41987
41988 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41989 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41990 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41991
41992 @menu
41993 * Integral Datatypes::
41994 * Pointer Values::
41995 * Memory Transfer::
41996 * struct stat::
41997 * struct timeval::
41998 @end menu
41999
42000 @node Integral Datatypes
42001 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
42002 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
42003
42004 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
42005 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
42006 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
42007
42008 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
42009 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
42010
42011 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
42012
42013 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
42014 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
42015
42016 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
42017
42018 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
42019 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
42020 byte order.
42021
42022 @node Pointer Values
42023 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
42024 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
42025
42026 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
42027 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
42028 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
42029 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
42030
42031 @smallexample
42032 @code{1aaf/12}
42033 @end smallexample
42034
42035 @noindent
42036 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
42037 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
42038 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
42039 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
42040
42041 @smallexample
42042 @code{123456/d}
42043 @end smallexample
42044
42045 @node Memory Transfer
42046 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
42047 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
42048
42049 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
42050 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
42051 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
42052 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
42053 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
42054 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
42055 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
42056
42057
42058 @node struct stat
42059 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
42060 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
42061
42062 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
42063 is defined as follows:
42064
42065 @smallexample
42066 struct stat @{
42067 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
42068 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
42069 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
42070 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
42071 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
42072 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
42073 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
42074 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
42075 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
42076 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
42077 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
42078 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
42079 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
42080 @};
42081 @end smallexample
42082
42083 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
42084 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
42085 structure is of size 64 bytes.
42086
42087 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
42088 range of values.
42089
42090 @table @code
42091
42092 @item st_dev
42093 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
42094
42095 @item st_ino
42096 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
42097
42098 @item st_mode
42099 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
42100 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
42101
42102 @item st_uid
42103 @itemx st_gid
42104 @itemx st_rdev
42105 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
42106
42107 @item st_atime
42108 @itemx st_mtime
42109 @itemx st_ctime
42110 These values have a host and file system dependent
42111 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
42112 support exact timing values.
42113 @end table
42114
42115 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
42116 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
42117 continuing.
42118
42119 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
42120 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
42121 get truncated on the target.
42122
42123 @node struct timeval
42124 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
42125 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
42126
42127 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
42128 is defined as follows:
42129
42130 @smallexample
42131 struct timeval @{
42132 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
42133 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
42134 @};
42135 @end smallexample
42136
42137 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
42138 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
42139 structure is of size 8 bytes.
42140
42141 @node Constants
42142 @subsection Constants
42143 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
42144
42145 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
42146 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
42147 values before and after the call as needed.
42148
42149 @menu
42150 * Open Flags::
42151 * mode_t Values::
42152 * Errno Values::
42153 * Lseek Flags::
42154 * Limits::
42155 @end menu
42156
42157 @node Open Flags
42158 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
42159 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
42160
42161 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
42162
42163 @smallexample
42164 O_RDONLY 0x0
42165 O_WRONLY 0x1
42166 O_RDWR 0x2
42167 O_APPEND 0x8
42168 O_CREAT 0x200
42169 O_TRUNC 0x400
42170 O_EXCL 0x800
42171 @end smallexample
42172
42173 @node mode_t Values
42174 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
42175 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
42176
42177 All values are given in octal representation.
42178
42179 @smallexample
42180 S_IFREG 0100000
42181 S_IFDIR 040000
42182 S_IRUSR 0400
42183 S_IWUSR 0200
42184 S_IXUSR 0100
42185 S_IRGRP 040
42186 S_IWGRP 020
42187 S_IXGRP 010
42188 S_IROTH 04
42189 S_IWOTH 02
42190 S_IXOTH 01
42191 @end smallexample
42192
42193 @node Errno Values
42194 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
42195 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
42196
42197 All values are given in decimal representation.
42198
42199 @smallexample
42200 EPERM 1
42201 ENOENT 2
42202 EINTR 4
42203 EBADF 9
42204 EACCES 13
42205 EFAULT 14
42206 EBUSY 16
42207 EEXIST 17
42208 ENODEV 19
42209 ENOTDIR 20
42210 EISDIR 21
42211 EINVAL 22
42212 ENFILE 23
42213 EMFILE 24
42214 EFBIG 27
42215 ENOSPC 28
42216 ESPIPE 29
42217 EROFS 30
42218 ENAMETOOLONG 91
42219 EUNKNOWN 9999
42220 @end smallexample
42221
42222 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
42223 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
42224
42225 @node Lseek Flags
42226 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
42227 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
42228
42229 @smallexample
42230 SEEK_SET 0
42231 SEEK_CUR 1
42232 SEEK_END 2
42233 @end smallexample
42234
42235 @node Limits
42236 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
42237 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
42238
42239 All values are given in decimal representation.
42240
42241 @smallexample
42242 INT_MIN -2147483648
42243 INT_MAX 2147483647
42244 UINT_MAX 4294967295
42245 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
42246 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
42247 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
42248 @end smallexample
42249
42250 @node File-I/O Examples
42251 @subsection File-I/O Examples
42252 @cindex file-i/o examples
42253
42254 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
42255 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
42256
42257 @smallexample
42258 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
42259 @emph{request memory read from target}
42260 -> @code{m1234,6}
42261 <- XXXXXX
42262 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
42263 -> @code{F6}
42264 @end smallexample
42265
42266 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
42267 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
42268
42269 @smallexample
42270 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42271 @emph{request memory write to target}
42272 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
42273 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
42274 -> @code{F6}
42275 @end smallexample
42276
42277 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
42278 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
42279
42280 @smallexample
42281 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42282 -> @code{F-1,9}
42283 @end smallexample
42284
42285 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
42286 host is called:
42287
42288 @smallexample
42289 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42290 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
42291 <- @code{T02}
42292 @end smallexample
42293
42294 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
42295 host is called:
42296
42297 @smallexample
42298 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
42299 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
42300 <- @code{T02}
42301 @end smallexample
42302
42303 @node Library List Format
42304 @section Library List Format
42305 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42306
42307 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
42308 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
42309 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
42310 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
42311 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
42312 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
42313 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
42314 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
42315 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
42316 are loaded.
42317
42318 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
42319 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
42320 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
42321 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
42322
42323 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
42324 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
42325 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
42326 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
42327 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
42328 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
42329
42330 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42331 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42332
42333 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
42334 offset, looks like this:
42335
42336 @smallexample
42337 <library-list>
42338 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
42339 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
42340 </library>
42341 </library-list>
42342 @end smallexample
42343
42344 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
42345 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
42346
42347 @smallexample
42348 <library-list>
42349 <library name="sharedlib.o">
42350 <section address="0x10000000"/>
42351 <section address="0x20000000"/>
42352 <section address="0x30000000"/>
42353 </library>
42354 </library-list>
42355 @end smallexample
42356
42357 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
42358
42359 @smallexample
42360 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
42361 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
42362 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42363 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
42364 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42365 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
42366 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42367 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
42368 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
42369 @end smallexample
42370
42371 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
42372 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
42373 section for each library.
42374
42375 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42376 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
42377 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
42378
42379 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
42380 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
42381 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
42382 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
42383
42384 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
42385 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
42386 target, the following parameters are reported:
42387
42388 @itemize @minus
42389 @item
42390 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
42391 @code{struct link_map}.
42392 @item
42393 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
42394 (Thread Local Storage) access.
42395 @item
42396 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
42397 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
42398 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
42399 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
42400 @item
42401 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
42402 @end itemize
42403
42404 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
42405 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
42406 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
42407
42408 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42409 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
42410
42411 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
42412 looks like this:
42413
42414 @smallexample
42415 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
42416 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
42417 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
42418 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
42419 l_ld="0x152350"/>
42420 </library-list-svr>
42421 @end smallexample
42422
42423 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
42424
42425 @smallexample
42426 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
42427 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
42428 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42429 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
42430 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
42431 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
42432 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
42433 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
42434 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
42435 @end smallexample
42436
42437 @node Memory Map Format
42438 @section Memory Map Format
42439 @cindex memory map format
42440
42441 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
42442 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
42443 memory map.
42444
42445 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
42446 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
42447 lists memory regions.
42448
42449 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42450 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
42451
42452 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42453
42454 @smallexample
42455 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42456 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
42457 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42458 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
42459 <memory-map>
42460 region...
42461 </memory-map>
42462 @end smallexample
42463
42464 Each region can be either:
42465
42466 @itemize
42467
42468 @item
42469 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
42470 bytes from there:
42471
42472 @smallexample
42473 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42474 @end smallexample
42475
42476
42477 @item
42478 A region of read-only memory:
42479
42480 @smallexample
42481 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42482 @end smallexample
42483
42484
42485 @item
42486 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
42487 bytes in length:
42488
42489 @smallexample
42490 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
42491 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
42492 </memory>
42493 @end smallexample
42494
42495 @end itemize
42496
42497 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
42498 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
42499 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
42500
42501 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
42502
42503 @smallexample
42504 <!-- ................................................... -->
42505 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
42506 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
42507 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
42508 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
42509 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
42510 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
42511 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
42512 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
42513 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
42514 and its type, or device. -->
42515 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
42516 start CDATA #REQUIRED
42517 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42518 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
42519 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
42520 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
42521 @end smallexample
42522
42523 @node Thread List Format
42524 @section Thread List Format
42525 @cindex thread list format
42526
42527 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
42528 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
42529 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
42530 the following structure:
42531
42532 @smallexample
42533 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42534 <threads>
42535 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
42536 ... description ...
42537 </thread>
42538 </threads>
42539 @end smallexample
42540
42541 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
42542 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
42543 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
42544 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
42545 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
42546 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
42547 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
42548 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
42549
42550
42551 @node Traceframe Info Format
42552 @section Traceframe Info Format
42553 @cindex traceframe info format
42554
42555 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
42556 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
42557 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
42558 collected in a traceframe.
42559
42560 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
42561 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
42562
42563 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42564 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42565
42566 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42567
42568 @smallexample
42569 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42570 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
42571 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
42572 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
42573 <traceframe-info>
42574 block...
42575 </traceframe-info>
42576 @end smallexample
42577
42578 Each traceframe block can be either:
42579
42580 @itemize
42581
42582 @item
42583 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
42584 @var{length} bytes from there:
42585
42586 @smallexample
42587 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
42588 @end smallexample
42589
42590 @item
42591 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
42592 collected:
42593
42594 @smallexample
42595 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
42596 @end smallexample
42597
42598 @end itemize
42599
42600 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
42601
42602 @smallexample
42603 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
42604 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42605
42606 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
42607 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
42608 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
42609 <!ELEMENT tvar>
42610 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
42611 @end smallexample
42612
42613 @node Branch Trace Format
42614 @section Branch Trace Format
42615 @cindex branch trace format
42616
42617 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
42618 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
42619 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
42620 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
42621
42622 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
42623 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
42624
42625 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42626 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42627
42628 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
42629
42630 @smallexample
42631 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42632 <!DOCTYPE btrace
42633 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
42634 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
42635 <btrace>
42636 block...
42637 </btrace>
42638 @end smallexample
42639
42640 @itemize
42641
42642 @item
42643 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
42644 and ending at @var{end}:
42645
42646 @smallexample
42647 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
42648 @end smallexample
42649
42650 @end itemize
42651
42652 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
42653
42654 @smallexample
42655 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
42656 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42657
42658 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
42659 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
42660 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
42661
42662 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
42663
42664 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
42665
42666 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
42667 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
42668 family CDATA #REQUIRED
42669 model CDATA #REQUIRED
42670 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
42671
42672 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
42673 @end smallexample
42674
42675 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
42676 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
42677 @cindex branch trace configuration format
42678
42679 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
42680 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
42681 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
42682
42683 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
42684 settings for that format. The following information is described:
42685
42686 @table @code
42687 @item bts
42688 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
42689 @table @code
42690 @item size
42691 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
42692 @end table
42693 @item pt
42694 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
42695 PT}) format.
42696 @table @code
42697 @item size
42698 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
42699 @end table
42700 @end table
42701
42702 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42703 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
42704
42705 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
42706
42707 @smallexample
42708 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
42709 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
42710
42711 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
42712 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42713
42714 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
42715 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
42716 @end smallexample
42717
42718 @include agentexpr.texi
42719
42720 @node Target Descriptions
42721 @appendix Target Descriptions
42722 @cindex target descriptions
42723
42724 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
42725 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
42726 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
42727 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
42728 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
42729 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
42730 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
42731
42732 @itemize @bullet
42733 @item
42734 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
42735 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
42736 @item
42737 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
42738 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42739 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42740 @item
42741 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42742 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42743 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42744 @end itemize
42745
42746 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42747 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42748 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42749 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42750 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42751
42752 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42753 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42754
42755 @menu
42756 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42757 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42758 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42759 descriptions.
42760 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42761 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42762 @end menu
42763
42764 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42765 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42766
42767 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42768 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42769 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42770 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42771 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42772 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42773 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42774 Format}.
42775
42776 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42777 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42778 specify a file are:
42779
42780 @table @code
42781 @cindex set tdesc filename
42782 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42783 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42784
42785 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42786 @item unset tdesc filename
42787 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42788 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42789
42790 @cindex show tdesc filename
42791 @item show tdesc filename
42792 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42793 @end table
42794
42795
42796 @node Target Description Format
42797 @section Target Description Format
42798 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42799
42800 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42801 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42802 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42803 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42804 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42805 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42806 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42807
42808 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42809 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42810 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42811 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42812 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42813
42814 Here is a simple target description:
42815
42816 @smallexample
42817 <target version="1.0">
42818 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42819 </target>
42820 @end smallexample
42821
42822 @noindent
42823 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42824 the x86-64 architecture.
42825
42826 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42827 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42828 are explained further below.
42829
42830 @smallexample
42831 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42832 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42833 <target version="1.0">
42834 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42835 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42836 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42837 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42838 </target>
42839 @end smallexample
42840
42841 @noindent
42842 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42843 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42844 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42845 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42846 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42847 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42848 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42849 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42850 the version mismatch.
42851
42852 @subsection Inclusion
42853 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42854 @cindex XInclude
42855 @ifnotinfo
42856 @cindex <xi:include>
42857 @end ifnotinfo
42858
42859 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42860 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42861 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42862 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42863 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42864
42865 @smallexample
42866 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42867 @end smallexample
42868
42869 @noindent
42870 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42871 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42872 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42873 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42874 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42875 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42876 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42877 original description.
42878
42879 @subsection Architecture
42880 @cindex <architecture>
42881
42882 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42883
42884 @smallexample
42885 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42886 @end smallexample
42887
42888 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42889 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42890
42891 @subsection OS ABI
42892 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42893
42894 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42895 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42896
42897 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42898
42899 @smallexample
42900 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42901 @end smallexample
42902
42903 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42904 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42905
42906 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42907 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42908
42909 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42910 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42911
42912 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42913
42914 @smallexample
42915 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42916 @end smallexample
42917
42918 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42919 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42920
42921 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42922 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42923 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42924 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42925 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42926 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42927 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42928
42929 @smallexample
42930 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42931 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42932 @end smallexample
42933
42934 @subsection Features
42935 @cindex <feature>
42936
42937 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42938 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42939 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42940 has this form:
42941
42942 @smallexample
42943 <feature name="@var{name}">
42944 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42945 @var{reg}@dots{}
42946 </feature>
42947 @end smallexample
42948
42949 @noindent
42950 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42951 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42952 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42953 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42954
42955 @subsection Types
42956
42957 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42958 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42959 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42960 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42961 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42962 and enum types.
42963
42964 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42965 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42966 Types must be defined before they are used.
42967
42968 @cindex <vector>
42969 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42970 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42971 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42972 @var{count}:
42973
42974 @smallexample
42975 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42976 @end smallexample
42977
42978 @cindex <union>
42979 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42980 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42981 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42982 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42983
42984 @smallexample
42985 <union id="@var{id}">
42986 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42987 @dots{}
42988 </union>
42989 @end smallexample
42990
42991 @cindex <struct>
42992 @cindex <flags>
42993 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42994 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42995 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42996 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42997 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42998 specified.
42999
43000 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
43001
43002 @smallexample
43003 <struct id="@var{id}">
43004 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
43005 @dots{}
43006 </struct>
43007 @end smallexample
43008
43009 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
43010 No implicit padding is added.
43011
43012 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
43013
43014 @smallexample
43015 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43016 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
43017 @dots{}
43018 </struct>
43019 @end smallexample
43020
43021 @smallexample
43022 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43023 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
43024 @dots{}
43025 </flags>
43026 @end smallexample
43027
43028 The @var{name} value is required.
43029 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
43030 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
43031 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
43032
43033 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
43034 is optional.
43035 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
43036 and zero represents the least significant bit.
43037
43038 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
43039 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
43040
43041 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
43042
43043 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
43044 defining them with @samp{struct}:
43045
43046 @itemize @bullet
43047 @item
43048 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
43049 @item
43050 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
43051 @end itemize
43052
43053 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
43054 defining them with @samp{flags}:
43055
43056 @itemize @bullet
43057 @item
43058 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
43059
43060 @smallexample
43061 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
43062 $1 = 42
43063 @end smallexample
43064
43065 @end itemize
43066
43067 @subsection Registers
43068 @cindex <reg>
43069
43070 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
43071
43072 @smallexample
43073 <reg name="@var{name}"
43074 bitsize="@var{size}"
43075 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
43076 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
43077 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
43078 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
43079 @end smallexample
43080
43081 @noindent
43082 The components are as follows:
43083
43084 @table @var
43085
43086 @item name
43087 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
43088
43089 @item bitsize
43090 The register's size, in bits.
43091
43092 @item regnum
43093 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
43094 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
43095 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
43096 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
43097 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
43098 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
43099 in order of increasing register number.
43100
43101 @item save-restore
43102 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
43103 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
43104 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
43105 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
43106 ABI.
43107
43108 @item type
43109 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
43110 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
43111 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
43112 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
43113 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
43114 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
43115
43116 @item group
43117 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
43118 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
43119 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
43120 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
43121 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
43122 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
43123 @code{info registers}.
43124
43125 @end table
43126
43127 @node Predefined Target Types
43128 @section Predefined Target Types
43129 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
43130
43131 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
43132 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
43133 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
43134 types. The currently supported types are:
43135
43136 @table @code
43137
43138 @item bool
43139 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
43140
43141 @item int8
43142 @itemx int16
43143 @itemx int24
43144 @itemx int32
43145 @itemx int64
43146 @itemx int128
43147 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43148
43149 @item uint8
43150 @itemx uint16
43151 @itemx uint24
43152 @itemx uint32
43153 @itemx uint64
43154 @itemx uint128
43155 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43156
43157 @item code_ptr
43158 @itemx data_ptr
43159 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
43160 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
43161 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
43162 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
43163 may be marked as data pointers.
43164
43165 @item ieee_single
43166 Single precision IEEE floating point.
43167
43168 @item ieee_double
43169 Double precision IEEE floating point.
43170
43171 @item arm_fpa_ext
43172 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
43173
43174 @item i387_ext
43175 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
43176
43177 @item i386_eflags
43178 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
43179
43180 @item i386_mxcsr
43181 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
43182
43183 @end table
43184
43185 @node Enum Target Types
43186 @section Enum Target Types
43187 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
43188
43189 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
43190 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
43191
43192 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
43193
43194 @smallexample
43195 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43196 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
43197 @dots{}
43198 </enum>
43199 @end smallexample
43200
43201 Enums must be defined before they are used.
43202
43203 @smallexample
43204 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
43205 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
43206 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
43207 </enum>
43208 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
43209 <field name="X" start="0"/>
43210 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
43211 </flags>
43212 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
43213 @end smallexample
43214
43215 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
43216 would be printed as:
43217
43218 @smallexample
43219 (gdb) info register flags
43220 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
43221 @end smallexample
43222
43223 @node Standard Target Features
43224 @section Standard Target Features
43225 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
43226
43227 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
43228 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
43229 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
43230 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
43231 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
43232 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
43233 can recognize them.
43234
43235 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
43236 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
43237 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
43238 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
43239 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
43240 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
43241 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
43242 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
43243
43244 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
43245 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
43246 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
43247
43248 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
43249 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
43250 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
43251 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
43252
43253 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
43254 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
43255 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
43256
43257 @menu
43258 * AArch64 Features::
43259 * ARC Features::
43260 * ARM Features::
43261 * i386 Features::
43262 * MicroBlaze Features::
43263 * MIPS Features::
43264 * M68K Features::
43265 * NDS32 Features::
43266 * Nios II Features::
43267 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
43268 * PowerPC Features::
43269 * RISC-V Features::
43270 * S/390 and System z Features::
43271 * Sparc Features::
43272 * TIC6x Features::
43273 @end menu
43274
43275
43276 @node AArch64 Features
43277 @subsection AArch64 Features
43278 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
43279
43280 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
43281 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
43282 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
43283
43284 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43285 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
43286 and @samp{fpcr}.
43287
43288 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
43289 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
43290 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
43291
43292 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.pauth} feature is optional. If present,
43293 it should contain registers @samp{pauth_dmask} and @samp{pauth_cmask}.
43294
43295 @node ARC Features
43296 @subsection ARC Features
43297 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
43298
43299 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
43300 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
43301 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
43302 that one of the core registers features is present.
43303 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
43304
43305 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
43306 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
43307 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
43308 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
43309 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
43310 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
43311 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
43312
43313 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
43314 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
43315 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
43316 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
43317 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
43318 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
43319
43320 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
43321 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
43322 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
43323 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
43324 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
43325 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
43326 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
43327 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
43328 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
43329 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
43330
43331 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
43332 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
43333
43334 @node ARM Features
43335 @subsection ARM Features
43336 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
43337
43338 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
43339 ARM targets.
43340 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
43341 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
43342
43343 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
43344 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
43345 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
43346 and @samp{xpsr}.
43347
43348 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
43349 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
43350
43351 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
43352 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
43353 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
43354 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
43355
43356 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
43357 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
43358 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
43359 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
43360 halves of the double-precision registers.
43361
43362 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
43363 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
43364 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
43365 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
43366 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
43367 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
43368
43369 @node i386 Features
43370 @subsection i386 Features
43371 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
43372
43373 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
43374 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43375
43376 @itemize @minus
43377 @item
43378 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
43379 @item
43380 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
43381 @item
43382 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
43383 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
43384 @item
43385 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
43386 @item
43387 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
43388 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
43389 @end itemize
43390
43391 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
43392
43393 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
43394 describe registers:
43395
43396 @itemize @minus
43397 @item
43398 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
43399 @item
43400 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
43401 @item
43402 @samp{mxcsr}
43403 @end itemize
43404
43405 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
43406 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
43407 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
43408
43409 @itemize @minus
43410 @item
43411 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
43412 @item
43413 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
43414 @end itemize
43415
43416 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
43417 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
43418
43419 @itemize @minus
43420 @item
43421 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
43422 @item
43423 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
43424 @end itemize
43425
43426 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
43427 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
43428
43429 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
43430 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
43431
43432 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
43433 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
43434 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
43435
43436 @itemize @minus
43437 @item
43438 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43439 @end itemize
43440
43441 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
43442
43443 @itemize @minus
43444 @item
43445 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43446 @end itemize
43447
43448 It should
43449 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
43450
43451 @itemize @minus
43452 @item
43453 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
43454 @item
43455 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
43456 @end itemize
43457
43458 It should
43459 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
43460
43461 @itemize @minus
43462 @item
43463 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
43464 @end itemize
43465
43466 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
43467 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
43468 valid for i386 and amd64.
43469
43470 @node MicroBlaze Features
43471 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
43472 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
43473
43474 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
43475 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43476 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
43477 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
43478 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
43479
43480 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
43481 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
43482
43483 @node MIPS Features
43484 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
43485 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
43486
43487 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
43488 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
43489 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
43490 on the target.
43491
43492 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
43493 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
43494 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43495
43496 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
43497 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
43498 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
43499 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43500
43501 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
43502 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
43503 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
43504 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43505
43506 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
43507 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
43508 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
43509
43510 @node M68K Features
43511 @subsection M68K Features
43512 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
43513
43514 @table @code
43515 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
43516 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
43517 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
43518 One of those features must be always present.
43519 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
43520 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
43521 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
43522 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
43523
43524 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
43525 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
43526 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
43527 @samp{fpiaddr}.
43528 @end table
43529
43530 @node NDS32 Features
43531 @subsection NDS32 Features
43532 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
43533
43534 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
43535 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
43536 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
43537 and @samp{pc}.
43538
43539 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
43540 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
43541 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
43542 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
43543
43544 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
43545 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
43546 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
43547 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
43548 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
43549 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
43550 support to it could be totally removed some day.
43551
43552 @node Nios II Features
43553 @subsection Nios II Features
43554 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
43555
43556 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
43557 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
43558 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
43559 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
43560 @samp{mpuacc}).
43561
43562 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
43563 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
43564 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
43565
43566 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
43567 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
43568 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
43569
43570 @node PowerPC Features
43571 @subsection PowerPC Features
43572 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
43573
43574 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
43575 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
43576 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
43577 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43578
43579 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43580 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
43581
43582 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
43583 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr}, and
43584 @samp{vrsave}. @value{GDBN} will define pseudo-registers @samp{v0}
43585 through @samp{v31} as aliases for the corresponding @samp{vrX}
43586 registers.
43587
43588 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43589 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} will
43590 combine these registers with the floating point registers (@samp{f0}
43591 through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} through
43592 @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} through
43593 @samp{vs63}, the set of vector-scalar registers for POWER7.
43594 Therefore, this feature requires both @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} and
43595 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec}.
43596
43597 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
43598 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
43599 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
43600 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
43601 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
43602 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
43603 user.
43604
43605 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43606 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
43607
43608 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43609 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
43610
43611 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
43612 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
43613
43614 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
43615 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
43616 64-bit wide.
43617
43618 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
43619 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
43620 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
43621 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
43622
43623 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
43624 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
43625 64-bit wide.
43626
43627 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
43628 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
43629 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
43630 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
43631 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
43632 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
43633 wide.
43634
43635 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
43636 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
43637 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
43638 @samp{cfpscr}.
43639
43640 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
43641 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
43642 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
43643 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
43644 wide.
43645
43646 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
43647 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
43648 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
43649 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
43650 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
43651 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
43652 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
43653 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
43654 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
43655
43656 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
43657 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
43658
43659 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
43660 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
43661
43662 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
43663 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
43664
43665
43666 @node RISC-V Features
43667 @subsection RISC-V Features
43668 @cindex target descriptions, RISC-V Features
43669
43670 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.cpu} feature is required for RISC-V
43671 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{x0} through
43672 @samp{x31}, and @samp{pc}. Either the architectural names (@samp{x0},
43673 @samp{x1}, etc) can be used, or the ABI names (@samp{zero}, @samp{ra},
43674 etc).
43675
43676 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.fpu} feature is optional. If present, it
43677 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fflags},
43678 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr}. As with the cpu feature, either the
43679 architectural register names, or the ABI names can be used.
43680
43681 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.virtual} feature is optional. If present,
43682 it should contain registers that are not backed by real registers on
43683 the target, but are instead virtual, where the register value is
43684 derived from other target state. In many ways these are like
43685 @value{GDBN}s pseudo-registers, except implemented by the target.
43686 Currently the only register expected in this set is the one byte
43687 @samp{priv} register that contains the target's privilege level in the
43688 least significant two bits.
43689
43690 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.csr} feature is optional. If present, it
43691 should contain all of the target's standard CSRs. Standard CSRs are
43692 those defined in the RISC-V specification documents. There is some
43693 overlap between this feature and the fpu feature; the @samp{fflags},
43694 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr} registers could be in either feature. The
43695 expectation is that these registers will be in the fpu feature if the
43696 target has floating point hardware, but can be moved into the csr
43697 feature if the target has the floating point control registers, but no
43698 other floating point hardware.
43699
43700 @node S/390 and System z Features
43701 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
43702 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
43703 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
43704
43705 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
43706 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
43707 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
43708 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
43709 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
43710 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
43711 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
43712 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
43713 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
43714
43715 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
43716 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
43717 @samp{fpc}.
43718
43719 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
43720 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
43721
43722 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
43723 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
43724 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
43725 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
43726 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
43727 32-bit wide.
43728
43729 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
43730 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
43731 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
43732
43733 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
43734 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
43735 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
43736 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
43737 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
43738 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
43739 @samp{v31}.
43740
43741 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
43742 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
43743 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
43744
43745 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
43746 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
43747 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
43748
43749 @node Sparc Features
43750 @subsection Sparc Features
43751 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
43752 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
43753 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43754 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43755
43756 @itemize @minus
43757 @item
43758 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
43759 @item
43760 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
43761 @item
43762 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
43763 @item
43764 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
43765 @end itemize
43766
43767 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
43768
43769 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43770 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43771
43772 @itemize @minus
43773 @item
43774 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
43775 @item
43776 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
43777 @end itemize
43778
43779 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
43780 targets. It should describe the following registers:
43781
43782 @itemize @minus
43783 @item
43784 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
43785 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
43786 @item
43787 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
43788 for sparc64
43789 @end itemize
43790
43791 @node TIC6x Features
43792 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
43793 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
43794 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
43795 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
43796 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
43797 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
43798
43799 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
43800 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
43801 through @samp{B31}.
43802
43803 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
43804 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
43805
43806 @node Operating System Information
43807 @appendix Operating System Information
43808 @cindex operating system information
43809
43810 @menu
43811 * Process list::
43812 @end menu
43813
43814 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
43815 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
43816 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
43817 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
43818 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
43819 on a different aspect of target.
43820
43821 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
43822 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
43823 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
43824 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
43825
43826 @node Process list
43827 @appendixsection Process list
43828 @cindex operating system information, process list
43829
43830 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
43831 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
43832 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
43833 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
43834
43835 An example document is:
43836
43837 @smallexample
43838 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43839 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
43840 <osdata type="processes">
43841 <item>
43842 <column name="pid">1</column>
43843 <column name="user">root</column>
43844 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43845 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43846 </item>
43847 </osdata>
43848 @end smallexample
43849
43850 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43851 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43852 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43853 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43854 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43855 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43856 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43857
43858 @node Trace File Format
43859 @appendix Trace File Format
43860 @cindex trace file format
43861
43862 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43863 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43864
43865 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43866 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43867 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43868 in the future.
43869
43870 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43871 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43872 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43873 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43874 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43875 of this section.
43876
43877 @table @code
43878 @item R @var{size}
43879 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43880 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43881 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43882 a single trace file.
43883
43884 @item status @var{status}
43885 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43886 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43887 file.
43888
43889 @item tp @var{payload}
43890 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43891 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43892 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43893 reply packets.
43894
43895 @item tsv @var{payload}
43896 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43897 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43898 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43899 reply packets.
43900
43901 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43902 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43903 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43904 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43905 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43906 file. Includes are not allowed.
43907
43908 @end table
43909
43910 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43911 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43912 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43913 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43914 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43915 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43916 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43917 endianness.
43918
43919 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43920
43921 @table @code
43922 @item R @var{bytes}
43923 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43924 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43925 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43926
43927 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43928 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43929 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43930 @var{length} bytes.
43931
43932 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43933 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43934 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43935
43936 @end table
43937
43938 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43939 of blocks.
43940
43941 @node Index Section Format
43942 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43943 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43944 @cindex index section format
43945
43946 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43947 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43948 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43949 description.
43950
43951 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43952 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43953 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43954 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43955 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43956 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43957
43958 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43959
43960 @enumerate
43961 @item
43962 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43963 unless otherwise noted:
43964
43965 @enumerate
43966 @item
43967 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43968 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43969 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43970 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43971 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43972 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43973 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43974
43975 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43976 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43977 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43978 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43979
43980 @item
43981 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43982
43983 @item
43984 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43985 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43986 to the next offset.
43987
43988 @item
43989 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43990
43991 @item
43992 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43993
43994 @item
43995 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43996 @end enumerate
43997
43998 @item
43999 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
44000 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
44001 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
44002 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
44003 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
44004 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
44005 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
44006 CU indices.
44007
44008 @item
44009 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
44010 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
44011 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
44012 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
44013
44014 @item
44015 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
44016 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
44017
44018 @enumerate
44019 @item
44020 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
44021
44022 @item
44023 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
44024 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
44025
44026 @item
44027 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
44028 @end enumerate
44029
44030 @item
44031 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
44032 the hash table is always a power of 2.
44033
44034 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
44035 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
44036 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
44037 constant pool.
44038
44039 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
44040 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
44041 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
44042
44043 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
44044 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
44045 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
44046 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
44047 index version:
44048
44049 @table @asis
44050 @item Version 4
44051 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
44052
44053 @item Versions 5 to 7
44054 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
44055 @end table
44056
44057 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
44058
44059 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
44060 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
44061 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
44062 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
44063 collision.
44064
44065 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
44066 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
44067 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
44068 the code.
44069
44070 @item
44071 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
44072 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
44073 strings.
44074
44075 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
44076 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
44077 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
44078 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
44079 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
44080 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
44081
44082 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
44083 @end enumerate
44084
44085 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
44086 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
44087 CU index+attributes value for each use.
44088
44089 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
44090 (bit 0 = LSB):
44091
44092 @table @asis
44093
44094 @item Bits 0-23
44095 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
44096 @item Bits 24-27
44097 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
44098 @item Bits 28-30
44099 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
44100
44101 @table @asis
44102 @item 0
44103 This value is reserved and should not be used.
44104 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
44105 with previous versions of the index.
44106 @item 1
44107 The symbol is a type.
44108 @item 2
44109 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
44110 @item 3
44111 The symbol is a function.
44112 @item 4
44113 Any other kind of symbol.
44114 @item 5,6,7
44115 These values are reserved.
44116 @end table
44117
44118 @item Bit 31
44119 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
44120
44121 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
44122 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
44123 @value{GDBN} sources.
44124
44125 @end table
44126
44127 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
44128 global/static attributes in the index.
44129
44130 @smallexample
44131 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
44132 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
44133 switch (die->tag)
44134 @{
44135 case DW_TAG_typedef:
44136 case DW_TAG_base_type:
44137 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
44138 kind = TYPE;
44139 is_static = 1;
44140 break;
44141 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
44142 kind = VARIABLE;
44143 is_static = language != CPLUS;
44144 break;
44145 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
44146 kind = FUNCTION;
44147 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
44148 break;
44149 case DW_TAG_constant:
44150 kind = VARIABLE;
44151 is_static = ! is_external;
44152 break;
44153 case DW_TAG_variable:
44154 kind = VARIABLE;
44155 is_static = ! is_external;
44156 break;
44157 case DW_TAG_namespace:
44158 kind = TYPE;
44159 is_static = 0;
44160 break;
44161 case DW_TAG_class_type:
44162 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
44163 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
44164 case DW_TAG_union_type:
44165 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
44166 kind = TYPE;
44167 is_static = language != CPLUS;
44168 break;
44169 default:
44170 assert (0);
44171 @}
44172 @end smallexample
44173
44174 @node Man Pages
44175 @appendix Manual pages
44176 @cindex Man pages
44177
44178 @menu
44179 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
44180 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
44181 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
44182 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
44183 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
44184 @end menu
44185
44186 @node gdb man
44187 @heading gdb man
44188
44189 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
44190
44191 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
44192 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
44193 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
44194 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
44195 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
44196 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
44197 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
44198 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
44199 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
44200 @c man end
44201
44202 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
44203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
44204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
44205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
44206
44207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
44208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
44209
44210 @itemize @bullet
44211 @item
44212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
44213
44214 @item
44215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
44216
44217 @item
44218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
44219
44220 @item
44221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
44222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
44223 @end itemize
44224
44225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
44226 Modula-2.
44227
44228 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
44229 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
44230 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
44231 by using the command @code{help}.
44232
44233 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
44234 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
44235 executable program as the argument:
44236
44237 @smallexample
44238 gdb program
44239 @end smallexample
44240
44241 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
44242
44243 @smallexample
44244 gdb program core
44245 @end smallexample
44246
44247 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
44248 to debug a running process:
44249
44250 @smallexample
44251 gdb program 1234
44252 gdb -p 1234
44253 @end smallexample
44254
44255 @noindent
44256 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
44257 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
44258 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
44259
44260 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
44261
44262 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
44263 @table @env
44264 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44265 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
44266
44267 @item run [@var{arglist}]
44268 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
44269
44270 @item bt
44271 Backtrace: display the program stack.
44272
44273 @item print @var{expr}
44274 Display the value of an expression.
44275
44276 @item c
44277 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
44278
44279 @item next
44280 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
44281 function calls in the line.
44282
44283 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44284 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
44285
44286 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
44287 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
44288
44289 @item step
44290 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
44291 function calls in the line.
44292
44293 @item help [@var{name}]
44294 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
44295 about using @value{GDBN}.
44296
44297 @item quit
44298 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
44299 @end table
44300
44301 @ifset man
44302 For full details on @value{GDBN},
44303 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44304 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
44305 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
44306 @end ifset
44307 @c man end
44308
44309 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
44310 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
44311 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
44312 encountered with no
44313 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
44314 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
44315 Many options have
44316 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
44317 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
44318 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
44319 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
44320 more usual convention.)
44321
44322 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
44323 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
44324 option is used.
44325
44326 @table @env
44327 @item -help
44328 @itemx -h
44329 List all options, with brief explanations.
44330
44331 @item -symbols=@var{file}
44332 @itemx -s @var{file}
44333 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
44334
44335 @item -write
44336 Enable writing into executable and core files.
44337
44338 @item -exec=@var{file}
44339 @itemx -e @var{file}
44340 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
44341 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
44342 dump.
44343
44344 @item -se=@var{file}
44345 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
44346 file.
44347
44348 @item -core=@var{file}
44349 @itemx -c @var{file}
44350 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
44351
44352 @item -command=@var{file}
44353 @itemx -x @var{file}
44354 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
44355
44356 @item -ex @var{command}
44357 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
44358
44359 @item -directory=@var{directory}
44360 @itemx -d @var{directory}
44361 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
44362
44363 @item -nh
44364 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
44365
44366 @item -nx
44367 @itemx -n
44368 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
44369
44370 @item -quiet
44371 @itemx -q
44372 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
44373 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
44374
44375 @item -batch
44376 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
44377 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
44378 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
44379 commands in the command files.
44380
44381 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
44382 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
44383 more useful, the message
44384
44385 @smallexample
44386 Program exited normally.
44387 @end smallexample
44388
44389 @noindent
44390 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
44391 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
44392
44393 @item -cd=@var{directory}
44394 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
44395 instead of the current directory.
44396
44397 @item -fullname
44398 @itemx -f
44399 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
44400 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
44401 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
44402 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
44403 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
44404 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
44405 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
44406 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
44407
44408 @item -b @var{bps}
44409 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
44410 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
44411
44412 @item -tty=@var{device}
44413 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
44414 @end table
44415 @c man end
44416
44417 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
44418 @ifset man
44419 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44420 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44421 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44422
44423 @smallexample
44424 info gdb
44425 @end smallexample
44426
44427 @noindent
44428 should give you access to the complete manual.
44429
44430 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44431 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44432 @end ifset
44433 @c man end
44434
44435 @node gdbserver man
44436 @heading gdbserver man
44437
44438 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
44439 @format
44440 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
44441 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44442
44443 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44444
44445 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44446 @c man end
44447 @end format
44448
44449 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
44450 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
44451 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
44452
44453 @ifclear man
44454 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
44455 @end ifclear
44456 @ifset man
44457 Usage (server (target) side):
44458 @end ifset
44459
44460 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
44461 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
44462 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
44463 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
44464
44465 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
44466 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
44467 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
44468
44469 @smallexample
44470 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
44471 @end smallexample
44472
44473 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
44474
44475 @smallexample
44476 @ifset man
44477 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
44478 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
44479 @end ifset
44480 @ifclear man
44481 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
44482 @end ifclear
44483 @end smallexample
44484
44485 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
44486 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
44487 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
44488
44489 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
44490
44491 @smallexample
44492 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
44493 @end smallexample
44494
44495 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
44496 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
44497 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
44498 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
44499 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
44500 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
44501 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
44502 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
44503 print an error message and exit.
44504
44505 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
44506 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
44507
44508 @smallexample
44509 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44510 @end smallexample
44511
44512 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44513 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44514
44515 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44516 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
44517 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
44518 the program you want to debug.
44519
44520 @smallexample
44521 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44522 @end smallexample
44523
44524 @ifclear man
44525 @subheading Usage (host side)
44526 @end ifclear
44527 @ifset man
44528 Usage (host side):
44529 @end ifset
44530
44531 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
44532 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
44533 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
44534 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
44535 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
44536 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
44537 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
44538 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
44539 descriptor. For example:
44540
44541 @smallexample
44542 @ifset man
44543 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
44544 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
44545 @end ifset
44546 @ifclear man
44547 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
44548 @end ifclear
44549 @end smallexample
44550
44551 @noindent
44552 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
44553
44554 @smallexample
44555 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
44556 @end smallexample
44557
44558 @noindent
44559 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
44560 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
44561 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
44562 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
44563 `Connection refused'.
44564
44565 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
44566 described in
44567 @ifset man
44568 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
44569 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
44570 @end ifset
44571 @ifclear man
44572 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
44573 @end ifclear
44574 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
44575
44576 @smallexample
44577 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
44578 @end smallexample
44579
44580 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
44581 case.
44582 @c man end
44583
44584 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
44585 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
44586
44587 @itemize @bullet
44588
44589 @item
44590 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
44591
44592 @smallexample
44593 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
44594 @end smallexample
44595
44596 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
44597 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
44598 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
44599 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
44600 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
44601 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
44602 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44603
44604 @item
44605 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
44606 program:
44607
44608 @smallexample
44609 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44610 @end smallexample
44611
44612 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
44613 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
44614 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
44615 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
44616
44617 @item
44618 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
44619
44620 @smallexample
44621 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44622 @end smallexample
44623
44624 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
44625 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
44626 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
44627 debug several processes in the same session.
44628 @end itemize
44629
44630 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
44631
44632 @table @env
44633
44634 @item --help
44635 List all options, with brief explanations.
44636
44637 @item --version
44638 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
44639
44640 @item --attach
44641 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
44642
44643 @smallexample
44644 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
44645 @end smallexample
44646
44647 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
44648 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
44649
44650 @item --multi
44651 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
44652 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
44653 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
44654 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
44655
44656 @smallexample
44657 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
44658 @end smallexample
44659
44660 @item --debug
44661 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
44662 process.
44663 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44664 the developers.
44665
44666 @item --remote-debug
44667 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
44668 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44669 the developers.
44670
44671 @item --debug-file=@var{filename}
44672 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to send any debug output to the given @var{filename}.
44673 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
44674 the developers.
44675
44676 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
44677 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
44678 of debugging output.
44679 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
44680
44681 @item --wrapper
44682 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
44683 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
44684 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
44685 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
44686
44687 @item --once
44688 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
44689 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
44690 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
44691 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
44692
44693 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
44694
44695 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
44696 @c QDisableRandomization.
44697
44698 @end table
44699 @c man end
44700
44701 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
44702 @ifset man
44703 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44704 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44705 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44706
44707 @smallexample
44708 info gdb
44709 @end smallexample
44710
44711 should give you access to the complete manual.
44712
44713 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44714 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44715 @end ifset
44716 @c man end
44717
44718 @node gcore man
44719 @heading gcore
44720
44721 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
44722
44723 @format
44724 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
44725 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
44726 @c man end
44727 @end format
44728
44729 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
44730 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
44731 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
44732 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
44733 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
44734 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
44735 its job the program remains running without any change.
44736 @c man end
44737
44738 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
44739 @table @env
44740 @item -a
44741 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
44742 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
44743 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
44744 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
44745 dump-excluded-mappings}).
44746
44747 @item -o @var{prefix}
44748 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
44749 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
44750 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
44751 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
44752 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
44753 @end table
44754 @c man end
44755
44756 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
44757 @ifset man
44758 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44759 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44760 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44761
44762 @smallexample
44763 info gdb
44764 @end smallexample
44765
44766 @noindent
44767 should give you access to the complete manual.
44768
44769 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44770 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44771 @end ifset
44772 @c man end
44773
44774 @node gdbinit man
44775 @heading gdbinit
44776
44777 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
44778
44779 @format
44780 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
44781 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44782 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44783 @end ifset
44784
44785 ~/.gdbinit
44786
44787 ./.gdbinit
44788 @c man end
44789 @end format
44790
44791 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
44792 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
44793 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
44794 described in
44795 @ifset man
44796 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
44797 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
44798 @end ifset
44799 @ifclear man
44800 @ref{Sequences}.
44801 @end ifclear
44802
44803 Please read more in
44804 @ifset man
44805 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
44806 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
44807 @end ifset
44808 @ifclear man
44809 @ref{Startup}.
44810 @end ifclear
44811
44812 @table @env
44813 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44814 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
44815 @end ifset
44816 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
44817 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
44818 @end ifclear
44819 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44820 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
44821 See more in
44822 @ifset man
44823 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
44824 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
44825 @end ifset
44826 @ifclear man
44827 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
44828 @end ifclear
44829
44830 @item ~/.gdbinit
44831 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
44832 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
44833
44834 @item ./.gdbinit
44835 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
44836 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
44837 See more in
44838 @ifset man
44839 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
44840 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
44841 @end ifset
44842 @ifclear man
44843 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
44844 @end ifclear
44845 @end table
44846 @c man end
44847
44848 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44849 @ifset man
44850 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44851
44852 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44853 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44854 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44855
44856 @smallexample
44857 info gdb
44858 @end smallexample
44859
44860 should give you access to the complete manual.
44861
44862 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44863 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44864 @end ifset
44865 @c man end
44866
44867 @node gdb-add-index man
44868 @heading gdb-add-index
44869 @pindex gdb-add-index
44870 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44871
44872 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44873
44874 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44875 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44876 @c man end
44877
44878 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44879 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44880 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44881 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44882 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44883 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44884
44885 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44886 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44887 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44888 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44889 named @code{.debug_*}).
44890
44891 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44892 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44893 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44894 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44895
44896 See more in
44897 @ifset man
44898 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44899 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44900 @end ifset
44901 @ifclear man
44902 @ref{Index Files}.
44903 @end ifclear
44904 @c man end
44905
44906 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44907 @ifset man
44908 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44909 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44910 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44911
44912 @smallexample
44913 info gdb
44914 @end smallexample
44915
44916 should give you access to the complete manual.
44917
44918 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44919 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44920 @end ifset
44921 @c man end
44922
44923 @include gpl.texi
44924
44925 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44926 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44927 @include fdl.texi
44928
44929 @node Concept Index
44930 @unnumbered Concept Index
44931
44932 @printindex cp
44933
44934 @node Command and Variable Index
44935 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44936
44937 @printindex fn
44938
44939 @tex
44940 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44941 % meantime:
44942 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44943 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44944 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44945 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44946 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44947 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44948 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44949 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44950 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44951 \page\colophon
44952 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44953 @end tex
44954
44955 @bye
This page took 0.985491 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.